gdb
gdb
(GDB)
Table of Contents
Summary of gdb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Free Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Free Software Needs Free Documentation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Contributors to gdb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
3 gdb Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
3.1 Command Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
3.2 Command Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
3.3 Command Completion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
3.4 Command options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
3.5 Getting Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
13 Tracepoints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
13.1 Commands to Set Tracepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
13.1.1 Create and Delete Tracepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
13.1.2 Enable and Disable Tracepoints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
13.1.3 Tracepoint Passcounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
13.1.4 Tracepoint Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
13.1.5 Trace State Variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
13.1.6 Tracepoint Action Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
13.1.7 Listing Tracepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
13.1.8 Listing Static Tracepoint Markers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
13.1.9 Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
13.1.10 Tracepoint Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
13.2 Using the Collected Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
13.2.1 tfind n . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
13.2.2 tdump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
13.2.3 save tracepoints filename . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
13.3 Convenience Variables for Tracepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
13.4 Using Trace Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 810
lseek . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 810
rename . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 810
unlink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
stat/fstat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
gettimeofday . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
isatty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
E.13.8 Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes . . . . . . . . . . 813
Integral Datatypes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
Pointer Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
Memory Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 814
struct stat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 814
struct timeval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
E.13.9 Constants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
Open Flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
mode t Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
Errno Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
Lseek Flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
E.13.10 File-I/O Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
E.14 Library List Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 817
E.15 Library List Format for SVR4 Targets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 818
E.16 Memory Map Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 818
E.17 Thread List Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
E.18 Traceframe Info Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 820
E.19 Branch Trace Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 820
E.20 Branch Trace Configuration Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 821
Summary of gdb
The purpose of a debugger such as gdb is to allow you to see what is going on “inside”
another program while it executes—or what another program was doing at the moment it
crashed.
gdb can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of these) to help you
catch bugs in the act:
• Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
• Make your program stop on specified conditions.
• Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
• Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the effects of
one bug and go on to learn about another.
You can use gdb to debug programs written in C and C++. For more information, see
Section 15.4 [Supported Languages], page 227. For more information, see Section 15.4.1 [C
and C++], page 227.
Support for D is partial. For information on D, see Section 15.4.2 [D], page 234.
Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see Section 15.4.9
[Modula-2], page 240.
Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see Section 15.4.5
[OpenCL C], page 235.
Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or nested functions
does not currently work. gdb does not support entering expressions, printing values, or
similar features using Pascal syntax.
gdb can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although it may be necessary
to refer to some variables with a trailing underscore.
gdb can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C, using either the Ap-
ple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
Free Software
gdb is free software, protected by the gnu General Public License (GPL). The GPL gives
you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed program—but every person getting a copy also
gets with it the freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to the
source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies. Typical software companies use
copyrights to limit your freedoms; the Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve
these freedoms.
Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that you have these
freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away from anyone else.
texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package; when an important free
software package does not come with a free manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap.
We have many such gaps today.
Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people normally use are non-free.
How did this come about? Because the authors of those manuals published them with
restrictive terms—no copying, no modification, source files not available—which exclude
them from the free software world.
That wasn’t the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far from the last.
Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a manual that he is writing, his
intended contribution to the community, only to learn that he had ruined everything by
signing a publication contract to make it non-free.
Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not price. The problem
with the non-free manual is not that publishers charge a price for printed copies—that in
itself is fine. (The Free Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals are available in source
code form, and give you permission to copy and modify. Non-free manuals do not allow
this.
The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for free software.
Redistribution (including the normal kinds of commercial redistribution) must be permitted,
so that the manual can accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too. When people mod-
ify the software, adding or changing features, if they are conscientious they will change
the manual too—so they can provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified
program. A manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document a
changed version of the program is not really available to our community.
Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are acceptable. For example,
requirements to preserve the original author’s copyright notice, the distribution terms, or
the list of authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions to include
notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that may not be deleted or changed
are acceptable, as long as they deal with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of
restrictions are acceptable because they don’t obstruct the community’s normal use of the
manual.
However, it must be possible to modify all the technical content of the manual, and then
distribute the result in all the usual media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the
restrictions obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another manual to
replace it.
Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to lose manuals
to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that free software needs free reference
manuals and free tutorials, perhaps the next person who wants to contribute by writing
documentation will realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to the
free software community.
If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under the GNU Free
Documentation License or another free documentation license. Remember that this deci-
sion requires your approval—you don’t have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial
publishers will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the option; it is up
Summary of gdb 3
to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is what you want. If the publisher you
are dealing with refuses, please try other publishers. If you’re not sure whether a proposed
license is free, write to licensing@gnu.org.
You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted manuals and
tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying copies from the publishers that paid
for their writing or for major improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free
documentation at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it, and
insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom. Check the history of
the book, and try to reward the publishers that have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation published by other
publishers, at http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html.
Contributors to gdb
Richard Stallman was the original author of gdb, and of many other gnu programs. Many
others have contributed to its development. This section attempts to credit major con-
tributors. One of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it;
with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file ChangeLog in the gdb
distribution approximates a blow-by-blow account.
Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
Plea: Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you or your friends
(or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly omitted from this list, we
would like to add your names!
So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we particularly thank those
who shepherded gdb through major releases: Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0,
5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0); Jim Blandy (release 4.18); Jason Molenda (release 4.17); Stan Shebs
(release 4.14); Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9); Stu Grossman
and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4); John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1,
4.0, and 3.9); Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3); and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1,
and 3.0).
Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris Hanson, and
Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the gnu C++ support in gdb, with significant
additional contributions from Per Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the gnu
C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general
update work leading to release 3.0).
gdb uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple object-file formats; BFD was
a joint project of David V. Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John
Gilmore.
David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did the original support
for encapsulated COFF.
Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support. Per Bothner,
Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS support. Jean-Daniel Fekete
contributed Sun 386i support. Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support. Noboyuki
4 Debugging with gdb
Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support. David Johnson con-
tributed Encore Umax support. Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support. Jeff
Law contributed HP PA and SOM support. Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support. Bob Rusk contributed Harris
Nighthawk CX-UX support. Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran de-
bugging). Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support. Michael Tiemann contributed
SPARC support. Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powern-
ode. Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support. Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry
support. Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
Andreas Schwab contributed M68K gnu/Linux support.
Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared libraries.
Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that gdb and GAS agree about several
machine instruction sets.
Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop remote
debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM contributed remote
debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI, and RDI targets, respectively.
Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing command-line editing and
command history.
Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the Modula-2 sup-
port, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4. He also enhanced the
command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded symbols.
Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300,
H8/500, and Super-H processors.
NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D proces-
sors.
Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware watchpoints.
Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made nearly innumerable
bug fixes and cleanups throughout gdb.
The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed support for the PA-
RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0 (narrow mode), HP’s implementation
of kernel threads, HP’s aC++ compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User
Interface): Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish
Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
information in this manual.
DJ Delorie ported gdb to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project. Robert Hoehne made
significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
Summary of gdb 5
Cygnus Solutions has sponsored gdb maintenance and much of its development since
1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on gdb fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim
Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin
Hunt, Jim Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek Radouch, Keith Seitz,
Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael,
Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank
Eigler, Doug Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff Holcomb,
Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, Jason Merrill, Catherine
Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike
Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim
Wilson, and David Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for Cygnus Solu-
tions, implemented the original gdb/mi interface.
Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red Hat.
Andrew Cagney designed gdb’s architecture vector. Many people including Andrew
Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Ket-
tenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab,
Jason Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped with the
migration of old architectures to this new framework.
Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented gdb’s unwinder framework,
this consisting of a fresh new design featuring frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and
the sentinel frame. Mark Kettenis implemented the dwarf 2 unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and trad unwinders.
The architecture-specific changes, each involving a complete rewrite of the architecture’s
frame code, were carried out by Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew
Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei Sakamoto, Yoshinori
Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich Weigand.
Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from Tensilica, Inc.
contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others who have worked on the Xtensa port of
gdb in the past include Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the Xilinx MicroBlaze
architecture.
Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration was developed
by SRI International and the University of Cambridge Computer Laboratory under
DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH
research programme.
Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration was developed by
SRI International and the University of Cambridge Computer Laboratory (Department of
Computer Science and Technology) under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"),
as part of the DARPA SSITH research programme.
The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to Alessandro Forin and
Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien,
Stefan Wallentowitz and Stafford Horne.
6 Debugging with gdb
Weimin Pan, David Faust and Jose E. Marchesi contributed support for the Linux kernel
BPF virtual architecture. This work was sponsored by Oracle.
7
foo
0000
define(bar,defn(‘foo’))
bar
0000
changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)
define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))
baz
Ctrl-d
m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
Let us use gdb to try to see what is going on.
$ gdb m4
gdb is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
the conditions.
There is absolutely no warranty for gdb; type "show warranty"
for details.
Using the run command, we start m4 running under gdb control; as long as control does
not reach the m4_changequote subroutine, the program runs as usual:
(gdb) run
Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
define(foo,0000)
foo
0000
To trigger the breakpoint, we call changequote. gdb suspends execution of m4, displaying
information about the context where it stops.
changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)
define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))
baz
0000
10 Debugging with gdb
Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The problem seems to
have been just the two typos defining the wrong lengths. We allow m4 exit by giving it an
EOF as input:
Ctrl-d
Program exited normally.
The message ‘Program exited normally.’ is from gdb; it indicates m4 has finished execut-
ing. We can end our gdb session with the gdb quit command.
(gdb) quit
11
-init-command file
-ix file Execute commands from file file before loading the inferior (but after loading
gdbinit files). See Section 2.1.3 [Startup], page 16.
Chapter 2: Getting In and Out of gdb 13
-init-eval-command command
-iex command
Execute a single gdb command before loading the inferior (but after loading
gdbinit files). See Section 2.1.3 [Startup], page 16.
-early-init-command file
-eix file Execute commands from file very early in the initialization process, before any
output is produced. See Section 2.1.3 [Startup], page 16.
-early-init-eval-command command
-eiex command
Execute a single gdb command very early in the initialization process, before
any output is produced.
-directory directory
-d directory
Add directory to the path to search for source and script files.
-r
-readnow Read each symbol file’s entire symbol table immediately, rather than the default,
which is to read it incrementally as it is needed. This makes startup slower,
but makes future operations faster.
--readnever
Do not read each symbol file’s symbolic debug information. This makes startup
faster but at the expense of not being able to perform symbolic debugging.
DWARF unwind information is also not read, meaning backtraces may become
incomplete or inaccurate. One use of this is when a user simply wants to do
the following sequence: attach, dump core, detach. Loading the debugging
information in this case is an unnecessary cause of delay.
-batch Run in batch mode. Exit with status 0 after processing all the command files
specified with ‘-x’ (and all commands from initialization files, if not inhibited
with ‘-n’). Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the gdb
commands in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets un-
limited terminal width and height see Section 22.4 [Screen Size], page 360, and
acts as if set confirm off were in effect (see Section 22.9 [Messages/Warnings],
page 371).
Batch mode may be useful for running gdb as a filter, for example to download
and run a program on another computer; in order to make this more useful, the
message
Program exited normally.
(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under gdb control
terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
-batch-silent
Run in batch mode exactly like ‘-batch’, but totally silently. All gdb output to
stdout is prevented (stderr is unaffected). This is much quieter than ‘-silent’
and would be useless for an interactive session.
This is particularly useful when using targets that give ‘Loading section’ mes-
sages, for example.
Note that targets that give their output via gdb, as opposed to writing directly
to stdout, will also be made silent.
-return-child-result
The return code from gdb will be the return code from the child process (the
process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
• gdb exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an internal
error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been without
‘-return-child-result’.
• The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., ‘quit 1’.
• The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
the exit code will be -1.
This option is useful in conjunction with ‘-batch’ or ‘-batch-silent’, when
gdb is being used as a remote program loader or simulator interface.
-nowindows
-nw “No windows”. If gdb comes with a graphical user interface (GUI) built in,
then this option tells gdb to only use the command-line interface. If no GUI is
available, this option has no effect.
-windows
-w If gdb includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be used if possible.
-cd directory
Run gdb using directory as its working directory, instead of the current direc-
tory.
Chapter 2: Getting In and Out of gdb 15
-data-directory directory
-D directory
Run gdb using directory as its data directory. The data directory is where gdb
searches for its auxiliary files. See Section 18.7 [Data Files], page 301.
-fullname
-f gnu Emacs sets this option when it runs gdb as a subprocess. It tells gdb to
output the full file name and line number in a standard, recognizable fashion
each time a stack frame is displayed (which includes each time your program
stops). This recognizable format looks like two ‘\032’ characters, followed by
the file name, line number and character position separated by colons, and a
newline. The Emacs-to-gdb interface program uses the two ‘\032’ characters
as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
-annotate level
This option sets the annotation level inside gdb. Its effect is identical to using
‘set annotate level’ (see Chapter 28 [Annotations], page 675). The annota-
tion level controls how much information gdb prints together with its prompt,
values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
normal, level 1 is for use when gdb is run as a subprocess of gnu Emacs, level
3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs that control gdb, and level
2 has been deprecated.
The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by gdb/mi (see
Chapter 27 [GDB/MI], page 569).
--args Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the exe-
cutable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior. This option
stops option processing.
-baud bps
-b bps Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial interface used by
gdb for remote debugging.
-l timeout
Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by gdb for remote
debugging.
-tty device
-t device Run using device for your program’s standard input and output.
-tui Activate the Text User Interface when starting. The Text User Interface man-
ages several text windows on the terminal, showing source, assembly, regis-
ters and gdb command outputs (see Chapter 25 [gdb Text User Interface],
page 559). Do not use this option if you run gdb from Emacs (see Chapter 26
[Using gdb under gnu Emacs], page 567).
-interpreter interp
Use the interpreter interp for interface with the controlling program or device.
This option is meant to be set by programs which communicate with gdb using
it as a back end. See Chapter 24 [Command Interpreters], page 557.
‘--interpreter=mi’ (or ‘--interpreter=mi3’) causes gdb to use the gdb/mi
interface version 3 (see Chapter 27 [The gdb/mi Interface], page 569) included
16 Debugging with gdb
since gdb version 9.1. gdb/mi version 2 (mi2), included in gdb 6.0 and version
1 (mi1), included in gdb 5.3, are also available. Earlier gdb/mi interfaces are
no longer supported.
-write Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This is equiv-
alent to the ‘set write on’ command inside gdb (see Section 17.6 [Patching],
page 279).
-statistics
This option causes gdb to print statistics about time and memory usage after
it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
-version This option causes gdb to print its version number and no-warranty blurb, and
exit.
-configuration
This option causes gdb to print details about its build-time configuration pa-
rameters, and then exit. These details can be important when reporting gdb
bugs (see Chapter 32 [GDB Bugs], page 689).
10. If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to attach to, or a core
file, gdb loads any auto-loaded scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared
libraries. See Section 22.8 [Auto-loading], page 366.
If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup, you must do something like the
following:
$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
Option ‘-ex’ does not work because the auto-loading is then turned off too late.
11. Executes commands and command files specified by the ‘-ex’ and ‘-x’ options in their
specified order. See Section 23.1.3 [Command Files], page 385, for more details about
gdb command files.
12. Reads the command history recorded in the history file. See Section 22.3 [Command
History], page 358, for more details about the command history and the files where
gdb records it.
It is possible to prevent the home directory early initialization file from being loaded
using the ‘-nx’ or ‘-nh’ command line options, see Section 2.1.2 [Choosing Modes], page 13.
system.gdbinit
This is a single system-wide initialization file. Its location is specified with
the --with-system-gdbinit configure option (see Section C.6 [System-wide
configuration], page 733). It is loaded first when gdb starts, before command
line options have been processed.
system.gdbinit.d
This is the system-wide initialization directory. Its location is specified with the
--with-system-gdbinit-dir configure option (see Section C.6 [System-wide
configuration], page 733). Files in this directory are loaded in alphabetical
order immediately after system.gdbinit (if enabled) when gdb starts, before
command line options have been processed. Files need to have a recognized
scripting language extension (.py/.scm) or be named with a .gdb extension
to be interpreted as regular gdb commands. gdb will not recurse into any
subdirectories of this directory.
It is possible to prevent the system wide initialization files from being loaded using the
‘-nx’ command line option, see Section 2.1.2 [Choosing Modes], page 13.
1
On DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the HOME environment variable.
Chapter 2: Getting In and Out of gdb 19
If you have been using gdb to control an attached process or device, you can release
it with the detach command (see Section 4.7 [Debugging an Already-running Process],
page 41).
shell command-string
!command-string
Invoke a shell to execute command-string. Note that no space is needed between
! and command-string. On GNU and Unix systems, the environment variable
SHELL, if it exists, determines which shell to run. Otherwise gdb uses the
default shell (/bin/sh on GNU and Unix systems, cmd.exe on MS-Windows,
COMMAND.COM on MS-DOS, etc.).
You may also invoke shell commands from expressions, using the $_shell convenience
function. See [$ shell convenience function], page 172.
The utility make is often needed in development environments. You do not have to use
the shell command for this purpose in gdb:
make make-args
Execute the make program with the specified arguments. This is equivalent to
‘shell make make-args’.
(gdb) p /x var
$4 = {
black = 0x90,
red = 0xe9,
green = 0x179,
blue = 0x262,
white = 0x3db
}
(gdb) ||grep red
red => 0xe9,
(gdb) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e ’s/|/PIPE/’
this contains a PIPE char
(gdb) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e ’s/|/PIPE/’
this contains a PIPE char!
(gdb)
3 gdb Commands
You can abbreviate a gdb command to the first few letters of the command name, if that
abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain gdb commands by typing just
RET. You can also use the TAB key to get gdb to fill out the rest of a word in a command
(or to show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
completing on things like function names as collecting all the possible candidates
can be time consuming. The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-
completion. Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
completion slow.
show max-completions
Show the maximum number of candidates that gdb will collect and show during
completion.
Sometimes the string you need, while logically a “word”, may contain parentheses or
other characters that gdb normally excludes from its notion of a word. To permit word
completion to work in this situation, you may enclose words in ’ (single quote marks) in
gdb commands.
A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an expression that involves a
C++ symbol name with template parameters. This is because when completing expressions,
GDB treats the ‘<’ character as word delimiter, assuming that it’s the less-than comparison
operator (see Section 15.4.1.1 [C and C++ Operators], page 227).
For example, when you want to call a C++ template function interactively using the
print or call commands, you may need to distinguish whether you mean the version
of name that was specialized for int, name<int>(), or the version that was specialized for
float, name<float>(). To use the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single
quote ’ at the beginning of the function name. This alerts gdb that it may need to consider
more information than usual when you press TAB or M-? to request word completion:
(gdb) p ’func<M-?
func<int>() func<float>()
(gdb) p ’func<
When setting breakpoints however (see Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122),
you don’t usually need to type a quote before the function name, because gdb understands
that you want to set a breakpoint on a function:
(gdb) b func<M-?
func<int>() func<float>()
(gdb) b func<
This is true even in the case of typing the name of C++ overloaded functions (multiple
definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument type). For example, when you
want to set a breakpoint you don’t need to distinguish whether you mean the version of
name that takes an int parameter, name(int), or the version that takes a float parameter,
name(float).
(gdb) b bubble(M-?
bubble(int) bubble(double)
(gdb) b bubble(douM-?
bubble(double)
See [quoting names], page 259, for a description of other scenarios that require quoting.
For more information about overloaded functions, see Section 15.4.1.3 [C++ Expressions],
page 230. You can use the command set overload-resolution off to disable overload
resolution; see Section 15.4.1.7 [gdb Features for C++], page 231.
Chapter 3: gdb Commands 27
When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a structure, gdb also tries1
to limit completions to the field names available in the type of the left-hand-side:
(gdb) p gdb_stdout.M-?
magic to_fputs to_rewind
to_data to_isatty to_write
to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
to_flush to_read
This is because the gdb_stdout is a variable of the type struct ui_file that is defined in
gdb sources as follows:
struct ui_file
{
int *magic;
ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
void *to_data;
}
help class
Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a list of
the individual commands in that class. If a command has aliases, the aliases
are given after the command name, separated by commas. If an alias has
default arguments, the full definition of the alias is given after the first line.
For example, here is the help display for the class status:
(gdb) help status
Status inquiries.
List of commands:
Chapter 3: gdb Commands 29
help command
With a command name as help argument, gdb displays a short paragraph on
how to use that command. If that command has one or more aliases, gdb
will display a first line with the command name and all its aliases separated by
commas. This first line will be followed by the full definition of all aliases having
default arguments. When asking the help for an alias, the documentation for
the aliased command is shown.
A user-defined alias can optionally be documented using the document com-
mand (see Section 23.1.1 [Define], page 381). gdb then considers this alias as
different from the aliased command: this alias is not listed in the aliased com-
mand help output, and asking help for this alias will show the documentation
provided for the alias instead of the documentation of the aliased command.
apropos [-v] regexp
The apropos command searches through all of the gdb commands and aliases,
and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in args. It prints
out all matches found. The optional flag ‘-v’, which stands for ‘verbose’,
indicates to output the full documentation of the matching commands and
highlight the parts of the documentation matching regexp. For example:
apropos alias
results in:
alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
aliases -- User-defined aliases of other commands
while
apropos -v cut.*thread apply
results in the below output, where ‘cut for ’thread apply’ is highlighted if
styling is enabled.
taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
and empty output).
Usage: taas COMMAND
shortcut for ’thread apply all -s COMMAND’
complete args
The complete args command lists all the possible completions for the begin-
ning of a command. Use args to specify the beginning of the command you
want completed. For example:
complete i
results in:
if
ignore
info
inspect
This is intended for use by gnu Emacs.
In addition to help, you can use the gdb commands info and show to inquire about
the state of your program, or the state of gdb itself. Each command supports many topics
of inquiry; this manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
under info and under show in the Command, Variable, and Function Index point to all the
sub-commands. See [Command and Variable Index], page 911.
info This command (abbreviated i) is for describing the state of your program. For
example, you can show the arguments passed to a function with info args,
list the registers currently in use with info registers, or list the breakpoints
you have set with info breakpoints. You can get a complete list of the info
sub-commands with help info.
set You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with set.
For example, you can set the gdb prompt to a $-sign with set prompt $.
show In contrast to info, show is for describing the state of gdb itself. You can
change most of the things you can show, by using the related command set;
for example, you can control what number system is used for displays with set
radix, or simply inquire which is currently in use with show radix.
To display all the settable parameters and their current values, you can use
show with no arguments; you may also use info set. Both commands produce
the same display.
Here are several miscellaneous show subcommands, all of which are exceptional in lacking
corresponding set commands:
show version
Show what version of gdb is running. You should include this information in
gdb bug-reports. If multiple versions of gdb are in use at your site, you may
need to determine which version of gdb you are running; as gdb evolves, new
commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many system
vendors ship variant versions of gdb, and there are variant versions of gdb in
gnu/Linux distributions as well. The version number is the same as the one
announced when you start gdb.
show copying
info copying
Display information about permission for copying gdb.
Chapter 3: gdb Commands 31
show warranty
info warranty
Display the gnu “NO WARRANTY” statement, or a warranty, if your version
of gdb comes with one.
show configuration
Display detailed information about the way gdb was configured when it was
built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the configure script
and also configuration parameters detected automatically by configure. When
reporting a gdb bug (see Chapter 32 [GDB Bugs], page 689), it is important
to include this information in your report.
33
When you run a program under gdb, you must first generate debugging information when
you compile it.
You may start gdb with its arguments, if any, in an environment of your choice. If you
are doing native debugging, you may redirect your program’s input and output, debug an
already running process, or kill a child process.
To request debugging information, specify the ‘-g’ option when you run the compiler.
Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with optimizations,
using the ‘-O’ compiler option. However, some compilers are unable to handle the ‘-g’ and
‘-O’ options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized executables
containing debugging information.
gcc, the gnu C/C++ compiler, supports ‘-g’ with or without ‘-O’, making it possible
to debug optimized code. We recommend that you always use ‘-g’ whenever you compile
a program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense in pushing your
luck. For more information, see Chapter 11 [Optimized Code], page 191.
Older versions of the gnu C compiler permitted a variant option ‘-gg’ for debugging
information. gdb no longer supports this format; if your gnu C compiler has this option,
do not use it.
gdb knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their expansion (see Chapter 12
[Macros], page 195). Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros
in the debugging information if you specify the -g flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of gcc,
the gnu C compiler, provides macro information if you are using the DWARF debugging
format, and specify the option -g3.
See Section “Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC” in Using the gnu Compiler
Collection (GCC), for more information on gcc options affecting debug information.
You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest version of the DWARF
debugging format that your compiler supports. DWARF is currently the most expressive
and best supported debugging format in gdb.
34 Debugging with gdb
If you are running your program in an execution environment that supports processes,
run creates an inferior process and makes that process run your program. In some envi-
ronments without processes, run jumps to the start of your program. Other targets, like
‘remote’, are always running. If you get an error message like this one:
The "remote" target does not support "run".
Try "help target" or "continue".
then use continue to run your program. You may need load first (see [load], page 305).
The execution of a program is affected by certain information it receives from its superior.
gdb provides ways to specify this information, which you must do before starting your
program. (You can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect your
program the next time you start it.) This information may be divided into four categories:
The arguments.
Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the run com-
mand. If a shell is available on your target, the shell is used to pass the argu-
ments, so that you may use normal conventions (such as wildcard expansion or
variable substitution) in describing the arguments. In Unix systems, you can
control which shell is used with the SHELL environment variable. If you do not
define SHELL, gdb uses the default shell (/bin/sh). You can disable use of any
shell with the set startup-with-shell command (see below for details).
The environment.
Your program normally inherits its environment from gdb, but you can use
the gdb commands set environment and unset environment to change parts
of the environment that affect your program. See Section 4.4 [Your Program’s
Environment], page 38.
The working directory.
You can set your program’s working directory with the command set cwd. If
you do not set any working directory with this command, your program will
inherit gdb’s working directory if native debugging, or the remote server’s work-
ing directory if remote debugging. See Section 4.5 [Your Program’s Working
Directory], page 39.
The standard input and output.
Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and standard
output as gdb is using. You can redirect input and output in the run command
line, or you can use the tty command to set a different device for your program.
See Section 4.6 [Your Program’s Input and Output], page 40.
Chapter 4: Running Programs Under gdb 35
Warning: While input and output redirection work, you cannot use pipes to
pass the output of the program you are debugging to another program; if you
attempt this, gdb is likely to wind up debugging the wrong program.
When you issue the run command, your program begins to execute immediately. See
Chapter 5 [Stopping and Continuing], page 57, for discussion of how to arrange for your
program to stop. Once your program has stopped, you may call functions in your program,
using the print or call commands. See Chapter 10 [Examining Data], page 137.
If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last time gdb read its
symbols, gdb discards its symbol table, and reads it again. When it does this, gdb tries to
retain your current breakpoints.
start The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language. With
C or C++, the main procedure name is always main, but other languages such
as Ada do not require a specific name for their main procedure. The debugger
provides a convenient way to start the execution of the program and to stop at
the beginning of the main procedure, depending on the language used.
The ‘start’ command does the equivalent of setting a temporary breakpoint
at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking the ‘run’ command.
Some programs contain an elaboration phase where some startup code is exe-
cuted before the main procedure is called. This depends on the languages used
to write your program. In C++, for instance, constructors for static and global
objects are executed before main is called. It is therefore possible that the
debugger stops before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary
breakpoint will remain to halt execution.
Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the ‘start’
command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the underlying ‘run’
command. Note that the same arguments will be reused if no argument is
provided during subsequent calls to ‘start’ or ‘run’.
It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In these
cases, using the start command would stop the execution of your program
too late, as the program would have already completed the elaboration phase.
Under these circumstances, either insert breakpoints in your elaboration code
before running your program or use the starti command.
starti The ‘starti’ command does the equivalent of setting a temporary breakpoint
at the first instruction of a program’s execution and then invoking the ‘run’
command. For programs containing an elaboration phase, the starti command
will stop execution at the start of the elaboration phase.
set exec-wrapper wrapper
show exec-wrapper
unset exec-wrapper
When ‘exec-wrapper’ is set, the specified wrapper is used to launch programs
for debugging. gdb starts your program with a shell command of the form exec
wrapper program. Quoting is added to program and its arguments, but not to
wrapper, so you should add quotes if appropriate for your shell. The wrapper
runs until it executes your program, and then gdb takes control.
36 Debugging with gdb
You can use any program that eventually calls execve with its arguments as
a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do this, e.g. env and nohup. Any
Unix shell script ending with exec "$@" will also work.
For example, you can use env to pass an environment variable to the debugged
program, without setting the variable in your shell’s environment:
(gdb) set exec-wrapper env ’LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so’
(gdb) run
This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
djgpp, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
set startup-with-shell
set startup-with-shell on
set startup-with-shell off
show startup-with-shell
On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target, gdb) uses it
to start your program. Arguments of the run command are passed to the shell,
which does variable substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs
redirection of I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use
of a shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing startup
failures such as:
(gdb) run
Starting program: ./a.out
During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with ‘exec-wrapper’ crashed,
not your program. Most often, this is caused by something odd in your shell’s
non-interactive mode initialization file—such as .cshrc for C-shell, $.zshenv
for the Z shell, or the file specified in the BASH_ENV environment variable for
BASH.
set auto-connect-native-target
set auto-connect-native-target on
set auto-connect-native-target off
show auto-connect-native-target
By default, if the current inferior is not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
target remote), the run command starts your program as a native process
under gdb, on your local machine. If you’re sure you don’t want to debug pro-
grams on your local machine, you can tell gdb to not connect to the native tar-
get automatically with the set auto-connect-native-target off command.
If on, which is the default, and if the current inferior is not connected to a
target already, the run command automaticaly connects to the native target, if
one is available.
If off, and if the current inferior is not connected to a target already, the run
command fails with an error:
(gdb) run
Don’t know how to run. Try "help target".
If the current inferior is already connected to a target, gdb always uses it with
the run command.
Chapter 4: Running Programs Under gdb 37
In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the target
native command. For example,
(gdb) set auto-connect-native-target off
(gdb) run
Don’t know how to run. Try "help target".
(gdb) target native
(gdb) run
Starting program: ./a.out
[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
In case you connected explicitly to the native target, gdb remains connected
even if all inferiors exit, ready for the next run command. Use the disconnect
command to disconnect.
Examples of other commands that likewise respect the auto-connect-native-
target setting: attach, info proc, info os.
set disable-randomization
set disable-randomization on
This option (enabled by default in gdb) will turn off the native randomiza-
tion of the virtual address space of the started program. This option is useful
for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better reproducible and
memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including gnu/Linux. On
gnu/Linux you can get the same behavior using
(gdb) set exec-wrapper setarch ‘uname -m‘ -R
prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such executable
using gcc -fPIE -pie.
Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed ran-
domly (as long as the randomization is enabled).
show disable-randomization
Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
the virtual address space of the started program.
show paths
Display the list of search paths for executables (the PATH environment variable).
show environment [varname]
Print the value of environment variable varname to be given to your program
when it starts. If you do not supply varname, print the names and values of
all environment variables to be given to your program. You can abbreviate
environment as env.
set environment varname [=value]
Set environment variable varname to value. The value changes for your pro-
gram (and the shell gdb uses to launch it), not for gdb itself. The value may be
any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and any inter-
pretation is supplied by your program itself. The value parameter is optional;
if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a null value.
For example, this command:
set env USER = foo
tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
‘foo’. (The spaces around ‘=’ are used for clarity here; they are not actually
required.)
Note that on Unix systems, gdb runs your program via a shell, which also
inherits the environment set with set environment. If necessary, you can avoid
that by using the ‘env’ program as a wrapper instead of using set environment.
See [set exec-wrapper], page 35, for an example doing just that.
Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted
to gdbserver to be used when starting the remote inferior. see
[QEnvironmentHexEncoded], page 767.
unset environment varname
Remove variable varname from the environment to be passed to your program.
This is different from ‘set env varname =’; unset environment removes the
variable from the environment, rather than assigning it an empty value.
Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on gdbserver
when starting the remote inferior. see [QEnvironmentUnset], page 767.
Warning: On Unix systems, gdb runs your program using the shell indicated by your
SHELL environment variable if it exists (or /bin/sh if not). If your SHELL variable names
a shell that runs an initialization file when started non-interactively—such as .cshrc for
C-shell, $.zshenv for the Z shell, or the file specified in the BASH_ENV environment variable
for BASH—any variables you set in that file affect your program. You may wish to move
setting of environment variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as .login
or .profile.
directory if native debugging, or it will inherit the remote server’s current working directory
if remote debugging.
set cwd [directory]
Set the inferior’s working directory to directory, which will be glob-expanded
in order to resolve tildes (~). If no argument has been specified, the command
clears the setting and resets it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on
gdb’s working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start the
inferior. The ~ in directory is a short for the home directory, usually pointed
to by the HOME environment variable. On MS-Windows, if HOME is not defined,
gdb uses the concatenation of HOMEDRIVE and HOMEPATH as fallback.
You can also change gdb’s current working directory by using the cd command.
See [cd command], page 40.
show cwd Show the inferior’s working directory. If no directory has been specified by set
cwd, then the default inferior’s working directory is the same as gdb’s working
directory.
cd [directory]
Set the gdb working directory to directory. If not given, directory uses ’~’.
The gdb working directory serves as a default for the commands that specify
files for gdb to operate on. See Section 18.1 [Commands to Specify Files],
page 285. See [set cwd command], page 40.
pwd Print the gdb working directory.
It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of the process being
debugged (since a program can change its directory during its run). If you work on a system
where gdb supports the info proc command (see Section 21.1.2 [Process Information],
page 329), you can use the info proc command to find out the current working directory
of the debuggee.
the default for future run commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
process, for future run commands. For example,
tty /dev/ttyb
directs that processes started with subsequent run commands default to do input and output
on the terminal /dev/ttyb and have that as their controlling terminal.
An explicit redirection in run overrides the tty command’s effect on the input/output
device, but not its effect on the controlling terminal.
When you use the tty command or redirect input in the run command, only the input
for your program is affected. The input for gdb still comes from your terminal. tty is an
alias for set inferior-tty.
You can use the show inferior-tty command to tell gdb to display the name of the
terminal that will be used for future runs of your program.
set inferior-tty [ tty ]
Set the tty for the program being debugged to tty. Omitting tty restores the
default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as gdb.
show inferior-tty
Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
confirms loading the process executable file, then its symbols will be loaded as
well.
show exec-file-mismatch
Show the current value of exec-file-mismatch.
The first thing gdb does after arranging to debug the specified process is to stop it. You
can examine and modify an attached process with all the gdb commands that are ordinarily
available when you start processes with run. You can insert breakpoints; you can step and
continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the process continue running, you
may use the continue command after attaching gdb to the process.
detach When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the detach
command to release it from gdb control. Detaching the process continues its
execution. After the detach command, that process and gdb become com-
pletely independent once more, and you are ready to attach another process
or start one with run. detach does not repeat if you press RET again after
executing the command.
If you exit gdb while you have an attached process, you detach that process. If you use
the run command, you kill that process. By default, gdb asks for confirmation if you try
to do either of these things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using
the set confirm command (see Section 22.9 [Optional Warnings and Messages], page 371).
be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are different from
process ids. Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although
some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts of a single
address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
The commands info inferiors and info connections, which will be introduced below,
accept a space-separated ID list as their argument specifying one or more elements on
which to operate. A list element can be either a single non-negative number, like ‘5’, or an
ascending range of such numbers, like ‘5-7’. A list can consist of any combination of such
elements, even duplicates or overlapping ranges are valid. E.g. ‘1 4-6 5 4-4’ or ‘1 2 4-7’.
To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use info inferiors:
info inferiors
Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by gdb. By default all
inferiors are printed, but the ID list id. . . can be used to limit the display to
just the requested inferiors.
gdb displays for each inferior (in this order):
1. the inferior number assigned by gdb
2. the target system’s inferior identifier
3. the target connection the inferior is bound to, including the unique con-
nection number assigned by gdb, and the protocol used by the connection.
4. the name of the executable the inferior is running.
An asterisk ‘*’ preceding the gdb inferior number indicates the current inferior.
For example,
(gdb) info inferiors
Num Description Connection Executable
* 1 process 3401 1 (native) goodbye
2 process 2307 2 (extended-remote host:10000) hello
To get information about the current inferior, use inferior:
inferior Shows information about the current inferior.
For example,
(gdb) inferior
[Current inferior is 1 [process 3401] (helloworld)]
To find out what open target connections exist at any moment, use info connections:
info connections
Print a list of all open target connections currently being managed by gdb. By
default all connections are printed, but the ID list id. . . can be used to limit
the display to just the requested connections.
gdb displays for each connection (in this order):
1. the connection number assigned by gdb.
2. the protocol used by the connection.
3. a textual description of the protocol used by the connection.
An asterisk ‘*’ preceding the connection number indicates the connection of the
current inferior.
For example,
44 Debugging with gdb
2. the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g., the
file command.
3. the name of the core file loaded into the program space, with e.g., the
core-file command.
An asterisk ‘*’ preceding the gdb program space number indicates the current
program space.
In addition, below each program space line, gdb prints extra information that
isn’t suitable to display in tabular form. For example, the list of inferiors bound
to the program space.
(gdb) maint info program-spaces
Id Executable Core File
* 1 hello
2 goodbye
Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
Here we can see that no inferior is running the program hello, while process
21561 is running the program goodbye. On some targets, it is possible that
multiple inferiors are bound to the same program space. The most common
example is that of debugging both the parent and child processes of a vfork
call. For example,
(gdb) maint info program-spaces
Id Executable Core File
* 1 vfork-test
Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program space as
a result of inferior 1 having executed a vfork call.
The gdb thread debugging facility allows you to observe all threads while your program
runs—but whenever gdb takes control, one thread in particular is always the focus of
debugging. This thread is called the current thread. Debugging commands show program
information from the perspective of the current thread.
Whenever gdb detects a new thread in your program, it displays the target system’s
identification for the thread with a message in the form ‘[New systag]’, where systag is a
thread identifier whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
gnu/Linux, you might see
[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
when gdb notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems, the systag is simply some-
thing like ‘process 368’, with no further qualifier.
For debugging purposes, gdb associates its own thread number —always a single
integer—with each thread of an inferior. This number is unique between all threads of an
inferior, but not unique between threads of different inferiors.
You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified inferior-num.thread-num
syntax, also known as qualified thread ID, with inferior-num being the inferior number and
thread-num being the thread number of the given inferior. For example, thread 2.3 refers
to thread number 3 of inferior 2. If you omit inferior-num (e.g., thread 3), then gdb infers
you’re referring to a thread of the current inferior.
Until you create a second inferior, gdb does not show the inferior-num part of thread
IDs, even though you can always use the full inferior-num.thread-num form to refer to
threads of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
Some commands accept a space-separated thread ID list as argument. A list element
can be:
1. A thread ID as shown in the first field of the ‘info threads’ display, with or without
an inferior qualifier. E.g., ‘2.1’ or ‘1’.
2. A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior qualifier, as in inf.thr1-
thr2 or thr1-thr2. E.g., ‘1.2-4’ or ‘2-4’.
3. All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or without an inferior
qualifier, as in inf.* (e.g., ‘1.*’) or *. The former refers to all threads of the given
inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier refers to all threads of the
current inferior.
For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one thread with ID 7.1, the
thread list ‘1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*’ includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior
4, threads 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in expanded qualified
form, the same as ‘1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9 7.1’.
In addition to a per-inferior number, each thread is also assigned a unique global number,
also known as global thread ID, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when you’re debugging multiple
inferiors.
From gdb’s perspective, a process always has at least one thread. In other words,
gdb assigns a thread number to the program’s “main thread” even if the program is not
multi-threaded.
48 Debugging with gdb
See Section 5.1.2 [Setting Watchpoints], page 65, for information about watchpoints in
programs with multiple threads.
set libthread-db-search-path [path]
If this variable is set, path is a colon-separated list of directories gdb will use
to search for libthread_db. If you omit path, ‘libthread-db-search-path’
will be reset to its default value ($sdir:$pdir on gnu/Linux and Solaris sys-
tems). Internally, the default value comes from the LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_
PATH macro.
On gnu/Linux and Solaris systems, gdb uses a “helper” libthread_db li-
brary to obtain information about threads in the inferior process. gdb will use
‘libthread-db-search-path’ to find libthread_db. gdb also consults first if
inferior specific thread debugging library loading is enabled by ‘set auto-load
libthread-db’ (see Section 22.8.2 [libthread db.so.1 file], page 368).
A special entry ‘$sdir’ for ‘libthread-db-search-path’ refers to the default
system directories that are normally searched for loading shared libraries. The
‘$sdir’ entry is the only kind not needing to be enabled by ‘set auto-load
libthread-db’ (see Section 22.8.2 [libthread db.so.1 file], page 368).
A special entry ‘$pdir’ for ‘libthread-db-search-path’ refers to the directory
from which libpthread was loaded in the inferior process.
For any libthread_db library gdb finds in above directories, gdb attempts
to initialize it with the current inferior process. If this initialization fails
(which could happen because of a version mismatch between libthread_db
and libpthread), gdb will unload libthread_db, and continue with the next
directory. If none of libthread_db libraries initialize successfully, gdb will
issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
Setting libthread-db-search-path is currently implemented only on some
platforms.
show libthread-db-search-path
Display current libthread db search path.
set debug libthread-db
show debug libthread-db
Turns on or off display of libthread_db-related events. Use 1 to enable, 0 to
disable.
set debug threads [on|off]
show debug threads
When ‘on’ gdb will print additional messages when threads are created and
deleted.
However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround which isn’t too
painful. Put a call to sleep in the code which the child process executes after the fork. It
may be useful to sleep only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
so that the delay need not occur when you don’t want to run gdb on the child. While the
child is sleeping, use the ps program to get its process ID. Then tell gdb (a new invocation
of gdb if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to the child process (see
Section 4.7 [Attach], page 41). From that point on you can debug the child process just like
any other process which you attached to.
On some systems, gdb provides support for debugging programs that create additional
processes using the fork or vfork functions. On gnu/Linux platforms, this feature is
supported with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when connected to
gdbserver in either target remote mode or target extended-remote mode.
By default, when a program forks, gdb will continue to debug the parent process and
the child process will run unimpeded.
If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process, use the command
set follow-fork-mode.
set follow-fork-mode mode
Set the debugger response to a program call of fork or vfork. A call to fork
or vfork creates a new process. The mode argument can be:
parent The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process
runs unimpeded. This is the default.
child The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
unimpeded.
show follow-fork-mode
Display the current debugger response to a fork or vfork call.
On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the command
set detach-on-fork.
set detach-on-fork mode
Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or retain debugger
control over them both.
on The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
follow-fork-mode) will be detached and allowed to run indepen-
dently. This is the default.
off Both processes will be held under the control of gdb. One process
(child or parent, depending on the value of follow-fork-mode) is
debugged as usual, while the other is held suspended.
show detach-on-fork
Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
If you choose to set ‘detach-on-fork’ mode off, then gdb will retain control of all forked
processes (including nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
Chapter 4: Running Programs Under gdb 53
gdb by using the info inferiors command, and switch from one fork to another by using
the inferior command (see Section 4.9 [Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and
Programs], page 42).
To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach from it by using
the detach inferiors command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it using the
kill inferiors command. See Section 4.9 [Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and
Programs], page 42.
If you ask to debug a child process and a vfork is followed by an exec, gdb executes
the new target up to the first breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
main in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on the child process’s main.
On some systems, when a child process is spawned by vfork, you cannot debug the child
or parent until an exec call completes.
If you issue a run command to gdb after an exec call executes, the new target restarts.
To restart the parent process, use the file command with the parent executable name
as its argument. By default, after an exec call executes, gdb discards the symbols of the
previous executable image. You can change this behaviour with the set follow-exec-mode
command.
set follow-exec-mode mode
Set debugger response to a program call of exec. An exec call replaces the
program image of a process.
follow-exec-mode can be:
new gdb creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this new
inferior. The program the process was running before the exec call
can be restarted afterwards by restarting the original inferior.
For example:
(gdb) info inferiors
(gdb) info inferior
Id Description Executable
* 1 <null> prog1
(gdb) run
process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
Program exited normally.
(gdb) info inferiors
Id Description Executable
1 <null> prog1
* 2 <null> prog2
same gdb keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new exe-
cutable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the infe-
rior. Restarting the inferior after the exec call, with e.g., the run
command, restarts the executable the process was running after the
exec call. This is the default mode.
For example:
(gdb) info inferiors
Id Description Executable
* 1 <null> prog1
(gdb) run
process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
54 Debugging with gdb
like ‘5-7’. When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list are
operated on.
break locspec
Set a breakpoint at all the code locations in your program that result from re-
solving the given locspec. locspec can specify a function name, a line number,
an address of an instruction, and more. See Section 9.2 [Location Specifica-
tions], page 122, for the various forms of locspec. The breakpoint will stop
your program just before it executes the instruction at the address of any of
the breakpoint’s code locations.
When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as C++,
a function name may refer to more than one symbol, and thus more than one
place to break. See Section 10.2 [Ambiguous Expressions], page 142, for a
discussion of that situation.
It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program only if a
specific thread (see Section 5.5.4 [Thread-Specific Breakpoints], page 96) or a
specific task (see Section 15.4.10.7 [Ada Tasks], page 251) hits that breakpoint.
break When called without any arguments, break sets a breakpoint at the next in-
struction to be executed in the selected stack frame (see Chapter 8 [Examining
the Stack], page 109). In any selected frame but the innermost, this makes
your program stop as soon as control returns to that frame. This is similar to
the effect of a finish command in the frame inside the selected frame—except
that finish does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use break without
an argument in the innermost frame, gdb stops the next time it reaches the
current location; this may be useful inside loops.
gdb normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at least one
instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you would be unable to pro-
ceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the breakpoint. This rule applies
whether or not the breakpoint already existed when your program stopped.
break ... if cond
Set a breakpoint with condition cond; evaluate the expression cond each time
the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the value is nonzero—that is, if cond
evaluates as true. ‘...’ stands for one of the possible arguments described
above (or no argument) specifying where to break. See Section 5.1.6 [Break
Conditions], page 75, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
The breakpoint may be mapped to multiple locations. If the breakpoint condi-
tion cond is invalid at some but not all of the locations, the locations for which
the condition is invalid are disabled. For example, gdb reports below that two
of the three locations are disabled.
(gdb) break func if a == 10
warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11ce, disabling:
No symbol "a" in current context.
warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11b6, disabling:
No symbol "a" in current context.
Breakpoint 1 at 0x11b6: func. (3 locations)
Locations that are disabled because of the condition are denoted by an upper-
case N in the output of the info breakpoints command:
(gdb) info breakpoints
Num Type Disp Enb Address What
60 Debugging with gdb
For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware breakpoints gdb
will use, see [set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit], page 318.
thbreak args
Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The args are the
same as for the hbreak command and the breakpoint is set in the same way.
However, like the tbreak command, the breakpoint is automatically deleted
after the first time your program stops there. Also, like the hbreak command,
the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
have this support. See Section 5.1.5 [Disabling Breakpoints], page 74. See also
Section 5.1.6 [Break Conditions], page 75.
rbreak regex
Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression regex. This
command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all matches, printing a list of all
breakpoints it set. Once these breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the
breakpoints set with the break command. You can delete them, disable them,
or make them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
In programs using different languages, gdb chooses the syntax to print the list
of all breakpoints it sets according to the ‘set language’ value: using ‘set
language auto’ (see Section 15.1.3 [Set Language Automatically], page 224)
means to use the language of the breakpoint’s function, other values mean to use
the manually specified language (see Section 15.1.2 [Set Language Manually],
page 224).
The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools like
grep. Note that this is different from the syntax used by shells, so for instance
foo* matches all functions that include an fo followed by zero or more os.
There is an implicit .* leading and trailing the regular expression you supply,
so to match only functions that begin with foo, use ^foo.
When debugging C++ programs, rbreak is useful for setting breakpoints on
overloaded functions that are not members of any special classes.
The rbreak command can be used to set breakpoints in all the functions in a
program, like this:
(gdb) rbreak .
rbreak file:regex
If rbreak is called with a filename qualification, it limits the search for functions
matching the given regular expression to the specified file. This can be used,
for example, to set breakpoints on every function in a given file:
(gdb) rbreak file.c:.
The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may optionally be
surrounded by spaces.
info breakpoints [list...]
info break [list...]
Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and not
deleted. Optional argument n means print information only about the spec-
ified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)). For each breakpoint,
following columns are printed:
62 Debugging with gdb
Breakpoint Numbers
Type Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
Disposition
Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when
hit.
Enabled or Disabled
Enabled breakpoints are marked with ‘y’. ‘n’ marks breakpoints
that are not enabled.
Address Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
For a pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this
field will contain ‘<PENDING>’. Such breakpoint won’t fire until a
shared library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is
loaded. See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations
will have ‘<MULTIPLE>’ in this field—see below for details.
What Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed
to the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved
until the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: “host” and
“target”. If mode is “host”, breakpoint condition evaluation is done by gdb on
the host’s side. If it is “target”, then the condition is evaluated by the target.
The info break command shows the condition on the line following the affected
breakpoint, together with its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to
resolve to a valid location.
info break with a breakpoint number n as argument lists only that break-
point. The convenience variable $_ and the default examining-address for the
x command are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed (see Section 10.6
[Examining Memory], page 148).
info break displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint has been
hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the ignore command. You
can ignore a large number of breakpoint hits, look at the breakpoint info to see
how many times the breakpoint was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less
than that number. This will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1, info break also
displays that count.
gdb allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in your program.
There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When the breakpoints are conditional,
this is even useful (see Section 5.1.6 [Break Conditions], page 75).
It is possible that a single logical breakpoint is set at several code locations in your
program. See Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122, for examples.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 63
A breakpoint with multiple code locations is displayed in the breakpoint table using
several rows—one header row, followed by one row for each code location. The header
row has ‘<MULTIPLE>’ in the address column. Each code location row contains the actual
address, source file, source line and function of its code location. The number column for a
code location is of the form breakpoint-number.location-number.
For example:
Num Type Disp Enb Address What
1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
stop only if i==1
breakpoint already hit 1 time
1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However, each location
can be individually enabled or disabled by passing breakpoint-number.location-number as
argument to the enable and disable commands. It’s also possible to enable and disable
a range of location-number locations using a breakpoint-number and two location-numbers,
in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like breakpoint-number.location-number1-
location-number2, in which case gdb acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (see Section 5.1.5 [Disabling], page 74) affects
all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
Locations that are enabled while their parent breakpoint is disabled won’t trigger a
break, and are denoted by y- in the Enb column. For example:
(gdb) info breakpoints
Num Type Disp Enb Address What
1 breakpoint keep n <MULTIPLE>
1.1 y- 0x00000000000011b6 in ...
1.2 y- 0x00000000000011c2 in ...
1.3 n 0x00000000000011ce in ...
It’s quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library. Shared libraries can
be loaded and unloaded explicitly, and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed.
To support this use case, gdb updates breakpoint locations whenever any shared library
is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would set a breakpoint in a shared library at the
beginning of your debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the symbols
from the library are not available. When you try to set breakpoint, gdb will ask you if you
want to set a so called pending breakpoint—breakpoint whose address is not yet resolved.
After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded, gdb reevaluates all the
breakpoints. When a newly loaded shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by
some pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an ordinary breakpoint.
When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints that refer to its symbols or source lines become
pending again.
This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For example, if you have
a breakpoint in a C++ template function, and a newly loaded shared library has an instan-
tiation of that template, a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not differ from regular
breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands, enable and disable them and perform
other breakpoint operations.
64 Debugging with gdb
gdb provides some additional commands for controlling what happens when the ‘break’
command cannot resolve the location spec to any code location in your program (see
Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122):
set breakpoint pending auto
This is the default behavior. When gdb cannot resolve the location spec, it
queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
set breakpoint pending on
This indicates that when gdb cannot resolve the location spec, it should create
a pending breakpoint without confirmation.
set breakpoint pending off
This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. If gdb cannot
resolve the location spec, it aborts the breakpoint creation with an error. This
setting does not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
show breakpoint pending
Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
The settings above only affect the break command and its variants. Once a breakpoint
is set, it will be automatically updated as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
For some targets, gdb can automatically decide if hardware or software breakpoints
should be used, depending on whether the breakpoint address is read-only or read-write.
This applies to breakpoints set with the break command as well as to internal breakpoints
set by commands like next and finish. For breakpoints set with hbreak, gdb will always
use hardware breakpoints.
You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
set breakpoint auto-hw on
This is the default behavior. When gdb sets a breakpoint, it will try to use the
target memory map to decide if software or hardware breakpoint must be used.
set breakpoint auto-hw off
This indicates gdb should not automatically select breakpoint type. If the
target provides a memory map, gdb will warn when trying to set software
breakpoint at a read-only address.
gdb normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code at the breakpoint
address with a special instruction, which, when executed, given control to the debugger.
By default, the program code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
the program stops, gdb restores the original instructions. This behaviour guards against
leaving breakpoints inserted in the target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with
slow remote targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance. This
behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
set breakpoint always-inserted off
All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in the target
only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are removed from the target
when it stops. This is the default mode.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 65
• An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example, ‘*(int *)0x12345678’ will
watch a 4-byte region at the specified address (assuming an int occupies 4 bytes).
• An arbitrarily complex expression, such as ‘a*b + c/d’. The expression can use any op-
erators valid in the program’s native language (see Chapter 15 [Languages], page 223).
You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can not be evaluated yet.
For instance, you can set a watchpoint on ‘*global_ptr’ before ‘global_ptr’ is initialized.
gdb will stop when your program sets ‘global_ptr’ and the expression produces a valid
value. If the expression becomes valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g. if
the memory pointed to by ‘*global_ptr’ becomes readable as the result of a malloc call),
gdb may not stop until the next time the expression changes.
Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or hardware.
gdb does software watchpointing by single-stepping your program and testing the variable’s
value each time, which is hundreds of times slower than normal execution. (But this may
still be worth it, to catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
culprit.)
On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets, gdb includes support
for hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
watch [-l|-location] expr [thread thread-id] [mask maskvalue] [task task-id]
Set a watchpoint for an expression. gdb will break when the expression expr
is written into by the program and its value changes. The simplest (and the
most popular) use of this command is to watch the value of a single variable:
(gdb) watch foo
If the command includes a [thread thread-id] argument, gdb breaks only
when the thread identified by thread-id changes the value of expr. If any other
threads change the value of expr, gdb will not break. Note that watchpoints
restricted to a single thread in this way only work with Hardware Watchpoints.
Similarly, if the task argument is given, then the watchpoint will be specific to
the indicated Ada task (see Section 15.4.10.7 [Ada Tasks], page 251).
Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in expr (see below).
The -location argument tells gdb to instead watch the memory referred to
by expr. In this case, gdb will evaluate expr, take the address of the result, and
watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used to determine
the size of the watched memory. If the expression’s result does not have an
address, then gdb will print an error.
The [mask maskvalue] argument allows creation of masked watchpoints, if the
current architecture supports this feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architec-
ture, see Section 21.3.8 [PowerPC Embedded], page 344.) A masked watchpoint
specifies a mask in addition to an address to watch. The mask specifies that
some bits of an address (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored
when matching the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint ad-
dress. Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously—
those addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
watchpoint address. The mask argument implies -location. Examples:
(gdb) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
(gdb) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 67
(gdb) r
Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
(gdb) c
Continuing.
However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding
name in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, gdb prints
a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall
name, but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example
below:
(gdb) catch syscall 764
warning: The number ’764’ does not represent a known syscall.
Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
(gdb)
If you configure gdb using the ‘--without-expat’ option, it will
not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your architecture does
not have an XML file describing its system calls, you will not be
able to see the syscall names. It is important to notice that these
two features are used for accessing the syscall name database. In
either case, you will see a warning like this:
(gdb) catch syscall
warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
warning: Could not load the syscall XML file ’syscalls/i386-linux.xml’.
GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
(gdb)
Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture
and system.
Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall
by its number. In this case, you would see something like:
(gdb) catch syscall 252
Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
Again, in this case gdb would not be able to display syscall’s names.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 73
clear locspec
Delete any breakpoint with a code location that corresponds to locspec. See
Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122, for the various forms of locspec.
Which code locations correspond to locspec depends on the form used in the
location specification locspec:
linenum
filename:linenum
-line linenum
-source filename -line linenum
If locspec specifies a line number, with or without a file name, the
command deletes any breakpoint with a code location that is at or
within the specified line linenum in files that match the specified
filename. If filename is omitted, it defaults to the current source
file.
*address If locspec specifies an address, the command deletes any breakpoint
with a code location that is at the given address.
function
-function function
If locspec specifies a function, the command deletes any breakpoint
with a code location that is at the entry to any function whose name
matches function.
Ambiguity in names of files and functions can be resolved as described in
Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122.
delete [breakpoints] [list...]
Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint list spec-
ified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all breakpoints (gdb
asks confirmation, unless you have set confirm off). You can abbreviate this
command as d.
• Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes disabled.
• Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next N times, then
becomes disabled.
• Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but immediately after it
does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint set with the tbreak command starts
out in this state.
You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints, watchpoints, and
catchpoints:
disable [breakpoints] [list...]
Disable the specified breakpoints—or all breakpoints, if none are listed. A
disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All options such as
ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in case the breakpoint
is enabled again later. You may abbreviate disable as dis.
enable [breakpoints] [list...]
Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They become
effective once again in stopping your program.
enable [breakpoints] once list...
Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. gdb disables any of these break-
points immediately after stopping your program.
enable [breakpoints] count count list...
Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. gdb records count with each of
the specified breakpoints, and decrements a breakpoint’s count when it is hit.
When any count reaches 0, gdb disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has
an ignore count (see Section 5.1.6 [Break Conditions], page 75), that will be
decremented to 0 before count is affected.
enable [breakpoints] delete list...
Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. gdb deletes any of
these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there. Breakpoints set by the
tbreak command start out in this state.
Except for a breakpoint set with tbreak (see Section 5.1.1 [Setting Breakpoints],
page 58), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled; subsequently, they become
disabled or enabled only when you use one of the commands above. (The command until
can set and delete a breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
breakpoints; see Section 5.2 [Continuing and Stepping], page 83.)
you want to test an assertion expressed by the condition assert, you should set the condition
‘! assert’ on the appropriate breakpoint.
Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them, since a watchpoint
is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow—but it might be simpler, say, to just set a
watchpoint on a variable name, and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is
an interesting one.
Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in your program. This
can be useful, for example, to activate functions that log program progress, or to use your
own print functions to format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In that case, gdb might
see the other breakpoint first and stop your program without checking the condition of
this one.) Note that breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than
break conditions for the purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
(see Section 5.1.7 [Breakpoint Command Lists], page 77).
Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target’s side if the target supports
it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally, gdb encodes the expression into an agent
expression (see Appendix F [Agent Expressions], page 823) suitable for execution on the
target, independently of gdb. Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become
stack accesses, and so forth.
In this case, gdb will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger when its condition evaluates
to true. This mechanism may provide faster response times depending on the performance
characteristics of the target since it does not need to keep gdb informed about every break-
point trigger, even those with false conditions.
Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using ‘if’ in the arguments
to the break command. See Section 5.1.1 [Setting Breakpoints], page 58. They can also be
changed at any time with the condition command.
You can also use the if keyword with the watch command. The catch command does
not recognize the if keyword; condition is the only way to impose a further condition on
a catchpoint.
condition bnum expression
Specify expression as the break condition for breakpoint, watchpoint, or catch-
point number bnum. After you set a condition, breakpoint bnum stops your
program only if the value of expression is true (nonzero, in C). When you
use condition, gdb checks expression immediately for syntactic correctness,
and to determine whether symbols in it have referents in the context of your
breakpoint. If expression uses symbols not referenced in the context of the
breakpoint, gdb prints an error message:
No symbol "foo" in current context.
gdb does not actually evaluate expression at the time the condition command
(or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like break if ...) is
given, however. See Section 10.1 [Expressions], page 141.
condition -force bnum expression
When the -force flag is used, define the condition even if expression is invalid
at all the current locations of breakpoint bnum. This is similar to the -force-
condition option of the break command.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 77
condition bnum
Remove the condition from breakpoint number bnum. It becomes an ordinary
unconditional breakpoint.
A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the breakpoint has been
reached a certain number of times. This is so useful that there is a special way to do it,
using the ignore count of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which is
an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and therefore has no effect. But if
your program reaches a breakpoint whose ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping,
it just decrements the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
value is n, the breakpoint does not stop the next n times your program reaches it.
ignore bnum count
Set the ignore count of breakpoint number bnum to count. The next count
times the breakpoint is reached, your program’s execution does not stop; other
than to decrement the ignore count, gdb takes no action.
To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify a count of zero.
When you use continue to resume execution of your program from a break-
point, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to continue,
rather than using ignore. See Section 5.2 [Continuing and Stepping], page 83.
If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the condition is
not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero, gdb resumes checking the
condition.
You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such as
‘$foo-- <= 0’ using a debugger convenience variable that is decremented each
time. See Section 10.12 [Convenience Variables], page 167.
Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
Pressing RET as a means of repeating the last gdb command is disabled within a
command-list.
Inside a command list, you can use the command disable $_hit_bpnum to disable the
encountered breakpoint.
If your breakpoint has several code locations, the command disable
$_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno will disable the specific breakpoint code location en-
countered. If the breakpoint has only one location, this command will disable the
encountered breakpoint.
You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply use the
continue command, or step, or any other command that resumes execution.
Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes execution, are
ignored. This is because any time you resume execution (even with a simple next or step),
you may encounter another breakpoint—which could have its own command list, leading
to ambiguities about which list to execute.
If the first command you specify in a command list is silent, the usual message about
stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may be desirable for breakpoints that are
to print a specific message and then continue. If none of the remaining commands print
anything, you see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. silent is meaningful only at
the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
The commands echo, output, and printf allow you to print precisely controlled output,
and are often useful in silent breakpoints. See Section 23.1.4 [Commands for Controlled
Output], page 386.
For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the value of x at
entry to foo whenever x is positive.
break foo if x>0
commands
silent
printf "x is %d\n",x
cont
end
One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so you can test
for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line of code, give it a condition
to detect the case in which something erroneous has been done, and give it commands to
assign correct values to any variables that need them. End with the continue command so
that your program does not stop, and start with the silent command so that no output
is produced. Here is an example:
break 403
commands
silent
set x = y + 4
cont
end
In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However, you can set
the variable dprintf-style for alternate handling. For instance, you can ask to format
the output by calling your program’s printf function. This has the advantage that the
characters go to the program’s output device, so they can recorded in redirects to files and
so forth.
If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also ask to have the
printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to ensuring that the output goes to the
remote program’s device along with any other output the program might produce, you can
also ask that the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote target.
Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do everything without needing to
communicate with gdb.
dprintf locspec,template,expression[,expression...]
Whenever execution reaches a code location that results from resolving locspec,
print the values of one or more expressions under the control of the string
template. To print several values, separate them with commas.
set dprintf-style style
Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different styles enumerated
below. A change of style affects all existing dynamic printfs immediately. (If
you need individual control over the print commands, simply define normal
breakpoints with explicitly-supplied command lists.)
gdb Handle the output using the gdb printf command. When using
this style, it is possible to use the ‘%V’ format specifier (see [%V
Format Specifier], page 388).
call Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
printf). When using this style the supported format specifiers
depend entirely on the function being called.
Most of gdb’s format specifiers align with those supported by the
printf function, however, gdb’s ‘%V’ format specifier extension is
not supported by printf. When using ‘call’ style dprintf, care
should be taken to ensure that only format specifiers supported by
the output function are used, otherwise the results will be unde-
fined.
agent Have the remote debugging agent (such as gdbserver) handle the
output itself. This style is only available for agents that support
running commands on the target. This style does not support the
‘%V’ format specifier.
set dprintf-function function
Set the function to call if the dprintf style is call. By default its value is
printf. You may set it to any expression that gdb can evaluate to a function,
as per the call command.
set dprintf-channel channel
Set a “channel” for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value, gdb will evaluate it as
an expression and pass the result as a first argument to the dprintf-function,
80 Debugging with gdb
in the manner of fprintf and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
string will be the first argument, in the manner of printf.
As an example, if you wanted dprintf output to go to a logfile that is a standard
I/O stream assigned to the variable mylog, you could do the following:
(gdb) set dprintf-style call
(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
(gdb) info break
1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
continue
(gdb)
Note that the info break displays the dynamic printf commands as normal
breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of the variable settings.
set disconnected-dprintf on
set disconnected-dprintf off
Choose whether dprintf commands should continue to run if gdb has discon-
nected from the target. This only applies if the dprintf-style is agent.
gdb does not check the validity of function and channel, relying on you to supply values
that are meaningful for the contexts in which they are being used. For instance, the function
and channel may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then all enabled
dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of those locals. If evaluation fails,
gdb will report an error.
Some SystemTap probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this hap-
pens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style .d file. If your probe
has a semaphore, gdb will automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using
the ‘-probe-stap’ notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe’s location by some
other method (e.g., break file:line), then gdb will not automatically set the semaphore.
DTrace probes do not support semaphores.
You can examine the available static static probes using info probes, with optional
arguments:
Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of enabling or disabling
a probe depends on the type of probe being handled. Some DTrace probes can be enabled
or disabled, but SystemTap probes cannot be disabled.
You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following commands, with
optional arguments:
1
See http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps for more information
on how to add SystemTap SDT probes in your applications.
2
See http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation for a good reference on
how the SDT probes are implemented.
82 Debugging with gdb
from one source statement to another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter gdb’s
breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is printed when the
breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint is hit.
A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint that’s been subject
to address adjustment:
warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
Such warnings are printed both for user settable and gdb’s internal breakpoints. If you
see one of these warnings, you should verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address
will have the desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and other
breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior. E.g., it may be sufficient to
place the breakpoint at a later instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in
some cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
gdb will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these adjusted breakpoints:
warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
to 0x00010410.
When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial action except in
cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more frequently than expected.
of your program where a problem is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at
that breakpoint, and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
interesting, until you see the problem happen.
step Continue running your program until control reaches a different source line,
then stop it and return control to gdb. This command is abbreviated s.
Warning: If you use the step command while control is within
a function that was compiled without debugging information, ex-
ecution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function
which is compiled without debugging information. To step through
functions without debugging information, use the stepi command,
described below.
The step command only stops at the first instruction of a source line. This pre-
vents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in switch statements, for
loops, etc. step continues to stop if a function that has debugging information
is called within the line. In other words, step steps inside any functions called
within the line.
Also, the step command only enters a function if there is line number infor-
mation for the function. Otherwise it acts like the next command. This avoids
problems when using cc -gl on MIPS machines. Previously, step entered sub-
routines if there was any debugging information about the routine.
step count
Continue running as in step, but do so count times. If a breakpoint is reached,
or a signal not related to stepping occurs before count steps, stepping stops
right away.
next [count]
Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame. This
is similar to step, but function calls that appear within the line of code are
executed without stopping. Execution stops when control reaches a different
line of code at the original stack level that was executing when you gave the
next command. This command is abbreviated n.
An argument count is a repeat count, as for step.
The next command only stops at the first instruction of a source line. This
prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in switch statements, for
loops, etc.
set step-mode
set step-mode on
The set step-mode on command causes the step command to stop at the first
instruction of a function which contains no debug line information rather than
stepping over it.
This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the machine
instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not want gdb to
automatically skip over this function.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 85
until locspec
u locspec Continue running your program until either it reaches a code location that
results from resolving locspec, or the current stack frame returns. locspec is
any of the forms described in Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122.
This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and hence is quicker
than until without an argument. The specified location is actually reached
only if it is in the current frame. This implies that until can be used to
skip over recursive function invocations. For instance in the code below, if the
current location is line 96, issuing until 99 will execute the program up to
line 99 in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner invocations have
returned.
94 int factorial (int value)
95 {
96 if (value > 1) {
97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
98 }
99 return (value);
100 }
advance locspec
Continue running your program until either it reaches a code location that
results from resolving locspec, or the current stack frame returns. locspec is
any of the forms described in Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122.
This command is similar to until, but advance will not skip over recursive
function calls, and the target code location doesn’t have to be in the same
frame as the current one.
stepi
stepi arg
si Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
It is often useful to do ‘display/i $pc’ when stepping by machine instructions.
This makes gdb automatically display the next instruction to be executed, each
time your program stops. See Section 10.8 [Automatic Display], page 151.
An argument is a repeat count, as in step.
nexti
nexti arg
ni Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call, proceed until the
function returns.
An argument is a repeat count, as in next.
By default, and if available, gdb makes use of target-assisted range stepping. In other
words, whenever you use a stepping command (e.g., step, next), gdb tells the target to
step the corresponding range of instruction addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps.
This speeds up line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should be no
reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it’s possible that a bug in the
debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for remote targets), or even a bug in gdb could make
line stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is enabled. You can
use the following command to turn off range stepping if necessary:
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 87
set range-stepping
show range-stepping
Control whether range stepping is enabled.
If on, and the target supports it, gdb tells the target to step a range of addresses
itself, instead of issuing multiple single-steps. If off, gdb always issues single-
steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The default is on.
-function linespec
-fu linespec
Functions named by linespec or the function containing the line
named by linespec will be skipped over when stepping. See
Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122.
-rfunction regexp
-rfu regexp
Functions whose name matches regexp will be skipped over when
stepping.
This form is useful for complex function names. For example, there
is generally no need to step into C++ std::string constructors or
destructors. Plus with C++ templates it can be hard to write out
the full name of the function, and often it doesn’t matter what the
template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as
a regular expression makes this easier.
(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
If you want to skip every templated C++ constructor and destructor
in the std namespace you can do:
(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
Enabled or Disabled
Enabled skips are marked with ‘y’. Disabled skips are marked with
‘n’.
Glob If the file name is a ‘glob’ pattern this is ‘y’. Otherwise it is ‘n’.
File The name or ‘glob’ pattern of the file to be skipped. If no file is
specified this is ‘<none>’.
RE If the function name is a ‘regular expression’ this is ‘y’. Other-
wise it is ‘n’.
Function The name or regular expression of the function to skip. If no func-
tion is specified this is ‘<none>’.
skip delete [range]
Delete the specified skip(s). If range is not specified, delete all skips.
skip enable [range]
Enable the specified skip(s). If range is not specified, enable all skips.
skip disable [range]
Disable the specified skip(s). If range is not specified, disable all skips.
set debug skip [on|off]
Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
show debug skip
Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5.4 Signals
A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The operating system
defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each kind a name and a number. For example,
in Unix SIGINT is the signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often
Ctrl-c); SIGSEGV is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in memory far
away from all the areas in use; SIGALRM occurs when the alarm clock timer goes off (which
happens only if your program has requested an alarm).
Some signals, including SIGALRM, are a normal part of the functioning of your program.
Others, such as SIGSEGV, indicate errors; these signals are fatal (they kill your program
immediately) if the program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the
signal. SIGINT does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally fatal so it can
carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
gdb has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your program. You can tell
gdb in advance what to do for each kind of signal.
Normally, gdb is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like SIGALRM be silently passed
to your program (so as not to interfere with their role in the program’s functioning) but to
stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens. You can change these
settings with the handle command.
90 Debugging with gdb
info signals
info handle
Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how gdb has been told to handle
each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all the defined types of
signals.
info signals sig
Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
info handle is an alias for info signals.
catch signal [signal... | ‘all’]
Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. See Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints],
page 68, for details about this command.
handle signal [ signal ... ] [keywords...]
Change the way gdb handles each signal. Each signal can be the number
of a signal or its name (with or without the ‘SIG’ at the beginning); a list
of signal numbers of the form ‘low-high’; or the word ‘all’, meaning all the
known signals, except SIGINT and SIGTRAP, which are used by gdb. Optional
argument keywords, described below, say what changes to make to all of the
specified signals.
The keywords allowed by the handle command can be abbreviated. Their full names
are:
nostop gdb should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may still print
a message telling you that the signal has come in.
stop gdb should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies the
print keyword as well.
print gdb should print a message when this signal happens.
noprint gdb should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This implies the
nostop keyword as well.
pass
noignore gdb should allow your program to see this signal; your program can handle the
signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal and not handled. pass and
noignore are synonyms.
nopass
ignore gdb should not allow your program to see this signal. nopass and ignore are
synonyms.
When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the program until you
continue. Your program sees the signal then, if pass is in effect for the signal in question
at that time. In other words, after gdb reports a signal, you can use the handle command
with pass or nopass to control whether your program sees that signal when you continue.
The default is set to nostop, noprint, pass for non-erroneous signals such as SIGALRM,
SIGWINCH and SIGCHLD, and to stop, print, pass for the erroneous signals.
You can also use the signal command to prevent your program from seeing a signal, or
cause it to see a signal it normally would not see, or to give it any signal at any time. For
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 91
example, if your program stopped due to some sort of memory reference error, you might
store correct values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more execution;
but your program would probably terminate immediately as a result of the fatal signal once
it saw the signal. To prevent this, you can continue with ‘signal 0’. See Section 17.3
[Giving your Program a Signal], page 275.
gdb optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal that has handle nostop and
handle pass set arrives while a stepping command (e.g., stepi, step, next) is in progress,
gdb lets the signal handler run and then resumes stepping the mainline code once the signal
handler returns. In other words, gdb steps over the signal handler. This prevents signals
that you’ve specified as not interesting (with handle nostop) from changing the focus of
debugging unexpectedly. Note that the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop
for another signal that has handle stop in effect, or for any other event that normally
results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also note that gdb still informs you that
the program received a signal if handle print is set.
If you set handle pass for a signal, and your program sets up a handler for it, then
issuing a stepping command, such as step or stepi, when your program is stopped due to
the signal will step into the signal handler (if the target supports that).
Likewise, if you use the queue-signal command to queue a signal to be delivered to
the current thread when execution of the thread resumes (see Section 17.3 [Giving your
Program a Signal], page 275), then a stepping command will step into the signal handler.
Here’s an example, using stepi to step to the first instruction of SIGUSR1’s handler:
(gdb) handle SIGUSR1
Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
(gdb) c
Continuing.
Here’s an example, on a gnu/Linux system, printing the stray referenced address that
raised a segmentation fault.
(gdb) continue
Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
0x0000000000400766 in main ()
69 *(int *)p = 0;
(gdb) ptype $_siginfo
type = struct {
int si_signo;
int si_errno;
int si_code;
union {
int _pad[28];
struct {...} _kill;
struct {...} _timer;
struct {...} _rt;
struct {...} _sigchld;
struct {...} _sigfault;
struct {...} _sigpoll;
} _sifields;
}
(gdb) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
type = struct {
void *si_addr;
}
(gdb) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
Depending on target support, $_siginfo may also be writable.
On some targets, a SIGSEGV can be caused by a boundary violation, i.e., accessing an ad-
dress outside of the allowed range. In those cases gdb may displays additional information,
depending on how gdb has been told to handle the signal. With handle stop SIGSEGV,
gdb displays the violation kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and
the bounds, while with handle nostop SIGSEGV no additional information is displayed.
The usual output of a segfault is:
Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
68 value = *(p + len);
While a bound violation is presented as:
Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
68 value = *(p + len);
two threads of the current inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program
that forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance, it doesn’t run to
exit), while you debug the child. In other situations, you may not be interested in inspecting
the current state of any of the processes gdb is attached to, and you may want to resume
them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case, you can instruct gdb to allow all
threads of all the inferiors to run with the set schedule-multiple command.
set schedule-multiple
Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed when an
execution command is issued. When on, all threads of all processes are allowed
to run. When off, only the threads of the current process are resumed. The
default is off. The scheduler-locking mode takes precedence when set to
on, or while you are stepping and set to step.
show schedule-multiple
Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of multiple
processes.
preference is only consulted when gdb starts or connects to the target program, and it is
generally not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore, since not
all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled non-stop mode, gdb may
still fall back to all-stop operation by default.
In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread by default.
That is, continue only continues one thread. To continue all threads, issue continue -a
or c -a.
You can use gdb’s background execution commands (see Section 5.5.3 [Background
Execution], page 95) to run some threads in the background while you continue to examine
or step others from gdb. The MI execution commands (see Section 27.15 [GDB/MI Program
Execution], page 607) are always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
Suspending execution is done with the interrupt command when running in the back-
ground, or Ctrl-c during foreground execution. In all-stop mode, this stops the whole
process; but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread. To stop the
whole program, use interrupt -a.
Other execution commands do not currently support the -a option.
In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, gdb doesn’t automatically make that thread
current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the thread stop notifications are
asynchronous with respect to gdb’s command interpreter, and it would be confusing if gdb
unexpectedly changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on
the previously current thread.
Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when gdb detects the correspond-
ing thread is no longer in the thread list. For example:
(gdb) c
Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular thread exit, but also
when you detach from the process with the detach command (see Section 4.7 [Debugging an
Already-running Process], page 41), or if gdb loses the remote connection (see Chapter 20
[Remote Debugging], page 307), etc. Note that with some targets, gdb is only able to
detect a thread has exited when the user explictly asks for the thread list with the info
threads command.
Chapter 5: Stopping and Continuing 97
The call to sleep will return early if a different thread stops at a breakpoint or for some
other reason.
Instead, write this:
int unslept = 10;
while (unslept > 0)
unslept = sleep (unslept);
A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still conforming to its specifica-
tion. But gdb does cause your multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would
without gdb.
Also, gdb uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to monitor certain events such
as thread creation and thread destruction. When such an event happens, a system call
in another thread may return prematurely, even though your program does not appear to
stop.
set observer on
set observer off
When set to on, this disables all the permission variables below (except for
insert-fast-tracepoints), plus enables non-stop debugging. Setting this to
off switches back to normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
show observer
Show whether observer mode is on or off.
98 Debugging with gdb
set may-write-registers on
set may-write-registers off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to alter the values of registers, such as
with assignment expressions in print, or the jump command. It defaults to on.
show may-write-registers
Show the current permission to write registers.
set may-write-memory on
set may-write-memory off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to alter the contents of memory, such
as with assignment expressions in print. It defaults to on.
show may-write-memory
Show the current permission to write memory.
set may-insert-breakpoints on
set may-insert-breakpoints off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to insert breakpoints. This affects all
breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined by gdb. It defaults to on.
show may-insert-breakpoints
Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
set may-insert-tracepoints on
set may-insert-tracepoints off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to insert (regular) tracepoints at the
beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only non-fast tracepoints, fast tra-
cepoints being under the control of may-insert-fast-tracepoints. It defaults
to on.
show may-insert-tracepoints
Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to insert fast tracepoints at the begin-
ning of a tracing experiment. It affects only fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast)
tracepoints being under the control of may-insert-tracepoints. It defaults
to on.
show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
set may-interrupt on
set may-interrupt off
This controls whether gdb will attempt to interrupt or stop program execution.
When this variable is off, the interrupt command will have no effect, nor will
Ctrl-c. It defaults to on.
show may-interrupt
Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
99
reverse-stepi [count]
Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction to be
reverse-executed is not the one pointed to by the program counter, but the
instruction executed prior to that one. For instance, if the last instruction was
a jump, reverse-stepi will take you back from the destination of the jump to
the jump instruction itself.
reverse-next [count]
Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in the current
(innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function calls, they will be
“un-executed” without stopping. Starting from the first line of a function,
reverse-next will take you back to the caller of that function, before the
function was called, just as the normal next command would take you from
the last line of a function back to its return to its caller2 .
reverse-nexti [count]
Like nexti, reverse-nexti executes a single instruction in reverse, except
that called functions are “un-executed” atomically. That is, if the previously
executed instruction was a return from another function, reverse-nexti will
continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function (from the current
stack frame) is reached.
reverse-finish
Just as the finish command takes you to the point where the current function
returns, reverse-finish takes you to the point where it was called. Instead
of ending up at the end of the current function invocation, you end up at the
beginning.
set exec-direction
Set the direction of target execution.
set exec-direction reverse
gdb will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the exec-direction
mode is changed to “forward”. Affected commands include step, stepi,
next, nexti, continue, and finish. The return command cannot be used
in reverse mode.
set exec-direction forward
gdb will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion. This is the
default.
2
Unless the code is too heavily optimized.
101
record goto
Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several ways to specify
the location to go to:
record goto begin
record goto start
Go to the beginning of the execution log.
record goto end
Go to the end of the execution log.
record goto n
Go to instruction number n in the execution log.
record save filename
Save the execution log to a file filename. Default filename is
gdb_record.process_id, where process id is the process ID of the inferior.
This command may not be available for all recording methods.
record restore filename
Restore the execution log from a file filename. File must have been created
with record save.
set record full insn-number-max limit
set record full insn-number-max unlimited
Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the full recording method.
Default value is 200000.
If limit is a positive number, then gdb will start deleting instructions from the
log once the number of the record instructions becomes greater than limit. For
every new recorded instruction, gdb will delete the earliest recorded instruc-
tion to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit. (Since deleting
recorded instructions loses information, gdb lets you control what happens
when the limit is reached, by means of the stop-at-limit option, described
below.)
If limit is unlimited or zero, gdb will never delete recorded instructions from
the execution log. The number of recorded instructions is limited only by the
available memory.
show record full insn-number-max
Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the full recording method.
set record full stop-at-limit
Control the behavior of the full recording method when the number of recorded
instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the default), gdb will stop when the limit
is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide to continue
recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the oldest one to be deleted.
If this option is OFF, gdb will automatically delete the oldest record to make
room for each new one, without asking.
show record full stop-at-limit
Show the current setting of stop-at-limit.
104 Debugging with gdb
intel family/model[/stepping]
Chapter 7: Recording Inferior’s Execution and Replaying It 105
specifying the /r or /b modifier. The behaviour of the /m, /s, /r, and /b
modifiers are the same as for the disassemble command (see [disassemble],
page 132).
The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the current program
counter value. This instruction can appear multiple times in the trace and the
current position marker will be printed every time. To omit the current position
marker, specify the /p modifier.
To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains instructions
from more than one function, the function name may be omitted by specifying
the /f modifier.
Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with ‘?’. This feature is not
available for all recording formats.
There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to disassemble:
record instruction-history insn
Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
insn.
record instruction-history insn, +/-n
Disassembles n instructions around instruction number insn. If n
is preceded with +, disassembles n instructions after instruction
number insn. If n is preceded with -, disassembles n instructions
before instruction number insn.
record instruction-history
Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
record instruction-history -
Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
record instruction-history begin, end
Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number be-
gin until instruction number end. The instruction number end is
included.
This command may not be available for all recording methods.
set record instruction-history-size size
set record instruction-history-size unlimited
Define how many instructions to disassemble in the record
instruction-history command. The default value is 10. A size of
unlimited means unlimited instructions.
show record instruction-history-size
Show how many instructions to disassemble in the record
instruction-history command.
record function-call-history
Prints the execution history at function granularity. For each sequence of in-
structions that belong to the same function, it prints the name of that function,
the source lines for this instruction sequence (if the /l modifier is specified),
108 Debugging with gdb
and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if the /i modifier is spec-
ified). The function names are indented to reflect the call stack depth if the /c
modifier is specified. The /l, /i, and /c modifiers can be given together.
(gdb) list 1, 10
1 void foo (void)
2 {
3 }
4
5 void bar (void)
6 {
7 ...
8 foo ();
9 ...
10 }
(gdb) record function-call-history /ilc
1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
By default, ten functions are printed. This can be changed using the set record
function-call-history-size command. Functions are printed in execution
order. There are several ways to specify what to print:
record function-call-history func
Prints ten functions starting from function number func.
record function-call-history func, +/-n
Prints n functions around function number func. If n is preceded
with +, prints n functions after function number func. If n is pre-
ceded with -, prints n functions before function number func.
record function-call-history
Prints ten more functions after the last ten-function print.
record function-call-history -
Prints ten more functions before the last ten-function print.
record function-call-history begin, end
Prints functions beginning with function number begin until func-
tion number end. The function number end is included.
This command may not be available for all recording methods.
set record function-call-history-size size
set record function-call-history-size unlimited
Define how many functions to print in the record function-call-history
command. The default value is 10. A size of unlimited means unlimited
functions.
show record function-call-history-size
Show how many functions to print in the record function-call-history com-
mand.
109
these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation has no stack frame, gdb
nevertheless regards it as though it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual,
allowing correct tracing of the function call chain. However, gdb has no provision for
frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
8.2 Backtraces
A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one line per frame,
for many frames, starting with the currently executing frame (frame zero), followed by its
caller (frame one), and on up the stack.
To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the backtrace command, or its alias bt.
This command will print one line per frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack
frames are printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
character, normally Ctrl-c.
backtrace [option]... [qualifier]... [count]
bt [option]... [qualifier]... [count]
Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
The optional count can be one of the following:
n
n Print only the innermost n frames, where n is a positive number.
-n
-n Print only the outermost n frames, where n is a positive number.
Options:
-full Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
with the optional count to limit the number of frames shown.
-no-filters
Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. See
Section 23.3.2.10 [Frame Filter API], page 419, for more
information. Additionally use [disable frame-filter all], page 118,
to turn off all frame filters. This is only relevant when gdb has
been configured with Python support.
-hide A Python frame filter might decide to “elide” some frames. Nor-
mally such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented
relative to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The
-hide option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
The backtrace command also supports a number of options that allow over-
riding relevant global print settings as set by set backtrace and set print
subcommands:
-past-main [on|off]
Set whether backtraces should continue past main. Related setting:
[set backtrace past-main], page 112.
-past-entry [on|off]
Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a
program. Related setting: [set backtrace past-entry], page 112.
Chapter 8: Examining the Stack 111
-entry-values no|only|preferred|if-needed|both|compact|default
Set printing of function arguments at function entry. Related set-
ting: [set print entry-values], page 157.
-frame-arguments all|scalars|none
Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments. Related setting: [set
print frame-arguments], page 156.
-raw-frame-arguments [on|off]
Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form. Related setting:
[set print raw-frame-arguments], page 157.
-frame-info auto|source-line|location|source-and-
location|location-and-address|short-location
Set printing of frame information. Related setting: [set print frame-
info], page 159.
The optional qualifier is maintained for backward compatibility. It can be one
of the following:
full Equivalent to the -full option.
no-filters
Equivalent to the -no-filters option.
hide Equivalent to the -hide option.
The names where and info stack (abbreviated info s) are additional aliases for
backtrace.
In a multi-threaded program, gdb by default shows the backtrace only for the current
thread. To display the backtrace for several or all of the threads, use the command thread
apply (see Section 4.10 [Threads], page 46). For example, if you type thread apply all
backtrace, gdb will display the backtrace for all the threads; this is handy when you debug
a core dump of a multi-threaded program.
Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name. The program
counter value is also shown—unless you use set print address off. The backtrace also
shows the source file name and line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The
program counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that line number.
Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command ‘bt 3’, so it shows
the innermost three frames.
#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
at builtin.c:993
#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
at macro.c:71
(More stack frames follow...)
The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter value, indicating that
your program has stopped at the beginning of the code for line 993 of builtin.c.
The value of parameter data in frame 1 has been replaced by .... By default, gdb prints
the value of a parameter only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See
command set print frame-arguments in Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153, for more
112 Debugging with gdb
details on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed. The command
set print frame-info (see Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153) controls what frame
information is printed.
If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will optimize away
arguments passed to functions if those arguments are never used after the call. Such opti-
mizations generate code that passes arguments through registers, but doesn’t store those
arguments in the stack frame. gdb has no way of displaying such arguments in stack frames
other than the innermost one. Here’s what such a backtrace might look like:
#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
at builtin.c:993
#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
at macro.c:71
(More stack frames follow...)
The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are shown as ‘<optimized
out>’.
If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments, either deduce that
from other variables whose values depend on the one you are interested in, or recompile
without optimizations.
Most programs have a standard user entry point—a place where system libraries and
startup code transition into user code. For C this is main1 . When gdb finds the entry
function in a backtrace it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-
specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels in a backtrace,
you can change this behavior:
set backtrace past-main
set backtrace past-main on
Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
set backtrace past-main off
Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
default.
show backtrace past-main
Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
set backtrace past-entry
set backtrace past-entry on
Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application. This
entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built, and is likely
before the user entry point main (or equivalent) is called.
set backtrace past-entry off
Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an appli-
cation. This is the default.
1
Note that embedded programs (the so-called “free-standing” environment) are not required to have a
main function as the entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.
Chapter 8: Examining the Stack 113
function function-name
Select the stack frame for function function-name. If there are
multiple stack frames for function function-name then the inner
most stack frame is selected.
view stack-address [ pc-addr ]
View a frame that is not part of gdb’s backtrace. The frame viewed
has stack address stack-addr, and optionally, a program counter
address of pc-addr.
This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been dam-
aged by a bug, making it impossible for gdb to assign numbers
properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful when your
program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using frame
view then you can always return to the original stack using one of
the previous stack frame selection instructions, for example frame
level 0.
up n Move n frames up the stack; n defaults to 1. For positive numbers n, this
advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames that
have existed longer.
down n Move n frames down the stack; n defaults to 1. For positive numbers n, this
advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames that
were created more recently. You may abbreviate down as do.
All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the frame. The
first line shows the frame number, the function name, the arguments, and the source file
and line number of execution in that frame. The second line shows the text of that source
line.
For example:
(gdb) up
#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
at env.c:10
10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
After such a printout, the list command with no arguments prints ten lines centered on
the point of execution in the frame. You can also edit the program at the point of execution
with your favorite editing program by typing edit. See Section 9.1 [Printing Source Lines],
page 121, for details.
Chapter 8: Examining the Stack 115
select-frame [ frame-selection-spec ]
The select-frame command is a variant of frame that does not display the
new frame after selecting it. This command is intended primarily for use in
gdb command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and distracting.
The frame-selection-spec is as for the frame command described in Section 8.3
[Selecting a Frame], page 113.
up-silently n
down-silently n
These two commands are variants of up and down, respectively; they differ in
that they do their work silently, without causing display of the new frame. They
are intended primarily for use in gdb command scripts, where the output might
be unnecessary and distracting.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header infor-
mation and messages explaining why no argument have been printed.
info args [-q] [-t type_regexp] [regexp]
Like info args, but only print the arguments selected with the provided reg-
exp(s).
If regexp is provided, print only the arguments whose names match the regular
expression regexp.
If type regexp is provided, print only the arguments whose types, as printed by
the whatis command, match the regular expression type regexp. If type regexp
contains space(s), it should be enclosed in quote characters. If needed, use
backslash to escape the meaning of special characters or quotes.
If both regexp and type regexp are provided, an argument is printed only if its
name matches regexp and its type matches type regexp.
info locals [-q]
Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate line. These
are all variables (declared either static or automatic) accessible at the point of
execution of the selected frame.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header infor-
mation and messages explaining why no local variables have been printed.
info locals [-q] [-t type_regexp] [regexp]
Like info locals, but only print the local variables selected with the provided
regexp(s).
If regexp is provided, print only the local variables whose names match the
regular expression regexp.
If type regexp is provided, print only the local variables whose types, as
printed by the whatis command, match the regular expression type regexp.
If type regexp contains space(s), it should be enclosed in quote characters. If
needed, use backslash to escape the meaning of special characters or quotes.
If both regexp and type regexp are provided, a local variable is printed only if
its name matches regexp and its type matches type regexp.
The command info locals -q -t type_regexp can usefully be combined with
the commands frame apply and thread apply. For example, your program
might use Resource Acquisition Is Initialization types (RAII) such as lock_
something_t: each local variable of type lock_something_t automatically
places a lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
or the equivalent shorter form
tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
count Use count to apply command to the innermost count frames, where
count is a positive number.
-count Use -count to apply command to the outermost count frames, where
count is a positive number.
level Use level to apply command to the set of frames identified by the
level list. level is a frame level or a range of frame levels as level1-
level2. The frame level is the number shown in the first field of the
‘backtrace’ command output. E.g., ‘2-4 6-8 3’ indicates to apply
command for the frames at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on
frame at level 3.
Note that the frames on which frame apply applies a command are also influ-
enced by the set backtrace settings such as set backtrace past-main and
set backtrace limit N. See Section 8.2 [Backtraces], page 110.
The frame apply command also supports a number of options that allow over-
riding relevant set backtrace settings:
-past-main [on|off]
Whether backtraces should continue past main. Related setting:
[set backtrace past-main], page 112.
-past-entry [on|off]
Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a pro-
gram. Related setting: [set backtrace past-entry], page 112.
By default, gdb displays some frame information before the output produced
by command, and an error raised during the execution of a command will abort
frame apply. The following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
-c The flag -c, which stands for ‘continue’, causes any errors in com-
mand to be displayed, and the execution of frame apply then con-
tinues.
-s The flag -s, which stands for ‘silent’, causes any errors or empty
output produced by a command to be silently ignored. That is, the
execution continues, but the frame information and errors are not
printed.
The following example shows how the flags -c and -s are working when applying
the command p j to all frames, where variable j can only be successfully printed
in the outermost #1 main frame.
118 Debugging with gdb
faas command
Shortcut for frame apply all -s command. Applies command on all frames,
ignoring errors and empty output.
It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function argument
without knowing the frame where this variable or argument is, using:
(gdb) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
The faas command accepts the same options as the frame apply command.
See Section 8.5 [frame apply], page 116.
Note that the command tfaas command applies command on all frames of all
threads. See See Section 4.10 [Threads], page 46.
the object file where the frame filter dictionary resides. When all is specified,
all frame filters across all dictionaries are disabled. The filter-name is the name
of the frame filter and is used when all is not the option for filter-dictionary.
A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it may be enabled again later.
enable frame-filter filter-dictionary filter-name
Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching filter-dictionary and filter-
name. The filter-dictionary may be all, global, progspace or the name of
the object file where the frame filter dictionary resides. When all is specified,
all frame filters across all dictionaries are enabled. The filter-name is the name
of the frame filter and is used when all is not the option for filter-dictionary.
Example:
(gdb) info frame-filter
global frame-filters:
Priority Enabled Name
1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
100 Yes Reverse
global frame-filters:
Priority Enabled Name
1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
100 Yes Reverse
global frame-filters:
Priority Enabled Name
1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
100 Yes Reverse
global frame-filters:
Priority Enabled Name
1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
100 Yes Reverse
global frame-filters:
Priority Enabled Name
1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
50 Yes Reverse
In general, the list command expects you to supply zero, one or two location specs.
These location specs are interpreted to resolve to source code lines; there are several ways
of writing them (see Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122), but the effect is always
to resolve to some source lines to display.
Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for list:
list locspec
Print lines centered around the line or lines of all the code locations that result
from resolving locspec.
list first,last
Print lines from first to last. Both arguments are location specs. When a list
command has two location specs, and the source file of the second location spec
is omitted, this refers to the same source file as the first location spec. If either
first or last resolve to more than one source line in the program, then the list
command shows the list of resolved source lines and does not proceed with the
source code listing.
list ,last
Print lines ending with last.
Likewise, if last resolves to more than one source line in the program, then the
list command prints the list of resolved source lines and does not proceed with
the source code listing.
list first,
Print lines starting with first.
list + Print lines just after the lines last printed.
list - Print lines just before the lines last printed.
list As described in the preceding table.
source file, or specify just the basename of the file, omitting its directories. In other words,
a location spec is usually incomplete, a kind of blueprint, and gdb needs to complete the
missing attributes by using the implied defaults, and by considering the source code and
the debug information available to it. This is what location resolution is about.
The resolution of an incomplete location spec can produce more than a single code
location, if the spec doesn’t allow distinguishing between them. Here are some examples of
situations that result in a location spec matching multiple code locations in your program:
• The location spec specifies a function name, and there are several functions in the
program which have that name. (To distinguish between them, you can specify a
fully-qualified and prototyped function name, such as A::func(int) instead of just
func.)
• The location spec specifies a source file name, and there are several source files in
the program that share the same name, for example several files with the same base-
name in different subdirectories. (To distinguish between them, specify enough leading
directories with the file name.)
• For a C++ constructor, the gcc compiler generates several instances of the function
body, used in different cases, but their source-level names are identical.
• For a C++ template function, a given line in the function can correspond to any number
of instantiations.
• For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to several actual code
locations with that function’s inlined code.
Resolution of a location spec can also fail to produce a complete code location, or even
fail to produce any code location. Here are some examples of such situations:
• Some parts of the program lack detailed enough debug info, so the resolved code location
lacks some attributes, like source file name and line number, leaving just the instruction
address and perhaps also a function name. Such an incomplete code location is only
usable in contexts that work with addresses and/or function names. Some commands
can only work with complete code locations.
• The location spec specifies a function name, and there are no functions in the program
by that name, or they only exist in a yet-unloaded shared library.
• The location spec specifies a source file name, and there are no source files in the
program by that name, or they only exist in a yet-unloaded shared library.
• The location spec specifies both a source file name and a source line number, and even
though there are source files in the program that match the file name, none of those
files has the specified line number.
Locations may be specified using three different formats: linespec locations, explicit
locations, or address locations. The following subsections describe these formats.
-offset
+offset Specifies the line offset lines before or after the current line. For the list
command, the current line is the last one printed; for the breakpoint commands,
this is the line at which execution stopped in the currently selected stack frame
(see Section 8.1 [Frames], page 109, for a description of stack frames.) When
used as the second of the two linespecs in a list command, this specifies the
line offset lines up or down from the first linespec.
filename:linenum
Specifies the line linenum in the source file filename. If filename is a relative file
name, then it will match any source file name with the same trailing compo-
nents. For example, if filename is ‘gcc/expr.c’, then it will match source file
name of /build/trunk/gcc/expr.c, but not /build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c
or /build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c.
function Specifies the line that begins the body of the function function. For example,
in C, this is the line with the open brace.
By default, in C++ and Ada, function is interpreted as specifying all functions
named function in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and classes.
For Ada, this means in all packages.
For example, assuming a program with C++ symbols named A::B::func and
B::func, both commands break func and break B::func set a breakpoint on
both symbols.
Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the -qualified op-
tion. For example, break -qualified func sets a breakpoint on a free-function
named func ignoring any C++ class methods and namespace functions called
func.
See Section 9.2.2 [Explicit Locations], page 125.
function:label
Specifies the line where label appears in function.
filename:function
Specifies the line that begins the body of the function function in the file
filename. You only need the file name with a function name to avoid ambi-
guity when there are identically named functions in different source files.
label Specifies the line at which the label named label appears in the function corre-
sponding to the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then gdb will not
search for a label.
-pstap|-probe-stap [objfile:[provider:]]name
The gnu/Linux tool SystemTap provides a way for applications to embed static
probes. See Section 5.1.10 [Static Probe Points], page 81, for more information
on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec specifies the location
of such a static probe.
If objfile is given, only probes coming from that shared library or executable
matching objfile as a regular expression are considered. If provider is given,
Chapter 9: Examining Source Files 125
then only probes from that provider are considered. If several probes match
the spec, gdb will insert a breakpoint at each one of those probes.
-line number
The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either be
absolute (-line 3) or relative (-line +3), depending on the command. When
specified without any other options, the line offset is relative to the current line.
Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique trailing char-
acters from the option name, e.g., break -s main.c -li 3.
If locspec resolves to more than one source line in your program, then the
command prints the list of resolved source lines and does not proceed with the
editing.
Here are the forms of the edit command most commonly used:
edit number
Edit the current source file with number as the active line number.
edit function
Edit the file containing function at the beginning of its definition.
the directories in the list, in the order they are present in the list, until it finds a file with
the desired name.
For example, suppose an executable references the file /usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c,
does not record a compilation directory, and the source path is /mnt/cross. gdb would
look for the source file in the following locations:
1. /usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
2. /mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
3. /mnt/cross/foo.c
If the source file is not present at any of the above locations then an error
is printed. gdb does not look up the parts of the source file name, such as
/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c. Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are
not searched: if the source path is /mnt/cross, and the binary refers to foo.c, gdb would
not find it under /mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib.
Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file names containing dots,
etc. are all treated as described above, except that non-absolute file names are not looked
up literally. If the source path is /mnt/cross, the source file is recorded as ../lib/foo.c,
and no compilation directory is recorded, then gdb will search in the following locations:
1. /mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c
2. /mnt/cross/foo.c
The source path will always include two special entries ‘$cdir’ and ‘$cwd’, these refer to
the compilation directory (if one is recorded) and the current working directory respectively.
‘$cdir’ causes gdb to search within the compilation directory, if one is recorded in the
debug information. If no compilation directory is recorded in the debug information then
‘$cdir’ is ignored.
‘$cwd’ is not the same as ‘.’—the former tracks the current working directory as it
changes during your gdb session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
If a compilation directory is recorded in the debug information, and gdb has not found
the source file after the first search using source path, then gdb will combine the compilation
directory and the filename, and then search for the source file again using the source path.
For example, if the executable records the source file as /usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c,
the compilation directory is recorded as /project/build, and the source path is
/mnt/cross:$cdir:$cwd while the current working directory of the gdb session is
/home/user, then gdb will search for the source file in the following locations:
1. /usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
2. /mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
3. /project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
4. /home/user/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
5. /mnt/cross/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
6. /project/build/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
7. /home/user/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c
8. /mnt/cross/foo.c
Chapter 9: Examining Source Files 129
9. /project/build/foo.c
10. /home/user/foo.c
If the file name in the previous example had been recorded in the executable as a relative
path rather than an absolute path, then the first look up would not have occurred, but all
of the remaining steps would be similar.
When searching for source files on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where absolute paths
start with a drive letter (e.g. C:/project/foo.c), gdb will remove the drive letter from
the file name before appending it to a search directory from source path; for instance
if the executable references the source file C:/project/foo.c and source path is set to
D:/mnt/cross, then gdb will search in the following locations for the source file:
1. C:/project/foo.c
2. D:/mnt/cross/project/foo.c
3. D:/mnt/cross/foo.c
Note that the executable search path is not used to locate the source files.
Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, gdb clears out any information it has
cached about where source files are found and where each line is in the file.
When you start gdb, its source path includes only ‘$cdir’ and ‘$cwd’, in that order. To
add other directories, use the directory command.
The search path is used to find both program source files and gdb script files (read using
the ‘-command’ option and ‘source’ command).
In addition to the source path, gdb provides a set of commands that manage a list of
source path substitution rules. A substitution rule specifies how to rewrite source directories
stored in the program’s debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of two strings, the first
specifying what needs to be rewritten in the path, and the second specifying how it should
be rewritten. In [set substitute-path], page 130, we name these two parts from and to
respectively. gdb does a simple string replacement of from with to at the start of the
directory part of the source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file name
to look up the sources.
Using the previous example, suppose the foo-1.0 tree has been moved from /usr/src
to /mnt/cross, then you can tell gdb to replace /usr/src in all source path names with
/mnt/cross. The first lookup will then be /mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c in place of the
original location of /usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c. To define a source path substitution
rule, use the set substitute-path command (see [set substitute-path], page 130).
To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the from part
of the directory name ends at a directory separator. For instance, a rule substituting
/usr/source into /mnt/cross will be applied to /usr/source/foo-1.0 but not to
/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0. And because the substitution is applied only at the beginning
of the directory name, this rule will not be applied to /root/usr/source/baz.c either.
In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the directory command. However,
set substitute-path can be more efficient in the case where the sources are organized in
a complex tree with multiple subdirectories. With the directory command, you need to
add each subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while preserving its
130 Debugging with gdb
internal organization, then set substitute-path allows you to direct the debugger to all
the sources with one single command.
set substitute-path is also more than just a shortcut command. The source path
is only used if the file at the original location no longer exists. On the other hand, set
substitute-path modifies the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead.
So, if for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is located at the
original location, a substitution rule is the only method available to point gdb at the new
location.
You can configure a default source path substitution rule by configuring gdb with the
‘--with-relocated-sources=dir’ option. The dir should be the name of a directory under
gdb’s configured prefix (set with ‘--prefix’ or ‘--exec-prefix’), and directory names in
debug information under dir will be adjusted automatically if the installed gdb is moved
to a new location. This is useful if gdb, libraries or executables with debug information
and corresponding source code are being moved together.
directory dirname ...
dir dirname ...
Add directory dirname to the front of the source path. Several directory names
may be given to this command, separated by ‘:’ (‘;’ on MS-DOS and MS-
Windows, where ‘:’ usually appears as part of absolute file names) or white-
space. You may specify a directory that is already in the source path; this
moves it forward, so gdb searches it sooner.
The special strings ‘$cdir’ (to refer to the compilation directory, if one is
recorded), and ‘$cwd’ (to refer to the current working directory) can also be
included in the list of directories dirname. Though these will already be in the
source path they will be moved forward in the list so gdb searches them sooner.
directory
Reset the source path to its default value (‘$cdir:$cwd’ on Unix systems). This
requires confirmation.
set directories path-list
Set the source path to path-list. ‘$cdir:$cwd’ are added if missing.
show directories
Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
set substitute-path from to
Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the current list
of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same from was already defined,
then the old rule is also deleted.
For example, if the file /foo/bar/baz.c was moved to /mnt/cross/baz.c, then
the command
(gdb) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
will tell gdb to replace ‘/foo/bar’ with ‘/mnt/cross’, which will allow gdb to
find the file baz.c even though it was moved.
In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined, the rules
are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been defined. The first
one matching, if any, is selected to perform the substitution.
Chapter 9: Examining Source Files 131
The following two examples are for RISC-V, and demonstrates the difference between
the /r and /b modifiers. First with /b, the bytes of the instruction are printed, in hex, in
memory order:
(gdb) disassemble /b 0x00010150,0x0001015c
Dump of assembler code from 0x10150 to 0x1015c:
0x00010150 <call_me+4>: 22 dc sw s0,56(sp)
0x00010152 <call_me+6>: 80 00 addi s0,sp,64
0x00010154 <call_me+8>: 23 26 a4 fe sw a0,-20(s0)
0x00010158 <call_me+12>: 23 24 b4 fe sw a1,-24(s0)
End of assembler dump.
In contrast, with /r the bytes of the instruction are displayed in the instruction order,
for RISC-V this means that the bytes have been swapped to little-endian order:
(gdb) disassemble /r 0x00010150,0x0001015c
Dump of assembler code from 0x10150 to 0x1015c:
0x00010150 <call_me+4>: dc22 sw s0,56(sp)
0x00010152 <call_me+6>: 0080 addi s0,sp,64
0x00010154 <call_me+8>: fea42623 sw a0,-20(s0)
0x00010158 <call_me+12>: feb42423 sw a1,-24(s0)
End of assembler dump.
Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86 with /m or /s, when
the program is stopped just after function prologue in a non-optimized function with no
inline code.
(gdb) disas /m main
Dump of assembler code for function main:
5 {
0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6 printf ("Hello.\n");
=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@plt>
7 return 0;
8 }
0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
0x0804834d <+29>: leave
0x0804834e <+30>: ret
return a * 2;
if (a == 0)
return 1;
return a + 10;
}
foo.c:
#include "foo.h"
volatile int x, y;
int
main ()
{
x = foo (y);
return 0;
}
(gdb) disas /m main
Dump of assembler code for function main:
5 {
6 x = foo (y);
0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
7 return 0;
8 }
0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
foo.h:
4 if (a < 0)
0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
6 if (a == 0)
7 return 1;
8 return a + 10;
0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
foo.c:
6 x = foo (y);
0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
7 return 0;
8 }
0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
Chapter 9: Examining Source Files 135
foo.h:
5 return a * 2;
0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
End of assembler dump.
Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
End of assembler dump.
Note that the ‘disassemble’ command’s address arguments are specified using expres-
sions in your programming language (see Section 10.1 [Expressions], page 141), not location
specs (see Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122). So, for example, if you want to
disassemble function bar in file foo.c, you must type ‘disassemble ’foo.c’::bar’ and
not ‘disassemble foo.c:bar’.
Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction mnemonics or
other syntax.
For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries, instructions that
call functions or branch to locations in the shared libraries might show a seemingly bogus
location—it’s actually a location of the relocation table. On some architectures, gdb might
be able to resolve these to actual function names.
set disassemble-next-line
show disassemble-next-line
Control whether or not gdb will disassemble the next source line or instruction
when execution stops. If ON, gdb will display disassembly of the next source
line when execution of the program being debugged stops. This is in addition
to displaying the source line itself, which gdb always does if possible. If the
next source line cannot be displayed for some reason (e.g., if gdb cannot find
the source file, or there’s no line info in the debug info), gdb will display
disassembly of the next instruction instead of showing the next source line. If
AUTO, gdb will display disassembly of next instruction only if the source line
cannot be displayed. This setting causes gdb to display some feedback when
you step through a function with no line info or whose source file is unavailable.
The default is OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line
or instruction.
10 Examining Data
The usual way to examine data in your program is with the print command (abbreviated p),
or its synonym inspect. It evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language
your program is written in (see Chapter 15 [Using gdb with Different Languages], page 223).
It may also print the expression using a Python-based pretty-printer (see Section 10.10
[Pretty Printing], page 164).
print [[options] --] expr
print [[options] --] /f expr
expr is an expression (in the source language). By default the value of expr is
printed in a format appropriate to its data type; you can choose a different for-
mat by specifying ‘/f’, where f is a letter specifying the format; see Section 10.5
[Output Formats], page 146.
The print command supports a number of options that allow overriding rele-
vant global print settings as set by set print subcommands:
-address [on|off]
Set printing of addresses. Related setting: [set print address],
page 153.
-array [on|off]
Pretty formatting of arrays. Related setting: [set print array],
page 155.
-array-indexes [on|off]
Set printing of array indexes. Related setting: [set print array-
indexes], page 155.
-characters number-of-characters|elements|unlimited
Set limit on string characters to print. The value elements
causes the limit on array elements to print to be used. The value
unlimited causes there to be no limit. Related setting: [set print
characters], page 155.
-elements number-of-elements|unlimited
Set limit on array elements and optionally string characters to print.
See [set print characters], page 155, and the -characters option
above for when this option applies to strings. The value unlimited
causes there to be no limit. See [set print elements], page 156, for
a related CLI command.
-max-depth depth|unlimited
Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
ellipsis. Related setting: [set print max-depth], page 159.
-nibbles [on|off]
Set whether to print binary values in groups of four bits, known as
“nibbles”. See [set print nibbles], page 155.
-memory-tag-violations [on|off]
Set printing of additional information about memory tag violations.
See [set print memory-tag-violations], page 160.
138 Debugging with gdb
-null-stop [on|off]
Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related setting:
[set print null-stop], page 160.
-object [on|off]
Set printing C++ virtual function tables. Related setting: [set print
object], page 163.
-pretty [on|off]
Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: [set print
pretty], page 161.
-raw-values [on|off]
Set whether to print values in raw form, bypassing any pretty-
printers for that value. Related setting: [set print raw-values],
page 161.
-repeats number-of-repeats|unlimited
Set threshold for repeated print elements. unlimited causes all
elements to be individually printed. Related setting: [set print
repeats], page 159.
-static-members [on|off]
Set printing C++ static members. Related setting: [set print static-
members], page 163.
-symbol [on|off]
Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related set-
ting: [set print symbol], page 154.
-union [on|off]
Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting: [set
print union], page 161.
-vtbl [on|off]
Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting: [set
print vtbl], page 163.
Because the print command accepts arbitrary expressions which may look like
options (including abbreviations), if you specify any command option, then you
must use a double dash (--) to mark the end of option processing.
For example, this prints the value of the -p expression:
(gdb) print -p
While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below) with the
-pretty option in effect:
(gdb) print -p --
print [options]
print [options] /f
If you omit expr, gdb displays the last value again (from the value history;
see Section 10.11 [Value History], page 166). This allows you to conveniently
inspect the same value in an alternative format.
If the architecture supports memory tagging, the print command will display
pointer/memory tag mismatches if what is being printed is a pointer or reference type. See
Section 10.7 [Memory Tagging], page 150.
A more low-level way of examining data is with the x command. It examines data
in memory at a specified address and prints it in a specified format. See Section 10.6
[Examining Memory], page 148.
If you are interested in information about types, or about how the fields of a struct
or a class are declared, use the ptype expr command rather than print. See Chapter 16
[Examining the Symbol Table], page 259.
Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is through the
Python extension command explore (available only if the gdb build is configured with
--with-python). It offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type itself) and explore all
the way down to leaf scalar values/fields embedded in the higher level data types.
explore arg
arg is either an expression (in the source language), or a type visible in the
current context of the program being debugged.
The working of the explore command can be illustrated with an example. If a data
type struct ComplexStruct is defined in your C program as
struct SimpleStruct
{
int i;
double d;
};
struct ComplexStruct
{
struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
int arr[10];
};
followed by variable declarations as
struct SimpleStruct ss = { 10, 1.11 };
struct ComplexStruct cs = { &ss, { 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 } };
140 Debugging with gdb
then, the value of the variable cs can be explored using the explore command as follows.
(gdb) explore cs
The value of ‘cs’ is a struct/class of type ‘struct ComplexStruct’ with
the following fields:
(cs.arr)[5] = 4
ment is being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type exploration
of the argument is being invoked.
explore value expr
This sub-command of explore explores the value of the expression expr (if expr
is an expression valid in the current context of the program being debugged).
The behavior of this command is identical to that of the behavior of the explore
command being passed the argument expr.
explore type arg
This sub-command of explore explores the type of arg (if arg is a type vis-
ible in the current context of program being debugged), or the type of the
value/expression arg (if arg is an expression valid in the current context of the
program being debugged). If arg is a type, then the behavior of this command
is identical to that of the explore command being passed the argument arg.
If arg is an expression, then the behavior of this command will be identical to
that of the explore command being passed the type of arg as the argument.
10.1 Expressions
print and many other gdb commands accept an expression and compute its value. Any
kind of constant, variable or operator defined by the programming language you are using
is valid in an expression in gdb. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts,
and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if you compiled your program
to include this information; see Section 4.1 [Compilation], page 33.
gdb supports array constants in expressions input by the user. The syntax is {element,
element. . . }. For example, you can use the command print {1, 2, 3} to create an array
of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it to a program variable, gdb
copies the array to memory that is malloced in the target program.
Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in this manual
are in C. See Chapter 15 [Using gdb with Different Languages], page 223, for information
on how to use expressions in other languages.
In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in gdb expressions regardless of
your programming language.
Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so useful to cast a
number into a pointer in order to examine a structure at that address in memory.
gdb supports these operators, in addition to those common to programming languages:
@ ‘@’ is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays. See Section 10.4
[Artificial Arrays], page 145, for more information.
:: ‘::’ allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or function where it is
defined. See Section 10.3 [Program Variables], page 143.
{type} addr
Refers to an object of type type stored at address addr in memory. The address
addr may be any expression whose value is an integer or pointer (but parenthe-
ses are required around binary operators, just as in a cast). This construct is
allowed regardless of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at addr.
142 Debugging with gdb
When mode is set to ask, the debugger always uses the menu when an ambiguity
is detected.
Finally, when mode is set to cancel, the debugger reports an error due to the
ambiguity and the command is aborted.
show multiple-symbols
Show the current value of the multiple-symbols setting.
{
if (a < 10)
bar (a);
else
process (a); /* Stop here */
}
int
bar (int a)
{
foo (a + 5);
}
For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line, here is what you might see
when the program stops after executing the call bar(0):
(gdb) p a
$1 = 10
(gdb) p bar::a
$2 = 5
(gdb) up 2
#2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
(gdb) p a
$3 = 5
(gdb) p bar::a
$4 = 0
These uses of ‘::’ are very rarely in conflict with the very similar use of the same notation
in C++. When they are in conflict, the C++ meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class that has a field
named includefile, and there is also an include file named includefile that defines a
variable, some_global.
(gdb) p includefile
$1 = 23
(gdb) p includefile::some_global
A syntax error in expression, near ‘’.
(gdb) p ’includefile’::some_global
$2 = 27
Warning: Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the wrong value
at certain points in a function—just after entry to a new scope, and just before
exit.
You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions. This is
because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to set up a stack frame
(including local variable definitions); if you are stepping by machine instructions, variables
may appear to have the wrong values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it
usually also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame; after you
begin stepping through that group of instructions, local variable definitions may be gone.
This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations. To be sure of
always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization when compiling.
Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize unused variables out of
existence, or assign variables to registers (as opposed to memory addresses). Depending
on the support for such cases offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, gdb
Chapter 10: Examining Data 145
might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that happens, gdb will print
a message like this:
No symbol "foo" in current context.
To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a different debug
info format, if the compiler supports several such formats. See Section 4.1 [Compilation],
page 33, for more information on choosing compiler options. See Section 15.4.1 [C and
C++], page 227, for more information about debug info formats that are best suited to C++
programs.
If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to gdb, e.g., because its
data type is not completely specified by the debug information, gdb will say ‘<incomplete
type>’. See Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259, for more about this.
If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for which gdb has no type
information, e.g., because the program includes no debug information, gdb displays an
error message. See Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259, for more about unknown types. If you
cast the variable to its declared type, gdb gets the variable’s value using the cast-to type
as the variable’s type. For example, in a C program:
(gdb) p var
’var’ has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
(gdb) p (float) var
$1 = 3.14
If you append @entry string to a function parameter name you get its value at the time
the function got called. If the value is not available an error message is printed. Entry
values are available only with some compilers. Entry values are normally also printed at
the function parameter list according to [set print entry-values], page 157.
Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
29 i++;
(gdb) next
30 e (i);
(gdb) print i
$1 = 31
(gdb) print i@entry
$2 = 30
Strings are identified as arrays of char values without specified signedness. Arrays
of either signed char or unsigned char get printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers.
-fsigned-char or -funsigned-char gcc options have no effect as gdb defines literal
string type "char" as char without a sign. For program code
char var0[] = "A";
signed char var1[] = "A";
You get during debugging
(gdb) print var0
$1 = "A"
(gdb) print var1
$2 = {65 ’A’, 0 ’\0’}
You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an artificial array, using
the binary operator ‘@’. The left operand of ‘@’ should be the first element of the desired
array and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length of the
array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of the type of the left argument.
The first element is actually the left argument; the second element comes from bytes of
memory immediately following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
example. If a program says
int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
you can print the contents of array with
p *array@len
The left operand of ‘@’ must reside in memory. Array values made with ‘@’ in this way
behave just like other arrays in terms of subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when
used in expressions. Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
(see Section 10.11 [Value History], page 166), after printing one out.
Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast. This re-interprets a value as if
it were an array. The value need not be in memory:
(gdb) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
$1 = {0x1234, 0x5678}
As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in ‘(type[])value’) gdb calcu-
lates the size to fill the value (as ‘sizeof(value)/sizeof(type)’:
(gdb) p/x (short[])0x12345678
$2 = {0x1234, 0x5678}
Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in moderately complex
data structures, the elements of interest may not actually be adjacent—for example, if you
are interested in the values of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation
is to use a convenience variable (see Section 10.12 [Convenience Variables], page 167) as
a counter in an expression that prints the first interesting value, and then repeat that
expression via RET. For instance, suppose you have an array dtab of pointers to structures,
and you are interested in the values of a field fv in each structure. Here is an example of
what you might type:
set $i = 0
p dtab[$i++]->fv
RET
RET
...
To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format, you can use the
print command with just a format and no expression. For example, ‘p/x’ reprints the last
value in hex.
For example, ‘x/3uh 0x54320’ is a request to display three halfwords (h) of memory,
formatted as unsigned decimal integers (‘u’), starting at address 0x54320. ‘x/4xw $sp’
prints the four words (‘w’) of memory above the stack pointer (here, ‘$sp’; see Section 10.14
[Registers], page 175) in hexadecimal (‘x’).
You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward from the given
address. For example, ‘x/-3uh 0x54320’ prints three halfwords (h) at 0x5431a, 0x5431c,
and 0x5431e.
Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the letters specifying output
formats, you do not have to remember whether unit size or format comes first; either order
works. The output specifications ‘4xw’ and ‘4wx’ mean exactly the same thing. (However,
the count n must come first; ‘wx4’ does not work.)
Even though the unit size u is ignored for the formats ‘s’ and ‘i’, you might still want to
use a count n; for example, ‘3i’ specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with the display command,
the ‘i’ format also prints branch delay slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified,
which immediately follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
disassemble gives an alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see Section 9.6
[Source and Machine Code], page 131.
If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats ‘s’ or ‘i’, the command displays
null-terminated strings or instructions before the given address as many as the absolute
value of the given number. For the ‘i’ format, we use line number information in the debug
info to accurately locate instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info
is not available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
All the defaults for the arguments to x are designed to make it easy to continue scanning
memory with minimal specifications each time you use x. For example, after you have
inspected three machine instructions with ‘x/3i addr’, you can inspect the next seven with
just ‘x/7’. If you use RET to repeat the x command, the repeat count n is used again; the
other arguments default as for successive uses of x.
When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program counter is
shown with a => marker. For example:
(gdb) x/5i $pc-6
0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@plt>
If the architecture supports memory tagging, the tags can be displayed by using ‘m’. See
Section 10.7 [Memory Tagging], page 150.
150 Debugging with gdb
The information will be displayed once per granule size (the amount of bytes a particular
memory tag covers). For example, AArch64 has a granule size of 16 bytes, so it will display
a tag every 16 bytes.
Due to the way gdb prints information with the x command (not aligned to a particular
boundary), the tag information will refer to the initial address displayed on a particular line.
If a memory tag boundary is crossed in the middle of a line displayed by the x command,
it will be displayed on the next line.
The ‘m’ format doesn’t affect any other specified formats that were passed to the x
command.
The addresses and contents printed by the x command are not saved in the value history
because there is often too much of them and they would get in the way. Instead, gdb
makes these values available for subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience
variables $_ and $__. After an x command, the last address examined is available for use
in expressions in the convenience variable $_. The contents of that address, as examined,
are available in the convenience variable $__.
If the x command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved are from the last
memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last address printed if several units were
printed on the last line of output.
Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means that to each
memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some targets, however, have other addressable
memory unit sizes. Within gdb and this document, the term addressable memory unit (or
memory unit for short) is used when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size.
The word byte is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of the addressable
memory unit size of the target. For most systems, addressable memory unit is a synonym
of byte.
When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine (see Chapter 20
[Remote Debugging], page 307), you may wish to verify the program’s image in the remote
machine’s memory against the executable file you downloaded to the target. Or, on any
target, you may want to check whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections.
The compare-sections command is provided for such situations.
compare-sections [section-name|-r]
Compare the data of a loadable section section-name in the executable file of the
program being debugged with the same section in the target machine’s memory,
and report any mismatches. With no arguments, compares all loadable sections.
With an argument of -r, compares all loadable read-only sections.
Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the target sup-
ports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory (see [qCRC packet],
page 766).
There are two types of tags that are used in this setup: logical and allocation. A
logical tag is stored in the pointers themselves, usually at the higher bits of the pointers.
An allocation tag is the tag associated with particular ranges of memory in the physical
address space, against which the logical tags from pointers are compared.
The pointer tag (logical tag) must match the memory tag (allocation tag) for the memory
access to be valid. If the logical tag does not match the allocation tag, that will raise a
memory violation.
Allocation tags cover multiple contiguous bytes of physical memory. This range of bytes
is called a memory tag granule and is architecture-specific. For example, AArch64 has a
tag granule of 16 bytes, meaning each allocation tag spans 16 bytes of memory.
If the underlying architecture supports memory tagging, like AArch64 MTE or SPARC
ADI do, gdb can make use of it to validate pointers against memory allocation tags.
The print (see Chapter 10 [Data], page 137) and x (see Section 10.6 [Memory],
page 148) commands will display tag information when appropriate, and a command prefix
of memory-tag gives access to the various memory tagging commands.
The memory-tag commands are the following:
memory-tag print-logical-tag pointer_expression
Print the logical tag stored in pointer expression.
memory-tag with-logical-tag pointer_expression tag_bytes
Print the pointer given by pointer expression, augmented with a logical tag of
tag bytes.
memory-tag print-allocation-tag address_expression
Print the allocation tag associated with the memory address given by ad-
dress expression.
memory-tag setatag starting_address length tag_bytes
Set the allocation tag(s) for memory range [starting address, starting address
+ length) to tag bytes.
memory-tag check pointer_expression
Check if the logical tag in the pointer given by pointer expression matches the
allocation tag for the memory referenced by the pointer.
This essentially emulates the hardware validation that is done when tagged
memory is accessed through a pointer, but does not cause a memory fault as it
would during hardware validation.
It can be used to inspect potential memory tagging violations in the running
process, before any faults get triggered.
display Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is done when
your program stops.
info display
Print the list of expressions previously set up to display automatically, each
one with its item number, but without showing the values. This includes dis-
abled expressions, which are marked as such. It also includes expressions which
would not be displayed right now because they refer to automatic variables not
currently available.
If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make sense outside the
lexical context for which it was set up. Such an expression is disabled when execution enters
a context where one of its variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
display last_char while inside a function with an argument last_char, gdb displays
this argument while your program continues to stop inside that function. When it stops
elsewhere—where there is no variable last_char—the display is disabled automatically.
The next time your program stops where last_char is meaningful, you can enable the
display expression once again.
whose scope is a single source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with info
line, for example ‘info line *0x4537’. Alternately, you can set gdb to print the source
file and line number when it prints a symbolic address:
set print symbol-filename on
Tell gdb to print the source file name and line number of a symbol in the
symbolic form of an address.
set print symbol-filename off
Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the default.
show print symbol-filename
Show whether or not gdb will print the source file name and line number of a
symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line numbers is when
disassembling code; gdb shows you the line number and source file that corresponds to each
instruction.
Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being printed is reason-
ably close to the closest earlier symbol:
set print max-symbolic-offset max-offset
set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
Tell gdb to only display the symbolic form of an address if the offset between
the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than max-offset. The default
is unlimited, which tells gdb to always print the symbolic form of an address
if any symbol precedes it. Zero is equivalent to unlimited.
show print max-symbolic-offset
Ask how large the maximum offset is that gdb prints in a symbolic address.
If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try ‘set print
symbol-filename on’. Then you can determine the name and source file location of the
variable where it points, using ‘p/a pointer’. This interprets the address in symbolic
form. For example, here gdb shows that a variable ptt points at another variable t,
defined in hi2.c:
(gdb) set print symbol-filename on
(gdb) p/a ptt
$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
Warning: For pointers that point to a local variable, ‘p/a’ does not show the
symbol name and filename of the referent, even with the appropriate set print
options turned on.
You can also enable ‘/a’-like formatting all the time using ‘set print symbol on’:
set print symbol on
Tell gdb to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if one exists.
set print symbol off
Tell gdb not to print the symbol corresponding to an address. In this mode,
gdb will still print the symbol corresponding to pointers to functions. This is
the default.
Chapter 10: Examining Data 155
print follows one for array elements; see [set print elements], page 156. Setting
number-of-characters to unlimited means that the number of characters to
print is unlimited. When gdb starts, this limit is set to elements.
show print characters
Display the number of characters of a large string that gdb will print.
set print elements number-of-elements
set print elements unlimited
Set a limit on how many elements of an array gdb will print. If gdb is printing
a large array, it stops printing after it has printed the number of elements set
by the set print elements command. By default this limit also applies to the
display of strings; see [set print characters], page 155. When gdb starts, this
limit is set to 200. Setting number-of-elements to unlimited or zero means
that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
When printing very large arrays, whose size is greater than max-value-size
(see [max-value-size], page 188), if the print elements is set such that the size
of the elements being printed is less than or equal to max-value-size, then gdb
will print the array (up to the print elements limit), and only max-value-
size worth of data will be added into the value history (see Section 10.11 [Value
History], page 166).
show print elements
Display the number of elements of a large array that gdb will print.
set print frame-arguments value
This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed when
the debugger prints a frame (see Section 8.1 [Frames], page 109). The possible
values are:
all The values of all arguments are printed.
scalars Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of
more complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is
replaced by .... This is the default. Here is an example where
only scalar arguments are shown:
#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=..., ss=0xbf8d508c, u=..., e=green)
at frame-args.c:23
none None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each
argument is replaced by .... In this case, the example above now
becomes:
#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=..., s=..., ss=..., u=..., e=...)
at frame-args.c:23
presence Only the presence of arguments is indicated by .... The ... are
not printed for function without any arguments. None of the ar-
gument names and values are printed. In this case, the example
above now becomes:
#1 0x08048361 in call_me (...) at frame-args.c:23
By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used to
configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless of their
Chapter 10: Examining Data 157
type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value of more complex
parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of information printed in each
frame, making the backtrace more readable. Also, it improves performance
when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments can
sometimes be CPU-intensive, especially in large applications. Setting print
frame-arguments to scalars (the default), none or presence avoids this com-
putation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
show print frame-arguments
Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
set print raw-frame-arguments on
Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
set print raw-frame-arguments off
Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer for
the value (see Section 10.10 [Pretty Printing], page 164), otherwise print the
value in raw form. This is the default.
show print raw-frame-arguments
Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
set print entry-values value
Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases gdb can
determine the value of function argument which was passed by the function
caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function and therefore is
different. With optimized code, the current value could be unavailable, but the
entry value may still be known.
The default value is default (see below for its description). Older gdb behaved
as with the setting no. Compilers not supporting this feature will behave in the
default setting the same way as with the no setting.
This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format
and the compiler has to produce ‘DW_TAG_call_site’ tags. With gcc, you
need to specify -O -g during compilation, to get this information.
The value parameter can be one of the following:
no Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function
entry point.
#0 equal (val=5)
#0 different (val=6)
#0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
#0 born (val=10)
#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
only Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual
parameter values are never printed.
#0 equal (val@entry=5)
#0 different (val@entry=5)
#0 lost (val@entry=5)
#0 born (val@entry=<optimized out>)
#0 invalid (val@entry=<optimized out>)
158 Debugging with gdb
preferred
Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value
from function entry point is not known while the actual value is
known, print the actual value for such parameter.
#0 equal (val@entry=5)
#0 different (val@entry=5)
#0 lost (val@entry=5)
#0 born (val=10)
#0 invalid (val@entry=<optimized out>)
if-needed
Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not
known while value from function entry point is known, print the
entry point value for such parameter.
#0 equal (val=5)
#0 different (val=6)
#0 lost (val@entry=5)
#0 born (val=10)
#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
both Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from
function entry point, even if values of one or both are not available
due to compiler optimizations.
#0 equal (val=5, val@entry=5)
#0 different (val=6, val@entry=5)
#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@entry=5)
#0 born (val=10, val@entry=<optimized out>)
#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@entry=<optimized out>)
compact Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value
from function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print
for the actual value <optimized out>. If not in MI mode (see
Chapter 27 [GDB/MI], page 569) and if both values are known and
identical, print the shortened param=param@entry=VALUE notation.
#0 equal (val=val@entry=5)
#0 different (val=6, val@entry=5)
#0 lost (val@entry=5)
#0 born (val=10)
#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
default Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from
function entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (see
Chapter 27 [GDB/MI], page 569) and if both values are known and
identical, print the shortened param=param@entry=VALUE notation.
#0 equal (val=val@entry=5)
#0 different (val=6, val@entry=5)
#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@entry=5)
#0 born (val=10)
#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
short-location
Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the beginning
of the location source line), the function, the function arguments.
location Same as short-location but also print the source file and source
line number.
location-and-address
Same as location but print the program counter even if located
at the beginning of the location source line.
source-line
Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
source line), the line number and the source line.
source-and-location
Print what location and source-line are printing.
s4 var = { { { { 3 } } } };
The following table shows how different values of depth will effect how var is
printed by gdb:
struct thing {
Species it;
union {
Tree_forms tree;
Bug_forms bug;
} form;
};
Example:
Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so named foo that
prints objects of type foo, and another from library2.so named bar that prints two types
of objects, bar1 and bar2.
(gdb) info pretty-printer
library1.so:
foo
library2.so:
bar
bar1
bar2
(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
library2.so:
bar
bar1
bar2
(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
1 printer disabled
2 of 3 printers enabled
(gdb) info pretty-printer
library1.so:
foo [disabled]
library2.so:
bar
bar1
bar2
166 Debugging with gdb
You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this command—which you can do
by just typing RET.
Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of x is 4 and you type
these commands:
print x
set x=5
then the value recorded in the value history by the print command remains 4 even though
the value of x has changed.
show values
Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers. This is
like ‘p $$9’ repeated ten times, except that show values does not change the
history.
show values n
Print ten history values centered on history item number n.
show values +
Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more values are
available, show values + produces no display.
Pressing RET to repeat show values n has exactly the same effect as ‘show values +’.
int
main (int argc, char *argv[])
{
raise (SIGALRM);
return 0;
}
Chapter 10: Examining Data 169
A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited or sig-
nalled would be:
(gdb) define has_exited_or_signalled
Type commands for definition of ‘‘has_exited_or_signalled’’.
End with a line saying just ‘‘end’’.
>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
>echo The program has exited\n
>else
>echo The program has signalled\n
>end
>end
(gdb) run
Starting program:
$_exception
The variable $_exception is set to the exception object being thrown at an
exception-related catchpoint. See Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68.
$_ada_exception
The variable $_ada_exception is set to the address of the exception being
caught or thrown at an Ada exception-related catchpoint. See Section 5.1.3
[Set Catchpoints], page 68.
$_probe_argc
$_probe_arg0...$_probe_arg11
Arguments to a static probe. See Section 5.1.10 [Static Probe Points], page 81.
$_sdata The variable $_sdata contains extra collected static tracepoint data. See
Section 13.1.6 [Tracepoint Action Lists], page 204. Note that $_sdata could
be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or if extra static tracepoint data has
not been collected.
$_siginfo
The variable $_siginfo contains extra signal information (see [extra signal
information], page 91). Note that $_siginfo could be empty, if the application
has not yet received any signals. For example, it will be empty before you
execute the run command.
$_tlb The variable $_tlb is automatically set when debugging applications running
on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to gdbserver that supports the
qGetTIBAddr request. See Section E.4 [General Query Packets], page 765. This
variable contains the address of the thread information block.
170 Debugging with gdb
$_inferior
The number of the current inferior. See Section 4.9 [Debugging Multiple Infe-
riors Connections and Programs], page 42.
$_thread The thread number of the current thread. See [thread numbers], page 47.
$_gthread
The global number of the current thread. See [global thread numbers], page 47.
$_inferior_thread_count
The number of live threads in the current inferior. See Section 4.10 [Threads],
page 46.
$_gdb_major
$_gdb_minor
The major and minor version numbers of the running gdb. Development snap-
shots and pretest versions have their minor version incremented by one; thus,
gdb pretest 9.11.90 will produce the value 12 for $_gdb_minor. These variables
allow you to write scripts that work with different versions of gdb without errors
caused by features unavailable in some of those versions.
$_shell_exitcode
$_shell_exitsignal
gdb commands such as shell and | are launching shell commands. When
a launched command terminates, gdb automatically maintains the variables
$_shell_exitcode and $_shell_exitsignal according to the exit status of
the last launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to the
variables $_exitcode and $_exitsignal.
$4 = 0
In the example above, we used $_isvoid to check whether $_exitcode is void
before and after the execution of the program being debugged. Before the
execution there is no exit code to be examined, therefore $_exitcode is void.
After the execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore $_
exitcode is zero, which means that it is not void anymore.
The void expression can also be a call of a function from the program being
debugged. For example, given the following function:
void
foo (void)
{
}
The result of calling it inside gdb is void:
(gdb) print foo ()
$1 = void
(gdb) print $_isvoid (foo ())
$2 = 1
(gdb) set $v = foo ()
(gdb) print $v
$3 = void
(gdb) print $_isvoid ($v)
$4 = 1
$_gdb_setting_str (setting)
Return the value of the gdb setting as a string. setting is any setting that
can be used in a set or show command (see Chapter 22 [Controlling GDB],
page 357).
(gdb) show print frame-arguments
Printing of non-scalar frame arguments is "scalars".
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("print frame-arguments")
$1 = "scalars"
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
$2 = "30"
(gdb)
$_gdb_setting (setting)
Return the value of the gdb setting. The type of the returned value depends
on the setting.
The value type for boolean and auto boolean settings is int. The boolean
values off and on are converted to the integer values 0 and 1. The value auto
is converted to the value -1.
The value type for integer settings is either unsigned int or int, depending
on the setting.
Some integer settings accept an unlimited value. Depending on the setting,
the set command also accepts the value 0 or the value −1 as a synonym for
unlimited. For example, set height unlimited is equivalent to set height
0.
Some other settings that accept the unlimited value use the value 0 to literally
mean zero. For example, set history size 0 indicates to not record any gdb
172 Debugging with gdb
commands in the command history. For such settings, −1 is the synonym for
unlimited.
See the documentation of the corresponding set command for the numerical
value equivalent to unlimited.
The $_gdb_setting function converts the unlimited value to a 0 or a −1 value
according to what the set command uses.
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
$1 = "30"
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting("height")
$2 = 30
(gdb) set height unlimited
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
$3 = "unlimited"
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting("height")
$4 = 0
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("history size")
$5 = "unlimited"
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting("history size")
$6 = -1
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting_str("disassemble-next-line")
$7 = "auto"
(gdb) p $_gdb_setting("disassemble-next-line")
$8 = -1
(gdb)
Other setting types (enum, filename, optional filename, string, string noescape)
are returned as string values.
$_gdb_maint_setting_str (setting)
Like the $_gdb_setting_str function, but works with maintenance set vari-
ables.
$_gdb_maint_setting (setting)
Like the $_gdb_setting function, but works with maintenance set variables.
$_shell (command-string)
Invoke a shell to execute command-string. command-string must be a string.
The shell runs on the host machine, the machine gdb is running on. Returns
the command’s exit status. On Unix systems, a command which exits with a
zero exit status has succeeded, and non-zero exit status indicates failure. When
a command terminates on a fatal signal whose number is N, gdb uses the value
128+N as the exit status, as is standard in Unix shells. Note that N is a host
signal number, not a target signal number. If you’re native debugging, they
will be the same, but if cross debugging, the host vs target signal numbers
may be completely unrelated. Please consult your host operating system’s
documentation for the mapping between host signal numbers and signal names.
The shell to run is determined in the same way as for the shell command. See
Section 2.3 [Shell Commands], page 20.
(gdb) print $_shell("true")
$1 = 0
(gdb) print $_shell("false")
$2 = 1
(gdb) p $_shell("echo hello")
Chapter 10: Examining Data 173
hello
$3 = 0
(gdb) p $_shell("foobar")
bash: line 1: foobar: command not found
$4 = 127
This may also be useful in breakpoint conditions. For example:
(gdb) break function if $_shell("some command") == 0
In this scenario, you’ll want to make sure that the shell command you run in
the breakpoint condition takes the least amount of time possible. For example,
avoid running a command that may block indefinitely, or that sleeps for a while
before exiting. Prefer a command or script which analyzes some state and exits
immediately. This is important because the debugged program stops for the
breakpoint every time, and then gdb evaluates the breakpoint condition. If the
condition is false, the program is re-resumed transparently, without informing
you of the stop. A quick shell command thus avoids significantly slowing down
the debugged program unnecessarily.
Note: unlike the shell command, the $_shell convenience function does not
affect the $_shell_exitcode and $_shell_exitsignal convenience variables.
The following functions require gdb to be configured with Python support.
$_memeq(buf1, buf2, length)
Returns one if the length bytes at the addresses given by buf1 and buf2 are
equal. Otherwise it returns zero.
$_regex(str, regex)
Returns one if the string str matches the regular expression regex. Otherwise it
returns zero. The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by Python’s
regular expression support.
$_streq(str1, str2)
Returns one if the strings str1 and str2 are equal. Otherwise it returns zero.
$_strlen(str)
Returns the length of string str.
$_caller_is(name[, number_of_frames])
Returns one if the calling function’s name is equal to name. Otherwise it returns
zero.
If the optional argument number of frames is provided, it is the number of
frames up in the stack to look. The default is 1.
Example:
(gdb) backtrace
#0 bottom_func ()
at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
#1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
#2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
#3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
174 Debugging with gdb
$1 = 1
(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
$1 = 1
$_caller_matches(regexp[, number_of_frames])
Returns one if the calling function’s name matches the regular expression
regexp. Otherwise it returns zero.
If the optional argument number of frames is provided, it is the number of
frames up in the stack to look. The default is 1.
$_any_caller_is(name[, number_of_frames])
Returns one if any calling function’s name is equal to name. Otherwise it
returns zero.
If the optional argument number of frames is provided, it is the number of
frames up in the stack to look. The default is 1.
This function differs from $_caller_is in that this function checks all stack
frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified by number of frames,
whereas $_caller_is only checks the frame specified by number of frames.
$_any_caller_matches(regexp[, number_of_frames])
Returns one if any calling function’s name matches the regular expression
regexp. Otherwise it returns zero.
If the optional argument number of frames is provided, it is the number of
frames up in the stack to look. The default is 1.
This function differs from $_caller_matches in that this function checks
all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified by
number of frames, whereas $_caller_matches only checks the frame specified
by number of frames.
$_as_string(value)
This convenience function is considered deprecated, and could be removed from
future versions of gdb. Use the ‘%V’ format specifier instead (see [%V Format
Specifier], page 388).
Return the string representation of value.
This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an enumera-
tion value. For example, assuming the variable node is of an enumerated type:
(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
$_cimag(value)
$_creal(value)
Return the imaginary ($_cimag) or real ($_creal) part of the complex number
value.
The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the complex
number, e.g., using $_cimag on a float complex will return an imaginary part
of type float.
gdb provides the ability to list and get help on convenience functions.
help function
Print a list of all convenience functions.
Chapter 10: Examining Data 175
10.14 Registers
You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables with names starting
with ‘$’. The names of registers are different for each machine; use info registers to see
the names used on your machine.
info registers
Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point and vector
registers (in the selected stack frame).
info all-registers
Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point and vector
registers (in the selected stack frame).
info registers reggroup ...
Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified reggroups.
The reggroup can be any of those returned by maint print reggroups (see
Appendix D [Maintenance Commands], page 735).
info registers regname ...
Print the relativized value of each specified register regname. As discussed in
detail below, register values are normally relative to the selected stack frame.
The regname may be any register name valid on the machine you are using,
with or without the initial ‘$’.
gdb has four “standard” register names that are available (in expressions) on most
machines—whenever they do not conflict with an architecture’s canonical mnemonics for
registers. The register names $pc and $sp are used for the program counter register and
the stack pointer. $fp is used for a register that contains a pointer to the current stack
frame, and $ps is used for a register that contains the processor status. For example, you
could print the program counter in hex with
p/x $pc
or print the instruction to be executed next with
x/i $pc
or add four to the stack pointer2 with
set $sp += 4
Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on your machine
even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics, so long as there is no conflict.
The info registers command shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC,
info registers displays the processor status register as $psr but you can also refer to it
as $ps; and on x86-based machines $ps is an alias for the eflags register.
gdb always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an integer when the register
is examined in this way. Some machines have special registers which can hold nothing but
floating point; these registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
2
This is a way of removing one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in memory
(most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost stack frame is selected; setting $sp is not
allowed when other stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack, regardless of machine
architecture, use return; see Section 17.4 [Returning from a Function], page 276.
176 Debugging with gdb
to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value (although you can
print it as a floating point value with ‘print/f $regname’).
Some registers have distinct “raw” and “virtual” data formats. This means that the data
format in which the register contents are saved by the operating system is not the same
one that your program normally sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
coprocessor are always saved in “extended” (raw) format, but all C programs expect to work
with “double” (virtual) format. In such cases, gdb normally works with the virtual format
only (the format that makes sense for your program), but the info registers command
prints the data in both formats.
Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted in several differ-
ent ways. For example, modern x86-based machines have SSE and MMX registers that can
hold several values packed together in several different formats. gdb refers to such registers
in struct notation:
(gdb) print $xmm1
$1 = {
v4_float = {0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044},
v2_double = {9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313},
v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
v8_int16 = {0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0},
v4_int32 = {0, 20657912, 11, 13},
v2_int64 = {88725056443645952, 55834574859},
uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
}
To set values of such registers, you need to tell gdb which view of the register you wish to
change, as if you were assigning value to a struct member:
(gdb) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame (see Section 8.3 [Select-
ing a Frame], page 113). This means that you get the value that the register would contain
if all stack frames farther in were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see
the true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost frame (with ‘frame
0’).
Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the callee (a.k.a.:
“caller-saved”, “call-clobbered” or “volatile” registers). It may therefore not be possible for
gdb to know the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer frame),
if the register value has since been changed by the callee. gdb tries to deduce where
the inner frame saved (“callee-saved”) registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not saved, and gdb knows the
register is “caller-saved” (via its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind
info explicitly says the register’s value is undefined), gdb displays ‘<not saved>’ as the
register’s value. With targets that gdb has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location in the outer frame are
assumed to be the same of the inner frame. This is usually harmless, because if the register
is call-clobbered, the caller either does not care what is in the register after the call, or has
code to restore the value that it does care about. Note, however, that if you change such
a register in the outer frame, you may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more
“outer” the frame is you’re looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered register’s value is
to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn’t actually represent the value the register had just
before the call.
Chapter 10: Examining Data 177
tecture different fields are available. Two common entries are pro-
cessor which gives CPU number and bogomips; a system constant
that is calculated during kernel initialization.
files Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
file descriptor, gdb prints the identifier of the process owning the
descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value of the
descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
modules Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For
each module, gdb prints the module name, the size of the module
in bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies
of the module, the status of the module, and the address of the
loaded module in memory.
msg Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For
each message queue, gdb prints the message queue key, the message
queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the
processes that last sent and received a message on the queue, the
user and group of the owner and creator of the message queue, the
times at which a message was last sent and received on the queue,
and the time at which the message queue was last changed.
processes
Display the list of processes on the target. For each process, gdb
prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the command
corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores that
the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
the general gnu/Linux documentation.)
procgroups
Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
gdb prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs to, the
command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped
together and the process group leader is listed first.
semaphores
Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target.
For each semaphore set, gdb prints the semaphore set key, the
semaphore set identifier, the access permissions, the number of
semaphores in the set, the user and group of the owner and creator
of the semaphore set, and the times at which the semaphore set
was operated upon and changed.
shm Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the tar-
get. For each shared-memory region, gdb prints the region key,
Chapter 10: Examining Data 179
10.18.1 Attributes
10.18.1.1 Memory Access Mode
The access mode attributes set whether gdb may make read or write accesses to a memory
region.
While these attributes prevent gdb from performing invalid memory accesses, they do
nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA, etc. from accessing memory.
ro Memory is read only.
wo Memory is write only.
rw Memory is read/write. This is the default.
restore a raw binary file you must specify the optional keyword binary after
the filename.
If bias is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses contained in the file.
Binary files always start at address zero, so they will be restored at address
bias. Other bfd files have a built-in location; they will be restored at offset bias
from that location.
If start and/or end are non-zero, then only data between file offset start and
file offset end will be restored. These offsets are relative to the addresses in the
file, before the bias argument is applied.
generate-core-file [file]
gcore [file]
Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument file specifies
the file name where to put the core dump. If not specified, the file name defaults
to core.pid, where pid is the inferior process ID.
Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of this
writing, gnu/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
On gnu/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the file
/proc/pid/coredump_filter when generating the core dump (see [set use-
coredump-filter], page 182), and by default honors the VM_DONTDUMP flag for
mappings where it is present in the file /proc/pid/smaps (see [set dump-
excluded-mappings], page 183).
set use-coredump-filter on
set use-coredump-filter off
Enable or disable the use of the file /proc/pid/coredump_filter when gen-
erating core dump files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what
types of memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core
dump file. pid is the process ID of a currently running process.
To make use of this feature, you have to write in the /proc/pid/coredump_
filter file a value, in hexadecimal, which is a bit mask representing the memory
mapping types. If a bit is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of
the corresponding types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information about the
bits that can be set in the /proc/pid/coredump_filter file, please refer to the
manpage of core(5).
Chapter 10: Examining Data 183
By default, this option is on. If this option is turned off, gdb does not read
the coredump_filter file and instead uses the same default value as the Linux
kernel in order to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
value is currently 0x33, which means that bits 0 (anonymous private mappings),
1 (anonymous shared mappings), 4 (ELF headers) and 5 (private huge pages)
are active. This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
set dump-excluded-mappings on
set dump-excluded-mappings off
If on is specified, gdb will dump memory mappings marked with the VM_
DONTDUMP flag. This flag is represented in the file /proc/pid/smaps with the
acronym dd.
The default value is off.
show charset
Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
show host-charset
Show the name of the current host character set.
show target-charset
Show the name of the current target character set.
set target-wide-charset charset
Set the current target’s wide character set to charset. This is the character
set used by the target’s wchar_t type. To display the list of supported wide
character sets, type set target-wide-charset TABTAB.
show target-wide-charset
Show the name of the current target’s wide character set.
Here is an example of gdb’s character set support in action. Assume that the following
source code has been placed in the file charset-test.c:
#include <stdio.h>
char ascii_hello[]
= {72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0};
char ibm1047_hello[]
= {200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0};
main ()
{
printf ("Hello, world!\n");
}
In this program, ascii_hello and ibm1047_hello are arrays containing the string
‘Hello, world!’ followed by a newline, encoded in the ascii and ibm1047 character sets.
We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
$ gdb -nw charset-test
GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
...
(gdb)
We can use the show charset command to see what character sets gdb is currently
using to interpret and display characters and strings:
(gdb) show charset
The current host and target character set is ‘ISO-8859-1’.
(gdb)
For the sake of printing this manual, let’s use ascii as our initial character set:
(gdb) set charset ASCII
(gdb) show charset
The current host and target character set is ‘ASCII’.
(gdb)
Let’s assume that ascii is indeed the correct character set for our host system — in
other words, let’s assume that if gdb prints characters using the ascii character set, our
Chapter 10: Examining Data 185
terminal will display them properly. Since our current target character set is also ascii, the
contents of ascii_hello print legibly:
(gdb) print ascii_hello
$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
$2 = 72 ’H’
(gdb)
gdb uses the target character set for character and string literals you use in expressions:
(gdb) print ’+’
$3 = 43 ’+’
(gdb)
The ascii character set uses the number 43 to encode the ‘+’ character.
gdb relies on the user to tell it which character set the target program uses. If we print
ibm1047_hello while our target character set is still ascii, we get jibberish:
(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
$5 = 200 ’\310’
(gdb)
If we invoke the set target-charset followed by TABTAB, gdb tells us the character
sets it supports:
(gdb) set target-charset
ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
(gdb) set target-charset
We can select ibm1047 as our target character set, and examine the program’s strings
again. Now the ascii string is wrong, but gdb translates the contents of ibm1047_hello
from the target character set, ibm1047, to the host character set, ascii, and they display
correctly:
(gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
(gdb) show charset
The current host character set is ‘ASCII’.
The current target character set is ‘IBM1047’.
(gdb) print ascii_hello
$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
$7 = 72 ’\110’
(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
$9 = 200 ’H’
(gdb)
As above, gdb uses the target character set for character and string literals you use in
expressions:
(gdb) print ’+’
$10 = 78 ’+’
(gdb)
The ibm1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the ‘+’ character.
186 Debugging with gdb
3
In non-stop mode, it is moderately rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread in
a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of stack reads provides a significant speed up
of remote backtraces.
Chapter 10: Examining Data 187
The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the number of matches
found.
The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable ‘$_’. A count of the
number of matches is stored in ‘$numfound’.
For example, if stopped at the printf in this function:
void
hello ()
{
static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
static struct { char c; short s; int i; }
__attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
= { ’c’, 0x1234, 0x87654321 };
printf ("%s\n", hello);
}
you get during debugging:
(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
1 pattern found
(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), ’h’, ’e’, ’l’, ’l’, ’o’
0x8049567 <hello.1620>
0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
2 patterns found.
(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), {char[5]}"hello"
0x8049567 <hello.1620>
0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
2 patterns found.
(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), ’h’, 0x65, ’l’
0x8049567 <hello.1620>
1 pattern found
(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) ’c’, (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
1 pattern found
(gdb) print $numfound
$1 = 1
(gdb) print $_
$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
• Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not work, because the
call site does not contain any code. gdb may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the
next line of the enclosing function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in
a future version of gdb; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line or inside the
inlined function instead.
• gdb cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after using the finish command.
This is a limitation of compiler-generated debugging information; after finish, you
can step to the next line and print a variable where your program stored the return
value.
The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous. There is
no execution history stored (possible Chapter 6 [Reverse Execution], page 99, is never used
for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known callee by multiple
different jump sequences. In such case gdb still tries to show at least all the unambiguous
top tail callers and all the unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
(gdb) bt
#0 c (i=i@entry=0) at t.c:2
#1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
#2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
gdb cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did function a call
itself (via function b) as these calls would be tail calls. Such tail calls would modify the
i variable, therefore gdb cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - gdb prints
<optimized out> instead.
195
12 C Preprocessor Macros
Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke “preprocessor
macros” which expand into strings of tokens. gdb can evaluate expressions containing
macro invocations, show the result of macro expansion, and show a macro’s definition,
including where it was defined.
You may need to compile your program specially to provide gdb with information about
preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not include macros in their debugging information,
even when you compile with the -g flag. See Section 4.1 [Compilation], page 33.
A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later, and then
provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different points in the program, a macro
may have different definitions, or have no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame,
gdb uses the macros in scope at that frame’s source code line. Otherwise, gdb uses the
macros in scope at the current listing location; see Section 9.1 [List], page 121.
Whenever gdb evaluates an expression, it always expands any macro invocations present
in the expression. gdb also provides the following commands for working with macros
explicitly.
macro expand expression
macro exp expression
Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in expression.
Since gdb simply expands macros, but does not parse the result, expression
need not be a valid expression; it can be any string of tokens.
macro expand-once expression
macro exp1 expression
(This command is not yet implemented.) Show the results of expanding those
preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in expression. Macro
invocations appearing in that expansion are left unchanged. This command
allows you to see the effect of a particular macro more clearly, without being
confused by further expansions. Since gdb simply expands macros, but does
not parse the result, expression need not be a valid expression; it can be any
string of tokens.
info macro [-a|-all] [--] macro
Show the current definition or all definitions of the named macro, and describe
the source location or compiler command-line where that definition was estab-
lished. The optional double dash is to signify the end of argument processing
and the beginning of macro for non C-like macros where the macro may begin
with a hyphen.
info macros locspec
Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the source line of the code
location that results from resolving locspec, and describe the source location or
compiler command-line where those definitions were established.
macro define macro replacement-list
macro define macro(arglist) replacement-list
Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named macro, invocations of
which are replaced by the tokens given in replacement-list. The first form of
196 Debugging with gdb
#define M 42
#define ADD(x) (M + x)
main ()
{
#define N 28
printf ("Hello, world!\n");
#undef N
printf ("We’re so creative.\n");
#define N 1729
printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
}
$ cat sample.h
#define Q <
$
Now, we compile the program using the gnu C compiler, gcc. We pass the -gdwarf-21
and -g3 flags to ensure the compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the
debugging information.
$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
$
Now, we start gdb on our sample program:
$ gdb -nw sample
GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
GDB is free software, ...
(gdb)
1
This is the minimum. Recent versions of gcc support -gdwarf-3 and -gdwarf-4; we recommend always
choosing the most recent version of DWARF.
Chapter 12: C Preprocessor Macros 197
We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the program is not
running. gdb uses the current listing position to decide which macro definitions are in
scope:
(gdb) list main
3
4 #define M 42
5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6
7 main ()
8 {
9 #define N 28
10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11 #undef N
12 printf ("We’re so creative.\n");
(gdb) info macro ADD
Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
#define ADD(x) (M + x)
(gdb) info macro Q
Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
#define Q <
(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
expands to: (42 + 1)
(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
expands to: once (M + 1)
(gdb)
In the example above, note that macro expand-once expands only the macro invocation
explicit in the original text — the invocation of ADD — but does not expand the invocation
of the macro M, which was introduced by ADD.
Once the program is running, gdb uses the macro definitions in force at the source line
of the current stack frame:
(gdb) break main
Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
(gdb) run
Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
13 Tracepoints
In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program’s execution
long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior. If the program’s
correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger might cause
the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps fail, even when the code itself is
correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program’s behavior without interrupting it.
Using gdb’s trace and collect commands, you can specify locations in the program,
called tracepoints, and arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
Later, using the tfind command, you can examine the values those expressions had when
the program hit the tracepoints. The expressions may also denote objects in memory—
structures or arrays, for example—whose values gdb should record; while visiting a partic-
ular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were in memory at that moment.
However, because gdb records these values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly
and unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program’s behavior.
The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote targets. See Chapter 19
[Targets], page 303. In addition, your remote target must know how to collect trace data.
This functionality is implemented in the remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed
with gdb support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote packets used to
implement tracepoints are described in Section E.6 [Tracepoint Packets], page 792.
It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent of corefiles;
you specify the filename, and use tfind to search through the file. See Section 13.4 [Trace
Files], page 215, for more details.
This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
points, also known as markers, are embedded in the target program, and can be activated
or deactivated by name or address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
investigating what the target is actually doing. gdb’s support for static tracing includes
being able to list instrumentation points, and attach them with gdb defined high level tra-
cepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of gdb’s tracepoints support. Namely,
support for collecting registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables. The act of installing a gdb
static tracepoint on an instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as probing a static
tracepoint marker.
gdbserver supports tracepoints on some target systems. See Section 20.3 [Tracepoints
support in gdbserver], page 312.
This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated conditions and ac-
tions.
if cond evaluates as true. See Section 13.1.4 [Tracepoint Conditions], page 203,
for more information on tracepoint conditions.
ftrace locspec [ if cond ]
The ftrace command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that support them,
fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly less general technique to
trigger data collection, such as a jump instruction instead of a trap, or some
sort of hardware support. It may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at
the desired location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
message.
gdb handles arguments to ftrace exactly as for trace.
On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to be placed
at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be placed at 4-byte instruc-
tions if the low 64K of memory of the target program is available to install
trampolines. Some Unix-type systems, such as gnu/Linux, exclude low ad-
dresses from the program’s address space; but for instance with the Linux
kernel it is possible to let gdb use this area by doing a sysctl command to set
the mmap_min_addr kernel parameter, as in
sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for trampolines.
The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
strace [locspec | -m marker] [ if cond ]
The strace command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that support it,
setting a static tracepoint probes a static instrumentation point, or marker,
found at the code locations that result from resolving locspec. It may not be
possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired code location, in which case
the command will exit with an explanatory message.
gdb handles arguments to strace exactly as for trace, with the addition that
the user can also specify -m marker instead of a location spec. This probes
the marker identified by the marker string identifier. This identifier depends
on the static tracepoint backend library your program is using. You can find
all the marker identifiers in the ‘ID’ field of the info static-tracepoint-
markers command output. See Section 13.1.8 [Listing Static Tracepoint Mark-
ers], page 207. For example, in the following small program using the UST
tracing engine:
main ()
{
trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
}
the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the trace_mark
call with a slash, which translates to:
(gdb) info static-tracepoint-markers
Cnt Enb ID Address What
1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
Data: "str %s"
[etc...]
so you may probe the marker above with:
202 Debugging with gdb
the tracepoint number num is not specified, the passcount command sets the
passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is given, the
trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the user.
Examples:
(gdb) passcount 5 2 // Stop on the 5th execution of
// tracepoint 2
Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use them in print
commands and expressions as if they were convenience variables; gdb will get the current
value from the target while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share the
same namespace as other “$” variables, which means that you cannot have trace state vari-
ables with names like $23 or $pc, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
variable with the same name.
tvariable $name [ = expression ]
The tvariable command creates a new trace state variable named $name, and
optionally gives it an initial value of expression. The expression is evaluated
when this command is entered; the result will be converted to an integer if
possible, otherwise gdb will report an error. A subsequent tvariable command
specifying the same name does not create a variable, but instead assigns the
supplied initial value to the existing variable of that name, overwriting any
previous initial value. The default initial value is 0.
info tvariables
List all the trace state variables along with their initial values. Their current
values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is currently running.
delete tvariable [ $name ... ]
Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments are speci-
fied.
its own separate end command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an end
command.
(gdb) trace foo
(gdb) actions
Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
> collect bar,baz
> collect $regs
> while-stepping 12
> collect $pc, arr[i]
> end
end
format is similar to that used for info breakpoints; in fact, info tracepoints
is the same command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
A tracepoint’s listing may include additional information specific to tracing:
• its passcount as given by the passcount n command
• the state about installed on target of each location
(gdb) info trace
Num Type Disp Enb Address What
1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
while-stepping 20
collect globfoo, $regs
end
collect globfoo2
end
pass count 1200
2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
collect $eip
2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
installed on target
2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
installed on target
2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
not installed on target
(gdb)
This command can be abbreviated info tp.
tstop This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are supplied, they
are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is useful if you are stopping
a trace started by someone else, for instance if the trace is interfering with the
system’s behavior and needs to be stopped quickly.
Note: a trace experiment and data collection may stop automatically if any
tracepoint’s passcount is reached (see Section 13.1.3 [Tracepoint Passcounts],
page 202), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
tstatus This command displays the status of the current trace data collection.
You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if gdb disconnects from
the target, voluntarily or involuntarily. For commands such as detach, the debugger will
ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected terminations (gdb crash,
network outage), it would be unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
disconnected-tracing lets you decide whether the trace should continue running without
gdb.
Chapter 13: Tracepoints 209
set disconnected-tracing on
set disconnected-tracing off
Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if gdb has disconnected
from the target. Note that detach or quit will ask you directly what to do
about a running trace no matter what this variable’s setting, so the variable is
mainly useful for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
show disconnected-tracing
Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not still be running;
it might have filled the trace buffer in the meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons.
If it is running, it will continue after reconnection.
Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the tracepoints in effect.
gdb will then compare that information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and
attempt to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may have changed
due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of the target’s tracepoints does not
match any in gdb, the debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number
with which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is necessarily heuristic,
and it may result in useless tracepoints being created; you may simply delete them if they
are of no use.
If your target agent supports a circular trace buffer, then you can run a trace experiment
indefinitely without filling the trace buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-
collected trace frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue collecting. This
is especially useful if your tracepoints are being hit too often, and your trace gets termi-
nated prematurely because the buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
‘circular-trace-buffer’ to on. You can set this at any time, including during tracing;
if the agent can do it, it will change buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take
effect until the next run.
set circular-trace-buffer on
set circular-trace-buffer off
Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer for trace
data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may fill up prematurely,
while a circular buffer will discard old trace data, but it will have always room
for the latest tracepoint hits.
show circular-trace-buffer
Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not match the
agent’s current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to match the setting that
might have been in effect during a past run, for instance if you are looking at
frames from a trace file.
set trace-buffer-size n
set trace-buffer-size unlimited
Request that the target use a trace buffer of n bytes. Not all targets will honor
the request; they may have a compiled-in size for the trace buffer, or some other
limitation. Set to a value of unlimited or -1 to let the target use whatever
size it likes. This is also the default.
210 Debugging with gdb
show trace-buffer-size
Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this will only
match the actual size if the target supports size-setting, and was able to handle
the requested size. For instance, if the target can only change buffer size between
runs, this variable will not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use
tstatus to get a report of the actual buffer size.
set trace-user text
show trace-user
set trace-notes text
Set the trace run’s notes.
show trace-notes
Show the trace run’s notes.
set trace-stop-notes text
Set the trace run’s stop notes. The handling of the note is as for tstop argu-
ments; the set command is convenient way to fix a stop note that is mistaken
or incomplete.
show trace-stop-notes
Show the trace run’s stop notes.
pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example, *ptr@50 can be used to collect the
50 element array pointed to by ptr.
• It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a tracepoint. Instead, you may
collect the registers and a few hundred bytes from the stack pointer with something
like *(unsigned char *)$esp@300 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer
register on your target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
Then the backtrace command will show a partial backtrace when using a trace frame.
The number of stack frames that can be examined depends on the sizes of the frames
in the collected stack. Note that if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the
bottom of the stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an invalid
address.
• If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, gdb can infer that the value of $pc
must be the same as the address of the tracepoint and use that when you are looking
at a trace frame for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was inlined), or if it has
a while-stepping loop. In those cases gdb will warn you that it can’t infer $pc, and
default it to zero.
13.2.1 tfind n
The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is tfind n, which finds
trace snapshot number n, counting from zero. If no argument n is given, the next snapshot
is selected.
Here are the various forms of using the tfind command.
tfind start
Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for tfind 0 (since 0 is
the number of the first snapshot).
tfind none
Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume live debugging.
tfind end Same as ‘tfind none’.
tfind No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first one if no trace
snapshot is selected.
212 Debugging with gdb
tfind - Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits retracing
earlier steps.
tfind tracepoint num
Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint num. Search proceeds for-
ward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no argument num is given, it
means find the next snapshot collected for the same tracepoint as the current
snapshot.
tfind pc addr
Find the next snapshot associated with the value addr of the program counter.
Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no argument
addr is given, it means find the next snapshot with the same value of PC as
the current snapshot.
tfind outside addr1, addr2
Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of addresses (ex-
clusive).
tfind range addr1, addr2
Find the next snapshot whose PC is between addr1 and addr2 (inclusive).
tfind line [file:]n
Find the next snapshot associated with the source line n. If the optional argu-
ment file is given, refer to line n in that source file. Search proceeds forward
from the last examined trace snapshot. If no argument n is given, it means find
the next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying tfind
line repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as stepping from line to
line in a live debugging session.
The default arguments for the tfind commands are specifically designed to make it easy
to scan through the trace buffer. For instance, tfind with no argument selects the next
trace snapshot, and tfind - with no argument selects the previous trace snapshot. So, by
giving one tfind command, and then simply hitting RET repeatedly you can examine all
the trace snapshots in order. Or, by saying tfind - and then hitting RET repeatedly you
can examine the snapshots in reverse order. The tfind line command with no argument
selects the snapshot for the next source line executed. The tfind pc command with no
argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter (PC) as the current
frame. The tfind tracepoint command with no argument selects the next trace snapshot
collected by the same tracepoint as the current one.
In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually, these commands make
it easy to construct gdb scripts that scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever
collected data you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
(gdb) tfind start
(gdb) while ($trace frame != -1)
> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
$trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
> tfind
> end
Chapter 13: Tracepoints 213
Frame 0, X = 1
Frame 7, X = 2
Frame 13, X = 255
13.2.2 tdump
This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at the current trace
snapshot.
(gdb) trace 444
(gdb) actions
Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
> end
(gdb) tstart
(gdb) tdump
Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
d1 0x18 24
d2 0x80 128
d3 0x33 51
d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
d5 0x22 34
d6 0xe0 224
d7 0x380035 3670069
a0 0x19e24a 1696330
a1 0x3000668 50333288
a2 0x100 256
a3 0x322000 3284992
a4 0x3000698 50333336
a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
214 Debugging with gdb
ps 0x0 0
pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
fpcontrol 0x0 0
fpstatus 0x0 0
fpiaddr 0x0 0
p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
p1 = (void *) 0x11
p2 = (void *) 0x22
p3 = (void *) 0x33
p4 = (void *) 0x44
p5 = (void *) 0x55
p6 = (void *) 0x66
gdb_long_test = 17 ’\021’
(gdb)
tdump works by scanning the tracepoint’s current collection actions and printing the
value of each expression listed. So tdump can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint’s
actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
Also, for tracepoints with while-stepping loops, tdump uses the collected value of $pc
to distinguish between trace frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames
that were collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether to display
the basic list of collections, or the collections from the body of the while-stepping loop.
However, if $pc was not collected, then tdump will always attempt to dump using the basic
collection list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the same data
that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
Here’s a simple example of using these convenience variables for stepping through all the
trace snapshots and printing some of their data. Note that these are not the same as trace
state variables, which are managed by the target.
(gdb) tfind start
$1 = 1
217
A code overlay
The diagram (see [A code overlay], page 217) shows a system with separate data and
instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies its code from the larger
address space to the instruction address space. Since the overlays shown here all use the
same mapped address, only one may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single
address space for data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
program variables and heap would share an address space with the main program and the
overlay area.
218 Debugging with gdb
An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a mapped overlay;
its mapped address is its address in the instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only
partially present) in instruction memory is called unmapped; its load address is its address
in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called the virtual memory address, or
VMA; the load address is also called the load memory address, or LMA.
Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a program to
limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of global constraints you must keep
in mind as you design your program:
• Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program must make sure
that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or return will transfer control to
the right address, but in the wrong overlay, and your program will probably crash.
• If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you will need to
choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on your program’s performance.
• The executable file you load onto your system must contain each overlay’s instruc-
tions, appearing at the overlay’s load address, not its mapped address. However, each
overlay’s instructions must be relocated and its symbols defined as if the overlay were
at its mapped address. You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and
relocation addresses for pieces of your program; see Section “Overlay Description” in
Using ld: the GNU linker.
• The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able to load their
contents into the larger address space as well as the instruction and data spaces.
The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be improved in many
ways:
• If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management hardware,
you could use those facilities to make an overlay’s load area contents simply appear at
their mapped address in instruction space. This would probably be faster than copying
the overlay to its mapped area in the usual way.
• If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one overlay area, and
have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
• You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In general, data overlays
are even less transparent to your design than code overlays: whereas code overlays only
require care when you call or return to functions, data overlays require care every time
you access the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you must copy
its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a different data overlay
into the same mapped area.
overlay off
Disable gdb’s overlay support. When overlay support is disabled, gdb assumes
that all functions and variables are always present at their mapped addresses.
By default, gdb’s overlay support is disabled.
overlay manual
Enable manual overlay debugging. In this mode, gdb relies on you to tell it
which overlays are mapped, and which are not, using the overlay map-overlay
and overlay unmap-overlay commands described below.
overlay map-overlay overlay
overlay map overlay
Tell gdb that overlay is now mapped; overlay must be the name of the object
file section containing the overlay. When an overlay is mapped, gdb assumes it
can find the overlay’s functions and variables at their mapped addresses. gdb
assumes that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of overlay
are now unmapped.
overlay unmap-overlay overlay
overlay unmap overlay
Tell gdb that overlay is no longer mapped; overlay must be the name of the
object file section containing the overlay. When an overlay is unmapped, gdb
assumes it can find the overlay’s functions and variables at their load addresses.
overlay auto
Enable automatic overlay debugging. In this mode, gdb consults a data struc-
ture the overlay manager maintains in the inferior to see which overlays are
mapped. For details, see Section 14.3 [Automatic Overlay Debugging], page 220.
overlay load-target
overlay load
Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, gdb re-reads the table
gdb automatically each time the inferior stops, so this command should only
be necessary if you have changed the overlay mapping yourself using gdb. This
command is only useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
overlay list-overlays
overlay list
Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped ad-
dresses, load addresses, and sizes.
Normally, when gdb prints a code address, it includes the name of the function the
address falls in:
(gdb) print main
$3 = {int ()} 0x11a0 <main>
When overlay debugging is enabled, gdb recognizes code in unmapped overlays, and prints
the names of unmapped functions with asterisks around them. For example, if foo is a
function in an unmapped overlay, gdb prints it this way:
(gdb) overlay list
No sections are mapped.
(gdb) print foo
220 Debugging with gdb
_novlys: This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total number of
elements in _ovly_table.
To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, gdb looks for an entry in
_ovly_table whose vma and lma members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay’s section
Chapter 14: Debugging Programs That Use Overlays 221
in the executable file. When gdb finds a matching entry, it consults the entry’s mapped
member to determine whether the overlay is currently mapped.
In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called _ovly_debug_event. If
this function is defined, gdb will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager
then calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this will enable gdb to
accurately keep track of which overlays are in program memory, and update any breakpoints
that may be set in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the overlays are
kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they are not being executed.
.d D source file
.m Objective-C source file
.f
.F Fortran source file
.mod Modula-2 source file
.s
.S Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but gdb does not
skip over function prologues when stepping.
In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename extension. See
Section 15.2 [Displaying the Language], page 224.
show language
Display the current working language. This is the language you can use with
commands such as print to build and compute expressions that may involve
variables in your program.
info frame
Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the working
language if you use an identifier from this frame. See Section 8.4 [Information
about a Frame], page 115, to identify the other information listed here.
info source
Display the source language of this source file. See Chapter 16 [Examining the
Symbol Table], page 259, to identify the other information listed here.
In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions not in the standard
list. You can then set the extension associated with a language explicitly:
The second example fails because in C++ the integer constant ‘0x1234’ is not type-
compatible with the pointer parameter type.
226 Debugging with gdb
For the expressions you use in gdb commands, you can tell gdb to not enforce strict
type checking or to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression; When type
checking is disabled, gdb successfully evaluates expressions like the second example above.
Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons related to type that prevent gdb
from evaluating an expression. For instance, gdb does not know how to add an int and a
struct foo. These particular type errors have nothing to do with the language in use and
usually arise from expressions which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
gdb provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
set check type on
set check type off
Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in evaluating an
expression while type checking is on, gdb prints a message and aborts evaluation
of the expression.
show check type
Show the current setting of type checking and whether gdb is enforcing strict
type checking rules.
default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on, then a message is
printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
set check range warn
Output messages when the gdb range checker detects a range error, but at-
tempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the expression may still
be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing memory that the process does
not own (a typical example from many Unix systems).
show check range
Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is being
set automatically by gdb.
In addition, in order to imitate gdb’s behaviour with binary floating point computations,
error checking in decimal float operations ignores underflow, overflow and divide by zero
exceptions.
In the PowerPC architecture, gdb provides a set of pseudo-registers to inspect
_Decimal128 values stored in floating point registers. See Section 21.4.6 [PowerPC],
page 351, for more details.
15.4.2 D
gdb can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with GDC, LDC or DMD
compilers. Currently gdb supports only one D specific feature — dynamic arrays.
15.4.3 Go
gdb can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with gccgo or 6g compilers.
Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
The current Go package
The name of the current package does not need to be specified when specifying
global variables and functions.
For example, given the program:
package main
var myglob = "Shall we?"
func main () {
// ...
}
When stopped inside main either of these work:
(gdb) p myglob
(gdb) p main.myglob
Builtin Go types
The string type is recognized by gdb and is printed as a string.
Builtin Go functions
The gdb expression parser recognizes the unsafe.Sizeof function and handles
it internally.
Restrictions on Go expressions
All Go operators are supported except &^. The Go _ “blank identifier” is not
supported. Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15.4.4 Objective-C
This section provides information about some commands and command options that are
useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259, and
Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259, for a few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
• break
• info line
• jump
• list
where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a plus sign (not shown)
is used to indicate a class method. The class name Class and method name methodName
are enclosed in brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C source
code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the create instance method of class Fruit in
the program currently being debugged, enter:
break -[Fruit create]
To list ten program lines around the initialize class method, enter:
list +[NSText initialize]
In the current version of gdb, the plus or minus sign is required. In future versions of
gdb, the plus or minus sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It is
also possible to specify just a method name:
break create
You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If your program’s
source files contain more than one create method, you’ll be presented with a numbered
list of classes that implement that method. Indicate your choice by number, or type ‘0’ to
exit if none apply.
As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the makeKeyAndOrderFront:
method of the NSWindow class, enter:
clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
will tell gdb to send the hash message to object and print the result. Also, an additional
command has been added, print-object or po for short, which is meant to print the
description of an object. However, this command may only work with certain Objective-C
libraries that have a particular hook function, _NSPrintForDebugger, defined.
15.4.5 OpenCL C
This section provides information about gdbs OpenCL C support.
15.4.6 Fortran
gdb can be used to debug programs written in Fortran. Note, that not all Fortran language
features are available yet.
Some Fortran compilers (gnu Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers among them) append
an underscore to the names of variables and functions. When you debug programs com-
piled by those compilers, you will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
underscore.
Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so gdb by default uses case-insensitive
matching for Fortran symbols. You can change that with the ‘set case-insensitive’
command, see Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259, for the details.
15.4.7 Pascal
Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or nested functions
does not currently work. gdb does not support entering expressions, printing values, or
similar features using Pascal syntax.
The Pascal-specific command set print pascal_static-members controls whether
static members of Pascal objects are displayed. See Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153.
15.4.8 Rust
gdb supports the Rust Programming Language (https://www.rust-lang.org/). Type-
and value-printing, and expression parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a
few peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
• Linespecs (see Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122) are never relative to the
current crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of crates, somewhat
similar to the way extern crate behaves.
That is, if gdb is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in crate ‘A’, module ‘B’, then
break B::f will attempt to set a breakpoint in a function named ‘f’ in a crate named
‘B’.
As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to items using ‘self::’
or ‘super::’.
• Because gdb implements Rust name-lookup semantics in expressions, it will sometimes
prepend the current crate to a name. For example, if gdb is stopped at a breakpoint
in the crate ‘K’, then print ::x::y will try to find the symbol ‘K::x::y’.
However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when debugging, gdb
provides the extern extension to circumvent this. To use the extension, just put
extern before a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable “global” scope.
In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol ‘y’ in the crate ‘x’, you
would use print extern x::y.
• The Rust expression evaluator does not support “statement-like” expressions such as
if or match, or lambda expressions.
• Tuple expressions are not implemented.
• The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the Drop trait. Objects
that may be created by the evaluator will never be destroyed.
• gdb does not implement type inference for generics. In order to call generic functions or
otherwise refer to generic items, you will have to specify the type parameters manually.
• gdb currently uses the C++ demangler for Rust. In most cases this does not cause any
problems. However, in an expression context, completing a generic function name will
give syntactically invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the ‘::’ operator
between the function name and its generic arguments. For example, gdb might provide
a completion like crate::f<u32>, where the parser would require crate::f::<u32>.
• As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in the debugging
information it generates. These holes prevent certain features from being implemented
by gdb:
• Method calls cannot be made via traits.
240 Debugging with gdb
15.4.9 Modula-2
The extensions made to gdb to support Modula-2 only support output from the gnu
Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not
currently supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
to give an error as gdb reads in the executable’s symbol table.
15.4.9.1 Operators
Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, + is defined on numbers,
but not on structures. Operators are often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of
Modula-2, the following definitions hold:
• Integral types consist of INTEGER, CARDINAL, and their subranges.
• Character types consist of CHAR and its subranges.
• Floating-point types consist of REAL.
• Pointer types consist of anything declared as POINTER TO type.
• Scalar types consist of all of the above.
• Set types consist of SET and BITSET types.
• Boolean types consist of BOOLEAN.
The following operators are supported, and appear in order of increasing precedence:
, Function argument or array index separator.
:= Assignment. The value of var := value is value.
<, > Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated types.
<=, >= Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to on integral, floating-point and
enumerated types, or set inclusion on set types. Same precedence as <.
=, <>, # Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types. Same
precedence as <. In gdb scripts, only <> is available for inequality, since #
conflicts with the script comment character.
IN Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members. Same
precedence as <.
OR Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
AND, & Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
@ The gdb “artificial array” operator (see Section 10.1 [Expressions], page 141).
+, - Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union and
difference on set types.
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 241
15.4.9.3 Constants
gdb allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following ways:
• Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an expression, a con-
stant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the rest of the expression. Hexadecimal
integers are specified by a trailing ‘H’, and octal integers by a trailing ‘B’.
• Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal point
and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can then be specified, in the form
‘E[+|-]nnn’, where ‘[+|-]nnn’ is the desired exponent. All of the digits of the floating
point constant must be valid decimal (base 10) digits.
• Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of like quotes, either
single (’) or double ("). They may also be expressed by their ordinal value (their ascii
value, usually) followed by a ‘C’.
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 243
VAR
s: t ;
BEGIN
s := blue ;
The gdb interaction shows how you can query the data type and value of a variable.
(gdb) print s
$1 = blue
(gdb) ptype t
type = [blue..yellow]
In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents displayed. Observe that the
contents are written in the same way as their C counterparts.
VAR
s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
BEGIN
s[1] := 1 ;
(gdb) print s
$1 = {1, 0, 0, 0, 0}
(gdb) ptype s
type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
The Modula-2 language interface to gdb also understands pointer types as shown in this
example:
VAR
s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
BEGIN
NEW(s) ;
s^[1] := 1 ;
gdb handles compound types as we can see in this example. Here we combine array
types, record types, pointer types and subrange types:
TYPE
foo = RECORD
f1: CARDINAL ;
f2: CHAR ;
f3: myarray ;
END ;
and you can ask gdb to describe the type of s as shown below.
(gdb) ptype s
type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
f1 : CARDINAL;
f2 : CHAR;
f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
END
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 245
module . id
scope :: id
where scope is the name of a module or a procedure, module the name of a module, and
id is any declared identifier within your program, except another module.
Using the :: operator makes gdb search the scope specified by scope for the identifier
id. If it is not found in the specified scope, then gdb searches all scopes enclosing the one
specified by scope.
246 Debugging with gdb
Using the . operator makes gdb search the current scope for the identifier specified by
id that was imported from the definition module specified by module. With this operator,
it is an error if the identifier id was not imported from definition module module, or if id is
not an identifier in module.
15.4.10 Ada
The extensions made to gdb for Ada only support output from the gnu Ada (GNAT)
compiler. Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and attempting to debug
executables produced by them is most likely to be difficult.
15.4.10.1 Introduction
The Ada mode of gdb supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression syntax, with some
extensions. The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
• That gdb should provide basic literals and access to operations for arithmetic, deref-
erencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls, leaving more sophisticated
computations to subprograms written into the program (which therefore may be called
from gdb).
• That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions are not particularly
important to the gdb user.
• That brevity is important to the gdb user.
Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in user-written packages
are directly visible, even if they are not visible according to Ada rules, thus making it
unnecessary to fully qualify most names with their packages, regardless of context. Where
this causes ambiguity, gdb asks the user’s intent.
The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program. As for other
languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that was translated from an
Ada source file.
While in Ada mode, you may use ‘--’ for comments. This is useful mostly for docu-
menting command files. The standard gdb comment (‘#’) still works at the beginning of a
line in Ada mode, but not in the middle (to allow based literals).
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 247
real constant: zero means Float is used, one means Long_Float, and two means Long_
Long_Float.
(gdb) print 16f#41b80000#
$1 = 23.0
• Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special charac-
ters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation, which is also used to
print strings. A sequence of characters of the form ‘["XX"]’ within a string or character
literal denotes the (single) character whose numeric encoding is XX in hexadecimal.
The sequence of characters ‘["""]’ also denotes a single quotation mark in strings. For
example,
"One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
contains an ASCII newline character (Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF) after each period.
• The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes ’Pos, ’Min, and ’Max is optional (and
is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid to write
(gdb) print ’max(x, y)
• When printing arrays, gdb uses positional notation when the array has a lower bound
of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise. For example, a one-dimensional
array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
(3 => 10, 17, 1)
That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a => clause.
• You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique, multi-character subse-
quence of their names (an exact match gets preference). For example, you may use
a’len, a’gth, or a’lh in place of a’length.
• Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type to lower
case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for some of its internal identifiers,
which are normally of no interest to users. For the rare occasions when you actually
have to look at them, enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
For example,
(gdb) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
• Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an access-to-class-wide value will
display all the components of the object’s specific type (as indicated by its run-time
tag). Likewise, component selection on such a value will operate on the specific type
of the object.
In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation (type 0
and press RET) or to continue evaluation with a specific instance (type the corresponding
number and press RET).
Here are a couple of commands to customize gdb’s behavior in this case:
info exceptions
info exceptions regexp
The info exceptions command allows you to list all Ada exceptions defined
within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses. With a regular
expression, regexp, as argument, only those exceptions whose names match
regexp are listed.
Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first without argu-
ment, and next with a regular expression passed as an argument.
(gdb) info exceptions
All defined Ada exceptions:
constraint_error: 0x613da0
program_error: 0x613d20
storage_error: 0x613ce0
tasking_error: 0x613ca0
const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
(gdb) info exceptions const.aint
All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
constraint_error: 0x613da0
const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
It is also possible to ask gdb to stop your program’s execution when an exception is
raised. For more details, see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68.
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 251
In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the task cur-
rently being inspected.
ID Represents gdb’s internal task number.
TID The Ada task ID.
P-ID The parent’s task ID (gdb’s internal task number).
Pri The base priority of the task.
State Current state of the task.
Unactivated
The task has been created but has not been activated.
It cannot be executing.
Runnable The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada.
(It may be waiting for a mutex, though.) It is concep-
tually "executing" in normal mode.
Terminated
The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5).
Any dependents that were waiting on terminate alter-
natives have been awakened and have terminated them-
selves.
Child Activation Wait
The task is waiting for created tasks to complete acti-
vation.
Accept or Select Term
The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait state-
ment.
Waiting on entry call
The task is waiting on an entry call.
Async Select Wait
The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an
asynchronous select statement.
252 Debugging with gdb
Delay Sleep
The task is waiting on a select statement with only a
delay alternative open.
Child Termination Wait
The task is sleeping having completed a master within
itself, and is waiting for the tasks dependent on that
master to become terminated or waiting on a terminate
Phase.
Wait Child in Term Alt
The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate al-
ternatives to finish terminating.
Asynchronous Hold
The task has been held by Ada.Asynchronous_Task_
Control.Hold_Task.
Activating
The task has been created and is being made runnable.
Selective Wait
The task is waiting in a selective wait statement.
Accepting RV with taskno
The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task
taskno.
Waiting on RV with taskno
The task is waiting for a rendez-vous with the task
taskno.
Name Name of the task in the program.
info task taskno
This command shows detailed information on the specified task, as in the fol-
lowing example:
task This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 253
task taskno
This command is like the thread thread-id command (see Section 4.10
[Threads], page 46). It switches the context of debugging from the current
task to the given task.
-c The flag -c, which stands for ‘continue’, causes any errors in com-
mand to be displayed, and the execution of task apply then con-
tinues.
-s The flag -s, which stands for ‘silent’, causes any errors or empty
output produced by a command to be silently ignored. That is,
the execution continues, but the task information and errors are
not printed.
On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some memory writes in order to
provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting a core file, this means that the core file must
be opened with read-write privileges, using the command ‘"set write on"’ (see Section 17.6
[Patching], page 279). Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the
core file before inspecting it with gdb.
Chapter 15: Using gdb with Different Languages 255
Both Ravenscar tasks and the underlying CPU threads will show up in the output of
info threads:
(gdb) info threads
Id Target Id Frame
1 Thread 1 (CPU#0 [running]) simple () at simple.adb:10
2 Thread 2 (CPU#1 [running]) 0x0000000000003d34 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
3 Thread 3 (CPU#2 [running]) 0x0000000000003d28 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
4 Thread 4 (CPU#3 [halted ]) 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
* 5 Ravenscar Thread 0x2b8f0 simple () at simple.adb:10
6 Ravenscar Thread 0x2f150 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
One known limitation of the Ravenscar support in gdb is that it isn’t currently possible
to single-step through the runtime initialization sequence. If you need to debug this code,
you should use set ravenscar task-switching off.
these descriptive types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition, a
new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore those descriptive types.
It allows the user to quickly evaluate how well gdb works without them.
maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types. The default is
not to ignore descriptives types (off).
maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
Show if descriptive types are ignored by gdb.
o Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
pahole tool does. This option implies the /tm flags.
struct xyz
{
int f1;
char f2;
void *f3;
struct tuv f4;
};
union qwe
{
struct tuv fff1;
struct xyz fff2;
};
struct tyu
{
int a1 : 1;
int a2 : 3;
int a3 : 23;
char a4 : 2;
int64_t a5;
int a6 : 5;
int64_t a7 : 3;
};
Issuing a ptype /o struct tuv command would print:
(gdb) ptype /o struct tuv
/* offset | size */ type = struct tuv {
/* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
/* XXX 4-byte hole */
/* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
/* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
ptype[/flags] [arg]
ptype accepts the same arguments as whatis, but prints a detailed description
of the type, instead of just the name of the type. See Section 10.1 [Expressions],
page 141.
Contrary to whatis, ptype always unrolls any typedefs in its argument dec-
laration, whether the argument is a variable, expression, or a data type. This
means that ptype of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type
as present in the source code—use whatis for that. typedefs at the pointer
or reference targets are also unrolled. Only typedefs of fields, methods and
inner class typedefs of structs, classes and unions are not unrolled even
with ptype.
For example, for this variable declaration:
typedef double real_t;
struct complex { real_t real; double imag; };
typedef struct complex complex_t;
complex_t var;
real_t *real_pointer_var;
the two commands give this output:
(gdb) whatis var
type = complex_t
(gdb) ptype var
type = struct complex {
real_t real;
double imag;
}
(gdb) whatis complex_t
type = struct complex
(gdb) whatis struct complex
type = struct complex
(gdb) ptype struct complex
type = struct complex {
real_t real;
double imag;
}
(gdb) whatis real_pointer_var
type = real_t *
(gdb) ptype real_pointer_var
type = double *
As with whatis, using ptype without an argument refers to the type of $, the
last value in the value history.
Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications of
complex data structure. If the debug information included in the program
does not allow gdb to display a full declaration of the data type, it will say
‘<incomplete type>’. For example, given these declarations:
struct foo;
struct foo *fooptr;
but no definition for struct foo itself, gdb will say:
(gdb) ptype foo
$1 = <incomplete type>
“Incomplete type” is C terminology for data types that are not completely
specified.
Chapter 16: Examining the Symbol Table 265
In programs using different languages, gdb chooses the syntax to print the func-
tion name and type according to the ‘set language’ value: using ‘set language
auto’ (see Section 15.1.3 [Set Language Automatically], page 224) means to use
the language of the function, other values mean to use the manually specified
language (see Section 15.1.2 [Set Language Manually], page 224).
The ‘-n’ flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results. A
non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the executable’s symbol
table, not from the debug information (for example, DWARF) associated with
the executable.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header infor-
mation and messages explaining why no functions have been printed.
info functions [-q] [-n] [-t type_regexp] [regexp]
Like ‘info functions’, but only print the names and data types of the functions
selected with the provided regexp(s).
If regexp is provided, print only the functions whose names match the regu-
lar expression regexp. Thus, ‘info fun step’ finds all functions whose names
include step; ‘info fun ^step’ finds those whose names start with step. If
a function name contains characters that conflict with the regular expression
language (e.g. ‘operator*()’), they may be quoted with a backslash.
If type regexp is provided, print only the functions whose types, as printed by
the whatis command, match the regular expression type regexp. If type regexp
contains space(s), it should be enclosed in quote characters. If needed, use back-
slash to escape the meaning of special characters or quotes. Thus, ‘info fun -t
’^int (’’ finds the functions that return an integer; ‘info fun -t ’(.*int.*’’
finds the functions that have an argument type containing int; ‘info fun -t
’^int (’ ^step’ finds the functions whose names start with step and that
return int.
If both regexp and type regexp are provided, a function is printed only if its
name matches regexp and its type matches type regexp.
info variables [-q] [-n]
Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined outside of
functions (i.e. excluding local variables). The printed variables are grouped by
source files and annotated with their respective source line numbers.
In programs using different languages, gdb chooses the syntax to print the
variable name and type according to the ‘set language’ value: using ‘set
language auto’ (see Section 15.1.3 [Set Language Automatically], page 224)
means to use the language of the variable, other values mean to use the manually
specified language (see Section 15.1.2 [Set Language Manually], page 224).
The ‘-n’ flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header infor-
mation and messages explaining why no variables have been printed.
info variables [-q] [-n] [-t type_regexp] [regexp]
Like info variables, but only print the variables selected with the provided
regexp(s).
268 Debugging with gdb
If regexp is provided, print only the variables whose names match the regular
expression regexp.
If type regexp is provided, print only the variables whose types, as printed by
the whatis command, match the regular expression type regexp. If type regexp
contains space(s), it should be enclosed in quote characters. If needed, use
backslash to escape the meaning of special characters or quotes.
If both regexp and type regexp are provided, an argument is printed only if its
name matches regexp and its type matches type regexp.
info modules [-q] [regexp]
List all Fortran modules in the program, or all modules matching the optional
regular expression regexp.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header infor-
mation and messages explaining why no modules have been printed.
info module functions [-q] [-m module-regexp] [-t type-regexp] [regexp]
info module variables [-q] [-m module-regexp] [-t type-regexp] [regexp]
List all functions or variables within all Fortran modules. The set of functions
or variables listed can be limited by providing some or all of the optional regular
expressions. If module-regexp is provided, then only Fortran modules matching
module-regexp will be searched. Only functions or variables whose type matches
the optional regular expression type-regexp will be listed. And only functions
or variables whose name matches the optional regular expression regexp will be
listed.
The optional flag ‘-q’, which stands for ‘quiet’, disables printing header in-
formation and messages explaining why no functions or variables have been
printed.
info main Print the name of the starting function of the program. This serves primarily
Fortran programs, which have a user-supplied name for the main subroutine.
info classes
info classes regexp
Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or (with the regexp argument)
all those matching a particular regular expression.
info selectors
info selectors regexp
Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or (with the regexp argu-
ment) all those matching a particular regular expression.
set opaque-type-resolution on
Tell gdb to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type declared as a
pointer to a struct, class, or union—for example, struct MyType *—that
is used in one source file although the full declaration of struct MyType is in
another source file. The default is on.
A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until the next
time symbols for a file are loaded.
Chapter 16: Examining the Symbol Table 269
show opaque-type-resolution
Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
set print symbol-loading
set print symbol-loading full
set print symbol-loading brief
set print symbol-loading off
The set print symbol-loading command allows you to control the printing of
messages when gdb loads symbol information. By default a message is printed
for the executable and one for each shared library, and normally this is what you
want. However, when debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries
these messages can be annoying. When set to brief a message is printed for
each executable, and when gdb loads a collection of shared libraries at once it
will only print one message regardless of the number of shared libraries. When
set to off no messages are printed.
show print symbol-loading
Show whether messages will be printed when a gdb command entered from the
keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
maint print symbols [-pc address] [filename]
maint print symbols [-objfile objfile] [-source source] [--] [filename]
maint print psymbols [-objfile objfile] [-pc address] [--] [filename]
maint print psymbols [-objfile objfile] [-source source] [--] [filename]
maint print msymbols [-objfile objfile] [--] [filename]
Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file filename or the terminal if
filename is unspecified. If -objfile objfile is specified, only dump symbols
for that objfile. If -pc address is specified, only dump symbols for the file with
code at that address. Note that address may be a symbol like main. If -source
source is specified, only dump symbols for that source file.
These commands are used to debug the gdb symbol-reading code. These com-
mands do not modify internal gdb state, therefore ‘maint print symbols’ will
only print symbols for already expanded symbol tables. You can use the com-
mand info sources to find out which files these are. If you use ‘maint print
psymbols’ instead, the dump shows information about symbols that gdb only
knows partially—that is, symbols defined in files that gdb has skimmed, but
not yet read completely. Finally, ‘maint print msymbols’ just dumps “minimal
symbols”, e.g., “ELF symbols”.
See Section 18.1 [Commands to Specify Files], page 285, for a discussion of how
gdb reads symbols (in the description of symbol-file).
maint info symtabs [ regexp ]
maint info psymtabs [ regexp ]
List the struct symtab or struct partial_symtab structures whose names
match regexp. If regexp is not given, list them all. The output includes expres-
270 Debugging with gdb
sions which you can copy into a gdb debugging this one to examine a particular
structure in more detail. For example:
(gdb) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
readin no
fullname (null)
text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @ 9)
statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @ 2882)
dependencies (none)
}
}
(gdb) maint info symtabs
(gdb)
We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains the string
‘dwarf2read’, belonging to the ‘gdb’ executable; and we see that gdb has not
read in any symtabs yet at all. If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will
cause gdb to read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
(gdb) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
line 1574.
(gdb) maint info symtabs
{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
dirname (null)
fullname (null)
blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
debugformat DWARF 2
}
}
(gdb)
8 21 0x0000000000401140 Y
9 22 0x000000000040114f Y Y
10 22 0x0000000000401154
11 END 0x000000000040115a Y
The ‘IS-STMT’ column indicates if the address is a recommended breakpoint
location to represent a line or a statement. The ‘PROLOGUE-END’ column indi-
cates that a given address is an adequate place to set a breakpoint at the first
instruction following a function prologue.
set always-read-ctf [on|off]
show always-read-ctf
When off, CTF debug info is only read if DWARF debug info is not present.
When on, CTF debug info is read regardless of whether DWARF debug info is
present. The default value is off.
maint set symbol-cache-size size
Set the size of the symbol cache to size. The default size is intended to be
good enough for debugging most applications. This option exists to allow for
experimenting with different sizes.
maint show symbol-cache-size
Show the size of the symbol cache.
maint print symbol-cache
Print the contents of the symbol cache. This is useful when debugging symbol
cache issues.
maint print symbol-cache-statistics
Print symbol cache usage statistics. This helps determine how well the cache
is being utilized.
maint flush symbol-cache
maint flush-symbol-cache
Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed. This command
is useful when debugging the symbol cache. It is also useful when collecting
performance data. The command maint flush-symbol-cache is deprecated in
favor of maint flush symbol-cache..
maint set ignore-prologue-end-flag [on|off]
Enable or disable the use of the ‘PROLOGUE-END’ flag from the line-table. When
‘off’ (the default), gdb uses the ‘PROLOGUE-END’ flag to place breakpoints past
the end of a function prologue. When ‘on’, gdb ignores the flag and relies on
prologue analyzers to skip function prologues.
maint show ignore-prologue-end-flag
Show whether gdb will ignore the ‘PROLOGUE-END’ flag.
273
17 Altering Execution
Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to find out for
certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to correct results in the rest of the
run. You can find the answer by experiment, using the gdb features for altering execution
of the program.
For example, you can store new values into variables or memory locations, give your pro-
gram a signal, restart it at a different address, or even return prematurely from a function.
stores the value 4 into the variable x, and then prints the value of the assignment expression
(which is 4). See Chapter 15 [Using gdb with Different Languages], page 223, for more
information on operators in supported languages.
If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the set command
instead of the print command. set is really the same as print except that the expression’s
value is not printed and is not put in the value history (see Section 10.11 [Value History],
page 166). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
If the beginning of the argument string of the set command appears identical to a
set subcommand, use the set variable command instead of just set. This command is
identical to set except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your program has a
variable width, you get an error if you try to set a new value with just ‘set width=13’,
because gdb has the command set width:
(gdb) whatis width
type = double
(gdb) p width
$4 = 13
(gdb) set width=47
Invalid syntax in expression.
The invalid expression, of course, is ‘=47’. In order to actually set the program’s variable
width, use
(gdb) set var width=47
Because the set command has many subcommands that can conflict with the names of
program variables, it is a good idea to use the set variable command instead of just set.
For example, if your program has a variable g, you run into problems if you try to set a
new value with just ‘set g=4’, because gdb has the command set gnutarget, abbreviated
set g:
274 Debugging with gdb
(gdb) whatis g
type = double
(gdb) p g
$1 = 1
(gdb) set g=4
(gdb) p g
$2 = 1
(gdb) r
The program being debugged has been started already.
Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can’t open to read symbols:
Invalid bfd target.
(gdb) show g
The current BFD target is "=4".
The program variable g did not change, and you silently set the gnutarget to an invalid
value. In order to set the variable g, use
(gdb) set var g=4
gdb allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can freely store an
integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa, and you can convert any structure to any
other structure that is the same length or shorter.
To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the ‘{...}’ construct to generate a
value of specified type at a specified address (see Section 10.1 [Expressions], page 141). For
example, {int}0x83040 refers to memory location 0x83040 as an integer (which implies a
certain size and representation in memory), and
set {int}0x83040 = 4
stores the value 4 into that memory location.
currently executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the jump command by storing
a new value into the register $pc. The difference is that this does not start your program
running; it only changes the address of where it will run when you continue. For example,
set $pc = 0x485
makes the next continue command or stepping command execute at address 0x485, rather
than at the address where your program stopped. See Section 5.2 [Continuing and Stepping],
page 83.
However, writing directly to $pc will only change the value of the program-counter
register, while using jump will ensure that any additional auxiliary state is also updated.
For example, on SPARC, jump will update both $pc and $npc registers prior to resuming
execution. When using the approach of writing directly to $pc it is your job to also update
the $npc register.
The most common occasion to use the jump command is to back up—perhaps with more
breakpoints set—over a portion of a program that has already executed, in order to examine
its execution in more detail.
For example, on many systems signal 2 and signal SIGINT are both ways of
sending an interrupt signal. The handling of the signal must be set to pass
the signal to the program, otherwise gdb will report an error. You can control
the handling of signals from gdb with the handle command (see Section 5.4
[Signals], page 89).
Alternatively, if signal is zero, any currently queued signal for the current thread
is discarded and when execution resumes no signal will be delivered. This is
useful when your program stopped on account of a signal and would ordinarily
see the signal when resumed with the continue command.
This command differs from the signal command in that the signal is just
queued, execution is not resumed. And queue-signal cannot be used to pass
a signal whose handling state has been set to nopass (see Section 5.4 [Signals],
page 89).
See [stepping into signal handlers], page 91, for information on how stepping commands
behave when the thread has a signal queued.
show unwindonsignal
Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by gdb.
set unwind-on-terminating-exception
Set unwinding of the stack if a C++ exception is raised, but left unhandled while
in a function that gdb called in the program being debugged. If set to on (the
default), gdb unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores the context
to what it was before the call. If set to off, gdb the exception is delivered to
the default C++ exception handler and the inferior terminated.
show unwind-on-terminating-exception
Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by gdb.
set may-call-functions
Set permission to call functions in the program. This controls whether gdb will
attempt to call functions in the program, such as with expressions in the print
command. It defaults to on.
To call a function in the program, gdb has to temporarily modify the state
of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side effects. Also, having gdb
call nested functions is likely to be erroneous and may even crash the program
being debugged. You can avoid such hazards by forbidding gdb from calling
functions in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing an
expression) starts a function call in the program.
show may-call-functions
Show permission to call functions in the program.
When calling a function within a program, it is possible that the program could enter a
state from which the called function may never return. If this happens then it is possible
to interrupt the function call by typing the interrupt character (often Ctrl-c).
If a called function is interrupted for any reason, including hitting a breakpoint, or
triggering a watchpoint, and the stack is not unwound due to set unwind-on-terminating-
exception on or set unwindonsignal on (see [stack unwind settings], page 277), then the
dummy-frame, created by gdb to facilitate the call to the program function, will be visible
in the backtrace, for example frame #3 in the following backtrace:
(gdb) backtrace
#0 0x00007ffff7b3d1e7 in nanosleep () from /lib64/libc.so.6
#1 0x00007ffff7b3d11e in sleep () from /lib64/libc.so.6
#2 0x000000000040113f in deadlock () at test.cc:13
#3 <function called from gdb>
#4 breakpt () at test.cc:20
#5 0x0000000000401151 in main () at test.cc:25
At this point it is possible to examine the state of the inferior just like any other stop.
Depending on why the function was interrupted then it may be possible to resume the
inferior (using commands like continue, step, etc). In this case, when the inferior finally
returns to the dummy-frame, gdb will once again halt the inferior.
To avoid calling the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called function
functioning erroneously and even crash, gdb refuses to call the function unless you tell it
the type of the function.
For prototyped (i.e. ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways to do that. The
simplest is to cast the call to the function’s declared return type. For example:
(gdb) p getenv ("PATH")
’getenv’ has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
(gdb) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
$1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to casting the function
to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a prototype that matches the types of the
passed-in arguments, and calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
(gdb) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
float multiply (float v1, float v2) { return v1 * v2; }
these calls are equivalent:
(gdb) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
(gdb) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e. old K&R style), you
must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so that gdb knows that it needs to apply
default argument promotions (promote float arguments to double). See Section 22.7 [ABI],
page 365. For example, given this unprototyped C function with float parameters, and no
debug info:
float
multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
float v1, v2;
{
return v1 * v2;
}
you call it like this:
(gdb) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
show write
Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing as well as
reading.
int main(void)
{
int k = 6;
int *p;
function2 ();
return 0;
}
For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has been
compiled, loaded into gdb, stopped at the function main, and gdb is awaiting
input from the user.
To access variables and types for any program in gdb, the program must be
compiled and packaged with debug information. The compile command is not
an exception to this rule. Without debug information, you can still use the
compile command, but you will be very limited in what variables and types
you can access.
Chapter 17: Altering Execution 283
So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug infor-
mation enabled. The compile command will have access to all variables and
types (except those that may have been optimized out). Currently, as gdb has
stopped the program in the main function, the compile command would have
access to the variable k. You could invoke the compile command and type some
source code to set the value of k. You can also read it, or do anything with
that variable you would normally do in C. Be aware that changes to inferior
variables in the compile command are persistent. In the following example:
compile code k = 3;
the variable k is now 3. It will retain that value until something else in the
example program changes it, or another compile command changes it.
Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and injected by
the compile command. In the example, the variables j and k are not accessible
yet, because the program is currently stopped in the main function, where these
variables are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
compile code j = 3;
will result in a compilation error message.
Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in scope,
and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via the compile
command will be able to access them.
You can create variables and types with the compile command as part of
your source code. Variables and types that are created as part of the compile
command are not visible to the rest of the program for the duration of its run.
This example is valid:
compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
However, if you were to type the following into gdb after that command has
completed:
compile code printf ("ff is %d\n’’, ff);
a compiler error would be raised as the variable ff no longer exists. Object
code generated and injected by the compile command is removed when its
execution ends. Caution is advised when assigning to program variables values
of variables created by the code submitted to the compile command. This
example is valid:
compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
The value of the variable ff is assigned to k. The variable k does not require the
existence of ff to maintain the value it has been assigned. However, pointers
require particular care in assignment. If the source code compiled with the
compile command changed the address of a pointer in the example program,
perhaps to a variable created in the compile command, that pointer would
point to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
In this example, p would point to ff when the compile command is executing
the source code provided to it. However, as variables in the (example) program
persist with their assigned values, the variable p would point to an invalid
284 Debugging with gdb
location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed in that
you should either assign NULL to any assigned pointers, or restore a valid location
to the pointer before the command exits.
Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs defined
in compile command. Types defined in the compile command will no longer
be available in the next compile command. Therefore, if you cast a variable
to a type defined in the compile command, care must be taken to ensure that
any future need to resolve the type can be achieved.
(gdb) compile code static struct a { int a; } v = { 42 }; argv = &v;
(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type struct a
Compilation failed.
(gdb) compile code struct a { int a; }; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)-
>a);
42
Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not accessible to
the code submitted to the compile command. Access to those variables will
generate a compiler error which gdb will print to the console.
18 gdb Files
gdb needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged, both in order to read its
symbol table and in order to start your program. To debug a core dump of a previous run,
you must also tell gdb the name of the core dump file.
do this, use the kill command (see Section 4.8 [Killing the Child Process],
page 42).
add-symbol-file filename [ -readnow | -readnever ] [ -o offset ] [ textaddress ] [
-s section address ... ]
The add-symbol-file command reads additional symbol table information
from the file filename. You would use this command when filename has been
dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that is running.
The textaddress parameter gives the memory address at which the file’s text
section has been loaded. You can additionally specify the base address of other
sections using an arbitrary number of ‘-s section address’ pairs. If a section
is omitted, gdb will use its default addresses as found in filename. Any address
or textaddress can be given as an expression.
If an optional offset is specified, it is added to the start address of each section,
except those for which the address was specified explicitly.
The symbol table of the file filename is added to the symbol table originally read
with the symbol-file command. You can use the add-symbol-file command
any number of times; the new symbol data thus read is kept in addition to the
old.
Changes can be reverted using the command remove-symbol-file.
Although filename is typically a shared library file, an executable file, or some
other object file which has been fully relocated for loading into a process, you
can also load symbolic information from relocatable .o files, as long as:
• the file’s symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in that
file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
• every section the file’s symbolic information refers to has actually been
loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
• you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
provide these to the add-symbol-file command.
Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
relocatable files into an already running program; such systems typically make
the requirements above easy to meet. However, it’s important to recognize that
many native systems use complex link procedures (.linkonce section factoring
and C++ constructor table assembly, for example) that make the requirements
difficult to meet. In general, one cannot assume that using add-symbol-file
to read a relocatable object file’s symbolic information will have the same effect
as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal way.
add-symbol-file does not repeat if you press RET after using it.
remove-symbol-file filename
remove-symbol-file -a address
Remove a symbol file added via the add-symbol-file command. The file to
remove can be identified by its filename or by an address that lies within the
boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
288 Debugging with gdb
.text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
(y or n) y
Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...
(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
(gdb)
remove-symbol-file does not repeat if you press RET after using it.
add-symbol-file-from-memory address
Load symbols from the given address in a dynamically loaded object file whose
image is mapped directly into the inferior’s memory. For example, the Linux
kernel maps a syscall DSO into each process’s address space; this DSO provides
kernel-specific code for some system calls. The argument can be any expres-
sion whose evaluation yields the address of the file’s shared object file header.
For this command to work, you must have used symbol-file or exec-file
commands in advance.
section section addr
The section command changes the base address of the named section of the
exec file to addr. This can be used if the exec file does not contain section
addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses specified in the
file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The info files
command, described below, lists all the sections and their addresses.
info files
info target
info files and info target are synonymous; both print the current target
(see Chapter 19 [Specifying a Debugging Target], page 303), including the
names of the executable and core dump files currently in use by gdb, and
the files from which symbols were loaded. The command help target lists all
possible targets rather than current ones.
maint info sections [-all-objects] [filter-list]
Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
is maint info sections. In addition to the section information displayed by
info files, this command displays the flags and file offset of each section in
the executable and core dump files.
When ‘-all-objects’ is passed then sections from all loaded object files, in-
cluding shared libraries, are printed.
The optional filter-list is a space separated list of filter keywords. Sections that
match any one of the filter criteria will be printed. There are two types of filter:
section-name
Display information about any section named section-name.
section-flag
Display information for any section with section-flag. The section
flags that gdb currently knows about are:
ALLOC Section will have space allocated in the process when
loaded. Set for all sections except those containing de-
bug information.
Chapter 18: gdb Files 289
LOAD Section will be loaded from the file into the child pro-
cess memory. Set for pre-initialized code and data,
clear for .bss sections.
RELOC Section needs to be relocated before loading.
READONLY Section cannot be modified by the child process.
CODE Section contains executable code only.
DATA Section contains data only (no executable code).
ROM Section will reside in ROM.
CONSTRUCTOR
Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
HAS_CONTENTS
Section is not empty.
NEVER_LOAD
An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
A notification to the linker that the section contains
COFF shared library information.
IS_COMMON
Section contains common symbols.
maint info target-sections
This command prints gdb’s internal section table. For each target gdb main-
tains a table containing the allocatable sections from all currently mapped ob-
jects, along with information about where the section is mapped.
set trust-readonly-sections on
Tell gdb that readonly sections in your object file really are read-only (i.e.
that their contents will not change). In that case, gdb can fetch values from
these sections out of the object file, rather than from the target program. For
some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant enhancement
to debugging performance.
The default is off.
set trust-readonly-sections off
Tell gdb not to trust readonly sections. This means that the contents of the
section might change while the program is running, and must therefore be
fetched from the target when needed.
show trust-readonly-sections
Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names as arguments.
gdb always converts the file name to an absolute file name and remembers it that way.
gdb supports gnu/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS, Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000
AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
290 Debugging with gdb
On MS-Windows gdb must be linked with the Expat library to support shared libraries.
See [Expat], page 726.
gdb automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries when you use the run
command, or when you examine a core file. (Before you issue the run command, gdb
does not understand references to a function in a shared library, however—unless you are
debugging a core file).
There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load symbol defini-
tions from shared libraries, such as when they are particularly large or there are many of
them.
To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the commands:
set auto-solib-add mode
If mode is on, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded auto-
matically when the inferior begins execution, you attach to an independently
started inferior, or when the dynamic linker informs gdb that a new library
has been loaded. If mode is off, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
sharedlibrary command. The default value is on.
If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that takes large
amounts of memory, you can decrease the gdb memory footprint by prevent-
ing it from automatically loading the symbols from shared libraries. To that
end, type set auto-solib-add off before running the inferior, then load each
library whose debug symbols you do need with sharedlibrary regexp, where
regexp is a regular expression that matches the libraries whose symbols you
want to be loaded.
show auto-solib-add
Display the current autoloading mode.
To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the sharedlibrary command:
info share regex
info sharedlibrary regex
Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded that match
regex. If regex is omitted then print all shared libraries that are loaded.
info dll regex
This is an alias of info sharedlibrary.
sharedlibrary regex
share regex
Load shared object library symbols for files matching a Unix regular expression.
As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries required by your
program for a core file or after typing run. If regex is omitted all shared libraries
required by your program are loaded.
nosharedlibrary
Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols that have
been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared libraries that were
loaded by explicit user requests are not discarded.
Chapter 18: gdb Files 291
Sometimes you may wish that gdb stops and gives you control when any of shared
library events happen. The best way to do this is to use catch load and catch unload
(see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68).
gdb also supports the set stop-on-solib-events command for this. This command
exists for historical reasons. It is less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not
allow for conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
set stop-on-solib-events
This command controls whether gdb should give you control when the dynamic
linker notifies it about some shared library event. The most common event of
interest is loading or unloading of a new shared library.
show stop-on-solib-events
Show whether gdb stops and gives you control when shared library events
happen.
Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging configurations.
gdb needs to have access to the target’s libraries; this can be accomplished either by
providing copies of the libraries on the host system, or by asking gdb to automatically
retrieve the libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are provided, they need
to be the same as the target libraries, although the copies on the target can be stripped as
long as the copies on the host are not.
For remote debugging, you need to tell gdb where the target libraries are, so that it
can load the correct copies—otherwise, it may try to load the host’s libraries. gdb has two
variables to specify the search directories for target libraries.
set sysroot path
Use path as the system root for the program being debugged. Any absolute
shared library paths will be prefixed with path; many runtime loaders store the
absolute paths to the shared library in the target program’s memory. When
starting processes remotely, and when attaching to already-running processes
(local or remote), their executable filenames will be prefixed with path if re-
ported to gdb as absolute by the operating system. If you use set sysroot
to find executables and shared libraries, they need to be laid out in the same
way that they are on the target, with e.g. a /bin, /lib and /usr/lib hierarchy
under path.
If path starts with the sequence target: and the target system is remote then
gdb will retrieve the target binaries from the remote system. This is only
supported when using a remote target that supports the remote get command
(see Section 20.2 [Sending files to a remote system], page 312). The part of path
following the initial target: (if present) is used as system root prefix on the
remote file system. If path starts with the sequence remote: this is converted
to the sequence target: by set sysroot1 . If you want to specify a local system
root using a directory that happens to be named target: or remote:, you need
to use some equivalent variant of the name like ./target:.
1
Historically the functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was provided by prefixing path
with remote:
292 Debugging with gdb
For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows, gdb tries
prefixing a few variants of the target absolute file name with path. But first,
on Unix hosts, gdb converts all backslash directory separators into forward
slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
c:\foo\bar.dll ⇒ c:/foo/bar.dll
Then, gdb attempts prefixing the target file name with path, and looks for the
resulting file name in the host file system:
c:/foo/bar.dll ⇒ /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
If that does not find the binary, gdb tries removing the ‘:’ character from the
drive spec, both for convenience, and, for the case of the host file system not
supporting file names with colons:
c:/foo/bar.dll ⇒ /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target with more
than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local copies of the target
system shared libraries like so (note ‘c’ vs ‘z’):
/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll
/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll
/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll
and point the system root at /path/to/sysroot, so that gdb can find the
correct copies of both c:\sys\bin\foo.dll, and z:\sys\bin\bar.dll.
If that still does not find the binary, gdb tries removing the whole drive spec
from the target file name:
c:/foo/bar.dll ⇒ /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name, if you
don’t want or need to.
The set solib-absolute-prefix command is an alias for set sysroot.
You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
‘--with-sysroot’ option. If the system root is inside gdb’s configured binary
prefix (set with ‘--prefix’ or ‘--exec-prefix’), then the default system root
will be updated automatically if the installed gdb is moved to a new location.
show sysroot
Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
set solib-search-path path
If this variable is set, path is a colon-separated list of directories to search for
shared libraries. ‘solib-search-path’ is used after ‘sysroot’ fails to locate the
library, or if the path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want
to use ‘solib-search-path’ instead of ‘sysroot’, be sure to set ‘sysroot’
to a nonexistent directory to prevent gdb from finding your host’s libraries.
‘sysroot’ is preferred; setting it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with
automatic loading of shared library symbols.
show solib-search-path
Display the current shared library search path.
set target-file-system-kind kind
Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
Chapter 18: gdb Files 293
Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not make sense
as is on the system gdb is running on. For example, when remote debugging
a target that has MS-DOS based file system semantics, from a Unix host, the
target may be reporting to gdb a list of loaded shared libraries with file names
such as c:\Windows\kernel32.dll. On Unix hosts, there’s no concept of drive
letters, so the ‘c:\’ prefix is not normally understood as indicating an absolute
file name, and neither is the backslash normally considered a directory separator
character. In that case, the native file system would interpret this whole abso-
lute file name as a relative file name with no directory components. This would
make it impossible to point gdb at a copy of the remote target’s shared libraries
on the host using set sysroot, and impractical with set solib-search-path.
Setting target-file-system-kind to dos-based tells gdb to interpret such
file names similarly to how the target would, and to map them to file names
valid on gdb’s native file system semantics. The value of kind can be "auto",
in addition to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, gdb tries
to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the current target’s
operating system (see Section 22.7 [Configuring the Current ABI], page 365).
The supported file system settings are:
unix Instruct gdb to assume the target file system is of Unix kind. Only
file names starting the forward slash (‘/’) character are considered
absolute, and the directory separator character is also the forward
slash.
dos-based
Instruct gdb to assume the target file system is DOS based. File
names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter followed
by a colon (e.g., ‘c:’), are considered absolute, and both the slash
(‘/’) and the backslash (‘\\’) characters are considered directory
separators.
auto Instruct gdb to use the file system kind associated with the target
operating system (see Section 22.7 [Configuring the Current ABI],
page 365). This is the default.
When processing file names provided by the user, gdb frequently needs to compare
them to the file names recorded in the program’s debug info. Normally, gdb compares
just the base names of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast even for very large
programs. (The base name of a file is the last portion of its name, after stripping all the
leading directories.) This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but references to files that use
symlinks or similar filesystem facilities violate that assumption. If your program records
files using such facilities, or if you provide file names to gdb using symlinks etc., you can
set basenames-may-differ to true to instruct gdb to completely canonicalize each pair
of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name comparisons accurate, but at a
price of a significant slowdown.
set basenames-may-differ
Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
294 Debugging with gdb
show basenames-may-differ
Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, gdb uses two different methods of
looking for the debug file:
• For the “debug link” method, gdb looks up the named file in the directory of the
executable file, then in a subdirectory of that directory named .debug, and finally under
each one of the global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
the leading directories of the executable’s absolute file name. (On MS-Windows/MS-
DOS, the drive letter of the executable’s leading directories is converted to a one-
letter subdirectory, i.e. d:/usr/bin/ is converted to /d/usr/bin/, because Windows
filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
• For the “build ID” method, gdb looks in the .build-id subdirectory of each one of the
global debug directories for a file named nn/nnnnnnnn.debug, where nn are the first 2
hex characters of the build ID bit string, and nnnnnnnn are the rest of the bit string.
(Real build ID strings are 32 or more hex characters, not 10.) gdb can automatically
query debuginfod servers using build IDs in order to download separate debug files
that cannot be found locally. For more information see Appendix K [Debuginfod],
page 863.
So, for example, suppose you ask gdb to debug /usr/bin/ls, which has a debug link
that specifies the file ls.debug, and a build ID whose value in hex is abcdef1234. If the
list of the global debug directories includes /usr/lib/debug, then gdb will look for the
following debug information files, in the indicated order:
− /usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug
− /usr/bin/ls.debug
− /usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug
− /usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug.
If the debug file still has not been found and debuginfod (see Appendix K [Debuginfod],
page 863) is enabled, gdb will attempt to download the file from debuginfod servers.
Global debugging info directories default to what is set by gdb configure option --with-
separate-debug-dir. During gdb run you can also set the global debugging info directo-
ries, and view the list gdb is currently using.
set debug-file-directory directories
Set the directories which gdb searches for separate debugging information files
to directory. Multiple path components can be set concatenating them by a
path separator.
show debug-file-directory
Show the directories gdb searches for separate debugging information files.
A debug link is a special section of the executable file named .gnu_debuglink. The
section must contain:
• A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by a zero byte,
• zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte boundary within
the section, and
• a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the executable file
itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging information file’s full contents by
the function given below, passing zero as the crc argument.
296 Debugging with gdb
Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can contain a section
named .gnu_debuglink with the contents described above.
The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other ELF binary files that
gdb may consider). This section is often named .note.gnu.build-id, but that name is
not mandatory. It contains unique identification for the built files—the ID remains the same
across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default algorithm SHA1 produces 160
bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the content for the build ID string. The same section
with an identical value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its stripped
variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary executable, containing a full
set of linker symbols, sections, and debugging information. The sections of the debugging
information file should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file, but
they need not contain any data—much like a .bss section in an ordinary executable.
The gnu binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the ‘objcopy’ utility that can pro-
duce the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the following com-
mands:
objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug
strip -g foo
These commands remove the debugging information from the executable file foo and place
it in the file foo.debug. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the two files:
• The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave behind
a debug link in foo:
objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo
Ulrich Drepper’s elfutils package, starting with version 0.53, contains a version of
the strip command such that the command strip foo -f foo.debug has the same
functionality as the two objcopy commands and the ln -s command above, together.
• Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using ld --build-id or the gcc
counterpart gcc -Wl,--build-id. Build ID support plus compatibility fixes for debug
files separation are present in gnu binary utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
The CRC used in .gnu_debuglink is the CRC-32 defined in IEEE 802.3 using the
polynomial:
x32 + x26 + x23 + x22 + x16 + x12 + x11
+ x10 + x8 + x7 + x5 + x4 + x2 + x + 1
The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least significant bit of each byte
first. The initial pattern 0xffffffff is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the CRC.
Note: This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the Remote Serial Protocol
qCRC packet (see [qCRC packet], page 766). However in the case of the Remote Serial
Protocol, the CRC is computed most significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
To complete the description, we show below the code of the function which produces the
CRC used in .gnu_debuglink. Inverting the initially supplied crc argument means that an
initial call to this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using 0xffffffff.
unsigned long
Chapter 18: gdb Files 297
# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
nm binary --format=posix --defined-only \
| awk ’{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 }’ \
| sort > funcsyms
# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
# table.
comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
# removing some unnecessary sections.
objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
--keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
source file is affected by specifying set verbose on. See Section 22.9 [Optional
Warnings and Messages], page 371.)
bad block start address patched
The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address smaller
than the address of the preceding source line. This is known to occur in the
SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
gdb circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as starting
on the previous source line.
bad string table offset in symbol n
Symbol number n contains a pointer into the string table which is larger than
the size of the string table.
gdb circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the name foo,
which may cause other problems if many symbols end up with this name.
unknown symbol type 0xnn
The symbol information contains new data types that gdb does not yet know
how to read. 0xnn is the symbol type of the uncomprehended information, in
hexadecimal.
gdb circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information. This usually
allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols are not accessible. If
you encounter such a problem and feel like debugging it, you can debug gdb with
itself, breakpoint on complain, then go up to the function read_dbx_symtab
and examine *bufp to see the symbol.
stub type has NULL name
gdb could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got...
The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some information
that recent versions of the compiler should have output for it.
info mismatch between compiler and debugger
gdb could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
The data directory may also be specified with the --data-directory command line
option. See Section 2.1.2 [Mode Options], page 13.
303
The target command does not repeat if you press RET again after executing
the command.
help target
Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets currently selected,
use either info target or info files (see Section 18.1 [Commands to Specify
Files], page 285).
help target name
Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to select it.
set gnutarget args
gdb uses its own library BFD to read your files. gdb knows whether it is
reading an executable, a core, or a .o file; however, you can specify the file
format with the set gnutarget command. Unlike most target commands,
with gnutarget the target refers to a program, not a machine.
Warning: To specify a file format with set gnutarget, you must
know the actual BFD name.
See Section 18.1 [Commands to Specify Files], page 285.
show gnutarget
Use the show gnutarget command to display what file format gnutarget is set
to read. If you have not set gnutarget, gdb will determine the file format for
each file automatically, and show gnutarget displays ‘The current BFD target
is "auto"’.
Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB configuration):
target exec program
An executable file. ‘target exec program’ is the same as ‘exec-file program’.
target core filename
A core dump file. ‘target core filename’ is the same as ‘core-file
filename’.
target remote medium
A remote system connected to gdb via a serial line or network connection. This
command tells gdb to use its own remote protocol over medium for debugging.
See Chapter 20 [Remote Debugging], page 307.
For example, if you have a board connected to /dev/ttya on the machine
running gdb, you could say:
target remote /dev/ttya
target remote supports the load command. This is only useful if you have
some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put it
somewhere in memory where it won’t get clobbered by the download.
target sim [simargs] ...
Builtin CPU simulator. gdb includes simulators for most architectures. In
general,
target sim
load
Chapter 19: Specifying a Debugging Target 305
run
works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device drivers,
or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do provide these. For
info about any processor-specific simulator details, see the appropriate section
in Section 21.3 [Embedded Processors], page 340.
target native
Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the run command
spawn native processes (likewise attach, etc.) even when set auto-connect-
native-target is off (see [set auto-connect-native-target], page 36).
Different targets are available on different configurations of gdb; your configuration may
have more or fewer targets.
Many remote targets require you to download the executable’s code once you’ve success-
fully established a connection. You may wish to control various aspects of this process.
set hash This command controls whether a hash mark ‘#’ is displayed while downloading
a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is displayed after each S-record
is successfully downloaded to the monitor.
show hash Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
set debug monitor
Enable or disable display of communications messages between gdb and the
remote monitor.
show debug monitor
Show the current status of displaying communications between gdb and the
remote monitor.
load filename offset
Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into gdb, the
load command may be available. Where it exists, it is meant to make filename
(an executable) available for debugging on the remote system—by downloading,
or dynamic linking, for example. load also records the filename symbol table
in gdb, like the add-symbol-file command.
If your gdb does not have a load command, attempting to execute it gets the
error message “You can’t do that when your target is ...”
The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable. For some
object file formats, you can specify the load address when you link the program;
for other formats, like a.out, the object file format specifies a fixed address.
It is also possible to tell gdb to load the executable file at a specific offset
described by the optional argument offset. When offset is provided, filename
must also be provided.
Depending on the remote side capabilities, gdb may be able to load programs
into flash memory.
load does not repeat if you press RET again after using it.
flash-erase
Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
306 Debugging with gdb
With target extended-remote mode: You may specify the program to debug
on the gdbserver command line, or you can load the program or attach to it
using gdb commands after connecting to gdbserver.
You can start gdbserver without supplying an initial command to run or pro-
cess ID to attach. To do this, use the --multi command line option. Then
you can connect using target extended-remote and start the program you
want to debug (see below for details on using the run command in this sce-
nario). Note that the conditions under which gdbserver terminates depend
on how gdb connects to it (target remote or target extended-remote). The
--multi option to gdbserver has no influence on that.
The run command
With target remote mode: The run command is not supported. Once a connec-
tion has been established, you can use all the usual gdb commands to examine
and change data. The remote program is already running, so you can use
commands like step and continue.
With target extended-remote mode: The run command is supported. The run
command uses the value set by set remote exec-file (see [set remote exec-
file], page 319) to select the program to run. Command line arguments are
supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (see Section 4.3
[Arguments], page 38).
If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the run com-
mand is not required to start execution, and you can resume using commands
like step and continue as with target remote mode.
Attaching With target remote mode: The gdb command attach is not supported. To
attach to a running program using gdbserver, you must use the --attach
option (see [Running gdbserver], page 313).
With target extended-remote mode: To attach to a running program, you may
use the attach command after the connection has been established. If you are
using gdbserver, you may also invoke gdbserver using the --attach option
(see [Running gdbserver], page 313).
Some remote targets allow gdb to determine the executable file running in the
process the debugger is attaching to. In such a case, gdb uses the value of
exec-file-mismatch to handle a possible mismatch between the executable
file name running in the process and the name of the current exec-file loaded
by gdb (see [set exec-file-mismatch], page 41).
If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote program file
access, start up gdb using the name of the local unstripped copy of your program as the
first argument, or use the file command. Use set sysroot to specify the location (on
the host) of target libraries (unless your gdb was compiled with the correct sysroot using
--with-sysroot). Alternatively, you may use set solib-search-path to specify how gdb
locates target libraries.
The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable and libraries on
the target, with one exception: the files on the host system should not be stripped, even if
the files on the target system are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
during debugging. On gnu/Linux targets, mismatched or missing files may also prevent
gdbserver from debugging multi-threaded programs.
If you’re using a serial line, you may want to give gdb the ‘--baud’ option, or
use the set serial baud command (see Section 20.4 [Remote Configuration],
page 317) before the target command.
Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect to
a serial line. gdb will automatically determine which kind of file you have
specified and will make the appropriate kind of connection. This feature is not
available if the host system does not support Unix domain sockets.
310 Debugging with gdb
This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no visible
separation between the hostname and the port number. Therefore, we rec-
ommend the user to provide IPv6 addresses using square brackets for clarity.
However, it is important to mention that for gdb there is no ambiguity: the
number after the last colon is considered to be the port number.
If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your debugger
session (e.g. a simulator for your target running on the same host), you can omit
the hostname. For example, to connect to port 1234 on your local machine:
Whenever gdb is waiting for the remote program, if you type the interrupt character
(often Ctrl-c), gdb attempts to stop the program. This may or may not succeed, depending
in part on the hardware and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
interrupt character once again, gdb displays this prompt:
Interrupted while waiting for the program.
Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
In target remote mode, if you type y, gdb abandons the remote debugging session. (If
you decide you want to try again later, you can use target remote again to connect once
more.) If you type n, gdb goes back to waiting.
In target extended-remote mode, typing n will leave gdb connected to the target.
detach When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the detach
command to release it from gdb control. Detaching from the target normally re-
sumes its execution, but the results will depend on your particular remote stub.
After the detach command in target remote mode, gdb is free to connect to
another target. In target extended-remote mode, gdb is still connected to
the target.
312 Debugging with gdb
disconnect
The disconnect command closes the connection to the target, and the target
is generally not resumed. It will wait for gdb (this instance or another one)
to connect and continue debugging. After the disconnect command, gdb is
again free to connect to another target.
monitor cmd
This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the remote
monitor. Since gdb doesn’t care about the commands it sends like this, this
command is the way to extend gdb—you can add new commands that only
the external monitor will understand and implement.
provides access to the target system with the same privileges as the user
running gdbserver.
You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the pidof
utility:
target> gdbserver --attach comm ‘pidof program‘
In case more than one copy of program is running, or program has multiple threads,
most versions of pidof support the -s option to only return the first process ID.
Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if none appears last then no additional
information is added to debugging output.
The --wrapper option specifies a wrapper to launch programs for debugging. The option
should be followed by the name of the wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass
to the wrapper, then -- indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
gdbserver runs the specified wrapper program with a combined command line including
the wrapper arguments, then the name of the program to debug, then any arguments to the
program. The wrapper runs until it executes your program, and then gdb gains control.
You can use any program that eventually calls execve with its arguments as a wrapper.
Several standard Unix utilities do this, e.g. env and nohup. Any Unix shell script ending
with exec "$@" will also work.
For example, you can use env to pass an environment variable to the debugged program,
without setting the variable in gdbserver’s environment:
$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
monitor help
List the available monitor commands.
monitor set debug 0
monitor set debug 1
Disable or enable general debugging messages.
316 Debugging with gdb
connect fails, gdb reattempts to establish the connection using the timeout
specified by set tcp connect-timeout.
set tcp auto-retry off
Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
show tcp auto-retry
Show the current auto-retry setting.
set tcp connect-timeout seconds
set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
seconds. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections (enabled
by set tcp auto-retry on) and waiting for connections that are merely slow
to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative value. If seconds is
unlimited, there is no timeout and gdb will keep attempting to establish a
connection forever, unless interrupted with Ctrl-c. The default is 15 seconds.
show tcp connect-timeout
Show the current connection timeout setting.
The gdb remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by your debugging stub. If
you need to override the autodetection, you can use these commands to enable or disable
individual packets. Each packet can be set to ‘on’ (the remote target supports this packet),
‘off’ (the remote target does not support this packet), or ‘auto’ (detect remote target
support for this packet). They all default to ‘auto’. For more information about each
packet, see Appendix E [Remote Protocol], page 749.
During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands. If you do, that
may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug in gdb. You may want to report
the problem to the gdb developers.
For each packet name, the command to enable or disable the packet is set remote
name-packet. If you configure a packet, the configuration will apply for all future remote
targets if no target is selected. In case there is a target selected, only the configuration of
the current target is changed. All other existing remote targets’ features are not affected.
The command to print the current configuration of a packet is show remote name-packet.
It displays the current remote target’s configuration. If no remote target is selected, the
default configuration for future connections is shown. The available settings are:
Command Name Remote Packet Related Features
set-register P set
software-breakpoint Z0 break
hardware-breakpoint Z1 hbreak
write-watchpoint Z2 watch
read-watchpoint Z3 rwatch
access-watchpoint Z4 awatch
The number of bytes per memory-read or memory-write packet for a remote target
can be configured using the commands set remote memory-read-packet-size and
set remote memory-write-packet-size. If set to ‘0’ (zero) the default packet size will
be used. The actual limit is further reduced depending on the target. Specify ‘fixed’
to disable the target-dependent restriction and ‘limit’ to enable it. Similar to the
enabling and disabling of remote packets, the command applies to the currently selected
target (if available). If no remote target is selected, it applies to all future remote
connections. The configuration of the selected target can be displayed using the commands
show remote memory-read-packet-size and show remote memory-write-packet-size.
If no remote target is selected, the default configuration for future connections is shown.
21 Configuration-Specific Information
While nearly all gdb commands are available for all native and cross versions of the de-
bugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter describes things that are only available in
certain configurations.
There are three major categories of configurations: native configurations, where the host
and target are the same, embedded operating system configurations, which are usually the
same for several different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which are
quite different from each other.
21.1 Native
This section describes details specific to particular native configurations.
info proc
info proc process-id
Summarize available information about a process. If a process ID is specified by
process-id, display information about that process; otherwise display informa-
tion about the program being debugged. The summary includes the debugged
process ID, the command line used to invoke it, its current working directory,
and its executable file’s absolute file name.
On some systems, process-id can be of the form ‘[pid]/tid’ which specifies
a certain thread ID within a process. If the optional pid part is missing, it
means a thread from the process being debugged (the leading ‘/’ still needs to
be present, or else gdb will interpret the number as a process ID rather than a
thread ID).
info proc cmdline
Show the original command line of the process. This command is supported on
gnu/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
info proc cwd
Show the current working directory of the process. This command is supported
on gnu/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
info proc exe
Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported on
gnu/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
info proc files
Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file descriptor, gdb
shows its number, type (file, directory, character device, socket), file pointer
offset, and the name of the resource open on the descriptor. The resource name
can be a file name (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed
by socket address (for network connections). This command is supported on
FreeBSD.
This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a tty for stan-
dard input and output as well as two network sockets:
(gdb) info proc files 22136
process 22136
Open files:
whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each range. On
gnu/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, each memory range includes the
object file which is mapped to that range.
info proc stat
info proc status
Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and group
ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored;
its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its ‘nice’ value;
etc. These commands are supported on gnu/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
For gnu/Linux systems, see the ‘proc’ man page for more information (type
man 5 proc from your shell prompt).
For FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, info proc stat is an alias for info proc
status.
info proc all
Show all the information about the process described under all of the above
info proc subcommands.
set procfs-trace
This command enables and disables tracing of procfs API calls.
show procfs-trace
Show the current state of procfs API call tracing.
set procfs-file file
Tell gdb to write procfs API trace to the named file. gdb appends the trace
info to the previous contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on
the standard output.
show procfs-file
Show the file to which procfs API trace is written.
proc-trace-entry
proc-trace-exit
proc-untrace-entry
proc-untrace-exit
These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits from the
syscall interface.
info pidlist
For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the processes and
all the threads within each process.
info meminfo
For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
gdb supports native debugging of djgpp programs, and defines a few commands specific
to the djgpp port. This subsection describes those commands.
info dos This is a prefix of djgpp-specific commands which print information about the
target system and important OS structures.
info dos sysinfo
This command displays assorted information about the underlying platform:
the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the DPMI version, and
the available conventional and DPMI memory.
info dos gdt
info dos ldt
info dos idt
These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local, and Inter-
rupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor tables are data
structures which store a descriptor for each segment that is currently in use.
The segment’s selector is an index into a descriptor table; the table entry for
that index holds the descriptor’s base address and limit, and its attributes and
access rights.
A typical djgpp program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data segment
(used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which allows access to
DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in conventional memory).
However, the DPMI host will usually define additional segments in order to
support the DPMI environment.
These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables. Without
an argument, all entries from the specified table are displayed. An argument,
which should be an integer expression, means display a single entry whose index
is given by the argument. For example, here’s a convenient way to display
information about the debugged program’s data segment:
(gdb) info dos ldt $ds
0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)
This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside the
data segment’s limit (i.e. garbled).
info dos pde
info dos pte
These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page Directory and
the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are data structures which
control how virtual memory addresses are mapped into physical addresses. A
Page Table includes an entry for every page of memory that is mapped into the
program’s address space; there may be several Page Tables, each one holding
up to 4096 entries. A Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every
Page Table that is currently in use.
Without an argument, info dos pde displays the entire Page Directory, and
info dos pte displays all the entries in all of the Page Tables. An argument,
an integer expression, given to the info dos pde command means display only
that entry from the Page Directory table. An argument given to the info dos
Chapter 21: Configuration-Specific Information 333
pte command means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed
to by the specified entry in the Page Directory.
These commands are useful when your program uses DMA (Direct Memory
Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA controller.
These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
info dos address-pte addr
This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear address. The
argument addr is a linear address which should already have the appropriate
segment’s base address added to it, because this command accepts addresses
which may belong to any segment. For example, here’s how to display the Page
Table entry for the page where a variable i is stored:
(gdb) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i
Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:
Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30
This says that i is stored at offset 0xd30 from the page whose physical base
address is 0x02698000, and shows all the attributes of that page.
Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a char *, since otherwise
the value of __djgpp_base_address, the base address of all variables and func-
tions in a djgpp program, will be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics:
if i is declared an int, gdb will add 4 times the value of __djgpp_base_address
to the address of i.
Here’s another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the transfer buffer:
(gdb) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)
Page Table entry for address 0x29110:
Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110
(The + 3 offset is because the transfer buffer’s address is the 3rd member of the
_go32_info_block structure.) The output clearly shows that this DPMI server
maps the addresses in conventional memory 1:1, i.e. the physical (0x00029000
+ 0x110) and linear (0x29110) addresses are identical.
This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote debugging via a serial
data link. The following commands are specific to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP
port of gdb.
set com1base addr
This command sets the base I/O port address of the COM1 serial port.
set com1irq irq
This command sets the Interrupt Request (IRQ) line to use for the COM1 serial
port.
There are similar commands ‘set com2base’, ‘set com3irq’, etc. for setting the
port address and the IRQ lines for the other 3 COM ports.
The related commands ‘show com1base’, ‘show com1irq’ etc. display the cur-
rent settings of the base address and the IRQ lines used by the COM ports.
info serial
This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each port,
it prints whether it’s active or not, its I/O base address and IRQ number,
334 Debugging with gdb
whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the counts of various
errors encountered so far.
Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs will have been
loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to start the program — either by
setting a breakpoint or letting the program run once to completion.
Non-debugging symbols:
0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
(gdb) info function !
All functions matching regular expression "!":
Non-debugging symbols:
0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@0
0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
[etc...]
show exceptions
Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
set task pause
This command toggles task suspension when gdb has control. Setting it to on
takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended whenever gdb gets control.
Setting it to off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this
option is set to off, you can use set thread default pause on or set thread
pause on (see below) to pause individual threads.
show task pause
Show the current state of task suspension.
set task detach-suspend-count
This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when gdb
detaches from it.
show task detach-suspend-count
Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
set task exception-port
set task excp
This command sets the task exception port to which gdb will forward excep-
tions. The argument should be the value of the send rights of the task. set
task excp is a shorthand alias.
set noninvasive
This command switches gdb to a mode that is the least invasive as far as
interfering with the inferior is concerned. This is the same as using set task
pause, set exceptions, and set signals to values opposite to the defaults.
info send-rights
info receive-rights
info port-rights
info port-sets
info dead-names
info ports
info psets
These commands display information about, respectively, send rights, receive
rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task. There are also short-
hand aliases: info ports for info port-rights and info psets for info
port-sets.
set thread pause
This command toggles current thread suspension when gdb has control. Setting
it to on takes effect immediately, and the current thread is suspended whenever
gdb gets control. Setting it to off will take effect the next time the inferior is
continued. Normally, this command has no effect, since when gdb has control,
the whole task is suspended. However, if you used set task pause off (see
above), this command comes in handy to suspend only the current thread.
show thread pause
This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
Chapter 21: Configuration-Specific Information 339
21.1.6 Darwin
gdb provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
set debug darwin num
When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to the Darwin
support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
show debug darwin
Show the current state of Darwin messages.
set debug mach-o num
When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while gdb is reading
Darwin object files. (Mach-O is the file format used on Darwin for object
and executable files.) Higher values produce more verbose output. This is a
command to diagnose problems internal to gdb and should not be needed in
normal usage.
show debug mach-o
Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
340 Debugging with gdb
set mach-exceptions on
set mach-exceptions off
On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then mapped
to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of Mach exceptions
in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to better understand the cause
of a fault. The default is off.
show mach-exceptions
Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21.1.7 FreeBSD
When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this is implemented by
leaving a compatibility system call using the old ABI at the existing number and allocating
a new system call number for the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a
system call is caught by name (see [catch syscall], page 70), compatibility system calls are
also caught.
For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the kevent system call and catch-
ing the kevent system call by name catches both variants:
(gdb) catch syscall kevent
Catchpoint 1 (syscalls ’freebsd11_kevent’ [363] ’kevent’ [560])
(gdb)
21.3.2 ARM
gdb provides the following ARM-specific commands:
set arm disassembler
This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The "std" style is the
standard style.
show arm disassembler
Show the current disassembly style.
set arm apcs32
This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
show arm apcs32
Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
set arm fpu fputype
This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The argument
fputype can be one of these:
auto Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
softfpa Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
processors.
fpa GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
softvfp Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
vfp VFP co-processor.
show arm fpu
Show the current type of the FPU.
set arm abi
This command forces gdb to use the specified ABI.
show arm abi
Show the currently used ABI.
set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
gdb uses the symbol table, when available, to determine whether instructions
are ARM or Thumb. This command controls gdb’s default behavior when the
symbol table is not available. The default is ‘auto’, which causes gdb to use
the current execution mode (from the T bit in the CPSR register).
show arm fallback-mode
Show the current fallback instruction mode.
set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether instruc-
tions are ARM or Thumb. The default is ‘auto’, which causes gdb to use the
symbol table and then the setting of ‘set arm fallback-mode’.
show arm force-mode
Show the current forced instruction mode.
342 Debugging with gdb
21.3.3 BPF
target sim [simargs] ...
The gdb BPF simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
--skb-data-offset=offset
Tell the simulator the offset, measured in bytes, of the skb_data
field in the kernel struct sk_buff structure. This offset is used by
some BPF specific-purpose load/store instructions. Defaults to 0.
21.3.4 M68k
The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21.3.5 MicroBlaze
The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx FPGAs, such as Spar-
tan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors usually have JTAG ports which connect
to a host system running the Xilinx Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software De-
velopment Kit (SDK). This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream
to the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program communicates
with the target board using the JTAG interface and presents a gdbserver interface to the
Chapter 21: Configuration-Specific Information 343
board. By default xmd uses port 1234. (While it is possible to change this default port, it
requires the use of undocumented xmd commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to
do this.)
Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
target sim
Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic programs but does
not support most hardware functions like MMU. For more complex use cases the
user is advised to run an external target, and connect using ‘target remote’.
Example: target sim
set debug or1k
Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
OpenRISC target support subsystem.
show debug or1k
Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21.3.10 CRIS
When configured for debugging CRIS, gdb provides the following CRIS-specific commands:
set cris-version ver
Set the current CRIS version to ver, either ‘10’ or ‘32’. The CRIS version affects
register names and sizes. This command is useful in case autodetection of the
CRIS version fails.
show cris-version
Show the current CRIS version.
set cris-dwarf2-cfi
Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is ‘on’.
Change to ‘off’ when using gcc-cris whose version is below R59.
show cris-dwarf2-cfi
Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
set cris-mode mode
Set the current CRIS mode to mode. It should only be changed when debugging
in guru mode, in which case it should be set to ‘guru’ (the default is ‘normal’).
show cris-mode
Show the current CRIS mode.
346 Debugging with gdb
21.4 Architectures
This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect all uses of gdb with the
architecture, both native and cross.
21.4.1 AArch64
When gdb is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the following special com-
mands:
set debug aarch64
This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
messages are to be displayed.
show debug aarch64
Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
1
The register named with capital letters represent the architecture registers.
Chapter 21: Configuration-Specific Information 349
21.4.3 Alpha
See the following section.
21.4.4 MIPS
Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which sometimes requires
gdb to search backward in the object code to find the beginning of a function.
To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where gdb may be
restricted to a slow serial line for this search) you may want to limit the size of this search,
using one of these commands:
set heuristic-fence-post limit
Restrict gdb to examining at most limit bytes in its search for the beginning
of a function. A value of 0 (the default) means there is no limit. However,
except for 0, the larger the limit the more bytes heuristic-fence-post must
search and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
this command when debugging a stripped executable.
show heuristic-fence-post
Display the current limit.
These commands are available only when gdb is configured for debugging programs on
Alpha or MIPS processors.
Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS programs:
set mips abi arg
Tell gdb which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible values of arg are:
‘auto’ The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
default).
‘o32’
‘o64’
‘n32’
‘n64’
‘eabi32’
‘eabi64’
show mips abi
Show the MIPS ABI used by gdb to debug the inferior.
350 Debugging with gdb
21.4.5 HPPA
When gdb is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the following special commands:
Chapter 21: Configuration-Specific Information 351
21.4.6 PowerPC
When gdb is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of pseudo-registers to
enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point numbers stored in the floating
point registers. These values must be stored in two consecutive registers, always starting
at an even register like f0 or f2.
The pseudo-registers go from $dl0 through $dl15, and are formed by joining the
even/odd register pairs f0 and f1 for $dl0, f2 and f3 for $dl1 and so on.
For POWER7 processors, gdb provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit wide Ex-
tended Floating Point Registers (‘f32’ through ‘f63’).
21.4.7 Nios II
When gdb is debugging the Nios II architecture, it provides the following special commands:
set debug nios2
This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II target code
in gdb.
show debug nios2
Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21.4.8 Sparc64
21.4.8.1 ADI Support
The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that detects invalid
data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables ADI on the allocated memory,
it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer
to that data, and stores the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves
the latter in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store, the
processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the cacheline’s version. If there
is a mismatch, the processor generates a version mismatch trap which can be either precise
or disrupting. The trap is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a
SIGSEGV signal.
Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with ADI-enabled.
Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a cacheline (64 bytes), can
be viewed or modified.
adi (examine | x) [ / n ] addr
The adi examine command displays the value of one ADI version tag per cache-
line.
352 Debugging with gdb
21.4.9 S12Z
When gdb is debugging the S12Z architecture, it provides the following special command:
maint info bdccsr
This command displays the current value of the microprocessor’s BDCCSR
register.
gdb requires a compatible AMD ROCm runtime to be loaded in order to detect AMD
GPU code objects and wavefronts. A warning message is displayed if an unsupported AMD
ROCm runtime is detected, or there is an error or restriction that prevents debugging. gdb
will continue to function except no AMD GPU debugging will be possible.
If a single instruction raises more than one signal, they will be reported one at a time
each time the wavefront is continued.
22 Controlling gdb
You can alter the way gdb interacts with you by using the set command. For commands
controlling how gdb displays data, see Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153. Other settings
are described here.
22.1 Prompt
gdb indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string called the prompt.
This string is normally ‘(gdb)’. You can change the prompt string with the set prompt
command. For instance, when debugging gdb with gdb, it is useful to change the prompt
in one of the gdb sessions so that you can always tell which one you are talking to.
Note: set prompt does not add a space for you after the prompt you set. This allows
you to set a prompt which ends in a space or a prompt that does not.
set prompt newprompt
Directs gdb to use newprompt as its prompt string henceforth.
show prompt
Prints a line of the form: ‘Gdb’s prompt is: your-prompt’
Versions of gdb that ship with Python scripting enabled have prompt extensions. The
commands for interacting with these extensions are:
set extended-prompt prompt
Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions. See Section 23.3.4.3
[gdb.prompt], page 498, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt string are
replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
For example:
set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the prompt hook
hook. See [prompt hook], page 397, for further information.
show extended-prompt
Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of the
prompt string with set extended-prompt, are replaced with the corresponding
strings each time the prompt is displayed.
mand history will be recorded when gdb exits. If set history filename is set
to the empty string then history saving is disabled, even when set history
save is on.
History expansion assigns special meaning to the character !. See Section 34.1.1 [Event
Designators], page 717, for more details.
Since ! is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion is off by default. If you
decide to enable history expansion with the set history expansion on command, you may
sometimes need to follow ! (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with a space
or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline history facilities do not attempt
substitution on the strings != and !(, even when history expansion is enabled.
show history
show history filename
show history save
show history size
show history expansion
These commands display the state of the gdb history parameters. show
history by itself displays all four states.
show commands
Display the last ten commands in the command history.
show commands n
Print ten commands centered on command number n.
show commands +
Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
--batch option (see Section 2.1.2 [Mode Options], page 13) also automatically
disables pagination.
show pagination
Show the current pagination mode.
operands differently. However, the builtin disassembler is not able to style all
architectures.
For architectures that the builtin disassembler is unable to style, gdb will fall
back to use the Python Pygments package where possible. In order to use the
Python Pygments package, gdb must be built with Python support, and the
Pygments package must be installed.
If neither of these options are available then gdb will produce unstyled disas-
sembler output, even when this setting is ‘on’.
To discover if the current architecture supports styling using the builtin disas-
sembler library see [maint show libopcodes-styling enabled], page 746.
show style disassembler enabled
Show the current state of disassembler styling.
Subcommands of set style control specific forms of styling. These subcommands all
follow the same pattern: each style-able object can be styled with a foreground color, a
background color, and an intensity.
For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the set style filename
group of commands:
set style filename background color
Set the background to color. Valid colors are ‘none’ (meaning the termi-
nal’s default color), ‘black’, ‘red’, ‘green’, ‘yellow’, ‘blue’, ‘magenta’, ‘cyan’,
and‘white’.
set style filename foreground color
Set the foreground to color. Valid colors are ‘none’ (meaning the terminal’s
default color), ‘black’, ‘red’, ‘green’, ‘yellow’, ‘blue’, ‘magenta’, ‘cyan’,
and‘white’.
set style filename intensity value
Set the intensity to value. Valid intensities are ‘normal’ (the default), ‘bold’,
and ‘dim’.
The show style command and its subcommands are styling a style name in their output
using its own style. So, use show style to see the complete list of styles, their characteristics
and the visual aspect of each style.
The style-able objects are:
filename Control the styling of file names and URLs. By default, this style’s foreground
color is green.
function Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the set style
function family of commands. By default, this style’s foreground color is
yellow.
This style is also used for symbol names in styled disassembler output if gdb is
using its builtin disassembler library for styling (see [set style disassembler
enabled], page 361).
variable Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the set style
variable family of commands. By default, this style’s foreground color is cyan.
Chapter 22: Controlling gdb 363
address Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the set style
address family of commands. By default, this style’s foreground color is blue.
This style is also used for addresses in styled disassembler output if gdb is
using its builtin disassembler library for styling (see [set style disassembler
enabled], page 361).
version Control the styling of gdb’s version number text. By default, this style’s fore-
ground color is magenta and it has bold intensity. The version number is
displayed in two places, the output of show version, and when gdb starts up.
In order to control how gdb styles the version number at startup, add the set
style version family of commands to the early initialization command file
(see Section 2.1.4 [Initialization Files], page 17).
title Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the set style title
family of commands. By default, this style’s intensity is bold. Commands are
using the title style to improve the readability of large output. For example, the
commands apropos and help are using the title style for the command names.
highlight
Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the set style
highlight family of commands. By default, this style’s foreground color is
red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw the user attention to
some specific parts of their output. For example, the command apropos -v
REGEXP uses the highlight style to mark the documentation parts matching
regexp.
metadata Control the styling of data annotations added by gdb to data it displays. By
default, this style’s intensity is dim. Metadata annotations include the ‘repeats
n times’ annotation for suppressed display of repeated array elements (see
Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153), ‘<unavailable>’ and ‘<error descr>’
annotations for errors and ‘<optimized-out>’ annotations for optimized-out
values in displaying stack frame information in backtraces (see Section 8.2
[Backtrace], page 110), etc.
tui-border
Control the styling of the TUI border. Note that, unlike other styling options,
only the color of the border can be controlled via set style. This was done
for compatibility reasons, as TUI controls to set the border’s intensity predated
the addition of general styling to gdb. See Section 25.6 [TUI Configuration],
page 565.
tui-active-border
Control the styling of the active TUI border; that is, the TUI window that has
the focus.
disassembler comment
Control the styling of comments in the disassembler output. These are managed
with the set style disassembler comment family of commands. This style is
only used when gdb is styling using its builtin disassembler library (see [set
style disassembler enabled], page 361). By default, this style’s intensity is
dim, and its foreground color is white.
364 Debugging with gdb
disassembler immediate
Control the styling of numeric operands in the disassembler output. These are
managed with the set style disassembler immediate family of commands.
This style is not used for instruction operands that represent addresses, in that
case the ‘disassembler address’ style is used. This style is only used when
gdb is styling using its builtin disassembler library. By default, this style’s
foreground color is blue.
disassembler address
Control the styling of address operands in the disassembler output. This is an
alias for the ‘address’ style.
disassembler symbol
Control the styling of symbol names in the disassembler output. This is an alias
for the ‘function’ style.
disassembler mnemonic
Control the styling of instruction mnemonics in the disassembler output. These
are managed with the set style disassembler mnemonic family of commands.
This style is also used for assembler directives, e.g. .byte, .word, etc. This
style is only used when gdb is styling using its builtin disassembler library. By
default, this style’s foreground color is green.
disassembler register
Control the styling of register operands in the disassembler output. These are
managed with the set style disassembler register family of commands.
This style is only used when gdb is styling using its builtin disassembler library.
By default, this style’s foreground color is red.
22.6 Numbers
You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in gdb by the usual
conventions: octal numbers begin with ‘0’, decimal numbers end with ‘.’, and hexadecimal
numbers begin with ‘0x’. Numbers that neither begin with ‘0’ or ‘0x’, nor end with a ‘.’
are, by default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for numbers—when no
particular format is specified—is base 10. You can change the default base for both input
and output with the commands described below.
set input-radix base
Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices for base are decimal
8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be specified either unambiguously or using
the current input radix; for example, any of
set input-radix 012
set input-radix 10.
set input-radix 0xa
sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, ‘set input-radix 10’ leaves
the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since ‘10’, being without any
leading or trailing signs of its base, is interpreted in the current radix. Thus,
if the current radix is 16, ‘10’ is interpreted in hex, i.e. as 16 decimal, which
doesn’t change the radix.
Chapter 22: Controlling gdb 365
show osabi
Show the OS ABI currently in use.
set osabi With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI’s.
set osabi abi
Set the current OS ABI to abi.
Generally, the way that an argument of type float is passed to a function depends on
whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped (i.e. ANSI/ISO style) function, float
arguments are passed unchanged, according to the architecture’s convention for float. For
unprototyped (i.e. K&R style) functions, float arguments are first promoted to type double
and then passed.
Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether a func-
tion is prototyped. If gdb calls a function that is not marked as prototyped, it consults
set coerce-float-to-double.
366 Debugging with gdb
set coerce-float-to-double
set coerce-float-to-double on
Arguments of type float will be promoted to double when passed to an un-
prototyped function. This is the default setting.
set coerce-float-to-double off
Arguments of type float will be passed directly to unprototyped functions.
show coerce-float-to-double
Show the current setting of promoting float to double.
gdb needs to know the ABI used for your program’s C++ objects. The correct C++ ABI
depends on which C++ compiler was used to build your application. gdb only fully supports
programs with a single C++ ABI; if your program contains code using multiple C++ ABI’s
or if gdb can not identify your program’s ABI correctly, you can tell gdb which ABI to use.
Currently supported ABI’s include “gnu-v2”, for g++ versions before 3.0, “gnu-v3”, for g++
versions 3.0 and later, and “hpaCC” for the HP ANSI C++ compiler. Other C++ compilers
may use the “gnu-v2” or “gnu-v3” ABI’s as well. The default setting is “auto”.
show cp-abi
Show the C++ ABI currently in use.
set cp-abi
With no argument, show the list of supported C++ ABI’s.
set cp-abi abi
set cp-abi auto
Set the current C++ ABI to abi, or return to automatic detection.
File], page 18) still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
To prevent gdb from auto-loading even those init files, use the -nx option (see
Section 2.1.2 [Mode Options], page 13), in addition to set auto-load no.
show auto-load
Show whether auto-loading of each specific ‘auto-load’ file(s) is enabled or
disabled.
(gdb) show auto-load
gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
is on.
python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
info auto-load
Print whether each specific ‘auto-load’ file(s) have been auto-loaded or not.
(gdb) info auto-load
gdb-scripts:
Loaded Script
Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
loaded.
python-scripts:
Loaded Script
Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
See [show auto-load local-gdbinit], page 368. Show setting of init file in the current
directory.
See [info auto-load local-gdbinit], page 368. Show state of init file in the current
directory.
See [set auto-load libthread-db], page 368. Control for thread debugging library.
See [show auto-load libthread-db], page 368. Show setting of thread debugging library.
See [info auto-load libthread-db], page 369. Show state of thread debugging library.
See [set auto-load safe-path], page 369. Control directories trusted for automatic
loading.
See [show auto-load safe-path], page 369. Show directories trusted for automatic
loading.
See [add-auto-load-safe-path], page 369. Add directory trusted for automatic
loading.
[set auto-load scripts-directory], page 552. The default set auto-load safe-path value
can be also overriden by gdb configuration option --with-auto-load-safe-path.
Setting this variable to / disables this security protection, corresponding gdb configu-
ration option is --without-auto-load-safe-path. This variable is supposed to be set to
the system directories writable by the system superuser only. Users can add their source
directories in init files in their home directories (see [Home Directory Init File], page 18).
See also deprecated init file in the current directory (see [Init File in the Current Directory
during Startup], page 19).
To force gdb to load the files it declined to load in the previous example, you could use
one of the following ways:
~/.gdbinit: ‘add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb’
Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list. You
have to specify also any existing directories displayed by by ‘show auto-load
safe-path’ (such as ‘/usr:/bin’ in this example).
gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" ...
Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single gdb session.
gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" ...
Disable auto-loading safety for a single gdb session. This assumes all the files
you debug during this gdb session will come from trusted sources.
./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path
During compilation of gdb you may disable any auto-loading safety. This
assumes all the files you will ever debug with this gdb come from trusted
sources.
On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which also
suppresses any such warning messages:
gdb -iex "set auto-load no" ...
You can use gdb command-line option for a single gdb session.
~/.gdbinit: ‘set auto-load no’
Disable auto-loading globally for the user (see [Home Directory Init File],
page 18). While it is improbable, you could also use system init file instead
(see Section C.6 [System-wide configuration], page 733).
This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches gdb
tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into their canonical form (typically
resolving symbolic links) and compare the entries again. gdb already canonicalizes most of
the filenames on its own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories
is recommended to be entered.
For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files (see
Section 22.8.3 [Auto-loading safe path], page 369) applies also to canonicalized filenames
which may not be too obvious while setting it up.
(gdb) set debug auto-load on
(gdb) file ~/src/t/true
auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
for objfile "/tmp/true".
auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
by your ‘auto-load safe-path’ set to "/usr:/opt".
23 Extending gdb
gdb provides several mechanisms for extension. gdb also provides the ability to automati-
cally load extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the user to automatically
customize gdb for the program being debugged.
To facilitate the use of extension languages, gdb is capable of evaluating the contents of
a file. When doing so, gdb can recognize which extension language is being used by looking
at the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension are always treated
as a gdb Command Files. See Section 23.1.3 [Command files], page 385.
You can control how gdb evaluates these files with the following setting:
set script-extension off
All scripts are always evaluated as gdb Command Files.
set script-extension soft
The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename extension.
If this scripting language is supported, gdb evaluates the script using that
language. Otherwise, it evaluates the file as a gdb Command File.
set script-extension strict
The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename extension,
and evaluates the script using that language. If the language is not supported,
then the evaluation fails.
show script-extension
Display the current value of the script-extension option.
if $argc == 2
print $arg0 + $arg1
end
if $argc == 3
print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
end
end
Combining with the eval command (see [eval], page 388) makes it easier to process a
variable number of arguments:
define adder
set $i = 0
set $sum = 0
while $i < $argc
eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
set $i = $i + 1
end
print $sum
end
define commandname
Define a command named commandname. If there is already a command by
that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it. The argument
commandname may be a bare command name consisting of letters, numbers,
dashes, dots, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined or user-
defined prefix command. For example, ‘define target my-target’ creates a
user-defined ‘target my-target’ command.
The definition of the command is made up of other gdb command lines, which
are given following the define command. The end of these commands is marked
by a line containing end.
document commandname
Document the user-defined command commandname, so that it can be ac-
cessed by help. The command commandname must already be defined. This
command reads lines of documentation just as define reads the lines of the
command definition, ending with end. After the document command is fin-
ished, help on command commandname displays the documentation you have
written.
You may use the document command again to change the documentation of a
command. Redefining the command with define does not change the docu-
mentation.
It is also possible to document user-defined aliases. The alias documentation
will then be used by the help and apropos commands instead of the docu-
mentation of the aliased command. Documenting a user-defined alias is par-
ticularly useful when defining an alias as a set of nested with commands (see
Section 23.2.1 [Command aliases default args], page 390).
define-prefix commandname
Define or mark the command commandname as a user-defined prefix com-
mand. Once marked, commandname can be used as prefix command by the
define command. Note that define-prefix can be used with a not yet de-
fined commandname. In such a case, commandname is defined as an empty
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 383
Example:
dont-repeat
Used inside a user-defined command, this tells gdb that this command should
not be repeated when the user hits RET (see Section 3.1 [Command Syntax],
page 23).
help user-defined
List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class COM-
MAND USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is included (if
any).
show user
show user commandname
Display the gdb commands used to define commandname (but not its documen-
tation). If no commandname is given, display the definitions for all user-defined
commands. This does not work for user-defined python commands.
384 Debugging with gdb
show max-user-call-depth
set max-user-call-depth
The value of max-user-call-depth controls how many recursion levels are
allowed in user-defined commands before gdb suspects an infinite recursion and
aborts the command. This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently use control flow
commands, described in Section 23.1.3 [Command Files], page 385.
When user-defined commands are executed, the commands of the definition are not
printed. An error in any command stops execution of the user-defined command.
If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed without asking
when used inside a user-defined command. Many gdb commands that normally print mes-
sages to say what they are doing omit the messages when used in a user-defined command.
define hook-run
handle SIGALRM pass
end
define hook-continue
handle SIGALRM pass
end
As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the echo command, and to
add extra text to the beginning and end of the message, you could define:
define hook-echo
echo <<<---
end
define hookpost-echo
echo --->>>\n
end
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 385
You can define a hook for any single-word command in gdb, but not for command
aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command name, e.g. backtrace rather than
bt. You can hook a multi-word command by adding hook- or hookpost- to the last word
of the command, e.g. ‘define target hook-remote’ to add a hook to ‘target remote’.
If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of gdb commands stops
and gdb issues a prompt (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to
run).
If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you get a warning
from the define command.
Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed without asking
when used in a command file. Many gdb commands that normally print messages to say
what they are doing omit the messages when called from command files.
gdb also accepts command input from standard input. In this mode, normal output
goes to standard output and error output goes to standard error. Errors in a command
file supplied on standard input do not terminate execution of the command file—execution
continues with the next command.
gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example will execute
commands from the file cmds. All output and errors would be directed to log.
Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than commands typed
interactively, they frequently need to deal with complicated situations, such as different or
unexpected values of variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged
is built, etc. gdb provides a set of flow-control commands to deal with these complexities.
Using these commands, you can write complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute
commands conditionally, etc.
if
else This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed com-
mands. The if command takes a single argument, which is an expression to
evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that are executed only if the
expression is true (its value is nonzero). There can then optionally be an else
line, followed by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing end.
while This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to if: the command
takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate, and must be fol-
lowed by the commands to execute, one per line, terminated by an end. These
commands are called the body of the loop. The commands in the body of while
are executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
loop_break
This command exits the while loop in whose body it is included. Execution of
the script continues after that whiles end line.
loop_continue
This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands in the
while loop in whose body it is included. Execution branches to the beginning
of the while loop, where it evaluates the controlling expression.
end Terminate the block of commands that are the body of if, else, or while
flow-control commands.
echo text Print text. Nonprinting characters can be included in text using C escape se-
quences, such as ‘\n’ to print a newline. No newline is printed unless you specify
one. In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed by a
space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a string with spaces at the
beginning or the end, since leading and trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed
from all arguments. To print ‘ and foo = ’, use the command ‘echo \ and foo
= \ ’.
A backslash at the end of text can be used, as in C, to continue the command
onto subsequent lines. For example,
echo This is some text\n\
which is continued\n\
onto several lines.\n
produces the same output as
echo This is some text\n
echo which is continued\n
echo onto several lines.\n
output expression
Print the value of expression and nothing but that value: no newlines, no ‘$nn
= ’. The value is not entered in the value history either. See Section 10.1
[Expressions], page 141, for more information on expressions.
output/fmt expression
Print the value of expression in format fmt. You can use the same formats as
for print. See Section 10.5 [Output Formats], page 146, for more information.
printf template, expressions...
Print the values of one or more expressions under the control of the string
template. To print several values, make expressions be a comma-separated
list of individual expressions, which may be either numbers or pointers. Their
values are printed as specified by template, exactly as a C program would do
by executing the code below:
printf (template, expressions...);
As in C printf, ordinary characters in template are printed verbatim, while
conversion specification introduced by the ‘%’ character cause subsequent ex-
pressions to be evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to
type and style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
printed.
For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
printf supports all the standard C conversion specifications, including the flags
and modifiers between the ‘%’ character and the conversion letter, with the
following exceptions:
• The argument-ordering modifiers, such as ‘2$’, are not supported.
• The modifier ‘*’ is not supported for specifying precision or width.
• The ‘’’ flag (for separation of digits into groups according to LC_NUMERIC’)
is not supported.
388 Debugging with gdb
• The type modifiers ‘hh’, ‘j’, ‘t’, and ‘z’ are not supported.
• The conversion letter ‘n’ (as in ‘%n’) is not supported.
• The conversion letters ‘a’ and ‘A’ are not supported.
Note that the ‘ll’ type modifier is supported only if the underlying C imple-
mentation used to build gdb supports the long long int type, and the ‘L’ type
modifier is supported only if long double type is available.
As in C, printf supports simple backslash-escape sequences, such as \n, ‘\t’,
‘\\’, ‘\"’, ‘\a’, and ‘\f’, that consist of backslash followed by a single character.
Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not supported.
Additionally, printf supports conversion specifications for DFP (Decimal
Floating Point) types using the following length modifiers together with a
floating point specifier. letters:
• ‘H’ for printing Decimal32 types.
• ‘D’ for printing Decimal64 types.
• ‘DD’ for printing Decimal128 types.
If the underlying C implementation used to build gdb has support for the three
length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers such as width and precision
will also be available for gdb to use.
In case there is no such C support, no additional modifiers will be available and
the value will be printed in the standard way.
Here’s an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
Additionally, printf supports a special ‘%V’ output format. This format prints
the string representation of an expression just as gdb would produce with the
standard print command (see Chapter 10 [Examining Data], page 137):
(gdb) print array
$1 = {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5}
(gdb) printf "Array is: %V\n", array
Array is: {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5}
It is possible to include print options with the ‘%V’ format by placing them in
‘[...]’ immediately after the ‘%V’, like this:
(gdb) printf "Array is: %V[-array-indexes on]\n", array
Array is: {[0] = 0, [1] = 1, [2] = 2, [3] = 3, [4] = 4, [5] = 5}
If you need to print a literal ‘[’ directly after a ‘%V’, then just include an empty
print options list:
(gdb) printf "Array is: %V[][Hello]\n", array
Array is: {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5}[Hello]
eval template, expressions...
Convert the values of one or more expressions under the control of the string
template to a command line, and call it.
Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled, and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be
printed.
set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
show auto-load gdb-scripts
Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled
or disabled.
info auto-load gdb-scripts [regexp]
Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that gdb auto-loaded.
If regexp is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with matching names
are printed.
Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands. With a user-defined com-
mand, you also need to write documentation for it with the ‘document’ command. An alias
automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
Here is an example where we make ‘elms’ an abbreviation of ‘elements’ in the ‘set
print elements’ command. This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
of a command.
(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
(gdb) set p elms 200
(gdb) show p elms
Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
Note that if you are defining an alias of a ‘set’ command, and you want to have an alias
for the corresponding ‘show’ command, then you need to define the latter separately.
Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in command and alias, just as they
are normally.
(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word alias for a more complex
command. This creates alias ‘spe’ of the command ‘set print elements’.
(gdb) alias spe = set print elements
(gdb) spe 20
1
gdb could easily accept default arguments for pre-defined commands and aliases, but it was deemed this
would be confusing, and so is not allowed.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 391
python-interactive [command]
pi [command]
Without an argument, the python-interactive command can be used to start
an interactive Python prompt. To return to gdb, type the EOF character (e.g.,
Ctrl-D on an empty prompt).
Alternatively, a single-line Python command can be given as an argument and
evaluated. If the command is an expression, the result will be printed; other-
wise, nothing will be printed. For example:
(gdb) python-interactive 2 + 3
5
python [command]
py [command]
The python command can be used to evaluate Python code.
If given an argument, the python command will evaluate the argument as a
Python command. For example:
(gdb) python print 23
23
If you do not provide an argument to python, it will act as a multi-line com-
mand, like define. In this case, the Python script is made up of subsequent
command lines, given after the python command. This command list is termi-
nated using a line containing end. For example:
(gdb) python
>print 23
>end
23
If this option is set to ‘on’ before Python is initialized then Python will no
longer write the byte code to disk. As Python is initialized early during gdb’s
startup process, then this option must be placed into the early initialization file
(see Section 2.1.4 [Initialization Files], page 17) to have the desired effect.
By default this option is set to ‘auto’. In this mode, provided the
python ignore-environment setting is ‘off’, the environment variable
PYTHONDONTWRITEBYTECODE is examined to see if it should write out byte-code
or not. PYTHONDONTWRITEBYTECODE is considered to be off/disabled either
when set to the empty string or when the environment variable doesn’t exist.
All other settings, including those which don’t seem to make sense, indicate
that it’s on/enabled.
This option is equivalent to passing -B to the real python executable.
It is also possible to execute a Python script from the gdb interpreter:
source script-name
The script name must end with ‘.py’ and gdb must be configured to recognize
the script language based on filename extension using the script-extension
setting. See Chapter 23 [Extending GDB], page 381.
The following commands are intended to help debug gdb itself:
set debug py-breakpoint on|off
show debug py-breakpoint
When ‘on’, gdb prints debug messages related to the Python breakpoint API.
This is ‘off’ by default.
set debug py-unwind on|off
show debug py-unwind
When ‘on’, gdb prints debug messages related to the Python unwinder API.
This is ‘off’ by default.
these signals, gdb will most likely stop working correctly. Note that it is unfortunately
common for GUI toolkits to install a SIGCHLD handler.
• gdb takes care to mark its internal file descriptors as close-on-exec. However, this
cannot be done in a thread-safe way on all platforms. Your Python programs should
be aware of this and should both create new file descriptors with the close-on-exec flag
set and arrange to close unneeded file descriptors before starting a child process.
gdb introduces a new Python module, named gdb. All methods and classes added by
gdb are placed in this module. gdb automatically imports the gdb module for use in all
scripts evaluated by the python command.
Some types of the gdb module come with a textual representation (accessible through
the repr or str functions). These are offered for debugging purposes only, expect them to
change over time.
gdb.PYTHONDIR [Variable]
A string containing the python directory (see Section 23.3 [Python], page 391).
gdb.breakpoints () [Function]
Return a sequence holding all of gdb’s breakpoints. See Section 23.3.2.32 [Break-
points In Python], page 475, for more information. In gdb version 7.11 and earlier,
this function returned None if there were no breakpoints. This peculiarity was subse-
quently fixed, and now gdb.breakpoints returns an empty sequence in this case.
gdb.history_count () [Function]
Return an integer indicating the number of values in gdb’s value history (see
Section 10.11 [Value History], page 166).
396 Debugging with gdb
gdb.target_charset () [Function]
Return the name of the current target character set (see Section 10.21 [Character
Sets], page 183). This differs from gdb.parameter(’target-charset’) in that ‘auto’
is never returned.
gdb.target_wide_charset () [Function]
Return the name of the current target wide character set (see Section 10.21 [Character
Sets], page 183). This differs from gdb.parameter(’target-wide-charset’) in that
‘auto’ is never returned.
gdb.host_charset () [Function]
Return a string, the name of the current host character set (see Section 10.21 [Char-
acter Sets], page 183). This differs from gdb.parameter(’host-charset’) in that
‘auto’ is never returned.
The parameter current_prompt contains the current gdb prompt. This method must
return a Python string, or None. If a string is returned, the gdb prompt will be set
to that string. If None is returned, gdb will continue to use the current prompt.
Some prompts cannot be substituted in gdb. Secondary prompts such as those used
by readline for command input, and annotation related prompts are prohibited from
being changed.
gdb.architecture_names () [Function]
Return a list containing all of the architecture names that the current build of gdb
supports. Each architecture name is a string. The names returned in this list are the
same names as are returned from gdb.Architecture.name (see [Architecture.name],
page 481).
gdb.connections [Function]
Return a list of gdb.TargetConnection objects, one for each currently active con-
nection (see Section 23.3.2.37 [Connections In Python], page 483). The connection
objects are in no particular order in the returned list.
gdb.current_language () [Function]
Return the name of the current language as a string. Unlike gdb.parameter(’language’),
this function will never return ‘auto’. If a gdb.Frame object is available (see
Section 23.3.2.27 [Frames In Python], page 463), the language method might be
preferable in some cases, as that is not affected by the user’s language setting.
gdb.Thread [class]
This is a subclass of Python’s threading.Thread class. It overrides the start method
to call block_signals, making this an easy-to-use drop-in replacement for creating
threads that will work well in gdb.
gdb.post_event (event) [Function]
Put event, a callable object taking no arguments, into gdb’s internal event queue.
This callable will be invoked at some later point, during gdb’s event processing.
Events posted using post_event will be run in the order in which they were posted;
however, there is no way to know when they will be processed relative to other events
inside gdb.
Unlike most Python APIs in gdb, post_event is thread-safe. For example:
(gdb) python
>import threading
>
>class Writer():
> def __init__(self, message):
> self.message = message;
> def __call__(self):
> gdb.write(self.message)
>
>class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
> def run (self):
> gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
>
>class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
> def run (self):
> gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
>
>MyThread1().start()
>MyThread2().start()
>end
(gdb) Hello World
400 Debugging with gdb
>end
(gdb) hello-world 42
hello-world takes no arguments
Value.address [Variable]
If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a gdb.Value object rep-
resenting the address. Otherwise, this attribute holds None.
Value.is_optimized_out [Variable]
This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out this value, thus
it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
Value.type [Variable]
The type of this gdb.Value. The value of this attribute is a gdb.Type object (see
Section 23.3.2.5 [Types In Python], page 407).
Value.dynamic_type [Variable]
The dynamic type of this gdb.Value. This uses the object’s virtual table and the C++
run-time type information (RTTI) to determine the dynamic type of the value. If this
value is of class type, it will return the class in which the value is embedded, if any. If
this value is of pointer or reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type
of the referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type, respectively.
In all other cases, it will return the value’s static type.
Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C++ program that includes
RTTI for the object in question. Otherwise, it will just return the static type of the
value as in ptype foo (see Chapter 16 [Symbols], page 259).
Value.is_lazy [Variable]
The value of this read-only boolean attribute is True if this gdb.Value has not yet
been fetched from the inferior. gdb does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
For example:
myval = gdb.parse_and_eval (’somevar’)
The value of somevar is not fetched at this time. It will be fetched when the value is
needed, or when the fetch_lazy method is invoked.
The following methods are provided:
Value.__init__ (val) [Function]
Many Python values can be converted directly to a gdb.Value via this object initial-
izer. Specifically:
Python boolean
A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
language.
Python integer
A Python integer is converted to the C long type for the current archi-
tecture.
Python long
A Python long is converted to the C long long type for the current
architecture.
Python float
A Python float is converted to the C double type for the current archi-
tecture.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 403
Python string
A Python string is converted to a target string in the current target
language using the current target encoding. If a character cannot be
represented in the current target encoding, then an exception is thrown.
gdb.Value
If val is a gdb.Value, then a copy of the value is made.
gdb.LazyString
If val is a gdb.LazyString (see Section 23.3.2.34 [Lazy Strings In
Python], page 480), then the lazy string’s value method is called, and
its result is used.
Value.dereference () [Function]
For pointer data types, this method returns a new gdb.Value object whose contents
is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if foo is a C pointer to an int,
declared in your C program as
int *foo;
then you can use the corresponding gdb.Value to access what foo points to like this:
bar = foo.dereference ()
The result bar will be a gdb.Value object holding the value pointed to by foo.
A similar function Value.referenced_value exists which also returns gdb.Value ob-
jects corresponding to the values pointed to by pointer values (and additionally, values
referenced by reference values). However, the behavior of Value.dereference differs
from Value.referenced_value by the fact that the behavior of Value.dereference
is identical to applying the C unary operator * on a given value. For example, consider
a reference to a pointer ptrref, declared in your C++ program as
typedef int *intptr;
...
int val = 10;
intptr ptr = &val;
404 Debugging with gdb
the virtual function table. False if the declared type should be used.
(See set print object in Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
static_members
True if static members should be included in the string representation of
a C++ object, False if they shouldn’t (see set print static-members in
Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
max_characters
Number of string characters to print, 0 to follow max_elements, or
UINT_MAX to print an unlimited number of characters (see set print
characters in Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
max_elements
Number of array elements to print, or 0 to print an unlimited number
of elements (see set print elements in Section 10.9 [Print Settings],
page 153).
max_depth
The maximum depth to print for nested structs and unions, or -1 to
print an unlimited number of elements (see set print max-depth in
Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
repeat_threshold
Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array elements, or
0 to represent all elements, even if repeated. (See set print repeats in
Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
format A string containing a single character representing the format to use for
the returned string. For instance, ’x’ is equivalent to using the gdb com-
mand print with the /x option and formats the value as a hexadecimal
number.
styling True if gdb should apply styling to the returned string. When styling
is applied, the returned string might contain ANSI terminal escape se-
quences. Escape sequences will only be included if styling is turned on,
see Section 22.5 [Output Styling], page 361. Additionally, gdb only styles
some value contents, so not every output string will contain escape se-
quences.
When False, which is the default, no output styling is applied.
summary True when just a summary should be printed. In this mode, scalar values
are printed in their entirety, but aggregates such as structures or unions
are omitted. This mode is used by set print frame-arguments scalars
(see Section 10.9 [Print Settings], page 153).
and will include any embedded zeroes that the string may contain. Otherwise, for
languages where the string is zero-terminated, the entire string will be converted.
For example, in C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an array of
characters or ints of type wchar_t, char16_t, or char32_t.
If the optional encoding argument is given, it must be a string naming the encoding
of the string in the gdb.Value, such as "ascii", "iso-8859-6" or "utf-8". It ac-
cepts the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python’s string.decode
method, and the Python codec machinery will be used to convert the string. If encod-
ing is not given, or if encoding is the empty string, then either the target-charset
(see Section 10.21 [Character Sets], page 183) will be used, or a language-specific
encoding will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
The optional errors argument is the same as the corresponding argument to Python’s
string.decode method.
If the optional length argument is given, the string will be fetched and converted to
the given length.
Value.fetch_lazy () [Function]
If the gdb.Value object is currently a lazy value (gdb.Value.is_lazy is True), then
the value is fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process will produce
a Python exception.
If the gdb.Value object is not a lazy value, this method has no effect.
This method does not return a value.
If block is given, then name is looked up in that scope. Otherwise, it is searched for
globally.
Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of gdb.Type. If the named type
cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
Integer types can be found without looking them up by name. See Section 23.3.2.35
[Architectures In Python], page 481, for the integer_type method.
If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields of that type can be
accessed using the Python dictionary syntax. For example, if some_type is a gdb.Type
instance holding a structure type, you can access its foo field with:
bar = some_type[’foo’]
bar will be a gdb.Field object; see below under the description of the Type.fields
method for a description of the gdb.Field class.
An instance of Type has the following attributes:
Type.alignof [Variable]
The alignment of this type, in bytes. Type alignment comes from the debugging
information; if it was not specified, then gdb will use the relevant ABI to try to
determine the alignment. In some cases, even this is not possible, and zero will be
returned.
Type.code [Variable]
The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the TYPE_CODE_ constants
defined below.
Type.dynamic [Variable]
A boolean indicating whether this type is dynamic. In some situations, such as Rust
enum types or Ada variant records, the concrete type of a value may vary depending
on its contents. That is, the declared type of a variable, or the type returned by
gdb.lookup_type may be dynamic; while the type of the variable’s value will be a
concrete instance of that dynamic type.
For example, consider this code:
int n;
int array[n];
Here, at least conceptually (whether your compiler actually does this is a separate
issue), examining gdb.lookup_symbol("array", ...).type could yield a gdb.Type
which reports a size of None. This is the dynamic type.
However, examining gdb.parse_and_eval("array").type would yield a concrete
type, whose length would be known.
Type.name [Variable]
The name of this type. If this type has no name, then None is returned.
Type.sizeof [Variable]
The size of this type, in target char units. Usually, a target’s char type will be an
8-bit byte. However, on some unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
A dynamic type may not have a fixed size; in this case, this attribute’s value will be
None.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 409
Type.tag [Variable]
The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after struct, union, or enum
in C and C++; not all languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
None is returned.
Type.objfile [Variable]
The gdb.Objfile that this type was defined in, or None if there is no associated
objfile.
Type.is_scalar [Variable]
This property is True if the type is a scalar type, otherwise, this property is False.
Examples of non-scalar types include structures, unions, and classes.
Type.is_signed [Variable]
For scalar types (those for which Type.is_scalar is True), this property is True if
the type is signed, otherwise this property is False.
Attempting to read this property for a non-scalar type (a type for which Type.is_
scalar is False), will raise a ValueError.
Type.fields () [Function]
Return the fields of this type. The behavior depends on the type code:
• For structure and union types, this method returns the fields.
• Range types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values.
• Enum types have one field per enum constant.
• Function and method types have one field per parameter. The base types of C++
classes are also represented as fields.
• Array types have one field representing the array’s range.
• If the type does not fit into one of these categories, a TypeError is raised.
Each field is a gdb.Field object, with some pre-defined attributes:
bitpos This attribute is not available for enum or static (as in C++) fields. The
value is the position, counting in bits, from the start of the containing
type. Note that, in a dynamic type, the position of a field may not be
constant. In this case, the value will be None. Also, a dynamic type may
have fields that do not appear in a corresponding concrete type.
enumval This attribute is only available for enum fields, and its value is the enu-
meration member’s integer representation.
name The name of the field, or None for anonymous fields.
artificial
This is True if the field is artificial, usually meaning that it was provided
by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is always provided, and
is False if the field is not artificial.
410 Debugging with gdb
is_base_class
This is True if the field represents a base class of a C++ structure. This
attribute is always provided, and is False if the field is not a base class
of the type that is the argument of fields, or if that type was not a C++
class.
bitsize If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a non-zero value,
which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise, this will be zero; in this
case the field’s size is given by its type.
type The type of the field. This is usually an instance of Type, but it can be
None in some situations.
parent_type
The type which contains this field. This is an instance of gdb.Type.
Type.const () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents a const-qualified variant of this type.
Type.volatile () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents a volatile-qualified variant of this
type.
Type.unqualified () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents an unqualified variant of this type.
That is, the result is neither const nor volatile.
Type.range () [Function]
Return a Python Tuple object that contains two elements: the low bound of the
argument type and the high bound of that type. If the type does not have a range,
gdb will raise a gdb.error exception (see Section 23.3.2.3 [Exception Handling],
page 400).
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 411
Type.reference () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents a reference to this type.
Type.pointer () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents a pointer to this type.
Type.strip_typedefs () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type that represents the real type, after removing all layers of
typedefs.
Type.target () [Function]
Return a new gdb.Type object which represents the target type of this type.
For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to object. For an array
type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is the type of the elements of the array.
For a function or method type, the target type is the type of the return value. For a
complex type, the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the target
type is the aliased type.
If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an exception.
Type.template_argument (n [, block]) [Function]
If this gdb.Type is an instantiation of a template, this will return a new gdb.Value or
gdb.Type which represents the value of the nth template argument (indexed starting
at 0).
If this gdb.Type is not a template type, or if the type has fewer than n template
arguments, this will throw an exception. Ordinarily, only C++ code will have template
types.
If block is given, then name is looked up in that scope. Otherwise, it is searched for
globally.
Type.optimized_out () [Function]
Return gdb.Value instance of this type whose value is optimized out. This allows a
frame decorator to indicate that the value of an argument or a local variable is not
known.
Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls into. The available
type categories are represented by constants defined in the gdb module:
gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
The type is a pointer.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
The type is an array.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
The type is a structure.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
The type is a union.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
The type is an enum.
412 Debugging with gdb
gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
The type is a function.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
The type is an integer type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
A floating point type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
The special type void.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
A Pascal set type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with language-
defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
A string of bits. It is deprecated.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
An unknown or erroneous type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
A method type, as found in C++.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
A pointer-to-member-function.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
A pointer-to-member.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
A reference type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_RVALUE_REF
A C++11 rvalue reference type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
A character type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
A boolean type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
A complex float type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
A typedef to some other type.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 413
gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
A C++ namespace.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
A decimal floating point type.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
A function internal to gdb. This is the type used to represent convenience
functions.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_XMETHOD
A method internal to gdb. This is the type used to represent xmethods (see
Section 23.3.2.16 [Writing an Xmethod], page 434).
gdb.TYPE_CODE_FIXED_POINT
A fixed-point number.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
A Fortran namelist.
Further support for types is provided in the gdb.types Python module (see
Section 23.3.4.2 [gdb.types], page 496).
‘array’ Indicate that the object being printed is “array-like”. The CLI uses this to
respect parameters such as set print elements and set print array.
‘map’ Indicate that the object being printed is “map-like”, and that the children
of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and values.
‘string’ Indicate that the object being printed is “string-like”. If the printer’s to_
string method returns a Python string of some kind, then gdb will call
its internal language-specific string-printing function to format the string.
For the CLI this means adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some
characters, respecting set print elements, and the like.
The special value None causes gdb to apply the default display rules.
gdb provides a function which can be used to look up the default pretty-printer for a
gdb.Value:
Normally, a pretty-printer can respect the user’s print settings (including temporarily
applied settings, such as ‘/x’) simply by calling Value.format_string (see Section 23.3.2.4
[Values From Inferior], page 401). However, these settings can also be queried directly:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 415
gdb.print_options () [Function]
Return a dictionary whose keys are the valid keywords that can be given to
Value.format_string, and whose values are the user’s settings. During a print or
other operation, the values will reflect any flags that are temporarily in effect.
(gdb) python print (gdb.print_options ()[’max_elements’])
200
gdb.pretty_printers [Variable]
The Python list gdb.pretty_printers contains an array of functions or callable
objects that have been registered via addition as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list
are called global printers, they’re available when debugging all inferiors.
def to_string(self):
return self.val[’_M_dataplus’][’_M_p’]
def display_hint(self):
return ’string’
And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer example above
might be written.
def str_lookup_function(val):
lookup_tag = val.type.tag
if lookup_tag is None:
return None
regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
if regex.match(lookup_tag):
return StdStringPrinter(val)
return None
The example lookup function extracts the value’s type, and attempts to match it to a
type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the printer can pretty-print, it will return a
printer object. If not, it returns None.
We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python package. If your
pretty-printers are for use with a library, we further recommend embedding a version number
into the package name. This practice will enable gdb to load multiple versions of your
pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have different names.
You should write auto-loaded code (see Section 23.3.3 [Python Auto-loading], page 495)
such that it can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An ideal auto-
load file will consist solely of imports of your printer modules, followed by a call to a register
pretty-printers with the current objfile.
Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple inferiors, each potentially
using a different library version. Embedding a version number in the Python package name
will ensure that gdb is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously. Then, because the
search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and because your auto-loaded code took care
to register your library’s printers with a specific objfile, gdb will find the correct printers
for the specific version of the library used by each inferior.
To continue the std::string example (see Section 23.3.2.6 [Pretty Printing API],
page 413), this code might appear in gdb.libstdcxx.v6:
def register_printers(objfile):
objfile.pretty_printers.append(str_lookup_function)
And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 417
The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer. There are a few things that can
be improved on. The printer doesn’t have a name, making it hard to identify in a list of
installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but lookup functions can have arbitrary,
even identical, names.
Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has several types.
One could install a lookup function for each desired type in the library, but one could also
have a single lookup function recognize several types. The latter is the conventional way
this is handled. If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its subprinters are
the printers for the individual data types.
The gdb.printing module provides a formal way of solving these problems (see
Section 23.3.4.1 [gdb.printing], page 496). Here is another example that handles multiple
types.
These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
struct foo { int a, b; };
struct bar { struct foo x, y; };
Here are the printers:
class fooPrinter:
"""Print a foo object."""
def to_string(self):
return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
"> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
class barPrinter:
"""Print a bar object."""
def to_string(self):
return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
"> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
This example doesn’t need a lookup function, that is handled by the gdb.printing
module. Instead a function is provided to build up the object that handles the lookup.
import gdb.printing
def build_pretty_printer():
pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
"my_library")
pp.add_printer(’foo’, ’^foo$’, fooPrinter)
pp.add_printer(’bar’, ’^bar$’, barPrinter)
return pp
And here is the autoload support:
import gdb.printing
import my_library
gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
gdb.current_objfile(),
my_library.build_pretty_printer())
418 Debugging with gdb
Finally, when this printer is loaded into gdb, here is the corresponding output of ‘info
pretty-printer’:
(gdb) info pretty-printer
my_library.so:
my_library
foo
bar
When displaying a type, say via the ptype command, gdb will compute a list of
type recognizers. This is done by iterating first over the per-objfile type printers (see
Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python], page 461), followed by the per-progspace type print-
ers (see Section 23.3.2.25 [Progspaces In Python], page 459), and finally the global type
printers.
gdb will call the instantiate method of each enabled type printer. If this method
returns None, then the result is ignored; otherwise, it is appended to the list of recognizers.
Then, when gdb is going to display a type name, it iterates over the list of recognizers.
For each one, it calls the recognition function, stopping if the function returns a non-None
value. The recognition function is defined as:
gdb uses this two-pass approach so that type printers can efficiently cache information
without holding on to it too long. For example, it can be convenient to look up type
information in a type printer and hold it for a recognizer’s lifetime; if a single pass were
done then type printers would have to make use of the event system in order to avoid
holding information that could become stale as the inferior changed.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 419
Once the dictionaries are combined, pruned and sorted, gdb creates an iterator which
wraps each frame in the call stack in a FrameDecorator object, and calls each filter in order.
The output from the previous filter will always be the input to the next filter, and so on.
Frame filters have a mandatory interface which each frame filter must implement, defined
here:
Filter1 5
Filter2 10
Filter3 100
Filter4 1
Note that the output from Filter3 is passed to the input of Filter2, and so on.
This filter method is passed a Python iterator. This iterator contains a sequence of
frame decorators that wrap each gdb.Frame, or a frame decorator that wraps another
frame decorator. The first filter that is executed in the sequence of frame filters will
receive an iterator entirely comprised of default FrameDecorator objects. However,
after each frame filter is executed, the previous frame filter may have wrapped some
or all of the frame decorators with their own frame decorator. As frame decorators
must also conform to a mandatory interface, these decorators can be assumed to act
in a uniform manner (see Section 23.3.2.11 [Frame Decorator API], page 421).
This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator protocol. Each
item in the iterator must be an object conforming to the frame decorator interface.
If a frame filter does not wish to perform any operations on this iterator, it should
return that iterator untouched.
This method is not optional. If it does not exist, gdb will raise and print an error.
FrameFilter.name [Variable]
The name attribute must be Python string which contains the name of the filter dis-
played by gdb (see Section 8.6 [Frame Filter Management], page 118). This attribute
may contain any combination of letters or numbers. Care should be taken to ensure
that it is unique. This attribute is mandatory.
FrameFilter.enabled [Variable]
The enabled attribute must be Python boolean. This attribute indicates to gdb
whether the frame filter is enabled, and should be considered when frame filters are
executed. If enabled is True, then the frame filter will be executed when any of
the backtrace commands detailed earlier in this chapter are executed. If enabled is
False, then the frame filter will not be executed. This attribute is mandatory.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 421
FrameFilter.priority [Variable]
The priority attribute must be Python integer. This attribute controls the order
of execution in relation to other frame filters. There are no imposed limits on the
range of priority other than it must be a valid integer. The higher the priority
attribute, the sooner the frame filter will be executed in relation to other frame filters.
Although priority can be negative, it is recommended practice to assume zero is
the lowest priority that a frame filter can be assigned. Frame filters that have the
same priority are executed in unsorted order in that priority slot. This attribute is
mandatory. 100 is a good default priority.
If this function returns None, gdb will not print any data for this field.
def value(self):
return self.val
def symbol(self):
return self.sym
class SomeFrameDecorator()
...
...
def frame_args(self):
args = []
try:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 423
block = self.inferior_frame.block()
except:
return None
return args
return vars
gdb. In all cases, whether it works on the iterator or not, each frame filter must return an
iterator. A bare-bones frame filter follows the pattern in the following example.
import gdb
class FrameFilter():
def __init__(self):
# Frame filter attribute creation.
#
# ’name’ is the name of the filter that GDB will display.
#
# ’priority’ is the priority of the filter relative to other
# filters.
#
# ’enabled’ is a boolean that indicates whether this filter is
# enabled and should be executed.
self.name = "Foo"
self.priority = 100
self.enabled = True
ter Management], page 118), the names gdb will display are those contained in the name
attribute.
The final step of this example is the implementation of the filter method. As shown
in the example comments, we define the filter method and note that the method must
take an iterator, and also must return an iterator. In this bare-bones example, the frame
filter is not very useful as it just returns the iterator untouched. However this is a valid
operation for frame filters that have the enabled attribute set, but decide not to operate
on any frames.
In the next example, the frame filter operates on all frames and utilizes a frame decorator
to perform some work on the frames. See Section 23.3.2.11 [Frame Decorator API], page 421,
for further information on the frame decorator interface.
This example works on inlined frames. It highlights frames which are inlined by tag-
ging them with an “[inlined]” tag. By applying a frame decorator to all frames with the
Python itertools imap method, the example defers actions to the frame decorator. Frame
decorators are only processed when gdb prints the backtrace.
This introduces a new decision making topic: whether to perform decision making op-
erations at the filtering step, or at the printing step. In this example’s approach, it does
not perform any filtering decisions at the filtering step beyond mapping a frame decorator
to each frame. This allows the actual decision making to be performed when each frame is
printed. This is an important consideration, and well worth reflecting upon when designing
a frame filter. An issue that frame filters should avoid is unwinding the stack if possible.
Some stacks can run very deep, into the tens of thousands in some cases. To search every
frame to determine if it is inlined ahead of time may be too expensive at the filtering step.
The frame filter cannot know how many frames it has to iterate over, and it would have
to iterate through them all. This ends up duplicating effort as gdb performs this iteration
when it prints the frames.
In this example decision making can be deferred to the printing step. As each frame is
printed, the frame decorator can examine each frame in turn when gdb iterates. From a
performance viewpoint, this is the most appropriate decision to make as it avoids duplicating
the effort that the printing step would undertake anyway. Also, if there are many frame
filters unwinding the stack during filtering, it can substantially delay the printing of the
backtrace which will result in large memory usage, and a poor user experience.
class InlineFilter():
def __init__(self):
self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
self.priority = 100
self.enabled = True
gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
def function(self):
frame = self.inferior_frame()
name = str(frame.name())
if frame.type() == gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
name = name + " [inlined]"
return name
This frame decorator only defines and overrides the function method. It lets the sup-
plied FrameDecorator, which is shipped with gdb, perform the other work associated with
printing this frame.
The combination of these two objects create this output from a backtrace:
#0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
#1 0x00400566 in max [inlined] (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:21
#2 0x00400566 in main () at inline.c:31
So in the case of this example, a frame decorator is applied to all frames, regardless of
whether they may be inlined or not. As gdb iterates over the iterator produced by the
frame filters, gdb executes each frame decorator which then makes a decision on what to
print in the function callback. Using a strategy like this is a way to defer decisions on the
frame content to printing time.
Eliding Frames
It might be that the above example is not desirable for representing inlined frames, and a
hierarchical approach may be preferred. If we want to hierarchically represent frames, the
elided frame decorator interface might be preferable.
This example approaches the issue with the elided method. This example is quite long,
but very simplistic. It is out-of-scope for this section to write a complete example that
comprehensively covers all approaches of finding and printing inlined frames. However, this
example illustrates the approach an author might use.
This example comprises of three sections.
class InlineFrameFilter():
def __init__(self):
self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
self.priority = 100
self.enabled = True
gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
The iterator for this example is as follows. It is in this section of the example where
decisions are made on the content of the backtrace.
class ElidingInlineIterator:
def __init__(self, ii):
self.input_iterator = ii
def __iter__(self):
return self
def next(self):
frame = next(self.input_iterator)
if frame.inferior_frame().type() != gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
return frame
try:
eliding_frame = next(self.input_iterator)
except StopIteration:
return frame
return ElidingFrameDecorator(eliding_frame, [frame])
This iterator implements the Python iterator protocol. When the next function is called
(when gdb prints each frame), the iterator checks if this frame decorator, frame, is wrapping
an inlined frame. If it is not, it returns the existing frame decorator untouched. If it is
wrapping an inlined frame, it assumes that the inlined frame was contained within the
next oldest frame, eliding_frame, which it fetches. It then creates and returns a frame
decorator, ElidingFrameDecorator, which contains both the elided frame, and the eliding
frame.
class ElidingInlineDecorator(FrameDecorator):
def elided(self):
return iter(self.elided_frames)
This frame decorator overrides one function and returns the inlined frame in the elided
method. As before it lets FrameDecorator do the rest of the work involved in printing this
frame. This produces the following output.
#0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
#2 0x00400529 in main () at inline.c:25
#1 0x00400529 in max (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:15
In that output, max which has been inlined into main is printed hierarchically. Another
approach would be to combine the function method, and the elided method to both print
a marker in the inlined frame, and also show the hierarchical relationship.
frame. A running gdb mantains a list of the unwinders and calls each unwinder’s sniffer in
turn until it finds the one that recognizes the current frame. There is an API to register an
unwinder.
The unwinders that come with gdb handle standard frames. However, mixed language
applications (for example, an application running Java Virtual Machine) sometimes use
frame layouts that cannot be handled by the gdb unwinders. You can write Python code
that can handle such custom frames.
You implement a frame unwinder in Python as a class with which has two attributes,
name and enabled, with obvious meanings, and a single method __call__, which examines
a given frame and returns an object (an instance of gdb.UnwindInfo class) describing it.
If an unwinder does not recognize a frame, it should return None. The code in gdb that
enables writing unwinders in Python uses this object to return frame’s ID and previous
frame registers when gdb core asks for them.
An unwinder should do as little work as possible. Some otherwise innocuous operations
can cause problems (even crashes, as this code is not not well-hardened yet). For example,
making an inferior call from an unwinder is unadvisable, as an inferior call will reset gdb’s
stack unwinding process, potentially causing re-entrant unwinding.
Unwinder Input
An object passed to an unwinder (a gdb.PendingFrame instance) provides a method to
read frame’s registers:
the frame, so a typical choice is the value of the stack pointer at the start
of the function—in the DWARF standard, this would be the “Call Frame
Address”.
This is the most common case by far. The other cases are documented
for completeness but are only useful in specialized situations.
sp, pc, special
The frame is identified by the stack address, the PC, and a “special”
address. The special address is used on architectures that can have frames
that do not change the stack, but which are still distinct, for example the
IA-64, which has a second stack for registers. Both sp and special must
be constant throughout the lifetime of the frame.
sp The frame is identified by the stack address only. Any other stack frame
with a matching sp will be considered to match this frame. Inside gdb,
this is called a “wild frame”. You will never need this.
Each attribute value should either be an instance of gdb.Value or an integer.
A helper class is provided in the gdb.unwinder module that can be used to represent
a frame-id (see [gdb.unwinder.FrameId], page 430).
PendingFrame.architecture () [Function]
Return the gdb.Architecture (see Section 23.3.2.35 [Architectures In Python],
page 481) for this gdb.PendingFrame. This represents the architecture of the
particular frame being unwound.
PendingFrame.level () [Function]
Return an integer, the stack frame level for this frame. See Section 8.1 [Stack Frames],
page 109.
PendingFrame.name () [Function]
Returns the function name of this pending frame, or None if it can’t be obtained.
PendingFrame.is_valid () [Function]
Returns true if the gdb.PendingFrame object is valid, false if not. A pending frame
object becomes invalid when the call to the unwinder, for which the pending frame
was created, returns.
All gdb.PendingFrame methods, except this one, will raise an exception if the pending
frame object is invalid at the time the method is called.
PendingFrame.pc () [Function]
Returns the pending frame’s resume address.
PendingFrame.block () [Function]
Return the pending frame’s code block (see Section 23.3.2.28 [Blocks In Python],
page 467). If the frame does not have a block – for example, if there is no debugging
information for the code in question – then this will raise a RuntimeError exception.
PendingFrame.function () [Function]
Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this pending frame. See
Section 23.3.2.29 [Symbols In Python], page 469.
430 Debugging with gdb
PendingFrame.find_sal () [Function]
Return the pending frame’s symtab and line object (see Section 23.3.2.30 [Symbol
Tables In Python], page 472).
PendingFrame.language () [Function]
Return the language of this frame, as a string, or None.
gdb.unwinder.Unwinder [class]
The Unwinder class is a base class from which user created unwinders can derive,
though it is not required that unwinders derive from this class, so long as any user
created unwinder has the required name and enabled attributes.
gdb.unwinder.Unwinder.__init__(name) [Function]
The name is a string used to reference this unwinder within some gdb com-
mands (see [Managing Registered Unwinders], page 432).
gdb.unwinder.name [Variable]
A read-only attribute which is a string, the name of this unwinder.
gdb.unwinder.enabled [Variable]
A modifiable attribute containing a boolean; when True, the unwinder is en-
abled, and will be used by gdb. When False, the unwinder has been disabled,
and will not be used.
gdb.unwinder.FrameId [class]
This is a class suitable for being used as the frame-id when calling
gdb.PendingFrame.create_unwind_info. It is not required to use this class,
any class with the required attribute (see [gdb.PendingFrame.create unwind info],
page 428) will be accepted, but in most cases this class will be sufficient.
gdb.unwinder.FrameId has the following method:
gdb.unwinder.sp [Variable]
The sp value passed to the constructor.
gdb.unwinder.pc [Variable]
The pc value passed to the constructor.
gdb.unwinder.special [Variable]
The special value passed to the constructor, or None if no such value was passed.
Registering an Unwinder
Object files and program spaces can have unwinders registered with them. In addition, you
can register unwinders globally.
The gdb.unwinders module provides the function to register an unwinder:
class MyUnwinder(Unwinder):
def __init__(self):
super().__init___("MyUnwinder_Name")
the winning xmethod worker and the winning C++ method are compared to select an overall
winner. In case of a tie between a xmethod worker and a C++ method, the xmethod worker
is selected as the winner. That is, if a winning xmethod worker is found to be equivalent
to the winning C++ method, then the xmethod worker is treated as a replacement for the
C++ method. gdb uses the overall winner to invoke the method. If the winning xmethod
worker is the overall winner, then the corresponding xmethod is invoked via the __call__
method of the worker object.
If one wants to implement an xmethod as a replacement for an existing C++ method,
then they have to implement an equivalent xmethod which has exactly the same name and
takes arguments of exactly the same type as the C++ method. If the user wants to invoke
the C++ method even though a replacement xmethod is available for that method, then
they can disable the xmethod.
See Section 23.3.2.15 [Xmethod API], page 433, for API to implement xmethods in
Python. See Section 23.3.2.16 [Writing an Xmethod], page 434, for implementing xmethods
in Python.
For gdb to lookup xmethods, the xmethod matchers should be registered using the
following function defined in the module gdb.xmethod:
private:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 435
int a_;
};
int
MyClass::operator+ (int b)
{
return a_ + b;
}
Let us define two xmethods for the class MyClass, one replacing the method geta, and
another adding an overloaded flavor of operator+ which takes a MyClass argument (the
C++ code above already has an overloaded operator+ which takes an int argument). The
xmethod matcher can be defined as follows:
class MyClass_geta(gdb.xmethod.XMethod):
def __init__(self):
gdb.xmethod.XMethod.__init__(self, ’geta’)
class MyClass_sum(gdb.xmethod.XMethod):
def __init__(self):
gdb.xmethod.XMethod.__init__(self, ’sum’)
class MyClassMatcher(gdb.xmethod.XMethodMatcher):
def __init__(self):
gdb.xmethod.XMethodMatcher.__init__(self, ’MyClassMatcher’)
# List of methods ’managed’ by this matcher
self.methods = [MyClass_geta(), MyClass_sum()]
return workers
Notice that the match method of MyClassMatcher returns a worker object of type
MyClassWorker_geta for the geta method, and a worker object of type MyClassWorker_
plus for the operator+ method. This is done indirectly via helper classes derived from
gdb.xmethod.XMethod. One does not need to use the methods attribute in a matcher
as it is optional. However, if a matcher manages more than one xmethod, it is a good
practice to list the xmethods in the methods attribute of the matcher. This will then
facilitate enabling and disabling individual xmethods via the enable/disable commands.
436 Debugging with gdb
Notice also that a worker object is returned only if the corresponding entry in the methods
attribute of the matcher is enabled.
The implementation of the worker classes returned by the matcher setup above is as
follows:
class MyClassWorker_geta(gdb.xmethod.XMethodWorker):
def get_arg_types(self):
return None
class MyClassWorker_plus(gdb.xmethod.XMethodWorker):
def get_arg_types(self):
return gdb.lookup_type(’MyClass’)
private:
int dsize_;
T *data_;
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 437
};
Let us implement an xmethod for the above class which serves as a replacement for the
footprint method. The full code listing of the xmethod workers and xmethod matchers is
as follows:
class MyTemplateWorker_footprint(gdb.xmethod.XMethodWorker):
def __init__(self, class_type):
self.class_type = class_type
def get_arg_types(self):
return None
def get_result_type(self):
return gdb.lookup_type(’int’)
class MyTemplateMatcher_footprint(gdb.xmethod.XMethodMatcher):
def __init__(self):
gdb.xmethod.XMethodMatcher.__init__(self, ’MyTemplateMatcher’)
Inferior.connection_num [Variable]
ID of inferior’s connection as assigned by gdb, or None if the inferior is not
connected to a target. See Section 4.9 [Inferiors Connections and Programs],
page 42. This is equivalent to gdb.Inferior.connection.num in the case where
gdb.Inferior.connection is not None.
Inferior.pid [Variable]
Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating system.
Inferior.was_attached [Variable]
Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using ‘attach’, or started by gdb
itself.
Inferior.main_name [Variable]
A string holding the name of this inferior’s “main” function, if it can be determined.
If the name of main is not known, this is None.
Inferior.progspace [Variable]
The inferior’s program space. See Section 23.3.2.25 [Progspaces In Python], page 459.
Inferior.arguments [Variable]
The inferior’s command line arguments, if known. This corresponds to the set args
and show args commands. See Section 4.3 [Arguments], page 38.
When accessed, the value is a string holding all the arguments. The contents are
quoted as they would be when passed to the shell. If there are no arguments, the
value is None.
Either a string or a sequence of strings can be assigned to this attribute. When a
string is assigned, it is assumed to have any necessary quoting for the shell; when a
sequence is assigned, the quoting is applied by gdb.
Inferior.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Inferior object is valid, False if not. A gdb.Inferior
object will become invalid if the inferior no longer exists within gdb. All other
gdb.Inferior methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the method
is called.
Inferior.threads () [Function]
This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid when it is called.
If there are no valid threads, the method will return an empty tuple.
Inferior.architecture () [Function]
Return the gdb.Architecture (see Section 23.3.2.35 [Architectures In Python],
page 481) for this inferior. This represents the architecture of the inferior as a whole.
Some platforms can have multiple architectures in a single address space, so this
may not match the architecture of a particular frame (see Section 23.3.2.27 [Frames
In Python], page 463).
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 439
The environment that will be passed to the inferior can be changed from Python by
using the following methods. These methods only take effect when the inferior is started –
they will not affect an inferior that is already executing.
Inferior.clear_env () [Function]
Clear the current environment variables that will be passed to this inferior.
gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
In the above example we connect our handler exit_handler to the registry
events.exited. Once connected, exit_handler gets called when the inferior exits. The
argument event in this example is of type gdb.ExitedEvent. As you can see in the
example the ExitedEvent object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of the
inferior.
Some events can be thread specific when gdb is running in non-stop mode. When
represented in Python, these events all extend gdb.ThreadEvent. This event is a base
class and is never emitted directly; instead, events which are emitted by this or other
modules might extend this event. Examples of these events are gdb.BreakpointEvent and
gdb.ContinueEvent. gdb.ThreadEvent holds the following attributes:
ThreadEvent.inferior_thread [Variable]
In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was involved
in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to None.
The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and details of the events
they emit:
events.cont
Emits gdb.ContinueEvent, which extends gdb.ThreadEvent. This event indi-
cates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For inherited attribute
refer to gdb.ThreadEvent above.
events.exited
Emits events.ExitedEvent, which indicates that the inferior has exited.
events.ExitedEvent has two attributes:
ExitedEvent.exit_code [Variable]
An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior has
returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example, gdb de-
taches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable, the attribute
does not exist.
ExitedEvent.inferior [Variable]
A reference to the inferior which triggered the exited event.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 441
events.stop
Emits gdb.StopEvent, which extends gdb.ThreadEvent.
Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
extend gdb.StopEvent. As a child of gdb.ThreadEvent, gdb.StopEvent will
indicate the stopped thread when gdb is running in non-stop mode. Refer to
gdb.ThreadEvent above for more details.
Emits gdb.SignalEvent, which extends gdb.StopEvent.
This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received a signal.
gdb.SignalEvent has the following attributes:
SignalEvent.stop_signal [Variable]
A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
signal values can be obtained by running the command info signals in
the gdb command prompt.
BreakpointEvent.breakpoints [Variable]
A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
gdb.Breakpoint) that were hit. See Section 23.3.2.32 [Breakpoints In
Python], page 475, for details of the gdb.Breakpoint object.
BreakpointEvent.breakpoint [Variable]
A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit. This attribute is main-
tained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated in favor of the
gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints attribute.
events.new_objfile
Emits gdb.NewObjFileEvent which indicates that a new object file has been
loaded by gdb. gdb.NewObjFileEvent has one attribute:
NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile [Variable]
A reference to the object file (gdb.Objfile) which has been loaded.
See Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python], page 461, for details of the
gdb.Objfile object.
events.free_objfile
Emits gdb.FreeObjFileEvent which indicates that an object file is about to
be removed from gdb. One reason this can happen is when the inferior calls
dlclose. gdb.FreeObjFileEvent has one attribute:
NewObjFileEvent.objfile [Variable]
A reference to the object file (gdb.Objfile) which will be unloaded.
See Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python], page 461, for details of the
gdb.Objfile object.
442 Debugging with gdb
events.clear_objfiles
Emits gdb.ClearObjFilesEvent which indicates that the list of object files for
a program space has been reset. gdb.ClearObjFilesEvent has one attribute:
ClearObjFilesEvent.progspace [Variable]
A reference to the program space (gdb.Progspace) whose objfile list has
been cleared. See Section 23.3.2.25 [Progspaces In Python], page 459.
events.inferior_call
Emits events just before and after a function in the inferior is
called by gdb. Before an inferior call, this emits an event of type
gdb.InferiorCallPreEvent, and after an inferior call, this emits an event of
type gdb.InferiorCallPostEvent.
gdb.InferiorCallPreEvent
Indicates that a function in the inferior is about to be called.
InferiorCallPreEvent.ptid [Variable]
The thread in which the call will be run.
InferiorCallPreEvent.address [Variable]
The location of the function to be called.
gdb.InferiorCallPostEvent
Indicates that a function in the inferior has just been called.
InferiorCallPostEvent.ptid [Variable]
The thread in which the call was run.
InferiorCallPostEvent.address [Variable]
The location of the function that was called.
events.memory_changed
Emits gdb.MemoryChangedEvent which indicates that the memory of the in-
ferior has been modified by the gdb user, for instance via a command like
set *addr = value. The event has the following attributes:
MemoryChangedEvent.address [Variable]
The start address of the changed region.
MemoryChangedEvent.length [Variable]
Length in bytes of the changed region.
events.register_changed
Emits gdb.RegisterChangedEvent which indicates that a register in the infe-
rior has been modified by the gdb user.
RegisterChangedEvent.frame [Variable]
A gdb.Frame object representing the frame in which the register was
modified.
RegisterChangedEvent.regnum [Variable]
Denotes which register was modified.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 443
events.breakpoint_created
This is emitted when a new breakpoint has been created. The argument that
is passed is the new gdb.Breakpoint object.
events.breakpoint_modified
This is emitted when a breakpoint has been modified in some way. The argu-
ment that is passed is the new gdb.Breakpoint object.
events.breakpoint_deleted
This is emitted when a breakpoint has been deleted. The argument that
is passed is the gdb.Breakpoint object. When this event is emitted, the
gdb.Breakpoint object will already be in its invalid state; that is, the is_
valid method will return False.
events.before_prompt
This event carries no payload. It is emitted each time gdb presents a prompt
to the user.
events.new_inferior
This is emitted when a new inferior is created. Note that the inferior is not
necessarily running; in fact, it may not even have an associated executable.
The event is of type gdb.NewInferiorEvent. This has a single attribute:
NewInferiorEvent.inferior [Variable]
The new inferior, a gdb.Inferior object.
events.inferior_deleted
This is emitted when an inferior has been deleted. Note that this is not the
same as process exit; it is notified when the inferior itself is removed, say via
remove-inferiors.
The event is of type gdb.InferiorDeletedEvent. This has a single attribute:
InferiorDeletedEvent.inferior [Variable]
The inferior that is being removed, a gdb.Inferior object.
events.new_thread
This is emitted when gdb notices a new thread. The event is of type
gdb.NewThreadEvent, which extends gdb.ThreadEvent. This has a single
attribute:
NewThreadEvent.inferior_thread [Variable]
The new thread.
events.thread_exited
This is emitted when gdb notices a thread has exited. The event is of type
gdb.ThreadExitedEvent which extends gdb.ThreadEvent. This has a single
attribute:
ThreadExitedEvent.inferior_thread [Variable]
The exiting thread.
444 Debugging with gdb
events.gdb_exiting
This is emitted when gdb exits. This event is not emitted if gdb exits as a
result of an internal error, or after an unexpected signal. The event is of type
gdb.GdbExitingEvent, which has a single attribute:
GdbExitingEvent.exit_code [Variable]
An integer, the value of the exit code gdb will return.
events.connection_removed
This is emitted when gdb removes a connection (see Section 23.3.2.37 [Connec-
tions In Python], page 483). The event is of type gdb.ConnectionEvent. This
has a single read-only attribute:
ConnectionEvent.connection [Variable]
The gdb.TargetConnection that is being removed.
gdb.selected_thread () [Function]
This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there is no selected
thread, this will return None.
To get the list of threads for an inferior, use the Inferior.threads() method. See
Section 23.3.2.17 [Inferiors In Python], page 437.
A gdb.InferiorThread object has the following attributes:
InferiorThread.name [Variable]
The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using thread name, then this
returns that name. Otherwise, if an OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned.
Otherwise, this returns None.
This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string object, which sets
the new name, or None, which removes any user-specified thread name.
InferiorThread.num [Variable]
The per-inferior number of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
InferiorThread.global_num [Variable]
The global ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB. You can use this to make Python
breakpoints thread-specific, for example (see [The Breakpoint.thread attribute],
page 477).
InferiorThread.ptid [Variable]
ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a tuple con-
taining three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second is the Lightweight
Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID). Either the LWPID or
TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system does not use that identifier.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 445
InferiorThread.inferior [Variable]
The inferior this thread belongs to. This attribute is represented as a gdb.Inferior
object. This attribute is not writable.
InferiorThread.details [Variable]
A string containing target specific thread state information. The format of this string
varies by target. If there is no additional state information for this thread, then this
attribute contains None.
For example, on a gnu/Linux system, a thread that is in the process of exiting
will return the string ‘Exiting’. For remote targets the details string will be ob-
tained with the ‘qThreadExtraInfo’ remote packet, if the target supports it (see
[‘qThreadExtraInfo’], page 784).
gdb displays the details string as part of the ‘Target Id’ column, in the info
threads output (see [‘info threads’], page 48).
A gdb.InferiorThread object has the following methods:
InferiorThread.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.InferiorThread object is valid, False if not. A
gdb.InferiorThread object will become invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior
that the thread belongs is deleted. All other gdb.InferiorThread methods will
throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
InferiorThread.switch () [Function]
This changes gdb’s currently selected thread to the one represented by this object.
InferiorThread.is_stopped () [Function]
Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
InferiorThread.is_running () [Function]
Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
InferiorThread.is_exited () [Function]
Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
InferiorThread.handle () [Function]
Return the thread object’s handle, represented as a Python bytes object. A
gdb.Value representation of the handle may be constructed via gdb.Value(bufobj,
type) where bufobj is the Python bytes representation of the handle and type is a
gdb.Type for the handle type.
gdb.current_recording () [Function]
Access a currently running recording. Return a gdb.Record object on success. Return
None if no recording is currently active.
gdb.stop_recording () [Function]
Stop the current recording. Throw an exception if no recording is currently active.
All record objects become invalid after this call.
Record.method [Variable]
A string with the current recording method, e.g. full or btrace.
Record.format [Variable]
A string with the current recording format, e.g. bt, pts or None.
Record.begin [Variable]
A method specific instruction object representing the first instruction in this record-
ing.
Record.end [Variable]
A method specific instruction object representing the current instruction, that is not
actually part of the recording.
Record.replay_position [Variable]
The instruction representing the current replay position. If there is no replay active,
this will be None.
Record.instruction_history [Variable]
A list with all recorded instructions.
Record.function_call_history [Variable]
A list with all recorded function call segments.
The common gdb.Instruction class that recording method specific instruction objects
inherit from, has the following attributes:
Instruction.pc [Variable]
An integer representing this instruction’s address.
Instruction.data [Variable]
A memoryview object holding the raw instruction data.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 447
Instruction.decoded [Variable]
A human readable string with the disassembled instruction.
Instruction.size [Variable]
The size of the instruction in bytes.
Additionally gdb.RecordInstruction has the following attributes:
RecordInstruction.number [Variable]
An integer identifying this instruction. number corresponds to the numbers seen
in record instruction-history (see Chapter 7 [Process Record and Replay],
page 101).
RecordInstruction.sal [Variable]
A gdb.Symtab_and_line object representing the associated symtab and line of this
instruction. May be None if no debug information is available.
RecordInstruction.is_speculative [Variable]
A boolean indicating whether the instruction was executed speculatively.
If an error occurred during recording or decoding a recording, this error is represented
by a gdb.RecordGap object in the instruction list. It has the following attributes:
RecordGap.number [Variable]
An integer identifying this gap. number corresponds to the numbers seen in record
instruction-history (see Chapter 7 [Process Record and Replay], page 101).
RecordGap.error_code [Variable]
A numerical representation of the reason for the gap. The value is specific to the
current recording method.
RecordGap.error_string [Variable]
A human readable string with the reason for the gap.
A gdb.RecordFunctionSegment object has the following attributes:
RecordFunctionSegment.number [Variable]
An integer identifying this function segment. number corresponds to the numbers
seen in record function-call-history (see Chapter 7 [Process Record and Replay],
page 101).
RecordFunctionSegment.symbol [Variable]
A gdb.Symbol object representing the associated symbol. May be None if no debug
information is available.
RecordFunctionSegment.level [Variable]
An integer representing the function call’s stack level. May be None if the function
call is a gap.
RecordFunctionSegment.instructions [Variable]
A list of gdb.RecordInstruction or gdb.RecordGap objects associated with this
function call.
448 Debugging with gdb
RecordFunctionSegment.up [Variable]
A gdb.RecordFunctionSegment object representing the caller’s function segment. If
the call has not been recorded, this will be the function segment to which control
returns. If neither the call nor the return have been recorded, this will be None.
RecordFunctionSegment.prev [Variable]
A gdb.RecordFunctionSegment object representing the previous segment of this
function call. May be None.
RecordFunctionSegment.next [Variable]
A gdb.RecordFunctionSegment object representing the next segment of this function
call. May be None.
The following example demonstrates the usage of these objects and functions to create a
function that will rewind a record to the last time a function in a different file was executed.
This would typically be used to track the execution of user provided callback functions in
a library which typically are not visible in a back trace.
def bringback ():
rec = gdb.current_recording ()
if not rec:
return
insn = rec.instruction_history
if len (insn) == 0:
return
try:
position = insn.index (rec.replay_position)
except:
position = -1
try:
filename = insn[position].sal.symtab.fullname ()
except:
filename = None
if filename == current:
continue
rec.goto (i)
return
Another possible application is to write a function that counts the number of code
executions in a given line range. This line range can contain parts of functions or span
across several functions and is not limited to be contiguous.
def countrange (filename, linerange):
count = 0
try:
if file_name in call.symbol.symtab.fullname ():
yield call
except:
pass
return count
Command.dont_repeat () [Function]
By default, a gdb command is repeated when the user enters a blank line at the
command prompt. A command can suppress this behavior by invoking the dont_
repeat method at some point in its invoke method (normally this is done early in case
of exception). This is similar to the user command dont-repeat, see Section 23.1.1
[Define], page 381.
450 Debugging with gdb
gdb.COMMAND_DATA
The command is related to data or variables. For example, call, find, and
print are in this category. Type help data at the gdb prompt to see a list of
commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_STACK
The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
backtrace, frame, and return are in this category. Type help stack at the
gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_FILES
This class is used for file-related commands. For example, file, list and
section are in this category. Type help files at the gdb prompt to see a list
of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
This should be used for “support facilities”, generally meaning things that are
useful to the user when interacting with gdb, but not related to the state of
the inferior. For example, help, make, and shell are in this category. Type
help support at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
The command is an ‘info’-related command, that is, related to the state of
gdb itself. For example, info, macro, and show are in this category. Type
help status at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, break, clear, and
delete are in this category. Type help breakpoints at the gdb prompt to see
a list of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, trace, actions, and
tfind are in this category. Type help tracepoints at the gdb prompt to see
a list of commands in this category.
gdb.COMMAND_TUI
The command has to do with the text user interface (see Chapter 25 [TUI],
page 559). Type help tui at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this
category.
gdb.COMMAND_USER
The command is a general purpose command for the user, and typically does
not fit in one of the other categories. Type help user-defined at the gdb
prompt to see a list of commands in this category, as well as the list of gdb
macros (see Section 23.1 [Sequences], page 381).
gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of general interest
to users. For example, checkpoint, fork, and stop are in this category. Type
help obscure at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
452 Debugging with gdb
gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
The command is only useful to gdb maintainers. The maintenance and
flushregs commands are in this category. Type help internals at the gdb
prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by specifying it via an
argument at initialization, or by returning it from the complete method. These predefined
completion constants are all defined in the gdb module:
gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
This constant means that no completion should be done.
gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
This constant means that location completion should be done. See Section 9.2
[Location Specifications], page 122.
gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
This constant means that completion should examine gdb command names.
gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names as
the source.
gdb.COMPLETE_EXPRESSION
This constant means that completion should be done on expressions. Often
this means completing on symbol names, but some language parsers also have
support for completing on field names.
The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be implemented in
Python:
class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
"""Greet the whole world."""
HelloWorld ()
The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the registration of the
command with gdb. Depending on how the Python code is read into gdb, you may need
to import the gdb module explicitly.
MICommand.name [Variable]
A string, the name of this gdb/mi command, as was passed to the __init__ method.
This attribute is read-only.
MICommand.installed [Variable]
A boolean value indicating if this command is installed ready for a user to call from
the command line. Commands are automatically installed when they are instantiated,
after which this attribute will be True.
454 Debugging with gdb
If later, a new command is created with the same name, then the original command
will become uninstalled, and this attribute will be False.
This attribute is read-write, setting this attribute to False will uninstall the com-
mand, removing it from the set of available commands. Setting this attribute to
True will install the command for use. If there is already a Python command with
this name installed, the currently installed command will be uninstalled, and this
command installed in its stead.
The following code snippet shows how some trivial MI commands can be implemented
in Python:
class MIEcho(gdb.MICommand):
"""Echo arguments passed to the command."""
MIEcho("-echo-dict", "dict")
MIEcho("-echo-list", "list")
MIEcho("-echo-string", "string")
The last three lines instantiate the class three times, creating three new gdb/mi
commands -echo-dict, -echo-list, and -echo-string. Each time a subclass of
gdb.MICommand is instantiated, the new command is automatically registered with gdb.
Depending on how the Python code is read into gdb, you may need to import the gdb
module explicitly.
The following example shows a gdb session in which the above commands have been
added:
(gdb)
-echo-dict abc def ghi
^done,dict={argv=["abc","def","ghi"]}
(gdb)
-echo-list abc def ghi
^done,list=["abc","def","ghi"]
(gdb)
-echo-string abc def ghi
^done,string="abc, def, ghi"
(gdb)
Conversely, it is possible to execute gdb/mi commands from Python, with the re-
sults being a Python object and not a specially-formatted string. This is done with the
gdb.execute_mi function.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 455
Here is how this works using the commands from the example above:
(gdb) python print(gdb.execute_mi("-echo-dict", "abc", "def", "ghi"))
{’dict’: {’argv’: [’abc’, ’def’, ’ghi’]}}
(gdb) python print(gdb.execute_mi("-echo-list", "abc", "def", "ghi"))
{’list’: [’abc’, ’def’, ’ghi’]}
(gdb) python print(gdb.execute_mi("-echo-string", "abc", "def", "ghi"))
{’string’: ’abc, def, ghi’}
If parameter class is not PARAM_ENUM, then the presence of a fourth argument will
cause an exception to be thrown.
The help text for the new parameter includes the Python documentation string from
the parameter’s class, if there is one. If there is no documentation string, a default
value is used. The documentation string is included in the output of the parameters
help set and help show commands, and should be written taking this into account.
Parameter.set_doc [Variable]
If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as the first part of the
help text for this parameter’s set command. The second part of the help text is
taken from the documentation string for the parameter’s class, if there is one.
The value of set_doc should give a brief summary specific to the set action, this text
is only displayed when the user runs the help set command for this parameter. The
class documentation should be used to give a fuller description of what the parameter
does, this text is displayed for both the help set and help show commands.
The set_doc value is examined when Parameter.__init__ is invoked; subsequent
changes have no effect.
Parameter.show_doc [Variable]
If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as the first part of the
help text for this parameter’s show command. The second part of the help text is
taken from the documentation string for the parameter’s class, if there is one.
The value of show_doc should give a brief summary specific to the show action, this
text is only displayed when the user runs the help show command for this parameter.
The class documentation should be used to give a fuller description of what the pa-
rameter does, this text is displayed for both the help set and help show commands.
The show_doc value is examined when Parameter.__init__ is invoked; subsequent
changes have no effect.
Parameter.value [Variable]
The value attribute holds the underlying value of the parameter. It can be read and
assigned to just as any other attribute. gdb does validation when assignments are
made.
There are two methods that may be implemented in any Parameter class. These are:
When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The available types are
represented by constants defined in the gdb module:
gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, True and False are
the only valid values.
gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
The value has three possible states: true, false, and ‘auto’. In Python, true and
false are represented using boolean constants, and ‘auto’ is represented using
None.
gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
The value is an unsigned integer. The value of None should be interpreted to
mean “unlimited” (literal ’unlimited’ can also be used to set that value), and
the value of 0 is reserved and should not be used.
gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
The value is a signed integer. The value of None should be interpreted to mean
“unlimited” (literal ’unlimited’ can also be used to set that value), and the
value of 0 is reserved and should not be used.
gdb.PARAM_STRING
The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape sequences,
such as ‘\t’, ‘\f’, and octal escapes, are translated into corresponding characters
and encoded into the current host charset.
gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are passed
through untranslated.
gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
The value is a either a filename (a string), or None.
458 Debugging with gdb
gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
The value is a filename. This is just like PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE, but uses file
names for completion.
gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
The value is a signed integer. This is like PARAM_INTEGER, except that 0 is
allowed and the value of None is not supported.
gdb.PARAM_ZUINTEGER
The value is an unsigned integer. This is like PARAM_UINTEGER, except that 0
is allowed and the value of None is not supported.
gdb.PARAM_ZUINTEGER_UNLIMITED
The value is a signed integer. This is like PARAM_INTEGER including that the
value of None should be interpreted to mean “unlimited” (literal ’unlimited’
can also be used to set that value), except that 0 is allowed, and the value
cannot be negative, except the special value -1 is returned for the setting of
“unlimited”.
gdb.PARAM_ENUM
The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string constants provided
when the parameter is created.
Greet ()
The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the registration of the
function with gdb. Depending on how the Python code is read into gdb, you may need to
import the gdb module explicitly.
Now you can use the function in an expression:
(gdb) print $greet("Bob")
$1 = "Hello, Bob!"
Progspace.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Progspace object is valid, False if not. A gdb.Progspace
object can become invalid if the program space file it refers to is not referenced by
any inferior. All other gdb.Progspace methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
at the time the method is called.
Progspace.objfiles () [Function]
Return a sequence of all the objfiles referenced by this program space. See
Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python], page 461.
One may add arbitrary attributes to gdb.Progspace objects in the usual Python way.
This is useful if, for example, one needs to do some extra record keeping associated with
the program space.
In this contrived example, we want to perform some processing when an objfile with
a certain symbol is loaded, but we only want to do this once because it is expensive. To
achieve this we record the results with the program space because we can’t predict when
the desired objfile will be loaded.
(gdb) python
def clear_objfiles_handler(event):
event.progspace.expensive_computation = None
def expensive(symbol):
"""A mock routine to perform an "expensive" computation on symbol."""
print ("Computing the answer to the ultimate question ...")
return 42
def new_objfile_handler(event):
objfile = event.new_objfile
progspace = objfile.progspace
if not hasattr(progspace, ’expensive_computation’) or \
progspace.expensive_computation is None:
# We use ’main’ for the symbol to keep the example simple.
# Note: There’s no current way to constrain the lookup
# to one objfile.
symbol = gdb.lookup_global_symbol(’main’)
if symbol is not None:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 461
progspace.expensive_computation = expensive(symbol)
gdb.events.clear_objfiles.connect(clear_objfiles_handler)
gdb.events.new_objfile.connect(new_objfile_handler)
end
(gdb) file /tmp/hello
Reading symbols from /tmp/hello...
Computing the answer to the ultimate question ...
(gdb) python print gdb.current_progspace().expensive_computation
42
(gdb) run
Starting program: /tmp/hello
Hello.
[Inferior 1 (process 4242) exited normally]
gdb.current_objfile () [Function]
When auto-loading a Python script (see Section 23.3.3 [Python Auto-loading],
page 495), gdb sets the “current objfile” to the corresponding objfile. This function
returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile, this function returns None.
gdb.objfiles () [Function]
Return a sequence of objfiles referenced by the current program space.
See Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python], page 461, and Section 23.3.2.25
[Progspaces In Python], page 459. This is identical to gdb.selected_
inferior().progspace.objfiles() and is included for historical compatibility.
Objfile.filename [Variable]
The file name of the objfile as a string, with symbolic links resolved.
462 Debugging with gdb
The value is None if the objfile is no longer valid. See the gdb.Objfile.is_valid
method, described below.
Objfile.username [Variable]
The file name of the objfile as specified by the user as a string.
The value is None if the objfile is no longer valid. See the gdb.Objfile.is_valid
method, described below.
Objfile.is_file [Variable]
An objfile often comes from an ordinary file, but in some cases it may be constructed
from the contents of memory. This attribute is True for file-backed objfiles, and False
for other kinds.
Objfile.owner [Variable]
For separate debug info objfiles this is the corresponding gdb.Objfile object that
debug info is being provided for. Otherwise this is None. Separate debug info obj-
files are added with the gdb.Objfile.add_separate_debug_file method, described
below.
Objfile.build_id [Variable]
The build ID of the objfile as a string. If the objfile does not have a build ID then
the value is None.
This is supported only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF
format for binary files and the gnu Binutils. For more details about this feature, see
the description of the --build-id command-line option in Section “Command Line
Options” in The GNU Linker.
Objfile.progspace [Variable]
The containing program space of the objfile as a gdb.Progspace object. See
Section 23.3.2.25 [Progspaces In Python], page 459.
Objfile.pretty_printers [Variable]
The pretty_printers attribute is a list of functions. It is used to look up pretty-
printers. A Value is passed to each function in order; if the function returns None,
then the search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object which is
used to format the value. See Section 23.3.2.6 [Pretty Printing API], page 413, for
more information.
Objfile.type_printers [Variable]
The type_printers attribute is a list of type printer objects. See Section 23.3.2.9
[Type Printing API], page 418, for more information.
Objfile.frame_filters [Variable]
The frame_filters attribute is a dictionary of frame filter objects. See
Section 23.3.2.10 [Frame Filter API], page 419, for more information.
One may add arbitrary attributes to gdb.Objfile objects in the usual Python way.
This is useful if, for example, one needs to do some extra record keeping associated with
the objfile.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 463
In this contrived example we record the time when gdb loaded the objfile.
(gdb) python
import datetime
def new_objfile_handler(event):
# Set the time_loaded attribute of the new objfile.
event.new_objfile.time_loaded = datetime.datetime.today()
gdb.events.new_objfile.connect(new_objfile_handler)
end
(gdb) file ./hello
Reading symbols from ./hello...
(gdb) python print gdb.objfiles()[0].time_loaded
2014-10-09 11:41:36.770345
A gdb.Objfile object has the following methods:
Objfile.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Objfile object is valid, False if not. A gdb.Objfile object
can become invalid if the object file it refers to is not loaded in gdb any longer. All
other gdb.Objfile methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the
method is called.
Objfile.add_separate_debug_file (file) [Function]
Add file to the list of files that gdb will search for debug information for the objfile.
This is useful when the debug info has been removed from the program and stored
in a separate file. gdb has built-in support for finding separate debug info files (see
Section 18.3 [Separate Debug Files], page 294), but if the file doesn’t live in one of
the standard places that gdb searches then this function can be used to add a debug
info file from a different place.
Objfile.lookup_global_symbol (name [, domain]) [Function]
Search for a global symbol named name in this objfile. Optionally, the search scope
can be restricted with the domain argument. The domain argument must be a domain
constant defined in the gdb module and described in Section 23.3.2.29 [Symbols In
Python], page 469. This function is similar to gdb.lookup_global_symbol, except
that the search is limited to this objfile.
The result is a gdb.Symbol object or None if the symbol is not found.
Objfile.lookup_static_symbol (name [, domain]) [Function]
Like Objfile.lookup_global_symbol, but searches for a global symbol with static
linkage named name in this objfile.
gdb.selected_frame () [Function]
Return the selected frame object. (see Section 8.3 [Selecting a Frame], page 113).
gdb.newest_frame () [Function]
Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
gdb.invalidate_cached_frames [Function]
gdb internally keeps a cache of the frames that have been unwound. This function
invalidates this cache.
This function should not generally be called by ordinary Python code. It is docu-
mented for the sake of completeness.
Frame.is_valid () [Function]
Returns true if the gdb.Frame object is valid, false if not. A frame object can become
invalid if the frame it refers to doesn’t exist anymore in the inferior. All gdb.Frame
methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
Frame.name () [Function]
Returns the function name of the frame, or None if it can’t be obtained.
Frame.architecture () [Function]
Returns the gdb.Architecture object corresponding to the frame’s architecture. See
Section 23.3.2.35 [Architectures In Python], page 481.
Frame.type () [Function]
Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
An ordinary stack frame.
gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
A fake stack frame that was created by gdb when performing an inferior
function call.
gdb.INLINE_FRAME
A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined into
a gdb.NORMAL_FRAME that is older than this one.
gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
A frame representing a tail call. See Section 11.2 [Tail Call Frames],
page 192.
gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when it
calls into a signal handler.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 465
gdb.ARCH_FRAME
A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
This is like gdb.NORMAL_FRAME, but it is only used for the newest frame.
Frame.unwind_stop_reason () [Function]
Return an integer representing the reason why it’s not possible to find more frames
toward the outermost frame. Use gdb.frame_stop_reason_string to convert the
value returned by this function to a string. The value can be one of:
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
No particular reason (older frames should be available).
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
The previous frame’s analyzer returns an invalid result. This is no longer
used by gdb, and is kept only for backward compatibility.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
This frame is the outermost.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the values
of registers or memory that have not been collected.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame, but we
got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of unwinder failure. It
could also indicate stack corruption.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means that unwind-
ing further would almost certainly give us another frame with exactly the
same ID, so break the chain. Normally, this is a sign of unwinder failure.
It could also indicate stack corruption.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed one to
unwind further.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_MEMORY_ERROR
The frame unwinder caused an error while trying to access memory.
gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind of
error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests for errors in
unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if the list of the other
values is modified in future gdb versions. Using it, you could write:
reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
print ("An error occurred: %s" % reason_str)
466 Debugging with gdb
Frame.pc () [Function]
Returns the frame’s resume address.
Frame.block () [Function]
Return the frame’s code block. See Section 23.3.2.28 [Blocks In Python], page 467. If
the frame does not have a block – for example, if there is no debugging information
for the code in question – then this will throw an exception.
Frame.function () [Function]
Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame. See Section 23.3.2.29
[Symbols In Python], page 469.
Frame.older () [Function]
Return the frame that called this frame. If this is the oldest frame, return None.
Frame.newer () [Function]
Return the frame called by this frame. If this is the newest frame, return None.
Frame.find_sal () [Function]
Return the frame’s symtab and line object. See Section 23.3.2.30 [Symbol Tables In
Python], page 472.
Frame.select () [Function]
Set this frame to be the selected frame. See Chapter 8 [Examining the Stack],
page 109.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 467
Frame.level () [Function]
Return an integer, the stack frame level for this frame. See Section 8.1 [Stack Frames],
page 109.
Frame.language () [Function]
Return a string, the source language for this frame.
{
/* ’inner’ is in a block whose superblock is the one holding
’local’. */
int inner;
Block.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Block object is valid, False if not. A block object can
become invalid if the block it refers to doesn’t exist anymore in the inferior. All other
gdb.Block methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is
called. The block’s validity is also checked during iteration over symbols of the block.
Block.start [Variable]
The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
Block.end [Variable]
One past the last address that appears in the block. This attribute is not writable.
Block.function [Variable]
The name of the block represented as a gdb.Symbol. If the block is not named, then
this attribute holds None. This attribute is not writable.
For ordinary function blocks, the superblock is the static block. However, you should
note that it is possible for a function block to have a superblock that is not the static
block – for instance this happens for an inlined function.
Block.superblock [Variable]
The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist, this attribute
holds None. This attribute is not writable.
Block.global_block [Variable]
The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not writable.
Block.static_block [Variable]
The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not writable.
Block.is_global [Variable]
True if the gdb.Block object is a global block, False if not. This attribute is not
writable.
Block.is_static [Variable]
True if the gdb.Block object is a static block, False if not. This attribute is not
writable.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 469
Symbol.is_argument [Variable]
True if the symbol is an argument of a function.
Symbol.is_constant [Variable]
True if the symbol is a constant.
Symbol.is_function [Variable]
True if the symbol is a function or a method.
Symbol.is_variable [Variable]
True if the symbol is a variable.
A gdb.Symbol object has the following methods:
Symbol.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Symbol object is valid, False if not. A gdb.Symbol object
can become invalid if the symbol it refers to does not exist in gdb any longer. All
other gdb.Symbol methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the
method is called.
Symbol.value ([frame]) [Function]
Compute the value of the symbol, as a gdb.Value. For functions, this computes the
address of the function, cast to the appropriate type. If the symbol requires a frame
in order to compute its value, then frame must be given. If frame is not given, or if
frame is invalid, then this method will throw an exception.
The available domain categories in gdb.Symbol are represented as constants in the gdb
module:
gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the following
domains apply. This usually indicates an error either in the symbol information
or in gdb’s handling of symbols.
gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum type
values.
gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
gdb.SYMBOL_MODULE_DOMAIN
This domain contains names of Fortran module types.
gdb.SYMBOL_COMMON_BLOCK_DOMAIN
This domain contains names of Fortran common blocks.
The available address class categories in gdb.Symbol are represented as constants in the
gdb module:
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in the symbol
information or in gdb’s handling of symbols.
472 Debugging with gdb
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
Value is constant int.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
Value is at a fixed address.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
Value is in a register.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the symbol inside
the frame’s argument list.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
Value address is stored in the frame’s argument list. Just like LOC_ARG except
that the value’s address is stored at the offset, not the value itself.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
Value is a specified register. Just like LOC_REGISTER except the register holds
the address of the argument instead of the argument itself.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
Value is a local variable.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
Value not used. Symbols in the domain SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN all have this
class.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LABEL
Value is a label.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
Value is a block.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
Value is a byte-sequence.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be determined
from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is referenced.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
The value does not actually exist in the program.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
The value’s address is a computed location.
gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMMON_BLOCK
The value’s address is a symbol. This is only used for Fortran common blocks.
For more information on gdb’s symbol table management, see Chapter 16 [Examining
the Symbol Table], page 259, for more information.
A gdb.Symtab_and_line object has the following attributes:
Symtab_and_line.symtab [Variable]
The symbol table object (gdb.Symtab) for this frame. This attribute is not writable.
Symtab_and_line.pc [Variable]
Indicates the start of the address range occupied by code for the current source line.
This attribute is not writable.
Symtab_and_line.last [Variable]
Indicates the end of the address range occupied by code for the current source line.
This attribute is not writable.
Symtab_and_line.line [Variable]
Indicates the current line number for this object. This attribute is not writable.
Symtab_and_line.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Symtab_and_line object is valid, False if not. A
gdb.Symtab_and_line object can become invalid if the Symbol table and line object
it refers to does not exist in gdb any longer. All other gdb.Symtab_and_line
methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
Symtab.filename [Variable]
The symbol table’s source filename. This attribute is not writable.
Symtab.objfile [Variable]
The symbol table’s backing object file. See Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python],
page 461. This attribute is not writable.
Symtab.producer [Variable]
The name and possibly version number of the program that compiled the code in
the symbol table. The contents of this string is up to the compiler. If no producer
information is available then None is returned. This attribute is not writable.
Symtab.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the gdb.Symtab object is valid, False if not. A gdb.Symtab object
can become invalid if the symbol table it refers to does not exist in gdb any longer.
All other gdb.Symtab methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at the time the
method is called.
Symtab.fullname () [Function]
Return the symbol table’s source absolute file name.
474 Debugging with gdb
Symtab.global_block () [Function]
Return the global block of the underlying symbol table. See Section 23.3.2.28 [Blocks
In Python], page 467.
Symtab.static_block () [Function]
Return the static block of the underlying symbol table. See Section 23.3.2.28 [Blocks
In Python], page 467.
Symtab.linetable () [Function]
Return the line table associated with the symbol table. See Section 23.3.2.31 [Line
Tables In Python], page 474.
LineTableEntry.line [Variable]
The source line number for this line table entry. This number corresponds to the
actual line of source. This attribute is not writable.
LineTableEntry.pc [Variable]
The address that is associated with the line table entry where the executable code for
that source line resides in memory. This attribute is not writable.
As there can be multiple addresses for a single source line, you may receive multiple
LineTableEntry objects with matching line attributes, but with different pc attributes.
The iterator is sorted in ascending pc order. Here is a small example illustrating iterating
over a line table.
symtab = gdb.selected_frame().find_sal().symtab
linetable = symtab.linetable()
for line in linetable:
print ("Line: "+str(line.line)+" Address: "+hex(line.pc))
This will have the following output:
Line: 33 Address: 0x4005c8L
Line: 37 Address: 0x4005caL
Line: 39 Address: 0x4005d2L
Line: 40 Address: 0x4005f8L
Line: 42 Address: 0x4005ffL
Line: 44 Address: 0x400608L
Line: 42 Address: 0x40060cL
Line: 45 Address: 0x400615L
In addition to being able to iterate over a LineTable, it also has the following direct
access methods:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 475
LineTable.source_lines () [Function]
Return a Python List of the source line numbers in the symbol table. Only lines
with executable code locations are returned. The contents of the List will just be
the source line entries represented as Python Long values.
You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e., step, next, etc.), alter the
current frame context (i.e., change the current active frame), or alter, add or delete
any breakpoint. As a general rule, you should not alter any data within gdb or the
inferior at this time.
Example stop implementation:
class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
def stop (self):
inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
if inf_val == 3:
return True
return False
Breakpoint.is_valid () [Function]
Return True if this Breakpoint object is valid, False otherwise. A Breakpoint
object can become invalid if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object
still exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of watchpoint scope,
the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the inferior leaves the scope of that
watchpoint.
Breakpoint.delete () [Function]
Permanently deletes the gdb breakpoint. This also invalidates the Python
Breakpoint object. Any further access to this object’s attributes or methods will
raise an error.
Breakpoint.enabled [Variable]
This attribute is True if the breakpoint is enabled, and False otherwise. This at-
tribute is writable. You can use it to enable or disable the breakpoint.
Breakpoint.silent [Variable]
This attribute is True if the breakpoint is silent, and False otherwise. This attribute
is writable.
Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the first command
is silent. This is not reported by the silent attribute.
Breakpoint.pending [Variable]
This attribute is True if the breakpoint is pending, and False otherwise. See
Section 5.1.1 [Set Breaks], page 58. This attribute is read-only.
Breakpoint.thread [Variable]
If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread’s global id. If the
breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is None. This attribute is writable.
Breakpoint.task [Variable]
If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task id. If the
breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying language is not Ada), this attribute
is None. This attribute is writable.
Breakpoint.ignore_count [Variable]
This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer. This attribute
is writable.
478 Debugging with gdb
Breakpoint.number [Variable]
This attribute holds the breakpoint’s number — the identifier used by the user to
manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.type [Variable]
This attribute holds the breakpoint’s type — the identifier used to determine the
actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.visible [Variable]
This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user when set, or when
the ‘info breakpoints’ command is run. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.temporary [Variable]
This attribute indicates whether the breakpoint was created as a temporary break-
point. Temporary breakpoints are automatically deleted after that breakpoint has
been hit. Access to this attribute, and all other attributes and functions other than
the is_valid function, will result in an error after the breakpoint has been hit (as it
has been automatically deleted). This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.hit_count [Variable]
This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer. This attribute is
writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
Breakpoint.location [Variable]
This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by the user. It is a
string. If the breakpoint does not have a location (that is, it is a watchpoint) the
attribute’s value is None. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.locations [Variable]
Get the most current list of breakpoint locations that are inserted for this breakpoint,
with elements of type gdb.BreakpointLocation (described below). This functional-
ity matches that of the info breakpoint command (see Section 5.1.1 [Set Breaks],
page 58), in that it only retrieves the most current list of locations, thus the list itself
when returned is not updated behind the scenes. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.expression [Variable]
This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by the user. It is a string.
If the breakpoint does not have an expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint)
the attribute’s value is None. This attribute is not writable.
Breakpoint.condition [Variable]
This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by the user. It is
a string. If there is no condition, this attribute’s value is None. This attribute is
writable.
Breakpoint.commands [Variable]
This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If there are com-
mands, this attribute’s value is a string holding all the commands, separated by
newlines. If there are no commands, this attribute is None. This attribute is writable.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 479
Breakpoint Locations
A breakpoint location is one of the actual places where a breakpoint has been set, rep-
resented in the Python API by the gdb.BreakpointLocation type. This type is never
instantiated by the user directly, but is retrieved from Breakpoint.locations which re-
turns a list of breakpoint locations where it is currently set. Breakpoint locations can
become invalid if new symbol files are loaded or dynamically loaded libraries are closed.
Accessing the attributes of an invalidated breakpoint location will throw a RuntimeError
exception. Access the Breakpoint.locations attribute again to retrieve the new and valid
breakpoints location list.
BreakpointLocation.source [Variable]
This attribute returns the source file path and line number where this location was
set. The type of the attribute is a tuple of string and long. If the breakpoint location
doesn’t have a source location, it returns None, which is the case for watchpoints
and catchpoints. This will throw a RuntimeError exception if the location has been
invalidated. This attribute is not writable.
BreakpointLocation.address [Variable]
This attribute returns the address where this location was set. This attribute is
of type long. This will throw a RuntimeError exception if the location has been
invalidated. This attribute is not writable.
BreakpointLocation.enabled [Variable]
This attribute holds the value for whether or not this location is enabled. This
attribute is writable (boolean). This will throw a RuntimeError exception if the
location has been invalidated.
BreakpointLocation.owner [Variable]
This attribute holds a reference to the gdb.Breakpoint owner object, from which
this gdb.BreakpointLocation was retrieved from. This will throw a RuntimeError
exception if the location has been invalidated. This attribute is not writable.
BreakpointLocation.function [Variable]
This attribute gets the name of the function where this location was set. If no function
could be found this attribute returns None. This will throw a RuntimeError exception
if the location has been invalidated. This attribute is not writable.
BreakpointLocation.fullname [Variable]
This attribute gets the full name of where this location was set. If no full name could
be found, this attribute returns None. This will throw a RuntimeError exception if
the location has been invalidated. This attribute is not writable.
BreakpointLocation.thread_groups [Variable]
This attribute gets the thread groups it was set in. It returns a List of the thread
group ID’s. This will throw a RuntimeError exception if the location has been inval-
idated. This attribute is not writable.
480 Debugging with gdb
FinishBreakpoint.return_value [Variable]
When gdb is stopped at a finish breakpoint and the frame used to build the
gdb.FinishBreakpoint object had debug symbols, this attribute will contain a
gdb.Value object corresponding to the return value of the function. The value will
be None if the function return type is void or if the return value was not computable.
This attribute is not writable.
LazyString.value () [Function]
Convert the gdb.LazyString to a gdb.Value. This value will point to the string
in memory, but will lose all the delayed retrieval, encoding and handling that gdb
applies to a gdb.LazyString.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 481
LazyString.address [Variable]
This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not writable.
LazyString.length [Variable]
This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the length is -1, then
the string will be fetched and encoded up to the first null of appropriate width. This
attribute is not writable.
LazyString.encoding [Variable]
This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string when the string
is printed by gdb. If the encoding is not set, or contains an empty string, then gdb
will select the most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
is not writable.
LazyString.type [Variable]
This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string’s type. For a lazy
string this is a pointer or array type. To resolve this to the lazy string’s character
type, use the type’s target method. See Section 23.3.2.5 [Types In Python], page 407.
This attribute is not writable.
Architecture.register_groups () [Function]
Return a gdb.RegisterGroupsIterator (see Section 23.3.2.36 [Registers In Python],
page 482) for all of the register groups available for the gdb.Architecture.
RegisterDescriptor.name [Variable]
The name of this register.
It is also possible to lookup a register descriptor based on its name using the following
gdb.RegisterDescriptorIterator function:
Python code can also request from a gdb.Architecture information about the set of
register groups available on a given architecture (see [Architecture.register_groups],
page 482).
Every register can be a member of zero or more register groups. Some register groups are
used internally within gdb to control things like which registers must be saved when calling
into the program being debugged (see Section 17.5 [Calling Program Functions], page 277).
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 483
Other register groups exist to allow users to easily see related sets of registers in commands
like info registers (see [info registers reggroup], page 175).
The register groups information is returned as a gdb.RegisterGroupsIterator, which
is an iterator that in turn returns gdb.RegisterGroup objects.
A gdb.RegisterGroup object has the following read-only properties:
RegisterGroup.name [Variable]
A string that is the name of this register group.
TargetConnection.is_valid () [Function]
Return True if the gdb.TargetConnection object is valid, False if not. A
gdb.TargetConnection will become invalid if the connection no longer exists within
gdb, this might happen when no inferiors are using the connection, but could be
delayed until the user replaces the current target.
Reading any of the gdb.TargetConnection properties will throw an exception if the
connection is invalid.
TargetConnection.num [Variable]
An integer assigned by gdb to uniquely identify this connection. This is the same
value as displayed in the ‘Num’ column of the info connections command output
(see Section 4.9 [info connections], page 42).
484 Debugging with gdb
TargetConnection.type [Variable]
A string that describes what type of connection this is. This string will be one of
the valid names that can be passed to the target command (see Section 19.2 [target
command], page 303).
TargetConnection.description [Variable]
A string that gives a short description of this target type. This is the same string that
is displayed in the ‘Description’ column of the info connection command output
(see Section 4.9 [info connections], page 42).
TargetConnection.details [Variable]
An optional string that gives additional information about this connection. This
attribute can be None if there are no additional details for this connection.
An example of a connection type that might have additional details is the ‘remote’
connection, in this case the details string can contain the ‘hostname:port’ that was
used to connect to the remote target.
name is the name of the new window. It’s an error to try to replace one of the
built-in windows, but other window types can be replaced. The name should match
the regular expression [a-zA-Z][-_.a-zA-Z0-9]*, it is an error to try and create a
window with an invalid name.
function is a factory function that is called to create the TUI window. This is called
with a single argument of type gdb.TuiWindow, described below. It should return an
object that implements the TUI window protocol, also described below.
TuiWindow.is_valid () [Function]
This method returns True when this window is valid. When the user changes the TUI
layout, windows no longer visible in the new layout will be destroyed. At this point,
the gdb.TuiWindow will no longer be valid, and methods (and attributes) other than
is_valid will throw an exception.
When the TUI is disabled using tui disable (see Section 25.5 [tui disable], page 562)
the window is hidden rather than destroyed, but is_valid will still return False and
other methods (and attributes) will still throw an exception.
TuiWindow.width [Variable]
This attribute holds the width of the window. It is not writable.
TuiWindow.height [Variable]
This attribute holds the height of the window. It is not writable.
TuiWindow.title [Variable]
This attribute holds the window’s title, a string. This is normally displayed above
the window. This attribute can be modified.
TuiWindow.erase () [Function]
Remove all the contents of the window.
The factory function that you supply should return an object conforming to the TUI
window protocol. These are the method that can be called on this object, which is referred
to below as the “window object”. The methods documented below are optional; if the object
does not implement one of these methods, gdb will not attempt to call it. Additional new
methods may be added to the window protocol in the future. gdb guarantees that they will
begin with a lower-case letter, so you can start implementation methods with upper-case
letters or underscore to avoid any future conflicts.
486 Debugging with gdb
Window.close () [Function]
When the TUI window is closed, the gdb.TuiWindow object will be put into an invalid
state. At this time, gdb will call close method on the window object.
After this method is called, gdb will discard any references it holds on this window
object, and will no longer call methods on this object.
Window.render () [Function]
In some situations, a TUI window can change size. For example, this can happen if
the user resizes the terminal, or changes the layout. When this happens, gdb will
call the render method on the window object.
If your window is intended to update in response to changes in the inferior, you will
probably also want to register event listeners and send output to the gdb.TuiWindow.
gdb.disassembler.DisassembleInfo [class]
Disassembly is driven by instances of this class. Each time gdb needs to disassemble
an instruction, an instance of this class is created and passed to a registered disas-
sembler. The disassembler is then responsible for disassembling an instruction and
returning a result.
Instances of this type are usually created within gdb, however, it is possible to create
a copy of an instance of this type, see the description of __init__ for more details.
This class has the following properties and methods:
DisassembleInfo.address [Variable]
A read-only integer containing the address at which gdb wishes to disassemble
a single instruction.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 487
DisassembleInfo.architecture [Variable]
The gdb.Architecture (see Section 23.3.2.35 [Architectures In Python],
page 481) for which gdb is currently disassembling, this property is read-only.
DisassembleInfo.progspace [Variable]
The gdb.Progspace (see Section 23.3.2.25 [Program Spaces In Python],
page 459) for which gdb is currently disassembling, this property is read-only.
DisassembleInfo.is_valid () [Function]
Returns True if the DisassembleInfo object is valid, False if not. A
DisassembleInfo object will become invalid once the disassembly call
for which the DisassembleInfo was created, has returned. Calling other
DisassembleInfo methods, or accessing DisassembleInfo properties, will
raise a RuntimeError exception if it is invalid.
gdb.disassembler.Disassembler [class]
This is a base class from which all user implemented disassemblers must inherit.
was a problem accessing the required memory, this will then be displayed by
gdb within the disassembler output.
Ideally, the only three outcomes from invoking __call__ would be a return
of None, a successful disassembly returned in a DisassemblerResult, or a
MemoryError indicating that there was a problem reading memory.
However, as an implementation of __call__ could fail due to other reasons,
e.g. some external resource required to perform disassembly is temporarily un-
available, then, if __call__ raises a GdbError, the exception will be converted
to a string and printed at the end of the disassembly output, the disassembly
request will then stop.
Any other exception type raised by the __call__ method is considered an
error in the user code, the exception will be printed to the error stream accord-
ing to the set python print-stack setting (see [set python print-stack],
page 392).
gdb.disassembler.DisassemblerResult [class]
This class represents the result of disassembling a single instruction. An
instance of this class will be returned from builtin_disassemble (see
[builtin disassemble], page 494), and an instance of this class should be returned
from Disassembler.__call__ (see [Disassembler Class], page 488) if an instruction
was successfully disassembled.
It is not possible to sub-class the DisassemblerResult class.
The DisassemblerResult class has the following properties and methods:
DisassemblerResult.length [Variable]
A read-only property containing the length of the disassembled instruction in
bytes, this will always be greater than zero.
490 Debugging with gdb
DisassemblerResult.string [Variable]
A read-only property containing a non-empty string representing the disassem-
bled instruction. The string is a representation of the disassembled instruction
without any styling information. To see how the instruction will be styled use
the parts property.
If this instance was initialized using separate DisassemblerPart objects,
the string property will still be valid. The string value is created by
concatenating the DisassemblerPart.string values of each component part
(see [Disassembler Styling Parts], page 490).
DisassemblerResult.parts [Variable]
A read-only property containing a non-empty sequence of DisassemblerPart
objects. Each DisassemblerPart object contains a small part of the instruction
along with information about how that part should be styled. gdb uses this
information to create styled disassembler output (see [set style disassembler
enabled], page 361).
If this instance was initialized using a single string rather than with a
sequence of DisassemblerPart objects, the parts property will still be valid.
In this case the parts property will hold a sequence containing a single
DisassemblerTextPart object, the string of which will represent the entire
instruction, and the style of which will be STYLE_TEXT.
gdb.disassembler.DisassemblerPart [class]
This is a parent class from which the different part sub-classes inherit. Only instances
of the sub-classes detailed below will be returned by the Python API.
It is not possible to directly create instances of either this parent class, or any of the
sub-classes listed below. Instances of the sub-classes listed below are created by calling
builtin_disassemble (see [builtin disassemble], page 494) and are returned within
the DisassemblerResult object, or can be created by calling the text_part and
address_part methods on the DisassembleInfo class (see [DisassembleInfo Class],
page 486).
The DisassemblerPart class has a single property:
DisassemblerPart.string [Variable]
A read-only property that contains a non-empty string representing this part of
the disassembled instruction. The string within this property doesn’t include
any styling information.
gdb.disassembler.DisassemblerTextPart [class]
The DisassemblerTextPart class represents a piece of the disassembled instruction
and the associated style for that piece. Instances of this class can’t be created directly,
instead call DisassembleInfo.text_part to create a new instance of this class (see
[DisassembleInfo Class], page 486).
As well as the properties of its parent class, the DisassemblerTextPart has the
following additional property:
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 491
DisassemblerTextPart.style [Variable]
A read-only property that contains one of the defined style constants. gdb
will use this style when styling this part of the disassembled instruction (see
[Disassembler Style Constants], page 491).
gdb.disassembler.DisassemblerAddressPart [class]
The DisassemblerAddressPart class represents an absolute address within
a disassembled instruction. Using a DisassemblerAddressPart instead of a
DisassemblerTextPart with STYLE_ADDRESS is preferred, gdb will display the
address as both an absolute address, and will look up a suitable symbol to display
next to the address. Using DisassemblerAddressPart also ensures that user
settings such as set print max-symbolic-offset are respected.
Here is an example of an x86-64 instruction:
call 0x401136 <foo>
In this instruction the 0x401136 <foo> was generated from a single
DisassemblerAddressPart. The 0x401136 will be styled with STYLE_ADDRESS, and
foo will be styled with STYLE_SYMBOL. The < and > will be styled as STYLE_TEXT.
If the inclusion of the symbol name is not required then a DisassemblerTextPart
with style STYLE_ADDRESS can be used instead.
Instances of this class can’t be created directly, instead call DisassembleInfo.address_
part to create a new instance of this class (see [DisassembleInfo Class], page 486).
As well as the properties of its parent class, the DisassemblerAddressPart has the
following additional property:
DisassemblerAddressPart.address [Variable]
A read-only property that contains the address passed to this object’s __init__
method.
The following table lists all of the disassembler styles that are available. gdb maps
these style constants onto its style settings (see Section 22.5 [Output Styling], page 361). In
some cases, several style constants produce the same style settings, and thus will produce
the same visual effect on the screen. This could change in future releases of gdb, so care
should be taken to select the correct style constant to ensure correct output styling in future
releases of gdb.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_TEXT
This is the default style used by gdb when styling disassembler output. This
style should be used for any parts of the instruction that don’t fit any of the
other styles listed below. gdb styles text with this style using its default style.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_MNEMONIC
This style is used for styling the primary instruction mnemonic, which usually
appears at, or near, the start of the disassembled instruction string.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler mnemonic style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_SUB_MNEMONIC
This style is used for styling any sub-mnemonics within a disassembled instruc-
tion. A sub-mnemonic is any text within the instruction that controls the
492 Debugging with gdb
function of the instruction, but which is disjoint from the primary mnemonic
(which will have styled STYLE_MNEMONIC).
As an example, consider this AArch64 instruction:
add w16, w7, w1, lsl #1
The add is the primary instruction mnemonic, and would be given style STYLE_
MNEMONIC, while lsl is the sub-mnemonic, and would be given the style STYLE_
SUB_MNEMONIC.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler mnemonic style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_ASSEMBLER_DIRECTIVE
Sometimes a series of bytes doesn’t decode to a valid instruction. In this case
the disassembler may choose to represent the result of disassembling using an
assembler directive, for example:
.word 0x1234
In this case, the .word would be give the STYLE_ASSEMBLER_DIRECTIVE style.
An assembler directive is similar to a mnemonic in many ways but is something
that is not part of the architecture’s instruction set.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler mnemonic style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_REGISTER
This style is used for styling any text that represents a register name, or register
number, within a disassembled instruction.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler register style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_ADDRESS
This style is used for styling numerical values that represent absolute addresses
within the disassembled instruction.
When creating a DisassemblerTextPart with this style, you should consider
if a DisassemblerAddressPart would be more appropriate. See [Disassembler
Styling Parts], page 490, for a description of what each part offers.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler address style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_ADDRESS_OFFSET
This style is used for styling numerical values that represent offsets to addresses
within the disassembled instruction. A value is considered an address offset
when the instruction itself is going to access memory, and the value is being
used to offset which address is accessed.
For example, an architecture might have an instruction that loads from mem-
ory using an address within a register. If that instruction also allowed for an
immediate offset to be encoded into the instruction, this would be an address
offset. Similarly, a branch instruction might jump to an address in a register
plus an address offset that is encoded into the instruction.
gdb styles text with this style using the disassembler immediate style setting.
gdb.disassembler.STYLE_IMMEDIATE
Use STYLE_IMMEDIATE for any numerical values within a disassembled instruc-
tion when those values are not addresses, address offsets, or register numbers
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 493
Here is an example that registers a global disassembler. The new disassembler invokes
the builtin disassembler, and then adds a comment, ## Comment, to each line of disassembly
output:
class ExampleDisassembler(gdb.disassembler.Disassembler):
def __init__(self):
super().__init__("ExampleDisassembler")
gdb.disassembler.register_disassembler(ExampleDisassembler())
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 495
class NibbleSwapDisassembler(gdb.disassembler.Disassembler):
def __init__(self):
super().__init__("NibbleSwapDisassembler")
gdb.disassembler.register_disassembler(NibbleSwapDisassembler())
Example:
(gdb) info auto-load python-scripts
Loaded Script
Yes py-section-script.py
full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
No my-foo-pretty-printers.py
When reading an auto-loaded file or script, gdb sets the current objfile. This is avail-
able via the gdb.current_objfile function (see Section 23.3.2.26 [Objfiles In Python],
page 461). This can be useful for registering objfile-specific pretty-printers and frame-filters.
23.3.4.1 gdb.printing
This module provides a collection of utilities for working with pretty-printers.
PrettyPrinter (name, subprinters=None)
This class specifies the API that makes ‘info pretty-printer’, ‘enable
pretty-printer’ and ‘disable pretty-printer’ work. Pretty-printers
should generally inherit from this class.
SubPrettyPrinter (name)
For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the corresponding
API for the subprinters.
RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (name)
Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via regular expres-
sions. See Section 23.3.2.8 [Writing a Pretty-Printer], page 415, for an example.
FlagEnumerationPrinter (name)
A pretty-printer which handles printing of enum values. Unlike gdb’s built-
in enum printing, this printer attempts to work properly when there is some
overlap between the enumeration constants. The argument name is the name
of the printer and also the name of the enum type to look up.
register_pretty_printer (obj, printer, replace=False)
Register printer with the pretty-printer list of obj. If replace is True then any
existing copy of the printer is replaced. Otherwise a RuntimeError exception
is raised if a printer with the same name already exists.
23.3.4.2 gdb.types
This module provides a collection of utilities for working with gdb.Type objects.
get_basic_type (type)
Return type with const and volatile qualifiers stripped, and with typedefs and
C++ references converted to the underlying type.
C++ example:
typedef const int const_int;
const_int foo (3);
const_int& foo_ref (foo);
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 497
get_type_recognizers ()
Return a list of the enabled type recognizers for the current context. This
is called by gdb during the type-printing process (see Section 23.3.2.9 [Type
Printing API], page 418).
apply_type_recognizers (recognizers, type_obj)
Apply the type recognizers, recognizers, to the type object type obj. If any
recognizer returns a string, return that string. Otherwise, return None. This
is called by gdb during the type-printing process (see Section 23.3.2.9 [Type
Printing API], page 418).
register_type_printer (locus, printer)
This is a convenience function to register a type printer printer. The printer
must implement the type printer protocol. The locus argument is either
a gdb.Objfile, in which case the printer is registered with that objfile; a
gdb.Progspace, in which case the printer is registered with that progspace; or
None, in which case the printer is registered globally.
498 Debugging with gdb
TypePrinter
This is a base class that implements the type printer protocol. Type printers are
encouraged, but not required, to derive from this class. It defines a constructor:
23.3.4.3 gdb.prompt
This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
substitute_prompt (string)
Return string with escape sequences substituted by values. Some escape se-
quences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside “{}” immediately
following the escape sequence.
The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
\\ Substitute a backslash.
\e Substitute an ESC character.
\f Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame param-
eter.
\n Substitute a newline.
\p Substitute a parameter’s value; the argument names the parameter.
\r Substitute a carriage return.
\t Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread pa-
rameter.
\v Substitute the version of GDB.
\w Substitute the current working directory.
\[ Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the
string length. Example: “\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]” will return
a blue-colored “(gdb)” prompt where the length is five.
\] End a sequence of non-printing characters.
For example:
substitute_prompt ("frame: \f, args: \p{print frame-arguments}")
guile-repl
gr The guile-repl command can be used to start an interactive Guile prompt or
repl. To return to gdb, type ,q or the EOF character (e.g., Ctrl-D on an empty
prompt). These commands do not take any arguments.
guile [scheme-expression]
gu [scheme-expression]
The guile command can be used to evaluate a Scheme expression.
If given an argument, gdb will pass the argument to the Guile interpreter for
evaluation.
(gdb) guile (display (+ 20 3)) (newline)
23
The result of the Scheme expression is displayed using normal Guile rules.
(gdb) guile (+ 20 3)
23
If you do not provide an argument to guile, it will act as a multi-line command,
like define. In this case, the Guile script is made up of subsequent command
lines, given after the guile command. This command list is terminated using
a line containing end. For example:
(gdb) guile
>(display 23)
>(newline)
>end
23
source script-name
The script name must end with ‘.scm’ and gdb must be configured to recognize
the script language based on filename extension using the script-extension
setting. See Chapter 23 [Extending GDB], page 381.
guile (load "script-name")
This method uses the load Guile function. It takes a string argument that is
the name of the script to load. See the Guile documentation for a description
of this function. (see Section “Loading” in GNU Guile Reference Manual).
The rest of this manual assumes the gdb module has been imported without any prefix.
See the Guile documentation for use-modules for more information (see Section “Using
Guile Modules” in GNU Guile Reference Manual).
Example:
(gdb) guile (value-type (make-value 1))
ERROR: Unbound variable: value-type
Error while executing Scheme code.
(gdb) guile (use-modules (gdb))
(gdb) guile (value-type (make-value 1))
int
(gdb)
The (gdb) module provides these basic Guile functions.
<gdb:command>
See Section 23.4.3.11 [Commands In Guile], page 521.
<gdb:exception>
See Section 23.4.3.4 [Guile Exception Handling], page 504.
<gdb:frame>
See Section 23.4.3.15 [Frames In Guile], page 529.
<gdb:iterator>
See Section 23.4.3.25 [Iterators In Guile], page 547.
<gdb:lazy-string>
See Section 23.4.3.20 [Lazy Strings In Guile], page 542.
<gdb:objfile>
See Section 23.4.3.14 [Objfiles In Guile], page 529.
<gdb:parameter>
See Section 23.4.3.12 [Parameters In Guile], page 525.
<gdb:pretty-printer>
See Section 23.4.3.8 [Guile Pretty Printing API], page 517.
<gdb:pretty-printer-worker>
See Section 23.4.3.8 [Guile Pretty Printing API], page 517.
<gdb:progspace>
See Section 23.4.3.13 [Progspaces In Guile], page 528.
<gdb:symbol>
See Section 23.4.3.17 [Symbols In Guile], page 534.
<gdb:symtab>
See Section 23.4.3.18 [Symbol Tables In Guile], page 537.
<gdb:sal>
See Section 23.4.3.18 [Symbol Tables In Guile], page 537.
<gdb:type>
See Section 23.4.3.7 [Types In Guile], page 512.
<gdb:field>
See Section 23.4.3.7 [Types In Guile], page 512.
<gdb:value>
See Section 23.4.3.5 [Values From Inferior In Guile], page 505.
The following gdb objects are managed internally so that the Scheme function eq? may
be applied to them.
504 Debugging with gdb
<gdb:arch>
<gdb:block>
<gdb:breakpoint>
<gdb:frame>
<gdb:objfile>
<gdb:progspace>
<gdb:symbol>
<gdb:symtab>
<gdb:type>
23.4.3.4 Guile Exception Handling
When executing the guile command, Guile exceptions uncaught within the Guile code
are translated to calls to the gdb error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
guile does not handle the error, gdb will terminate it and report the error according to
the setting of the guile print-stack parameter.
The guile print-stack parameter has three settings:
none Nothing is printed.
message An error message is printed containing the Guile exception name, the associated
value, and the Guile call stack backtrace at the point where the exception was
raised. Example:
(gdb) guile (display foo)
ERROR: In procedure memoize-variable-access!:
ERROR: Unbound variable: foo
Error while executing Scheme code.
gdb errors that happen in gdb commands invoked by Guile code are converted to Guile
exceptions. The type of the Guile exception depends on the error.
Guile procedures provided by gdb can throw the standard Guile exceptions like
wrong-type-arg and out-of-range.
User interrupt (via C-c or by typing q at a pagination prompt) is translated to a Guile
signal exception with value SIGINT.
gdb Guile procedures can also throw these exceptions:
gdb:error
This exception is a catch-all for errors generated from within gdb.
gdb:invalid-object
This exception is thrown when accessing Guile objects that wrap underlying
gdb objects have become invalid. For example, a <gdb:breakpoint> object
becomes invalid if the user deletes it from the command line. The object still
exists in Guile, but the object it represents is gone. Further operations on this
breakpoint will throw this exception.
gdb:memory-error
This exception is thrown when an operation tried to access invalid memory in
the inferior.
gdb:pp-type-error
This exception is thrown when a Guile pretty-printer passes a bad object to
gdb.
The following exception-related procedures are provided by the (gdb) module.
$1 = #t
A <gdb:value> that represents a function can be executed via inferior function call with
value-call. Any arguments provided to the call must match the function’s prototype, and
must be provided in the order specified by that prototype.
For example, some-val is a <gdb:value> instance representing a function that takes
two integers as arguments. To execute this function, call it like so:
(define result (value-call some-val 10 20))
Any values returned from a function call are <gdb:value> objects.
Note: Unlike Python scripting in gdb, inferior values that are simple scalars cannot be
used directly in Scheme expressions that are valid for the value’s data type. For example,
(+ (parse-and-eval "int_variable") 2) does not work. And inferior values that are
structures or instances of some class cannot be accessed using any special syntax, instead
value-field must be used.
The following value-related procedures are provided by the (gdb) module.
TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
TYPE_CODE_FUNC
The type is a function.
TYPE_CODE_INT
The type is an integer type.
TYPE_CODE_FLT
A floating point type.
TYPE_CODE_VOID
The special type void.
TYPE_CODE_SET
A Pascal set type.
TYPE_CODE_RANGE
A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
TYPE_CODE_STRING
A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with language-
defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
A string of bits. It is deprecated.
TYPE_CODE_ERROR
An unknown or erroneous type.
TYPE_CODE_METHOD
A method type, as found in C++.
TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
A pointer-to-member-function.
TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
A pointer-to-member.
TYPE_CODE_REF
A reference type.
TYPE_CODE_RVALUE_REF
A C++11 rvalue reference type.
TYPE_CODE_CHAR
A character type.
TYPE_CODE_BOOL
A boolean type.
TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
A complex float type.
TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
A typedef to some other type.
516 Debugging with gdb
TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
A C++ namespace.
TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
A decimal floating point type.
TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
A function internal to gdb. This is the type used to represent convenience
functions (see Section 10.13 [Convenience Funs], page 170).
gdb.TYPE_CODE_XMETHOD
A method internal to gdb. This is the type used to represent xmethods (see
Section 23.3.2.16 [Writing an Xmethod], page 434).
gdb.TYPE_CODE_FIXED_POINT
A fixed-point number.
gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
A Fortran namelist.
Further support for types is provided in the (gdb types) Guile module (see
Section 23.4.5.2 [Guile Types Module], page 550).
Each field is represented as an object of type <gdb:field>.
The following field-related procedures are provided by the (gdb) module:
(and tag
(string-prefix? "std::string<" tag)
(make-my-string-printer value))))
Then to register this printer in the global printer list:
(append-pretty-printer!
(make-pretty-printer "my-string" str-lookup-function))
The example lookup function extracts the value’s type, and attempts to match it to a
type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the printer can pretty-print, it will return a
<gdb:pretty-printer-worker> object. If not, it returns #f.
We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Guile package. If your
pretty-printers are for use with a library, we further recommend embedding a version number
into the package name. This practice will enable gdb to load multiple versions of your
pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have different names.
You should write auto-loaded code (see Section 23.4.4 [Guile Auto-loading], page 549)
such that it can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An ideal auto-
load file will consist solely of imports of your printer modules, followed by a call to a register
pretty-printers with the current objfile.
Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple inferiors, each potentially
using a different library version. Embedding a version number in the Guile package name
will ensure that gdb is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously. Then, because the
search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and because your auto-loaded code took care
to register your library’s printers with a specific objfile, gdb will find the correct printers
for the specific version of the library used by each inferior.
To continue the my::string example, this code might appear in (my-project my-
library v1):
(use-modules (gdb))
(define (register-printers objfile)
(append-objfile-pretty-printer!
(make-pretty-printer "my-string" str-lookup-function)))
And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
(use-modules (gdb) (my-project my-library v1))
(register-printers (current-objfile))
The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer. There are a few things that can
be improved on. The printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has several
types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type in the library, but one could
also have a single lookup function recognize several types. The latter is the conventional
way this is handled. If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its subprinters
are the printers for the individual data types.
The (gdb printing) module provides a formal way of solving this problem (see
Section 23.4.5.1 [Guile Printing Module], page 550). Here is another example that handles
multiple types.
These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
struct foo { int a, b; };
struct bar { struct foo x, y; };
Here are the printers:
(define (make-foo-printer value)
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 521
(define (build-pretty-printer)
(let ((pp (make-pretty-printer-collection "my-library")))
(pp-collection-add-tag-printer "foo" make-foo-printer)
(pp-collection-add-tag-printer "bar" make-bar-printer)
pp))
And here is the autoload support:
(use-modules (gdb) (my-library))
(append-objfile-pretty-printer! (current-objfile) (build-pretty-printer))
Finally, when this printer is loaded into gdb, here is the corresponding output of ‘info
pretty-printer’:
(gdb) info pretty-printer
my_library.so:
my-library
foo
bar
(gdb) guile
(register-command! (make-command "test-user-error"
#:command-class COMMAND_OBSCURE
#:invoke (lambda (self arg from-tty)
(throw-user-error "Bad argument ~a" arg))))
end
(gdb) test-user-error ugh
ERROR: Bad argument ugh
When a new command is registered, it will have been declared as a member of some
general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level commands in the on-line help
system; note that prefix commands are not listed under their own category but rather
that of their top-level command. The available classifications are represented by constants
defined in the gdb module:
COMMAND_NONE
The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in this
category will not be displayed in any of the help categories. This is the default.
COMMAND_RUNNING
The command is related to running the inferior. For example, start, step,
and continue are in this category. Type help running at the gdb prompt to
see a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_DATA
The command is related to data or variables. For example, call, find, and
print are in this category. Type help data at the gdb prompt to see a list of
commands in this category.
524 Debugging with gdb
COMMAND_STACK
The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
backtrace, frame, and return are in this category. Type help stack at the
gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_FILES
This class is used for file-related commands. For example, file, list and
section are in this category. Type help files at the gdb prompt to see a list
of commands in this category.
COMMAND_SUPPORT
This should be used for “support facilities”, generally meaning things that are
useful to the user when interacting with gdb, but not related to the state of
the inferior. For example, help, make, and shell are in this category. Type
help support at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_STATUS
The command is an ‘info’-related command, that is, related to the state of
gdb itself. For example, info, macro, and show are in this category. Type
help status at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, break, clear, and
delete are in this category. Type help breakpoints at the gdb prompt to see
a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, trace, actions, and
tfind are in this category. Type help tracepoints at the gdb prompt to see
a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_USER
The command is a general purpose command for the user, and typically does
not fit in one of the other categories. Type help user-defined at the gdb
prompt to see a list of commands in this category, as well as the list of gdb
macros (see Section 23.1 [Sequences], page 381).
COMMAND_OBSCURE
The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of general interest
to users. For example, checkpoint, fork, and stop are in this category. Type
help obscure at the gdb prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
The command is only useful to gdb maintainers. The maintenance and
flushregs commands are in this category. Type help internals at the gdb
prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by specifying it via
an argument at initialization, or by returning it from the completer procedure. These
predefined completion constants are all defined in the gdb module:
COMPLETE_NONE
This constant means that no completion should be done.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 525
COMPLETE_FILENAME
This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
COMPLETE_LOCATION
This constant means that location completion should be done. See Section 9.2
[Location Specifications], page 122.
COMPLETE_COMMAND
This constant means that completion should examine gdb command names.
COMPLETE_SYMBOL
This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names as
the source.
COMPLETE_EXPRESSION
This constant means that completion should be done on expressions. Often
this means completing on symbol names, but some language parsers also have
support for completing on field names.
The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be implemented in
Guile:
(gdb) guile
(register-command! (make-command "hello-world"
#:command-class COMMAND_USER
#:doc "Greet the whole world."
#:invoke (lambda (self args from-tty) (display "Hello, World!\n"))))
end
(gdb) hello-world
Hello, World!
this can be illustrated with the set print set of parameters. If name is print foo,
then print will be searched as the prefix parameter. In this case the parameter
can subsequently be accessed in gdb as set print foo. If name consists of multiple
words, and no prefix parameter group can be found, an exception is raised.
The result is the <gdb:parameter> object representing the parameter. The parameter
is not usable until it has been registered with gdb with register-parameter!.
The rest of the arguments are optional.
The argument command-class should be one of the ‘COMMAND_’ constants (see
Section 23.4.3.11 [Commands In Guile], page 521). This argument tells gdb how to
categorize the new parameter in the help system. The default is COMMAND_NONE.
The argument parameter-type should be one of the ‘PARAM_’ constants defined below.
This argument tells gdb the type of the new parameter; this information is used for
input validation and completion. The default is PARAM_BOOLEAN.
If parameter-type is PARAM_ENUM, then enum-list must be a list of strings. These
strings represent the possible values for the parameter.
If parameter-type is not PARAM_ENUM, then the presence of enum-list will cause an
exception to be thrown.
The argument set-func is a function of one argument: self which is the
<gdb:parameter> object representing the parameter. gdb will call this function
when a parameter’s value has been changed via the set API (for example, set
foo off). The value of the parameter has already been set to the new value. This
function must return a string to be displayed to the user. gdb will add a trailing
newline if the string is non-empty. gdb generally doesn’t print anything when a
parameter is set, thus typically this function should return ‘""’. A non-empty string
result should typically be used for displaying warnings and errors.
The argument show-func is a function of two arguments: self which is the
<gdb:parameter> object representing the parameter, and svalue which is the string
representation of the current value. gdb will call this function when a parameter’s
show API has been invoked (for example, show foo). This function must return a
string, and will be displayed to the user. gdb will add a trailing newline.
The argument doc is the help text for the new parameter. If there is no documentation
string, a default value is used.
The argument set-doc is the help text for this parameter’s set command.
The argument show-doc is the help text for this parameter’s show command.
The argument initial-value specifies the initial value of the parameter. If it is a
function, it takes one parameter, the <gdb:parameter> object and its result is used
as the initial value of the parameter. The initial value must be valid for the parameter
type, otherwise an exception is thrown.
FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
This frame is the outermost.
FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the values
of registers or memory that have not been collected.
FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame, but we
got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of unwinder failure. It
could also indicate stack corruption.
FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means that unwind-
ing further would almost certainly give us another frame with exactly the
same ID, so break the chain. Normally, this is a sign of unwinder failure.
It could also indicate stack corruption.
FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed one to
unwind further.
FRAME_UNWIND_MEMORY_ERROR
The frame unwinder caused an error while trying to access memory.
FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind of
error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests for errors in
unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if the list of the other
values is modified in future gdb versions. Using it, you could write:
(define reason (frame-unwind-stop-readon (selected-frame)))
(define reason-str (unwind-stop-reason-string reason))
(if (>= reason FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR)
(format #t "An error occurred: ~s\n" reason-str))
{
/* ’inner’ is in a block whose superblock is the one holding
’local’. */
int inner;
SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
Value address is stored in the frame’s argument list. Just like LOC_ARG except
that the value’s address is stored at the offset, not the value itself.
SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
Value is a specified register. Just like LOC_REGISTER except the register holds
the address of the argument instead of the argument itself.
SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
Value is a local variable.
SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
Value not used. Symbols in the domain SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN all have this
class.
SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
Value is a block.
SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
Value is a byte-sequence.
SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be determined
from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is referenced.
SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
The value does not actually exist in the program.
SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
The value’s address is a computed location.
The available watchpoint types are represented by constants defined in the (gdb)
module:
WP_READ Read only watchpoint.
WP_WRITE Write only watchpoint.
WP_ACCESS
Read/Write watchpoint.
register-breakpoint! breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Add breakpoint, a <gdb:breakpoint> object, to gdb’s list of breakpoints. The break-
point must have been created with make-breakpoint. One cannot register break-
points that have been created outside of Guile. Once a breakpoint is registered it
becomes ‘valid’. It is an error to register an already registered breakpoint. The
result is unspecified.
delete-breakpoint! breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Remove breakpoint from gdb’s list of breakpoints. This also invalidates the Guile
breakpoint object. Any further attempt to access the object will throw an exception.
If breakpoint was created from Guile with make-breakpoint it may be re-registered
with gdb, in which case the breakpoint becomes valid again.
breakpoints [Scheme Procedure]
Return a list of all breakpoints. Each element of the list is a <gdb:breakpoint>
object.
breakpoint? object [Scheme Procedure]
Return #t if object is a <gdb:breakpoint> object, and #f otherwise.
breakpoint-valid? breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Return #t if breakpoint is valid, #f otherwise. Breakpoints created with
make-breakpoint are marked as invalid until they are registered with gdb with
register-breakpoint!. A <gdb:breakpoint> object can become invalid if the
user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still exists, but the underlying
breakpoint does not. In the cases of watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid
even if execution of the inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
breakpoint-number breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Return the breakpoint’s number — the identifier used by the user to manipulate the
breakpoint.
breakpoint-temporary? breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Return #t if the breakpoint was created as a temporary breakpoint. Temporary break-
points are automatically deleted after they’ve been hit. Calling this procedure, and all
other procedures other than breakpoint-valid? and register-breakpoint!, will
result in an error after the breakpoint has been hit (since it has been automatically
deleted).
breakpoint-type breakpoint [Scheme Procedure]
Return the breakpoint’s type — the identifier used to determine the actual breakpoint
type or use-case.
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 541
Each architecture provides a set of predefined types, obtained by the following functions.
Example:
(gdb) guile (type-name (arch-uchar-type (current-arch)))
"unsigned char"
not specified but size is specified, then all instructions whose start address falls in the
closed memory address interval from start-pc to (start-pc + size - 1) are returned. If
neither size nor count are specified, then a single instruction at start-pc is returned.
Each element of the returned list is an alist (associative list) with the following keys:
address The value corresponding to this key is a Guile integer of the memory
address of the instruction.
asm The value corresponding to this key is a string value which represents the
instruction with assembly language mnemonics. The assembly language
flavor used is the same as that specified by the current CLI variable
disassembly-flavor. See Section 9.6 [Machine Code], page 131.
length The value corresponding to this key is the length of the instruction in
bytes.
Loaded Script
Yes scm-section-script.scm
full name: /tmp/scm-section-script.scm
No my-foo-pretty-printers.scm
When reading an auto-loaded file, gdb sets the current objfile. This is available via the
current-objfile procedure (see Section 23.4.3.14 [Objfiles In Guile], page 529). This can
be useful for registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible between Unix and
MS-Windows hosts.
add-auto-load-scripts-directory [directories...]
Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
gdb does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way. gdb will load the
associated script every time the corresponding objfile is opened. So your -gdb.ext file
should be careful to avoid errors if it is evaluated more than once.
SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
Chapter 23: Extending gdb 553
performed the request (e.g., has returned the pretty-printed form of a value). This extends
to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens while, for example, trying to
pretty-print an object then the error is reported and any following extension languages are
not tried.
557
24 Command Interpreters
gdb supports multiple command interpreters, and some command infrastructure to allow
users or user interface writers to switch between interpreters or run commands in other
interpreters.
gdb currently supports two command interpreters, the console interpreter (sometimes
called the command-line interpreter or cli) and the machine interface interpreter (or
gdb/mi). This manual describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
By default, gdb will start with the console interpreter. However, the user may choose to
start gdb with another interpreter by specifying the -i or --interpreter startup options.
Defined interpreters include:
console The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
used interpreter with gdb. With no interpreter specified at runtime, gdb will
use this interpreter.
dap When gdb has been built with Python support, it also supports the Debugger
Adapter Protocol. This protocol can be used by a debugger GUI or an IDE to
communicate with gdb. This protocol is documented at https://microsoft.
github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/. See Chapter 29 [Debugger Adapter
Protocol], page 679, for information about gdb extensions to the protocol.
mi The newest gdb/mi interface (currently mi3). Used primarily by programs
wishing to use gdb as a backend for a debugger GUI or an IDE. For more
information, see Chapter 27 [The gdb/mi Interface], page 569.
mi3 The gdb/mi interface introduced in gdb 9.1.
mi2 The gdb/mi interface introduced in gdb 6.0.
You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using
the appropriate command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
interpreter-exec command:
interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
gdb/mi has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of gdb which
support gdb/mi version 2 (or greater).
Note that interpreter-exec only changes the interpreter for the duration of the spec-
ified command. It does not change the interpreter permanently.
Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is possible to run an
independent interpreter on a specified input/output device (usually a tty).
For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a gdb console view.
It may do so by embedding a terminal emulator widget in its GUI, starting gdb in the
traditional command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that terminal, and
then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified input/output device. The console
interpreter created by gdb at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal
widget, while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with gdb using the separate MI
interpreter.
To start a new secondary user interface running MI, use the new-ui command:
new-ui interpreter tty
558 Debugging with gdb
The interpreter parameter specifies the interpreter to run. This accepts the same values
as the interpreter-exec command. For example, ‘console’, ‘mi’, ‘mi2’, etc. The tty
parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the interpreter uses for input/output,
usually the name of a pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
(gdb) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
runs an MI interpreter on /dev/pts/9.
559
C-x o Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings (like
scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command gives the
focus to the next TUI window.
Think of it as the Emacs C-x o binding.
This key binding uses the bindable Readline function tui-other-window.
C-x s Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single keys to gdb
commands (see Section 25.3 [TUI Single Key Mode], page 561).
This key binding uses the bindable Readline function next-keymap.
The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
PgUp Scroll the active window one page up.
PgDn Scroll the active window one page down.
Up Scroll the active window one line up.
Down Scroll the active window one line down.
Left Scroll the active window one column left.
Right Scroll the active window one column right.
C-L Refresh the screen.
Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they are not available
for their normal use by readline unless the command window has the focus. When another
window is active, you must use other readline key bindings such as C-p, C-n, C-b and C-f
to control the command window.
w where
Other keys temporarily switch to the gdb command prompt. The key that was pressed
is inserted in the editing buffer so that it is possible to type most gdb commands without
interaction with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI SingleKey
mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave this mode is by typing q or C-x s.
If gdb was built with Readline 8.0 or later, the TUI SingleKey keymap will be named
‘SingleKey’. This can be used in .inputrc to add additional bindings to this keymap.
The set of currently visible windows must always fill the terminal, and so, it is
only possible to resize on window if there are other visible windows that can
either give or receive the extra terminal space.
C-c C-s Execute to another source line, like the gdb step command; also update the
display window to show the current file and location.
C-c C-n Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function calls, like the
gdb next command. Then update the display window to show the current file
and location.
C-c C-i Execute one instruction, like the gdb stepi command; update display window
accordingly.
C-c C-f Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the gdb finish command.
C-c C-r Continue execution of your program, like the gdb continue command.
C-c < Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument (see Section
“Numeric Arguments” in The gnu Emacs Manual), like the gdb up command.
C-c > Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
gdb down command.
In any source file, the Emacs command C-x SPC (gud-break) tells gdb to set a break-
point on the source line point is on.
In text command mode, if you type M-x speedbar, Emacs displays a separate frame
which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current. Move point to any frame in the
stack and type RET to make it become the current frame and display the associated source
in the source buffer. Alternatively, click Mouse-2 to make the selected frame become the
current one. In graphical mode, the speedbar displays watch expressions.
If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get it back is to type
the command f in the gdb buffer, to request a frame display; when you run under Emacs,
this recreates the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current frame.
The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers which are visiting the
source files in the usual way. You can edit the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep
in mind that gdb communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or delete
lines from the text, the line numbers that gdb knows cease to correspond properly with the
code.
A more detailed description of Emacs’ interaction with gdb is given in the Emacs manual
(see Section “Debuggers” in The gnu Emacs Manual).
569
27.3.1.2 Language
The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected. By default, the
current language (see [show language], page 225) is used. But for commands known to be
language-sensitive, it is recommended to use the ‘--language’ option. This option takes
one argument, which is the name of the language to use while executing the command. For
instance:
-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
^done,value="4"
(gdb)
The valid language names are the same names accepted by the ‘set language’ command
(see Section 15.1.2 [Manually], page 224), excluding ‘auto’, ‘local’ or ‘unknown’.
When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the target in the
context of that thread may not work, or may work only on some targets. In particular,
commands that try to operate on thread’s stack will not work, on any target. Commands
that read memory, or modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target.
Note that even commands that operate on global state, such as print, set, and breakpoint
commands, still access the target in the context of a specific thread, so frontend should try
to find a stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the ‘--thread’
option).
Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is highly target dependent.
However, the two commands -exec-interrupt, to stop a thread, and -thread-info, to
find the state of a thread, will always work.
The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the target, MI can have a global
list of threads, because most commands that accept the ‘--thread’ option do not need to
know what process that thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce neither
additional ‘--process’ option, nor an notion of the current process in the MI interface. The
only strictly new feature that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
into processes.
To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary hierarchy of ma-
chines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a thread group. Thread group is a
collection of threads and other thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier,
a type, and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new command, -list-
thread-groups, returns the list of top-level thread groups, which correspond to processes
that gdb is debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group to the
-list-thread-groups command, it is possible to obtain the members of specific thread
group.
To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he wishes to de-
bug, a concept of available thread group is introduced. Available thread group is an
thread group that gdb is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the -target-
attach command. The list of available top-level thread groups can be obtained using
‘-list-thread-groups --available’. In general, the content of a thread group may be
only retrieved only after attaching to that thread group.
Thread groups are related to inferiors (see Section 4.9 [Inferiors Connections and Pro-
grams], page 42). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special type ‘process’,
and some additional operations are permitted on such thread groups.
result-record 7→
[ token ] "^" result-class ( "," result )* nl
out-of-band-record 7→
async-record | stream-record
async-record 7→
exec-async-output | status-async-output | notify-async-output
exec-async-output 7→
[ token ] "*" async-output nl
status-async-output 7→
[ token ] "+" async-output nl
notify-async-output 7→
[ token ] "=" async-output nl
async-output 7→
async-class ( "," result )*
result-class 7→
"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"
async-class 7→
"stopped" | others (where others will be added depending on the needs—this
is still in development).
result 7→ variable "=" value
variable 7→
string
value 7→ const | tuple | list
const 7→ c-string
tuple 7→ "{}" | "{" result ( "," result )* "}"
list 7→ "[]" | "[" value ( "," value )* "]" | "[" result ( "," result )* "]"
stream-record 7→
console-stream-output | target-stream-output | log-stream-output
console-stream-output 7→
"~" c-string nl
target-stream-output 7→
"@" c-string nl
log-stream-output 7→
"&" c-string nl
nl 7→ CR | CR-LF
token 7→ any sequence of digits.
Notes:
• All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 575
• The token is from the corresponding request. Note that for all async output, while
the token is allowed by the grammar and may be output by future versions of gdb for
select async output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat all async
output as reporting general changes in the state of the target and there should be no
need to associate async output to any prior command.
• status-async-output contains on-going status information about the progress of a slow
operation. It can be discarded. All status output is prefixed by ‘+’.
• exec-async-output contains asynchronous state change on the target (stopped, started,
disappeared). All async output is prefixed by ‘*’.
• notify-async-output contains supplementary information that the client should handle
(e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify output is prefixed by ‘=’.
• console-stream-output is output that should be displayed as is in the console. It is the
textual response to a CLI command. All the console output is prefixed by ‘~’.
• target-stream-output is the output produced by the target program. All the target
output is prefixed by ‘@’.
• log-stream-output is output text coming from gdb’s internals, for instance messages
that should be displayed as part of an error log. All the log output is prefixed by ‘&’.
• New gdb/mi commands should only output lists containing values.
See Section 27.7.2 [gdb/mi Stream Records], page 577, for more details about the various
output records.
If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level will be increased by one.
The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible with the old versions. Old versions
of MI remain available, allowing front ends to keep using them until they are modified to
use the latest MI version.
Since --interpreter=mi always points to the latest MI version, it is recommended that
front ends request a specific version of MI when launching gdb (e.g. --interpreter=mi2)
to make sure they get an interpreter with the MI version they expect.
The following table gives a summary of the released versions of the MI interface: the
version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared and the breaking changes
compared to the previous version.
If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the MI protocol, you
can nevertheless selectively enable specific features available in those recent MI versions,
using the following commands:
-fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by MI 3,
even when using MI versions below 3. This command has no effect when using
MI version 3 or later.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 577
-fix-breakpoint-script-output
Use the output for the breakpoint "script" field which was introduced by MI 4,
even when using MI versions below 4. This command has no effect when using
MI version 4 or later.
The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
end is to make your project known to gdb developers and follow development on
gdb@sourceware.org and gdb-patches@sourceware.org.
"~" string-output
The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the CLI
console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
"@" string-output
The target output stream contains any textual output from the running target.
This is only present when GDB’s event loop is truly asynchronous, which is
currently only the case for remote targets.
"&" string-output
The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by gdb’s internals.
end-stepping-range
An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-
instruction or similar CLI command was accomplished.
exited-signalled
The inferior exited because of a signal.
exited The inferior exited.
exited-normally
The inferior exited normally.
signal-received
A signal was received by the inferior.
solib-event
The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
This can happen when stop-on-solib-events (see Section 18.1
[Files], page 285) is set or when a catch load or catch unload
catchpoint is in use (see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68).
fork The inferior has forked. This is reported when catch fork (see
Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68) has been used.
vfork The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when catch vfork
(see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68) has been used.
syscall-entry
The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when catch
syscall (see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68) has been
used.
syscall-return
The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
catch syscall (see Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68) has
been used.
exec The inferior called exec. This is reported when catch exec (see
Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68) has been used.
no-history
There isn’t enough history recorded to continue reverse execution.
The id field identifies the global thread ID of the thread that directly caused
the stop – for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-
stop mode is in effect (see Section 5.5.1 [All-Stop Mode], page 93), gdb may
either stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop. If all
threads are stopped, the stopped field will have the value of "all". Otherwise,
the value of the stopped field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this
list will always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
several threads in the list. The core field reports the processor core on which
the stop event has happened. This field may be absent if such information is
not available.
580 Debugging with gdb
=thread-group-added,id="id"
=thread-group-removed,id="id"
A thread group was either added or removed. The id field contains the gdb
identifier of the thread group. When a thread group is added, it generally might
not be associated with a running process. When a thread group is removed, its
id becomes invalid and cannot be used in any way.
=thread-group-started,id="id",pid="pid"
A thread group became associated with a running program, either because the
program was just started or the thread group was attached to a program. The
id field contains the gdb identifier of the thread group. The pid field contains
process identifier, specific to the operating system.
=thread-group-exited,id="id"[,exit-code="code"]
A thread group is no longer associated with a running program, either because
the program has exited, or because it was detached from. The id field contains
the gdb identifier of the thread group. The code field is the exit code of the
inferior; it exists only when the inferior exited with some code.
=thread-created,id="id",group-id="gid"
=thread-exited,id="id",group-id="gid"
A thread either was created, or has exited. The id field contains the global gdb
identifier of the thread. The gid field identifies the thread group this thread
belongs to.
=thread-selected,id="id"[,frame="frame"]
Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification is not
emitted as result of the -thread-select or -stack-select-frame commands,
but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented to change
the selected thread and frame actually changes them. In particular, invoking,
directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI thread or frame
commands, will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from
another user interface (see Chapter 24 [Interpreters], page 557) will also generate
this notification.
The frame field is only present if the newly selected thread is stopped. See
Section 27.7.5 [GDB/MI Frame Information], page 584, for the format of its
value.
We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends highlight the selected
thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to that thread.
=library-loaded,...
Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This notification has
5 fields—id, target-name, host-name, symbols-loaded and ranges. The id field
is an opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case, target-name
and host-name fields give the name of the library file on the target, and on the
host respectively. For native debugging, both those fields have the same value.
The symbols-loaded field is emitted only for backward compatibility and should
not be relied on to convey any useful information. The thread-group field, if
present, specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 581
loaded. If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
of all present thread groups. The ranges field specifies the ranges of addresses
belonging to this library.
=library-unloaded,...
Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification has
3 fields—id, target-name and host-name with the same meaning as for the
=library-loaded notification. The thread-group field, if present, specifies the
id of the thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present thread
groups.
=traceframe-changed,num=tfnum,tracepoint=tpnum
=traceframe-changed,end
Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is tfnum. The
number of the tracepoint associated with this trace frame is tpnum.
=tsv-created,name=name,initial=initial
Reports that the new trace state variable name is created with initial value
initial.
=tsv-deleted,name=name
=tsv-deleted
Reports that the trace state variable name is deleted or all trace state variables
are deleted.
=tsv-modified,name=name,initial=initial[,current=current]
Reports that the trace state variable name is modified with the initial value
initial. The current value current of trace state variable is optional and is
reported if the current value of trace state variable is known.
=breakpoint-created,bkpt={...}
=breakpoint-modified,bkpt={...}
=breakpoint-deleted,id=number
Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted, respectively. Only
user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI user.
The bkpt argument is of the same form as returned by the various breakpoint
commands; See Section 27.10 [GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands], page 587. The
number is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a command, then it
will not also be emitted in an async record.
=record-started,thread-group="id",method="method"[,format="format"]
=record-stopped,thread-group="id"
Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an inferior. The id is
the gdb identifier of the thread group corresponding to the affected inferior.
The method field indicates the method used to record execution. If the method
in use supports multiple recording formats, format will be present and con-
tain the currently used format. See Chapter 7 [Process Record and Replay],
page 101, for existing method and format values.
582 Debugging with gdb
=cmd-param-changed,param=param,value=value
Reports that a parameter of the command set param is changed to value. In
the multi-word set command, the param is the whole parameter list to set
command. For example, In command set check type on, param is check type
and value is on.
=memory-changed,thread-group=id,addr=addr,len=len[,type="code"]
Reports that bytes from addr to data + len were written in an inferior. The
id is the identifier of the thread group corresponding to the affected inferior.
The optional type="code" part is reported if the memory written to holds
executable code.
line The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known. If not known, this
field is not present.
at If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If provided, this
holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed by a symbol name.
pending If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the text used to set
the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
evaluated-by
Where this breakpoint’s condition is evaluated, either ‘host’ or ‘target’.
thread If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the thread in which
the breakpoint can trigger.
task If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this field will hold
the task identifier.
cond If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
ignore The ignore count of the breakpoint.
enable The enable count of the breakpoint.
traceframe-usage
FIXME.
static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
mask For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
pass A tracepoint’s pass count.
original-location
The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user. This field is
optional.
times The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
installed
This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either ‘y’, meaning that the
tracepoint is installed, or ‘n’, meaning that it is not.
what Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
locations
This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also excep-
tionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled location.
The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is described below.
A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the following
fields:
number The location number as a dotted pair, like ‘1.2’. The first digit is the number
of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the location within
that breakpoint.
584 Debugging with gdb
enabled There are three possible values, with the following meanings:
y The location is enabled.
n The location is disabled by the user.
N The location is disabled because the breakpoint condition is invalid
at this location.
addr The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
addr_flags
Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
architecture-dependent; see Section 21.4 [Architectures], page 346, for their
meaning for a particular CPU.
func If known, the function in which the location appears. If not known, this field
is not present.
file The name of the source file which contains this location, if known. If not known,
this field is not present.
fullname The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if known. If
not known, this field is not present.
line The line number at which this location appears, if known. If not known, this
field is not present.
thread-groups
The thread groups this location is in.
For example, here is what the output of -break-insert (see Section 27.10 [GDB/MI
Breakpoint Commands], page 587) might be:
-> -break-insert main
<- ^done,bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
<- (gdb)
file The name of the source files that correspond to the frame’s code address. This
field may be absent.
line The source line corresponding to the frames’ code address. This field may be
absent.
from The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the corresponds
to the frame’s code address. This field may be absent.
Setting a Breakpoint
Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed information of
the breakpoint.
-> -break-insert main
<- ^done,bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
<- (gdb)
Program Execution
Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the reason that execution
stopped.
-> -exec-run
<- ^running
<- (gdb)
<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
frame={addr="0x08048564",func="main",
args=[{name="argc",value="1"},{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"}],
file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
<- (gdb)
-> -exec-continue
<- ^running
<- (gdb)
<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
<- (gdb)
Quitting gdb
Quitting gdb just prints the result class ‘^exit’.
-> (gdb)
<- -gdb-exit
<- ^exit
Please note that ‘^exit’ is printed immediately, but it might take some time for gdb
to actually exit. During that time, gdb performs necessary cleanups, including killing
programs being debugged or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should
wait till gdb exits and should only forcibly kill gdb if it fails to exit in reasonable time.
A Bad Command
Here’s what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
-> -rubbish
<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
<- (gdb)
Motivation
The motivation for this collection of commands.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 587
Introduction
A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
Commands
For each command in the block, the following is described:
Synopsis
-command args...
Result
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb CLI command(s), if any.
Example
Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have not been
implemented yet and these are labeled N.A. (not available).
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘ignore’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-insert main
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
(gdb)
-break-after 1 3
~
^done
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
588 Debugging with gdb
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"}]}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘commands’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-insert main
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
(gdb)
-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘condition’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-condition 1 1
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 589
^done
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"}]}
(gdb)
Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument list. This is
obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘delete’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-delete 1
^done
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[]}
(gdb)
Disable the named breakpoint(s). The field ‘enabled’ in the break list is now set to ‘n’
for the named breakpoint(s).
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘disable’.
590 Debugging with gdb
Example
(gdb)
-break-disable 2
^done
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"}]}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘enable’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-enable 2
^done
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"}]}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info break breakpoint’.
Example
N.A.
‘--force-condition’
Forcibly define the breakpoint even if the condition is invalid at all of the
breakpoint locations.
‘-i ignore-count’
Initialize the ignore-count.
‘-p thread-id’
Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global thread-id.
thread-id must be a valid thread-id at the time the breakpoint is requested.
Breakpoints created with a thread-id will automatically be deleted when the
corresponding thread exits.
‘--qualified’
This option makes gdb interpret a function name specified as a complete fully-
qualified name.
Result
See Section 27.7.4 [GDB/MI Breakpoint Information], page 582, for details on the format
of the resulting breakpoint.
Note: this format is open to change.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘break’, ‘tbreak’, ‘hbreak’, and ‘thbreak’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-insert main
^done,bkpt={number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
(gdb)
-break-insert -t foo
^done,bkpt={number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"},
bkpt={number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"}]}
(gdb)
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 593
Result
See Section 27.7.4 [GDB/MI Breakpoint Information], page 582, for details on the format
of the resulting breakpoint.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘dprintf’.
Example
(gdb)
4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
4^done,bkpt={number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0",script=["printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"],
original-location="foo"}
(gdb)
594 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info break’.
Example
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"},
bkpt={number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"}]}
(gdb)
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 595
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘watch’, ‘awatch’, and ‘rwatch’.
Example
Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the main function:
(gdb)
-break-watch x
^done,wpt={number="2",exp="x"}
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt={number="2",exp="x"},
value={old="-268439212",new="55"},
frame={func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
596 Debugging with gdb
Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. gdb will stop the program
execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then for the watchpoint going out of
scope.
(gdb)
-break-watch C
^done,wpt={number="5",exp="C"}
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
wpt={number="5",exp="C"},value={old="-276895068",new="3"},
frame={func="callee4",args=[],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
frame={func="callee3",args=[{name="strarg",
value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""}],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program execution. Note
that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is deleted.
(gdb)
-break-watch C
^done,wpt={number="2",exp="C"}
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="1"},
bkpt={number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"}]}
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt={number="2",exp="C"},
value={old="-276895068",new="3"},
frame={func="callee4",args=[],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 597
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="1"},
bkpt={number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"}]}
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
frame={func="callee3",args=[{name="strarg",
value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""}],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
-break-list
^done,BreakpointTable={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
hdr=[{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"},
{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"},
{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"},
{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"},
{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"}],
body=[bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"}]}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘catch load’.
Example
-catch-load -t foo.so
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘catch unload’.
Example
-catch-unload -d bar.so
^done,bkpt={number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘catch assert’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 599
Example
-catch-assert
^done,bkptno="5",bkpt={number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘catch exception’ and ‘catch exception
unhandled’.
Example
-catch-exception -e Program_Error
^done,bkptno="4",bkpt={number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
what="‘Program_Error’ Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘catch handlers’.
Example
-catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
^done,bkptno="4",bkpt={number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
what="‘Constraint_Error’ Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘catch throw’ and ‘tcatch throw’ (see Section 5.1.3
[Set Catchpoints], page 68).
Example
-catch-throw -r exception_type
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
thread-groups=["i1"],
regexp="exception_type",times="0"}
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
~"\n"
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 601
Stop when a C++ exception is re-thrown. If regexp is given, then only exceptions whose
type matches the regular expression will be caught.
If ‘-t’ is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one stop, the catchpoint is
automatically deleted after the first event is caught.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘catch rethrow’ and ‘tcatch rethrow’ (see
Section 5.1.3 [Set Catchpoints], page 68).
Example
-catch-rethrow -r exception_type
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
thread-groups=["i1"],
regexp="exception_type",times="0"}
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
~"\n"
~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
*stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
frame={addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"},
thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
(gdb)
Stop when the debuggee catches a C++ exception. If regexp is given, then only exceptions
whose type matches the regular expression will be caught.
If ‘-t’ is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one stop, the catchpoint is
automatically deleted after the first event is caught.
602 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘catch catch’ and ‘tcatch catch’ (see Section 5.1.3
[Set Catchpoints], page 68).
Example
-catch-catch -r exception_type
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
thread-groups=["i1"],
regexp="exception_type",times="0"}
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
~"\n"
~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
*stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
frame={addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"},
thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘set args’.
Example
(gdb)
-exec-arguments -v word
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘cd’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 603
Example
(gdb)
-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘dir’.
Example
(gdb)
-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
(gdb)
-environment-directory ""
^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
(gdb)
-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
(gdb)
-environment-directory -r
^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
(gdb)
around the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated by the system
directory-separator character. The directory-separator character must not be used in any
directory name. If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘path’.
Example
(gdb)
-environment-path
^done,path="/usr/bin"
(gdb)
-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
(gdb)
-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘pwd’.
Example
(gdb)
-environment-pwd
^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
(gdb)
Reports information about either a specific thread, if the thread-id parameter is present,
or about all threads. thread-id is the thread’s global thread ID. When printing information
about all threads, also reports the global ID of the current thread.
gdb Command
The ‘info thread’ command prints the same information about all threads.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 605
Result
The result contains the following attributes:
‘threads’ A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
Section 27.7.6 [GDB/MI Thread Information], page 585.
‘current-thread-id’
The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
and therefore has no threads) or if a thread-id argument was passed to the
command.
Example
-thread-info
^done,threads=[
{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
frame={level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
args=[]},state="running"},
{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
frame={level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
args=[{name="i",value="10"}],
file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"},
state="running"}],
current-thread-id="1"
(gdb)
gdb Command
Part of ‘info threads’ supplies the same information.
Example
(gdb)
-thread-list-ids
^done,thread-ids={thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"},
current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
(gdb)
This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the ‘--thread’ option to each
command.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘thread’.
Example
(gdb)
-exec-next
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
(gdb)
-thread-list-ids
^done,
thread-ids={thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"},
number-of-threads="3"
(gdb)
-thread-select 3
^done,new-thread-id="3",
frame={level="0",func="vprintf",
args=[{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""},
{name="arg",value="0x2"}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The ‘info tasks’ command prints the same information about all Ada tasks (see
Section 15.4.10.7 [Ada Tasks], page 251).
Result
The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are defined for each Ada task:
‘current’ This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value ‘*’.
‘id’ The identifier that gdb uses to refer to the Ada task.
‘task-id’ The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
‘thread-id’
The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented on top of
a thread. But if gdb cannot find this corresponding thread for any reason, the
field is omitted.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 607
‘parent-id’
This field exists only when the task was created by another task. In this case,
it provides the ID of the parent task.
‘priority’
The base priority of the task.
‘state’ The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the possible states,
see Section 15.4.10.7 [Ada Tasks], page 251.
‘name’ The name of the task.
Example
-ada-task-info
^done,tasks={nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
hdr=[{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""},
{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"},
{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"},
{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""},
{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"},
{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"},
{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"},
{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"}],
body=[{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"}]}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb corresponding is ‘continue’.
Example
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
@Hello world
*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame={
func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
For a ‘breakpoint-hit’ stopped reason, when the breakpoint encountered has multiple
locations, the field ‘bkptno’ is followed by the field ‘locno’.
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
@Hello world
*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",locno="3",frame={
func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘finish’.
Example
Function returning void.
-exec-finish
^running
(gdb)
@hello from foo
*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame={func="main",args=[],
file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Function returning other than void. The name of the internal gdb variable storing the
result is printed, together with the value itself.
-exec-finish
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame={addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
args=[{name="a",value="1"],{name="b",value="9"}},
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 609
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
(gdb)
Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token associated with
the stop message is the one for the execution command that has been interrupted. The
token for the interrupt itself only appears in the ‘^done’ output. If the user is trying to
interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is asynchronous just
like other execution commands. That is, first the ‘^done’ response will be printed, and the
target stop will be reported after that using the ‘*stopped’ notification.
In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default. All threads (in
all inferiors) will be interrupted if the ‘--all’ option is specified. If the ‘--thread-group’
option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘interrupt’.
Example
(gdb)
111-exec-continue
111^running
(gdb)
222-exec-interrupt
222^done
(gdb)
111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
frame={addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
(gdb)
-exec-interrupt
^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
(gdb)
Resumes execution of the inferior program at the address to which locspec resolves. See
Section 9.2 [Location Specifications], page 122, for a description of the different forms of
locspec.
610 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘jump’.
Example
-exec-jump foo.c:10
*running,thread-id="all"
^running
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘next’.
Example
-exec-next
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘nexti’.
Example
(gdb)
-exec-next-instruction
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 611
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘return’.
Example
(gdb)
200-break-insert callee4
200^done,bkpt={number="1",addr="0x00010734",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"}
(gdb)
000-exec-run
000^running
(gdb)
000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
frame={func="callee4",args=[],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
205-break-delete
205^done
(gdb)
111-exec-return
111^done,frame={level="0",func="callee3",
args=[{name="strarg",
value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""}],
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
group of type ‘process’, and that thread group will be started. If the ‘--all’ option is
specified, then all inferiors will be started.
Using the ‘--start’ option instructs the debugger to stop the execution at the start of
the inferior’s main subprogram, following the same behavior as the start command (see
Section 4.2 [Starting], page 34).
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘run’.
Examples
(gdb)
-break-insert main
^done,bkpt={number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"}
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
frame={func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Program exited normally:
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
x = 55
*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
(gdb)
Program exited exceptionally:
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
x = 55
*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
(gdb)
Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as SIGINT. In this
case, gdb/mi displays this:
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
signal-meaning="Interrupt"
execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previously executed
source line.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘step’.
Example
Stepping into a function:
-exec-step
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
frame={func="foo",args=[{name="a",value="10"},
{name="b",value="0"}],file="recursive2.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Regular stepping:
-exec-step
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘stepi’.
Example
(gdb)
-exec-step-instruction
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
frame={func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
-exec-step-instruction
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
614 Debugging with gdb
frame={addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Executes the inferior until it reaches the address to which locspec resolves. If there is no
argument, the inferior executes until it reaches a source line greater than the current one.
The reason for stopping in this case will be ‘location-reached’.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘until’.
Example
(gdb)
-exec-until recursive2.c:6
^running
(gdb)
x = 55
*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame={func="main",args=[],
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
gdb allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of the MI commands relating
to stack traces. As there is no way to implement this in a fully backward-compatible way,
a front end must request that this functionality be enabled.
Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
Note that if Python support has not been compiled into gdb, this command will still
succeed (and do nothing).
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info frame’ or ‘frame’ (without arguments).
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 615
Example
(gdb)
-stack-info-frame
^done,frame={level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
gdb Command
There’s no equivalent gdb command.
Example
For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
(gdb)
-stack-info-depth
^done,depth="12"
(gdb)
-stack-info-depth 4
^done,depth="4"
(gdb)
-stack-info-depth 12
^done,depth="12"
(gdb)
-stack-info-depth 11
^done,depth="11"
(gdb)
-stack-info-depth 13
^done,depth="12"
(gdb)
type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, structures and
unions. If the option --no-frame-filters is supplied, then Python frame filters will not
be executed.
If the --skip-unavailable option is specified, arguments that are not available are not
listed. Partially available arguments are still displayed, however.
Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is deprecated in favor of the
‘-stack-list-variables’ command.
gdb Command
gdb does not have an equivalent command. gdbtk has a ‘gdb_get_args’ command which
partially overlaps with the functionality of ‘-stack-list-arguments’.
Example
(gdb)
-stack-list-frames
^done,
stack=[
frame={level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
arch="i386:x86_64"}]
(gdb)
-stack-list-arguments 0
^done,
stack-args=[
frame={level="0",args=[]},
frame={level="1",args=[name="strarg"]},
frame={level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]},
frame={level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]},
frame={level="4",args=[]}]
(gdb)
-stack-list-arguments 1
^done,
stack-args=[
frame={level="0",args=[]},
frame={level="1",
args=[{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""}]},
frame={level="2",args=[
{name="intarg",value="2"},
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 617
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘backtrace’ and ‘where’.
Example
Full stack backtrace:
(gdb)
618 Debugging with gdb
-stack-list-frames
^done,stack=
[frame={level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
arch="i386:x86_64"}]
(gdb)
Show frames between low frame and high frame:
(gdb)
-stack-list-frames 3 5
^done,stack=
[frame={level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"},
frame={level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"}]
(gdb)
Show a single frame:
(gdb)
-stack-list-frames 3 3
^done,stack=
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 619
[frame={level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
arch="i386:x86_64"}]
(gdb)
gdb Command
‘info locals’ in gdb, ‘gdb_get_locals’ in gdbtk.
Example
(gdb)
-stack-list-locals 0
^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
(gdb)
-stack-list-locals --all-values
^done,locals=[{name="A",value="1"},{name="B",value="2"},
{name="C",value="{1, 2, 3}"}]
-stack-list-locals --simple-values
^done,locals=[{name="A",type="int",value="1"},
{name="B",type="int",value="2"},{name="C",type="int [3]"}]
(gdb)
Example
(gdb)
-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
^done,variables=[{name="x",value="11"},{name="s",value="{a = 1, b = 2}"}]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘frame’, ‘up’, ‘down’, ‘select-frame’, ‘up-silent’,
and ‘down-silent’.
Example
(gdb)
-stack-select-frame 2
^done
(gdb)
has changed since the last update operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data
that must be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable objects are
created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a real value. As result, gdb will
read target memory only for leaf variables that frontend has created.
The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend might want
to keep a value of some expression for future reference, and never update it. For another
example, fetching memory is relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not visible on the screen, or
“closed”. This is possible using so called “frozen variable objects”. Such variable objects
are never implicitly updated.
Variable objects can be either fixed or floating. For the fixed variable object, the ex-
pression is parsed when the variable object is created, including associating identifiers to
specific variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating variable object
the values of variables whose names appear in the expressions are re-evaluated every time
in the context of the current frame. Consider this example:
void do_work(...)
{
struct work_state state;
if (...)
do_work(...);
}
If a fixed variable object for the state variable is created in this function, and we enter
the recursive call, the variable object will report the value of state in the top-level do_work
invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable object will report the value of state in
the current frame.
If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object refers to a local variable,
the variable object becomes bound to the thread and frame in which the variable object
is created. When such variable object is updated, gdb makes sure that the thread/frame
combination the variable object is bound to still exists, and re-evaluates the variable object
in context of that thread/frame.
The following is the complete set of gdb/mi operations defined to access this function-
ality:
Operation Description
Result
This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These are:
Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children. With the ‘-c’ option,
just deletes the children.
Returns an error if the object name is not found.
Synopsis
-var-set-format name format-spec
Sets the output format for the value of the object name to be format-spec.
The syntax for the format-spec is as follows:
format-spec 7→
{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal}
The natural format is the default format choosen automatically based on the variable
type (like decimal for an int, hex for pointers, etc.).
The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal but with
padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit hexadecimal value of 0x1234
would be represented as 0x00001234 in the zero-hexadecimal format.
For a variable with children, the format is set only on the variable itself, and the children
are not affected.
approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the front end to request more
children with -var-list-children, and then the front end could call -var-set-update-
range with a different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just the visible
items.
For each child the following results are returned:
name Name of the variable object created for this child.
exp The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
For example this may be the name of a structure member.
For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an expression. There
is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
For C/C++ structures there are several pseudo children returned to designate
access qualifiers. For these pseudo children exp is ‘public’, ‘private’, or
‘protected’. In this case the type and value are not present.
A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying pseudo-children, regard-
less of the language. This information is not available at all with a dynamic
varobj.
numchild Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
type The type of the child. If ‘print object’ (see Section 10.9 [Print Settings],
page 153) is set to on, the actual (derived) type of the object is shown rather
than the declared one.
value If values were requested, this is the value.
thread-id If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread’s global
thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
frozen If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
displayhint
A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The value comes
directly from the Python pretty-printer object’s display_hint method. See
Section 23.3.2.6 [Pretty Printing API], page 413.
dynamic This attribute will be present and have the value ‘1’ if the varobj is a dynamic
varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, then this attribute will not be
present.
The result may have its own attributes:
‘displayhint’
A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The value comes
directly from the Python pretty-printer object’s display_hint method. See
Section 23.3.2.6 [Pretty Printing API], page 413.
‘has_more’
This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children remaining
after the end of the selected range.
626 Debugging with gdb
Example
(gdb)
-var-list-children n
^done,numchild=n,children=[child={name=name,exp=exp,
numchild=n,type=type},(repeats N times)]
(gdb)
-var-list-children --all-values n
^done,numchild=n,children=[child={name=name,exp=exp,
numchild=n,value=value,type=type},(repeats N times)]
Example
(gdb)
-var-assign var1 3
^done,value="3"
(gdb)
-var-update *
^done,changelist=[{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"}]
(gdb)
[-var-set-frozen], page 629). The option print-values determines whether both names and
values, or just names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same as for
-var-list-children (see [-var-list-children], page 624). It is recommended to use the
‘--all-values’ option, to reduce the number of MI commands needed on each program
stop.
With the ‘*’ parameter, if a variable object is bound to a currently running thread, it
will not be updated, without any diagnostic.
If -var-set-update-range was previously used on a varobj, then only the selected range
of children will be reported.
-var-update reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named ‘changelist’.
Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
‘name’ The name of the varobj.
‘value’ If values were requested for this update, then this field will be present and will
hold the value of the varobj.
‘in_scope’
This field is a string which may take one of three values:
"true" The variable object’s current value is valid.
"false" The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
scope.
"invalid"
The variable object no longer holds a valid value. This can oc-
cur when the executable file being debugged has changed, either
through recompilation or by using the gdb file command. The
front end should normally choose to delete these variable objects.
In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should be
prepared for this possibility. See Section 27.6 [gdb/mi Development and Front
Ends], page 575.
‘type_changed’
This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type changed, then this
will be the string ‘true’; otherwise it will be ‘false’.
When a varobj’s type changes, its children are also likely to have become in-
correct. Therefore, the varobj’s children are automatically deleted when this
attribute is ‘true’. Also, the varobj’s update range, when set using the -var-
set-update-range command, is unset.
‘new_type’
If the varobj’s type changed, then this field will be present and will hold the
new type.
‘new_num_children’
For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the type changed,
this will be the new number of children.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 629
The ‘numchild’ field in other varobj responses is generally not valid for a dy-
namic varobj – it will show the number of children that gdb knows about, but
because dynamic varobjs lazily instantiate their children, this will not reflect
the number of children which may be available.
The ‘new_num_children’ attribute only reports changes to the number of chil-
dren known by gdb. This is the only way to detect whether an update has
removed children (which necessarily can only happen at the end of the update
range).
‘displayhint’
The display hint, if any.
‘has_more’
This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children available
outside the varobj’s update range.
‘dynamic’ This attribute will be present and have the value ‘1’ if the varobj is a dynamic
varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, then this attribute will not be
present.
‘new_children’
If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected update range
(as set by -var-set-update-range), then they will be listed in this attribute.
Example
(gdb)
-var-assign var1 3
^done,value="3"
(gdb)
-var-update --all-values var1
^done,changelist=[{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
type_changed="false"}]
(gdb)
Example
(gdb)
-var-set-frozen V 1
^done
(gdb)
630 Debugging with gdb
Example
(gdb)
-var-set-update-range V 1 2
^done
Example
Resetting the visualizer:
(gdb)
-var-set-visualizer V None
^done
Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
(gdb)
-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
^done
Suppose SomeClass is a visualizer class. A lambda expression can be used to instantiate
this class for a varobj:
(gdb)
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 631
‘mode’ the use of mode is deprecated in favour of using the --opcodes and --source
options. When no mode is given, mode 0 will be assumed. However, the mode
is still available for backward compatibility. The mode should be one of:
‘0’ disassembly only, this is the default mode if no mode is specified.
‘1’ mixed source and disassembly (deprecated), it is not possible to
recreate this mode using --opcodes and --source options.
‘2’ disassembly with raw opcodes, this mode is equivalent to using mode
0 and passing --opcodes bytes to the command.
‘3’ mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated), it is
not possible to recreate this mode using --opcodes and --source
options.
‘4’ mixed source and disassembly, this mode is equivalent to using
mode 0 and passing --source to the command.
‘5’ mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes, this mode is equiv-
alent to using mode 0 and passing --opcodes bytes and --source
to the command.
Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is “source centric” which hasn’t
proved useful in practice. See Section 9.6 [Machine Code], page 131, for a
discussion of the difference between /m and /s output of the disassemble
command.
The --source can only be used with mode 0. Passing this option will include the source
code in the disassembly result as if mode 4 or 5 had been used.
Result
The result of the -data-disassemble command will be a list named ‘asm_insns’, the
contents of this list depend on the options used with the -data-disassemble command.
For modes 0 and 2, and when the --source option is not used, the ‘asm_insns’ list
contains tuples with the following fields:
address The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
func-name
The name of the function this instruction is within.
offset The decimal offset in bytes from the start of ‘func-name’.
inst The text disassembly for this ‘address’.
opcodes This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5, or when the --opcodes option
‘bytes’ or ‘display’ is used. This contains the raw opcode bytes for the ‘inst’
field.
When the ‘--opcodes’ option is not passed to -data-disassemble, or the
‘bytes’ value is passed to ‘--opcodes’, then the bytes are formatted as a series
of single bytes, in hex, in ascending address order, with a single space between
each byte. This format is equivalent to the ‘/b’ option being used with the
disassemble command (see [disassemble], page 132).
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 633
When ‘--opcodes’ is passed the value ‘display’ then the bytes are formatted in
the natural instruction display order. This means multiple bytes can be grouped
together, and the bytes might be byte-swapped. This format is equivalent to
the ‘/r’ option being used with the disassemble command.
For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5, or when the --source option is used, the ‘asm_insns’ list
contains tuples named ‘src_and_asm_line’, each of which has the following fields:
line The line number within ‘file’.
file The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute file name
or a relative file name depending on the compile command used.
fullname Absolute file name of ‘file’. It is converted to a canonical form using the source
file search path (see Section 9.5 [Specifying Source Directories], page 127) and
after resolving all the symbolic links.
If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as present in the
debug information.
line_asm_insn
This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for ‘line’ in ‘file’. The
fields of each tuple are the same as for -data-disassemble in mode 0 and 2,
so ‘address’, ‘func-name’, ‘offset’, ‘inst’, and optionally ‘opcodes’.
Note that whatever included in the ‘inst’ field, is not manipulated directly by gdb/mi,
i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘disassemble’.
Example
Disassemble from the current value of $pc to $pc + 20:
(gdb)
-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
^done,
asm_insns=[
{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
inst="mov 2, %o0"},
{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"},
{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"},
{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"},
{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"}]
(gdb)
Disassemble the whole main function. Line 32 is part of main.
-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
^done,asm_insns=[
{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"},
{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
634 Debugging with gdb
inst="mov 2, %o0"},
{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"},
[...]
{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "},
{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "}]
(gdb)
Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of main:
(gdb)
-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
^done,asm_insns=[
{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"},
{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
inst="mov 2, %o0"},
{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"}]
(gdb)
Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of main in mixed mode:
(gdb)
-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
^done,asm_insns=[
src_and_asm_line={line="31",
file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
line_asm_insn=[{address="0x000107bc",
func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"}]},
src_and_asm_line={line="32",
file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
line_asm_insn=[{address="0x000107c0",
func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"},
{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"}]}]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘print’, ‘output’, and ‘call’. In gdbtk only, there’s
a corresponding ‘gdb_eval’ command.
Example
In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the tokens described
in Section 27.4 [gdb/mi Command Syntax], page 572. Notice how gdb/mi returns the same
tokens in its output.
211-data-evaluate-expression A
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 635
211^done,value="1"
(gdb)
311-data-evaluate-expression &A
311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
(gdb)
411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
411^done,value="4"
(gdb)
511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
511^done,value="4"
(gdb)
gdb Command
gdb doesn’t have a direct analog for this command; gdbtk has the corresponding command
‘gdb_changed_register_list’.
Example
On a PPC MBX board:
(gdb)
-exec-continue
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame={
func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
line="5",arch="powerpc"}
(gdb)
-data-list-changed-registers
^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
(gdb)
gdb Command
gdb does not have a command which corresponds to ‘-data-list-register-names’. In
gdbtk there is a corresponding command ‘gdb_regnames’.
636 Debugging with gdb
Example
For the PPC MBX board:
(gdb)
-data-list-register-names
^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
(gdb)
-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb commands are ‘info reg’, ‘info all-reg’, and (in gdbtk)
‘gdb_fetch_registers’.
Example
For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they don’t appear in the
actual output):
(gdb)
-data-list-register-values r 64 65
^done,register-values=[{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"},
{number="65",value="0x00029002"}]
(gdb)
-data-list-register-values x
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 637
^done,register-values=[{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"},
{number="1",value="0x3fff88"},{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"},
{number="3",value="0x0"},{number="4",value="0xa"},
{number="5",value="0x3fff68"},{number="6",value="0x3fff58"},
{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"},{number="8",value="0x2"},
{number="9",value="0xfa202820"},{number="10",value="0xfa202808"},
{number="11",value="0x1"},{number="12",value="0x0"},
{number="13",value="0x4544"},{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"},
{number="15",value="0xffffffff"},{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"},
{number="17",value="0xefffffed"},{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"},
{number="19",value="0xffffffff"},{number="20",value="0xffffffff"},
{number="21",value="0xffffffff"},{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"},
{number="23",value="0xffffffff"},{number="24",value="0xffffffff"},
{number="25",value="0xffffffff"},{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"},
{number="27",value="0xffffffff"},{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"},
{number="29",value="0x0"},{number="30",value="0xfe010000"},
{number="31",value="0x0"},{number="32",value="0x0"},
{number="33",value="0x0"},{number="34",value="0x0"},
{number="35",value="0x0"},{number="36",value="0x0"},
{number="37",value="0x0"},{number="38",value="0x0"},
{number="39",value="0x0"},{number="40",value="0x0"},
{number="41",value="0x0"},{number="42",value="0x0"},
{number="43",value="0x0"},{number="44",value="0x0"},
{number="45",value="0x0"},{number="46",value="0x0"},
{number="47",value="0x0"},{number="48",value="0x0"},
{number="49",value="0x0"},{number="50",value="0x0"},
{number="51",value="0x0"},{number="52",value="0x0"},
{number="53",value="0x0"},{number="54",value="0x0"},
{number="55",value="0x0"},{number="56",value="0x0"},
{number="57",value="0x0"},{number="58",value="0x0"},
{number="59",value="0x0"},{number="60",value="0x0"},
{number="61",value="0x0"},{number="62",value="0x0"},
{number="63",value="0x0"},{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"},
{number="65",value="0x29002"},{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"},
{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"},{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"},
{number="69",value="0x20002b03"}]
(gdb)
Synopsis
-data-read-memory [ -o byte-offset ]
address word-format word-size
nr-rows nr-cols [ aschar ]
where:
‘address’ An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be read.
Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be quoted using
the C convention.
‘word-format’
The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the same
as for gdb’s print command (see Section 10.5 [Output Formats], page 146).
638 Debugging with gdb
‘word-size’
The size of each memory word in bytes.
‘nr-rows’ The number of rows in the output table.
‘nr-cols’ The number of columns in the output table.
‘aschar’ If present, indicates that each row should include an ascii dump. The value
of aschar is used as a padding character when a byte is not a member of the
printable ascii character set (printable ascii characters are those whose code
is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
‘byte-offset’
An offset to add to the address before fetching memory.
This command displays memory contents as a table of nr-rows by nr-cols words, each
word being word-size bytes. In total, nr-rows * nr-cols * word-size bytes are read (re-
turned as ‘total-bytes’). Should less than the requested number of bytes be returned by
the target, the missing words are identified using ‘N/A’. The number of bytes read from the
target is returned in ‘nr-bytes’ and the starting address used to read memory in ‘addr’.
The address of the next/previous row or page is available in ‘next-row’ and ‘prev-row’,
‘next-page’ and ‘prev-page’.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘x’. gdbtk has ‘gdb_get_mem’ memory read command.
Example
Read six bytes of memory starting at bytes+6 but then offset by -6 bytes. Format as three
rows of two columns. One byte per word. Display each word in hex.
(gdb)
9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]},
{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]},
{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]}]
(gdb)
Read two bytes of memory starting at address shorts + 64 and display as a single word
formatted in decimal.
(gdb)
5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]}]
(gdb)
Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at bytes+16 and format as eight rows of four
columns. Include a string encoding with ‘x’ used as the non-printable character.
(gdb)
4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 639
next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"},
{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"},
{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"},
{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"},
{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"},
{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&’"},
{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"},
{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"}]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘x’.
Example
(gdb)
-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
^done,memory=[{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
end="0xbffff15e",
contents="01000000020000000300"}]
(gdb)
where:
‘address’ An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit to
be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
quoted using the C convention.
‘contents’
The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if contents does not represent an
integral number of addressable memory units.
‘count’ Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
written. If count is greater than contents’ length, gdb will repeatedly write
contents until it fills count memory units.
gdb Command
There’s no corresponding gdb command.
Example
(gdb)
-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
^done
(gdb)
(gdb)
-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
^done
(gdb)
Synopsis
-trace-find mode [parameters...]
Find a trace frame using criteria defined by mode and parameters. The following table
lists permissible modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see Section 13.2.1
[tfind], page 211.
‘none’ No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
‘frame-number’
An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with that index.
‘tracepoint-number’
An integer is required as parameter. Finds next trace frame that corresponds
to tracepoint with the specified number.
‘pc’ An address is required as parameter. Finds next trace frame that corresponds
to any tracepoint at the specified address.
‘pc-inside-range’
Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace frame that corre-
sponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the specified range. Both bounds
are considered to be inside the range.
‘pc-outside-range’
Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace frame that corre-
sponds to a tracepoint at an address outside the specified range. Both bounds
are considered to be inside the range.
‘line’ Location specification is required as parameter. See Section 9.2 [Location Spec-
ifications], page 122. Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint
at the specified location.
If ‘none’ was passed as mode, the response does not have fields. Otherwise, the response
may have the following fields:
‘found’ This field has either ‘0’ or ‘1’ as the value, depending on whether a matching
tracepoint was found.
‘traceframe’
The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff the ‘found’ field has
value of ‘1’.
‘tracepoint’
The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff the ‘found’ field has
value of ‘1’.
‘frame’ The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace frame. This
field is present only if a trace frame was found. See Section 27.7.5 [GDB/MI
Frame Information], page 584, for description of this field.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tfind’.
Synopsis
-trace-define-variable name [ value ]
Create trace variable name if it does not exist. If value is specified, sets the initial value
of the specified trace variable to that value. Note that the name should start with the ‘$’
character.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tvariable’.
Where:
explicit-variables
The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as opposed to
collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct members). For each
object, its name and value are printed. The --var-print-values option affects
how or whether the value field is output. If var pval is 0, then print only the
names; if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name, type and
value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, structures and
unions.
computed-expressions
The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the current trace
frame. The --comp-print-values option affects this set like the --var-print-
values option affects the explicit-variables set. See above.
registers
The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame. For each reg-
ister collected, the name and current value are returned. The value is formatted
according to the --registers-format option. See the -data-list-register-
values command for a list of the allowed formats. The default is ‘x’.
tvars The trace state variables that have been collected at the current trace frame.
For each trace state variable collected, the name and current value are returned.
memory The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace frame.
Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a collected memory range
and has the following fields:
address The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
length The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
contents The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
if the --memory-contents option is specified.
gdb Command
There is no corresponding gdb command.
Example
The -trace-list-variables Command
Synopsis
-trace-list-variables
Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the table has the following
fields:
‘name’ The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
‘initial’ The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This field is always present.
644 Debugging with gdb
‘current’ The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit signed integer.
This field is absent iff current value is not defined, for example if the trace was
never run, or is presently running.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tvariables’.
Example
(gdb)
-trace-list-variables
^done,trace-variables={nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
hdr=[{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"},
{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"},
{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"}],
body=[variable={name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"}
variable={name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"}]}
(gdb)
Saves the collected trace data to filename. Without the ‘-r’ option, the data is down-
loaded from the target and saved in a local file. With the ‘-r’ option the target is asked to
perform the save.
By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can supply the
optional ‘-ctf’ argument to save it the CTF format. See Section 13.4 [Trace Files], page 215,
for more information about CTF.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tsave’.
Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not have any fields.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tstart’.
Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include the following fields:
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 645
‘supported’
May have a value of either ‘0’, when no tracing operations are supported, ‘1’,
when all tracing operations are supported, or ‘file’ when examining trace
file. In the latter case, examining of trace frame is possible but new tracing
experiement cannot be started. This field is always present.
‘running’ May have a value of either ‘0’ or ‘1’ depending on whether tracing experiement
is in progress on target. This field is present if ‘supported’ field is not ‘0’.
‘stop-reason’
Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field may be
absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The value of ‘request’ means
the tracing was stopped as result of the -trace-stop command. The value of
‘overflow’ means the tracing buffer is full. The value of ‘disconnection’
means tracing was automatically stopped when gdb has disconnected. The
value of ‘passcount’ means tracing was stopped when a tracepoint was passed a
maximal number of times for that tracepoint. This field is present if ‘supported’
field is not ‘0’.
‘stopping-tracepoint’
The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is present
iff the ‘stop-reason’ field has the value of ‘passcount’.
‘frames’
‘frames-created’
The ‘frames’ field is a count of the total number of trace frames in the trace
buffer, while ‘frames-created’ is the total created during the run, including
ones that were discarded, such as when a circular trace buffer filled up. Both
fields are optional.
‘buffer-size’
‘buffer-free’
These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the remaining space.
These fields are optional.
‘circular’
The value of the circular trace buffer flag. 1 means that the trace buffer is
circular and old trace frames will be discarded if necessary to make room, 0
means that the trace buffer is linear and may fill up.
‘disconnected’
The value of the disconnected tracing flag. 1 means that tracing will continue
after gdb disconnects, 0 means that the trace run will stop.
‘trace-file’
The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is optional, and only
present when examining a trace file.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tstatus’.
Synopsis
-trace-stop
Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same fields as -trace-
status, except that the ‘supported’ and ‘running’ fields are not output.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘tstop’.
Return a list containing the names and types for all global functions taken from the debug
information. The functions are grouped by source file, and shown with the line number on
which each function is defined.
The --include-nondebug option causes the output to include code symbols from the
symbol table.
The options --type and --name allow the symbols returned to be filtered based on either
the name of the function, or the type signature of the function.
The option --max-results restricts the command to return no more than limit results.
If exactly limit results are returned then there might be additional results available if a
higher limit is used.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info functions’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 647
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-functions
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
description="void f4(int *);"},
{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
description="int main();"},
{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
description="float f2(another_float_t);"},
{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
description="int f3(another_int_t);"},
{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
description="static another_float_t f1(int);"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-functions --name f1
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
description="static another_float_t f1(int);"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-functions --type void
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
description="void f4(int *);"}]}]}
648 Debugging with gdb
(gdb)
-symbol-info-functions --include-nondebug
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
description="void f4(int *);"},
{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
description="int main();"},
{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
description="float f2(another_float_t);"},
{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
description="int f3(another_int_t);"},
{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
description="static another_float_t f1(int);"}]}],
nondebug=
[{address="0x0000000000400398",name="_init"},
{address="0x00000000004003b0",name="_start"},
...
]}
Return a list containing the names of all known functions within all know Fortran modules.
The functions are grouped by source file and containing module, and shown with the line
number on which each function is defined.
The option --module only returns results for modules matching module regexp. The
option --name only returns functions whose name matches name regexp, and --type only
returns functions whose type matches type regexp.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info module functions’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 649
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-module-functions
^done,symbols=
[{module="mod1",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="21",name="mod1::check_all",type="void (void)",
description="void mod1::check_all(void);"}]}]},
{module="mod2",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="30",name="mod2::check_var_i",type="void (void)",
description="void mod2::check_var_i(void);"}]}]},
{module="mod3",
files=[{filename="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="21",name="mod3::check_all",type="void (void)",
description="void mod3::check_all(void);"},
{line="27",name="mod3::check_mod2",type="void (void)",
description="void mod3::check_mod2(void);"}]}]},
{module="modmany",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="35",name="modmany::check_some",type="void (void)",
description="void modmany::check_some(void);"}]}]},
{module="moduse",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="44",name="moduse::check_all",type="void (void)",
description="void moduse::check_all(void);"},
{line="49",name="moduse::check_var_x",type="void (void)",
description="void moduse::check_var_x(void);"}]}]}]
Return a list containing the names of all known variables within all know Fortran modules.
The variables are grouped by source file and containing module, and shown with the line
number on which each variable is defined.
The option --module only returns results for modules matching module regexp. The
option --name only returns variables whose name matches name regexp, and --type only
returns variables whose type matches type regexp.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info module variables’.
650 Debugging with gdb
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-module-variables
^done,symbols=
[{module="mod1",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="18",name="mod1::var_const",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_const;"},
{line="17",name="mod1::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_i;"}]}]},
{module="mod2",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="28",name="mod2::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod2::var_i;"}]}]},
{module="mod3",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="18",name="mod3::mod1",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod1;"},
{line="17",name="mod3::mod2",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod2;"},
{line="19",name="mod3::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) mod3::var_i;"}]}]},
{module="modmany",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="33",name="modmany::var_a",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_a;"},
{line="33",name="modmany::var_b",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_b;"},
{line="33",name="modmany::var_c",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_c;"},
{line="33",name="modmany::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_i;"}]}]},
{module="moduse",
files=[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="42",name="moduse::var_x",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_x;"},
{line="42",name="moduse::var_y",type="integer(kind=4)",
description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_y;"}]}]}]
Return a list containing the names of all known Fortran modules. The modules are grouped
by source file, and shown with the line number on which each modules is defined.
The option --name allows the modules returned to be filtered based the name of the
module.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 651
The option --max-results restricts the command to return no more than limit results.
If exactly limit results are returned then there might be additional results available if a
higher limit is used.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info modules’.
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-modules
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="16",name="mod1"},
{line="22",name="mod2"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="16",name="mod3"},
{line="22",name="modmany"},
{line="26",name="moduse"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-modules --name mod[123]
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
symbols=[{line="16",name="mod1"},
{line="22",name="mod2"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
symbols=[{line="16",name="mod3"}]}]}
Return a list of all defined types. The types are grouped by source file, and shown with the
line number on which each user defined type is defined. Some base types are not defined in
the source code but are added to the debug information by the compiler, for example int,
float, etc.; these types do not have an associated line number.
The option --name allows the list of types returned to be filtered by name.
The option --max-results restricts the command to return no more than limit results.
If exactly limit results are returned then there might be additional results available if a
higher limit is used.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info types’.
652 Debugging with gdb
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-types
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{name="float"},
{name="int"},
{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"}]},
{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="24",name="typedef float another_float_t;"},
{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"},
{name="float"},
{name="int"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-types --name _int_
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"}]},
{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"}]}]}
Return a list containing the names and types for all global variables taken from the debug
information. The variables are grouped by source file, and shown with the line number on
which each variable is defined.
The --include-nondebug option causes the output to include data symbols from the
symbol table.
The options --type and --name allow the symbols returned to be filtered based on either
the name of the variable, or the type of the variable.
The option --max-results restricts the command to return no more than limit results.
If exactly limit results are returned then there might be additional results available if a
higher limit is used.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info variables’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 653
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-info-variables
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"},
{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
description="static int global_i1;"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
description="int global_f2;"},
{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
description="int global_i2;"},
{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"},
{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
description="static int global_i1;"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-variables --name f1
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"}]}]}
(gdb)
-symbol-info-variables --type float
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"}]}]}
654 Debugging with gdb
(gdb)
-symbol-info-variables --include-nondebug
^done,symbols=
{debug=
[{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
symbols=[{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"},
{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
description="static int global_i1;"}]},
{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
symbols=[{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
description="int global_f2;"},
{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
description="int global_i2;"},
{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
description="static float global_f1;"},
{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
description="static int global_i1;"}]}],
nondebug=
[{address="0x00000000004005d0",name="_IO_stdin_used"},
{address="0x00000000004005d8",name="__dso_handle"}
...
]}
gdb Command
There is no corresponding gdb command.
Example
(gdb)
-symbol-list-lines basics.c
^done,lines=[{pc="0x08048554",line="7"},{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"}]
(gdb)
information. If breakpoints are set when using this command with no arguments, gdb will
produce error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion notification.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘file’.
Example
(gdb)
-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘exec-file’.
Example
(gdb)
-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The gdb equivalent is ‘info source’
Example
(gdb)
123-file-list-exec-source-file
123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
(gdb)
Synopsis
-file-list-exec-source-files [ --group-by-objfile ]
[ --dirname | --basename ]
[ -- ]
[ regexp ]
This command returns information about the source files gdb knows about, it will output
both the filename and fullname (absolute file name) of a source file, though the fullname
can be elided if this information is not known to gdb.
With no arguments this command returns a list of source files. Each source file is
represented by a tuple with the fields; file, fullname, and debug-fully-read. The file is the
display name for the file, while fullname is the absolute name of the file. The fullname
field can be elided if the absolute name of the source file can’t be computed. The field
debug-fully-read will be a string, either true or false. When true, this indicates the full
debug information for the compilation unit describing this file has been read in. When
false, the full debug information has not yet been read in. While reading in the full debug
information it is possible that gdb could become aware of additional source files.
The optional regexp can be used to filter the list of source files returned. The regexp
will be matched against the full source file name. The matching is case-sensitive, except
on operating systems that have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows). ‘--’ can be
used before regexp to prevent gdb interpreting regexp as a command option (e.g. if regexp
starts with ‘-’).
If --dirname is provided, then regexp is matched only against the directory name of
each source file. If --basename is provided, then regexp is matched against the basename
of each source file. Only one of --dirname or --basename may be given, and if either is
given then regexp is required.
If --group-by-objfile is used then the format of the results is changed. The results
will now be a list of tuples, with each tuple representing an object file (executable or shared
library) loaded into gdb. The fields of these tuples are; filename, debug-info, and sources.
The filename is the absolute name of the object file, debug-info is a string with one of the
following values:
none This object file has no debug information.
partially-read
This object file has debug information, but it is not fully read in yet. When it
is read in later, GDB might become aware of additional source files.
fully-read
This object file has debug information, and this information is fully read into
GDB. The list of source files is complete.
The sources is a list or tuples, with each tuple describing a single source file with the
same fields as described previously. The sources list can be empty for object files that have
no debug information.
gdb Command
The gdb equivalent is ‘info sources’. gdbtk has an analogous command ‘gdb_listfiles’.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 657
Example
(gdb)
-file-list-exec-source-files
^done,files=[{file="foo.c",fullname="/home/foo.c",debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="/home/bar.c",fullname="/home/bar.c",debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c",debug-fully-read="true"}]
(gdb)
-file-list-exec-source-files
^done,files=[{file="test.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="header.h",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="helper.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
debug-fully-read="true"}]
(gdb)
-file-list-exec-source-files -- \\.c
^done,files=[{file="test.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="helper.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
debug-fully-read="true"}]
(gdb)
-file-list-exec-source-files --group-by-objfile
^done,files=[{filename="/tmp/info-sources/test.x",
debug-info="fully-read",
sources=[{file="test.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="header.h",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
debug-fully-read="true"}]},
{filename="/lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2",
debug-info="none",
sources=[]},
{filename="system-supplied DSO at 0x7ffff7fcf000",
debug-info="none",
sources=[]},
{filename="/tmp/info-sources/libhelper.so",
debug-info="fully-read",
sources=[{file="helper.c",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
debug-fully-read="true"},
{file="header.h",
fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
debug-fully-read="true"}]},
658 Debugging with gdb
{filename="/lib64/libc.so.6",
debug-info="none",
sources=[]}]
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info shared’. The fields have a similar meaning to the
=library-loaded notification. The ranges field specifies the multiple segments belonging
to this library. Each range has the following fields:
‘from’ The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
‘to’ The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
Example
(gdb)
-file-list-exec-source-files
^done,shared-libraries=[
{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-
group="i1",ranges=[{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"}]},
{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-
group="i1",ranges=[{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"}]}]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘symbol-file’.
Example
(gdb)
-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
^done
(gdb)
Synopsis
-target-attach pid | gid | file
Attach to a process pid or a file file outside of gdb, or a thread group gid. If attaching to
a thread group, the id previously returned by ‘-list-thread-groups --available’ must
be used.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘attach’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-attach 34
=thread-created,id="1"
*stopped,thread-id="1",frame={addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]}
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘detach’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-detach
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘disconnect’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-disconnect
^done
(gdb)
660 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘load’.
Example
Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages have been broken
down so that they can fit onto a page.
(gdb)
-target-download
+download,{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
total-sent="512",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"}
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 661
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"}
+download,{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"}
^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
write-rate="429"
(gdb)
gdb Command
No equivalent.
Example
N.A.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘target’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-select remote /dev/ttya
^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘remote put’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-file-put localfile remotefile
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘remote get’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-file-get remotefile localfile
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘remote delete’.
Example
(gdb)
-target-file-delete remotefile
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info exceptions’.
Result
The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are defined for each excep-
tion:
‘name’ The name of the exception.
‘address’ The address of the exception.
Example
-info-ada-exceptions aint
^done,ada-exceptions={nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
hdr=[{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"},
{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"}],
664 Debugging with gdb
body=[{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"},
{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"}]}
gdb Command
There is no corresponding gdb command.
Result
The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
‘exists’ This field is equal to "true" if the gdb/mi command exists, "false" otherwise.
Example
Here is an example where the gdb/mi command does not exist:
-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
^done,command={exists="false"}
And here is an example where the gdb/mi command is known to the debugger:
-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
^done,command={exists="true"}
Example output:
(gdb) -list-features
^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
The current list of features is:
‘frozen-varobjs’
Indicates support for the -var-set-frozen command, as well as possible pres-
ence of the frozen field in the output of -varobj-create.
‘pending-breakpoints’
Indicates support for the -f option to the -break-insert command.
‘python’ Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based pretty-printing commands,
and possible presence of the ‘display_hint’ field in the output of -var-list-
children
‘thread-info’
Indicates support for the -thread-info command.
‘data-read-memory-bytes’
Indicates support for the -data-read-memory-bytes and the -data-write-
memory-bytes commands.
‘breakpoint-notifications’
Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the CLI will
be announced via async records.
‘ada-task-info’
Indicates support for the -ada-task-info command.
‘language-option’
Indicates that all gdb/mi commands accept the --language option (see
Section 27.3.1 [Context management], page 570).
‘info-gdb-mi-command’
Indicates support for the -info-gdb-mi-command command.
‘undefined-command-error-code’
Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
records, produced when trying to execute an undefined gdb/mi command (see
Section 27.7.1 [GDB/MI Result Records], page 577).
‘exec-run-start-option’
Indicates that the -exec-run command supports the --start option (see
Section 27.15 [GDB/MI Program Execution], page 607).
‘data-disassemble-a-option’
Indicates that the -data-disassemble command supports the -a option (see
Section 27.18 [GDB/MI Data Manipulation], page 631).
‘simple-values-ref-types’
Indicates that the --simple-values argument to the -stack-list-
arguments, -stack-list-locals, -stack-list-variables, and
-var-list-children commands takes reference types into account: that is, a
value is considered simple if it is neither an array, structure, or union, nor a
reference to an array, structure, or union.
666 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
Approximately corresponds to ‘quit’.
Example
(gdb)
-gdb-exit
^exit
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘set’.
Example
(gdb)
-gdb-set $foo=3
^done
(gdb)
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 667
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘show’.
Example
(gdb)
-gdb-show annotate
^done,value="0"
(gdb)
gdb Command
The gdb equivalent is ‘show version’. gdb by default shows this information when you
start an interactive session.
Example
(gdb)
-gdb-version
~GNU gdb 5.2.1
~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
~ certain conditions.
~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
~ details.
~This GDB was configured as
"--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
^done
(gdb)
Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported. With the ‘--available’
option, gdb reports thread groups available on the target.
The output of this command may have either a ‘threads’ result or a ‘groups’ result.
The ‘thread’ result has a list of tuples as value, with each tuple describing a thread (see
Section 27.7.6 [GDB/MI Thread Information], page 585). The ‘groups’ result has a list
of tuples as value, each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are requested
(that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups are passed, the output always has
a ‘groups’ result. The format of the ‘group’ result is described below.
To reduce the number of roundtrips it’s possible to list thread groups together with
their children, by passing the ‘--recurse’ option and the recursion depth. Presently, only
recursion depth of 1 is permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
will also include its children, either as ‘group’ or ‘threads’ field.
In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with the following
caveats:
• When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically be the ‘threads’ result.
Because threads may not contain anything, the ‘recurse’ option will be ignored.
• When the ‘--available’ option is passed, limited information may be available. In
particular, the list of threads of a process might be inaccessible. Further, specifying
specific thread groups might not give any performance advantage over listing all thread
groups. The frontend should assume that ‘-list-thread-groups --available’ is
always an expensive operation and cache the results.
The ‘groups’ result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may have the following fields:
id Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present. The identifier is an
opaque string; frontends should not try to convert it to an integer, even though
it might look like one.
type The type of the thread group. At present, only ‘process’ is a valid type.
pid The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present for thread groups
of type ‘process’ and only if the process exists.
exit-code
The exit code of this group’s last exited thread, formatted in octal. This field
is only present for thread groups of type ‘process’ and only if the process is
not running.
num_children
The number of children this thread group has. This field may be absent for an
available thread group.
threads This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a thread. It may
be present if the ‘--recurse’ option is specified, and it’s actually possible to
obtain the threads.
cores This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one thread of the group
is running on. This field may be absent if such information is not available.
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 669
executable
The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group. The
field is only present for thread groups of type ‘process’, and only if there is a
corresponding executable file.
Example
(gdb)
-list-thread-groups
^done,groups=[{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"}]
-list-thread-groups 17
^done,threads=[{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
frame={level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]},state="running"},
{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
frame={level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[{name="i",value="10"}],
file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"},state="running"}]]
-list-thread-groups --available
^done,groups=[{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]}]
-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
^done,groups=[{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
threads=[{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]},
{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]}]},..]
-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
^done,groups=[{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
threads=[{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]},
{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]}]},...]
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘info os’.
Example
When run on a gnu/Linux system, the output will look something like this:
(gdb)
-info-os
^done,OSDataTable={nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
hdr=[{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"},
{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"}],
body=[item={col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
col2="CPUs"},
item={col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
col2="File descriptors"},
item={col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
col2="Kernel modules"},
670 Debugging with gdb
‘number’ The number of the connection used for the new inferior.
‘name’ The name of the connection type used for the new inferior.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘add-inferior’ (see [‘add-inferior’], page 44).
Example
(gdb)
-add-inferior
^done,inferior="i3"
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘remove-inferiors’ (see [‘remove-inferiors’],
page 45).
Example
(gdb)
-remove-inferior i3
=thread-group-removed,id="i3"
^done
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘interpreter-exec’.
Example
(gdb)
-interpreter-exec console "break main"
&"During symbol reading, couldn’t parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
^done
(gdb)
672 Debugging with gdb
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘set inferior-tty’ /dev/pts/1.
Example
(gdb)
-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
^done
(gdb)
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘show inferior-tty’.
Example
(gdb)
-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
^done
(gdb)
-inferior-tty-show
^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
(gdb)
gdb Command
No equivalent.
Example
(gdb)
-enable-timings
^done
(gdb)
Chapter 27: The gdb/mi Interface 673
-break-insert main
^done,bkpt={number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
times="0"},
time={wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"}
(gdb)
-enable-timings no
^done
(gdb)
-exec-run
^running
(gdb)
*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
frame={addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[{name="argc",value="1"},
{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"}],file="myprog.c",
fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"}
(gdb)
Result
The result consists of two or three fields:
‘completion’
This field contains the completed command. If command has no known com-
pletions, this field is omitted.
‘matches’ This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
‘max_completions_reached’
This field contains 1 if number of known completions is above max-completions
limit (see Section 3.3 [Completion], page 24), otherwise it contains 0. It is always
present.
gdb Command
The corresponding gdb command is ‘complete’.
Example
(gdb)
-complete br
^done,completion="break",
matches=["break","break-range"],
max_completions_reached="0"
(gdb)
-complete "b ma"
674 Debugging with gdb
^done,completion="b ma",
matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
(gdb)
-complete "b push_b"
^done,completion="b push_back(",
matches=[
"b A::push_back(void*)",
"b std::string::push_back(char)",
"b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
max_completions_reached="0"
(gdb)
-complete "nonexist"
^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
(gdb)
675
28 gdb Annotations
This chapter describes annotations in gdb. Annotations were designed to interface gdb to
graphical user interfaces or other similar programs which want to interact with gdb at a
relatively high level.
The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by gdb/mi (see Chapter 27
[GDB/MI], page 569).
^Z^Zpre-prompt
(gdb)
^Z^Zprompt
quit
676 Debugging with gdb
^Z^Zpost-prompt
$
Here ‘quit’ is input to gdb; the rest is output from gdb. The three lines beginning
‘^Z^Z’ (where ‘^Z’ denotes a ‘control-z’ character) are annotations; the rest is output
from gdb.
prompt When gdb is prompting for a command (the main gdb prompt).
commands When gdb prompts for a set of commands, like in the commands command.
The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
overload-choice
When gdb wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
query When gdb wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
prompt-for-continue
When gdb is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don’t expect
this to work well; instead use set height 0 to disable prompting. This is
because the counting of lines is buggy in the presence of annotations.
Chapter 28: gdb Annotations 677
28.4 Errors
^Z^Zquit
This annotation occurs right before gdb responds to an interrupt.
^Z^Zerror
This annotation occurs right before gdb responds to an error.
Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which gdb was in the middle
of may end abruptly. For example, if a value-history-begin annotation is followed by a
error, one cannot expect to receive the matching value-history-end. One cannot expect
not to receive it either, however; an error annotation does not necessarily mean that gdb
is immediately returning all the way to the top level.
A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
^Z^Zerror-begin
Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error message.
Warning messages are not yet annotated.
string
^Z^Zsignal-string-end
end-text
where name is the name of the signal, such as SIGILL or SIGSEGV, and string is
the explanation of the signal, such as Illegal Instruction or Segmentation
fault. The arguments intro-text, middle-text, and end-text are for the user’s
benefit and have no particular format.
^Z^Zsignal
The syntax of this annotation is just like signalled, but gdb is just saying
that the program received the signal, not that it was terminated with it.
^Z^Zbreakpoint number
The program hit breakpoint number number.
^Z^Zwatchpoint number
The program hit watchpoint number number.
struct jit_code_entry
{
struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
const char *symfile_addr;
uint64_t symfile_size;
};
struct jit_descriptor
{
uint32_t version;
/* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
uint32_t action_flag;
struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
};
gdb_read_debug_info *read;
gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
};
The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by gdb to do their job. For
read, these callbacks are passed in a struct gdb_symbol_callbacks and for unwind and
684 Debugging with gdb
31 In-Process Agent
The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine, because most
bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However, as multi-core or many-core
processors are becoming mainstream, and multi-threaded programs become more and more
popular, there should be more and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode
execution, for example, thread races, because debugger’s interference with the program’s
timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications, it is not feasible for
the debugger to interrupt the program’s execution long enough for the developer to learn
anything helpful about its behavior. If the program’s correctness depends on its real-time
behavior, delays introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program’s behavior without
interrupting it.
Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce some bugs. In
order to reduce the interference with the program, we can reduce the number of operations
performed by debugger. The In-Process Agent, a shared library, is running within the same
process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations itself. As a result,
debugger is only involved when necessary, and performance of debugging can be improved
accordingly. Note that interference with program can be reduced but can’t be removed
completely, because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions (see Appendix F
[Agent Expressions], page 823) during performing debugging operations. The agent expres-
sions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting data in tracepoints, and condition
evaluation in breakpoints.
You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for debugging with the
following commands:
set agent on
Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the debug-
ger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done by the in-process
agent depends on the its capabilities. For example, if you request to evaluate
breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent, and the in-process agent has such
capability as well, then breakpoint conditions will be evaluated in the in-process
agent.
set agent off
Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All of the
operations will be performed by gdb.
show agent
Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by the in-
process agent.
(see Section 31.1.2 [IPA Protocol Commands], page 687) and data to in-process agent, and
then in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or some other
information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed of primitive data types, such
as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite types, which are called objects (see Section 31.1.1
[IPA Protocol Objects], page 686).
The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol object:
‘FastTrace:tracepoint_object gdb_jump_pad_head’
Installs a new fast tracepoint described by tracepoint object (see [tracepoint
object], page 686). The gdb jump pad head, 8-byte long, is the head of jump-
pad, which is used to jump to data collection routine in IPA finally.
Replies:
‘close’ Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when gdb or GDBserver is
about to kill inferiors.
‘qTfSTM’ See [qTfSTM], page 797.
‘qTsSTM’ See [qTsSTM], page 797.
‘qTSTMat’ See [qTSTMat], page 798.
‘probe_marker_at:address’
Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at address.
Replies:
‘E NN’ for an error
‘unprobe_marker_at:address’
Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at address.
689
Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, “Does this ring a bell?” Those bug
reports are useless, and we urge everyone to refuse to respond to them except to chide the
sender to report bugs properly.
To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
• The version of gdb. gdb announces it if you start with no arguments; you can also
print it at any time using show version.
Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for the bug in the
current version of gdb.
• The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and version number.
• The details of the gdb build-time configuration. gdb shows these details if you invoke it
with the --configuration command-line option, or if you type show configuration
at gdb’s prompt.
• What compiler (and its version) was used to compile gdb—e.g. “gcc–2.8.1”.
• What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are debugging—
e.g. “gcc–2.8.1”, or “HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP C Compiler”. For gcc, you can say
gcc --version to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
those compilers.
• The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and observe
the bug. For example, did you use ‘-O’? To guarantee you will not omit something
important, list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong and then we
might not encounter the bug.
• A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will reproduce the bug.
• A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is incorrect. For example,
“It gets a fatal signal.”
Of course, if the bug is that gdb gets a fatal signal, then we will certainly notice it.
But if the bug is incorrect output, we might not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.
You might as well not give us a chance to make a mistake.
Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still say so explicitly.
Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your copy of gdb is out of synch, or
you have encountered a bug in the C library on your system. (This has happened!)
Your copy might crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If you had
not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw any conclusion from
our observations.
To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program such as script,
which is available on many Unix systems. Just run your gdb session inside script and
then include the typescript file with your bug report.
Another way to record a gdb session is to run gdb inside Emacs and then save the
entire buffer to a file.
• If you wish to suggest changes to the gdb source, send us context diffs. If you even
discuss something in the gdb source, refer to it by context, not by line number.
The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your sources.
Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
691
back’ to fill in the blank space created by the removal of the text. A list of the bare essentials
for editing the text of an input line follows.
C-b Move back one character.
C-f Move forward one character.
DEL or Backspace
Delete the character to the left of the cursor.
C-d Delete the character underneath the cursor.
Printing characters
Insert the character into the line at the cursor.
C-_ or C-x C-u
Undo the last editing command. You can undo all the way back to an empty
line.
(Depending on your configuration, the Backspace key be set to delete the character to the
left of the cursor and the DEL key set to delete the character underneath the cursor, like
C-d, rather than the character to the left of the cursor.)
typed so far. Any other key sequence bound to a Readline command will terminate the
search and execute that command. For instance, a RET will terminate the search and accept
the line, thereby executing the command from the history list. A movement command will
terminate the search, make the last line found the current line, and begin editing.
Readline remembers the last incremental search string. If two C-rs are typed without
any intervening characters defining a new search string, any remembered search string is
used.
Non-incremental searches read the entire search string before starting to search for
matching history lines. The search string may be typed by the user or be part of the
contents of the current line.
bell-style
Controls what happens when Readline wants to ring the termi-
nal bell. If set to ‘none’, Readline never rings the bell. If set to
‘visible’, Readline uses a visible bell if one is available. If set to
‘audible’ (the default), Readline attempts to ring the terminal’s
bell.
bind-tty-special-chars
If set to ‘on’ (the default), Readline attempts to bind the control
characters treated specially by the kernel’s terminal driver to their
Readline equivalents.
blink-matching-paren
If set to ‘on’, Readline attempts to briefly move the cursor to an
opening parenthesis when a closing parenthesis is inserted. The
default is ‘off’.
colored-completion-prefix
If set to ‘on’, when listing completions, Readline displays the com-
mon prefix of the set of possible completions using a different color.
The color definitions are taken from the value of the LS_COLORS
environment variable. The default is ‘off’.
colored-stats
If set to ‘on’, Readline displays possible completions using different
colors to indicate their file type. The color definitions are taken
from the value of the LS_COLORS environment variable. The default
is ‘off’.
comment-begin
The string to insert at the beginning of the line when the
insert-comment command is executed. The default value is "#".
completion-display-width
The number of screen columns used to display possible matches
when performing completion. The value is ignored if it is less than
0 or greater than the terminal screen width. A value of 0 will cause
matches to be displayed one per line. The default value is -1.
completion-ignore-case
If set to ‘on’, Readline performs filename matching and completion
in a case-insensitive fashion. The default value is ‘off’.
completion-map-case
If set to ‘on’, and completion-ignore-case is enabled, Readline treats
hyphens (‘-’) and underscores (‘_’) as equivalent when performing
case-insensitive filename matching and completion. The default
value is ‘off’.
completion-prefix-display-length
The length in characters of the common prefix of a list of possible
completions that is displayed without modification. When set to a
698 Debugging with gdb
value greater than zero, common prefixes longer than this value are
replaced with an ellipsis when displaying possible completions.
completion-query-items
The number of possible completions that determines when the user
is asked whether the list of possibilities should be displayed. If
the number of possible completions is greater than or equal to this
value, Readline will ask whether or not the user wishes to view
them; otherwise, they are simply listed. This variable must be set
to an integer value greater than or equal to 0. A negative value
means Readline should never ask. The default limit is 100.
convert-meta
If set to ‘on’, Readline will convert characters with the eighth bit set
to an ascii key sequence by stripping the eighth bit and prefixing
an ESC character, converting them to a meta-prefixed key sequence.
The default value is ‘on’, but will be set to ‘off’ if the locale is one
that contains eight-bit characters.
disable-completion
If set to ‘On’, Readline will inhibit word completion. Completion
characters will be inserted into the line as if they had been mapped
to self-insert. The default is ‘off’.
echo-control-characters
When set to ‘on’, on operating systems that indicate they support
it, readline echoes a character corresponding to a signal generated
from the keyboard. The default is ‘on’.
editing-mode
The editing-mode variable controls which default set of key bind-
ings is used. By default, Readline starts up in Emacs editing mode,
where the keystrokes are most similar to Emacs. This variable can
be set to either ‘emacs’ or ‘vi’.
emacs-mode-string
If the show-mode-in-prompt variable is enabled, this string is dis-
played immediately before the last line of the primary prompt when
emacs editing mode is active. The value is expanded like a key bind-
ing, so the standard set of meta- and control prefixes and backslash
escape sequences is available. Use the ‘\1’ and ‘\2’ escapes to begin
and end sequences of non-printing characters, which can be used
to embed a terminal control sequence into the mode string. The
default is ‘@’.
enable-bracketed-paste
When set to ‘On’, Readline will configure the terminal in a way that
will enable it to insert each paste into the editing buffer as a single
string of characters, instead of treating each character as if it had
been read from the keyboard. This can prevent pasted characters
from being interpreted as editing commands. The default is ‘On’.
Chapter 33: Command Line Editing 699
enable-keypad
When set to ‘on’, Readline will try to enable the application keypad
when it is called. Some systems need this to enable the arrow keys.
The default is ‘off’.
enable-meta-key
When set to ‘on’, Readline will try to enable any meta modifier
key the terminal claims to support when it is called. On many
terminals, the meta key is used to send eight-bit characters. The
default is ‘on’.
expand-tilde
If set to ‘on’, tilde expansion is performed when Readline attempts
word completion. The default is ‘off’.
history-preserve-point
If set to ‘on’, the history code attempts to place the point (the
current cursor position) at the same location on each history line
retrieved with previous-history or next-history. The default
is ‘off’.
history-size
Set the maximum number of history entries saved in the history
list. If set to zero, any existing history entries are deleted and no
new entries are saved. If set to a value less than zero, the number
of history entries is not limited. By default, the number of history
entries is not limited. If an attempt is made to set history-size to
a non-numeric value, the maximum number of history entries will
be set to 500.
horizontal-scroll-mode
This variable can be set to either ‘on’ or ‘off’. Setting it to ‘on’
means that the text of the lines being edited will scroll horizontally
on a single screen line when they are longer than the width of the
screen, instead of wrapping onto a new screen line. This variable is
automatically set to ‘on’ for terminals of height 1. By default, this
variable is set to ‘off’.
input-meta
If set to ‘on’, Readline will enable eight-bit input (it will not clear
the eighth bit in the characters it reads), regardless of what the
terminal claims it can support. The default value is ‘off’, but
Readline will set it to ‘on’ if the locale contains eight-bit characters.
The name meta-flag is a synonym for this variable.
isearch-terminators
The string of characters that should terminate an incremental
search without subsequently executing the character as a command
(see Section 33.2.5 [Searching], page 695). If this variable has not
been given a value, the characters ESC and C-J will terminate an
incremental search.
700 Debugging with gdb
keymap Sets Readline’s idea of the current keymap for key binding
commands. Built-in keymap names are emacs, emacs-standard,
emacs-meta, emacs-ctlx, vi, vi-move, vi-command, and
vi-insert. vi is equivalent to vi-command (vi-move is also a
synonym); emacs is equivalent to emacs-standard. Applications
may add additional names. The default value is emacs. The value
of the editing-mode variable also affects the default keymap.
keyseq-timeout
Specifies the duration Readline will wait for a character when read-
ing an ambiguous key sequence (one that can form a complete key
sequence using the input read so far, or can take additional input
to complete a longer key sequence). If no input is received within
the timeout, Readline will use the shorter but complete key se-
quence. Readline uses this value to determine whether or not input
is available on the current input source (rl_instream by default).
The value is specified in milliseconds, so a value of 1000 means that
Readline will wait one second for additional input. If this variable is
set to a value less than or equal to zero, or to a non-numeric value,
Readline will wait until another key is pressed to decide which key
sequence to complete. The default value is 500.
mark-directories
If set to ‘on’, completed directory names have a slash appended.
The default is ‘on’.
mark-modified-lines
This variable, when set to ‘on’, causes Readline to display an as-
terisk (‘*’) at the start of history lines which have been modified.
This variable is ‘off’ by default.
mark-symlinked-directories
If set to ‘on’, completed names which are symbolic links to
directories have a slash appended (subject to the value of
mark-directories). The default is ‘off’.
match-hidden-files
This variable, when set to ‘on’, causes Readline to match files whose
names begin with a ‘.’ (hidden files) when performing filename
completion. If set to ‘off’, the leading ‘.’ must be supplied by
the user in the filename to be completed. This variable is ‘on’ by
default.
menu-complete-display-prefix
If set to ‘on’, menu completion displays the common prefix of the
list of possible completions (which may be empty) before cycling
through the list. The default is ‘off’.
output-meta
If set to ‘on’, Readline will display characters with the eighth bit
set directly rather than as a meta-prefixed escape sequence. The
Chapter 33: Command Line Editing 701
default is ‘off’, but Readline will set it to ‘on’ if the locale contains
eight-bit characters.
page-completions
If set to ‘on’, Readline uses an internal more-like pager to display
a screenful of possible completions at a time. This variable is ‘on’
by default.
print-completions-horizontally
If set to ‘on’, Readline will display completions with matches sorted
horizontally in alphabetical order, rather than down the screen.
The default is ‘off’.
revert-all-at-newline
If set to ‘on’, Readline will undo all changes to history lines before
returning when accept-line is executed. By default, history lines
may be modified and retain individual undo lists across calls to
readline. The default is ‘off’.
show-all-if-ambiguous
This alters the default behavior of the completion functions. If set
to ‘on’, words which have more than one possible completion cause
the matches to be listed immediately instead of ringing the bell.
The default value is ‘off’.
show-all-if-unmodified
This alters the default behavior of the completion functions in a
fashion similar to show-all-if-ambiguous. If set to ‘on’, words which
have more than one possible completion without any possible par-
tial completion (the possible completions don’t share a common
prefix) cause the matches to be listed immediately instead of ring-
ing the bell. The default value is ‘off’.
show-mode-in-prompt
If set to ‘on’, add a string to the beginning of the prompt indicating
the editing mode: emacs, vi command, or vi insertion. The mode
strings are user-settable (e.g., emacs-mode-string). The default
value is ‘off’.
skip-completed-text
If set to ‘on’, this alters the default completion behavior when in-
serting a single match into the line. It’s only active when perform-
ing completion in the middle of a word. If enabled, readline does
not insert characters from the completion that match characters
after point in the word being completed, so portions of the word
following the cursor are not duplicated. For instance, if this is en-
abled, attempting completion when the cursor is after the ‘e’ in
‘Makefile’ will result in ‘Makefile’ rather than ‘Makefilefile’,
assuming there is a single possible completion. The default value
is ‘off’.
702 Debugging with gdb
vi-cmd-mode-string
If the show-mode-in-prompt variable is enabled, this string is dis-
played immediately before the last line of the primary prompt when
vi editing mode is active and in command mode. The value is ex-
panded like a key binding, so the standard set of meta- and control
prefixes and backslash escape sequences is available. Use the ‘\1’
and ‘\2’ escapes to begin and end sequences of non-printing charac-
ters, which can be used to embed a terminal control sequence into
the mode string. The default is ‘(cmd)’.
vi-ins-mode-string
If the show-mode-in-prompt variable is enabled, this string is dis-
played immediately before the last line of the primary prompt when
vi editing mode is active and in insertion mode. The value is ex-
panded like a key binding, so the standard set of meta- and control
prefixes and backslash escape sequences is available. Use the ‘\1’
and ‘\2’ escapes to begin and end sequences of non-printing charac-
ters, which can be used to embed a terminal control sequence into
the mode string. The default is ‘(ins)’.
visible-stats
If set to ‘on’, a character denoting a file’s type is appended to the
filename when listing possible completions. The default is ‘off’.
Key Bindings
The syntax for controlling key bindings in the init file is simple. First you
need to find the name of the command that you want to change. The following
sections contain tables of the command name, the default keybinding, if any,
and a short description of what the command does.
Once you know the name of the command, simply place on a line in the init
file the name of the key you wish to bind the command to, a colon, and then
the name of the command. There can be no space between the key name and
the colon – that will be interpreted as part of the key name. The name of
the key can be expressed in different ways, depending on what you find most
comfortable.
In addition to command names, readline allows keys to be bound to a string
that is inserted when the key is pressed (a macro).
keyname: function-name or macro
keyname is the name of a key spelled out in English. For example:
Control-u: universal-argument
Meta-Rubout: backward-kill-word
Control-o: "> output"
In the example above, C-u is bound to the function
universal-argument, M-DEL is bound to the function
backward-kill-word, and C-o is bound to run the macro
expressed on the right hand side (that is, to insert the text ‘>
output’ into the line).
Chapter 33: Command Line Editing 703
When entering the text of a macro, single or double quotes must be used to
indicate a macro definition. Unquoted text is assumed to be a function name. In
the macro body, the backslash escapes described above are expanded. Backslash
will quote any other character in the macro text, including ‘"’ and ‘’’. For
example, the following binding will make ‘C-x \’ insert a single ‘\’ into the line:
"\C-x\\": "\\"
#
# Set various bindings for emacs mode.
$if mode=emacs
#
# Arrow keys in keypad mode
#
#"\M-OD": backward-char
#"\M-OC": forward-char
#"\M-OA": previous-history
#"\M-OB": next-history
#
# Arrow keys in ANSI mode
#
"\M-[D": backward-char
"\M-[C": forward-char
"\M-[A": previous-history
"\M-[B": next-history
#
# Arrow keys in 8 bit keypad mode
#
#"\M-\C-OD": backward-char
#"\M-\C-OC": forward-char
#"\M-\C-OA": previous-history
#"\M-\C-OB": next-history
#
# Arrow keys in 8 bit ANSI mode
#
#"\M-\C-[D": backward-char
#"\M-\C-[C": forward-char
Chapter 33: Command Line Editing 707
#"\M-\C-[A": previous-history
#"\M-\C-[B": next-history
C-q: quoted-insert
$endif
# For FTP
$if Ftp
"\C-xg": "get \M-?"
"\C-xt": "put \M-?"
"\M-.": yank-last-arg
$endif
clear-screen (C-l)
Clear the screen, then redraw the current line, leaving the current line at the
top of the screen.
redraw-current-line ()
Refresh the current line. By default, this is unbound.
backward-delete-char (Rubout)
Delete the character behind the cursor. A numeric argument means to kill the
characters instead of deleting them.
forward-backward-delete-char ()
Delete the character under the cursor, unless the cursor is at the end of the
line, in which case the character behind the cursor is deleted. By default, this
is not bound to a key.
quoted-insert (C-q or C-v)
Add the next character typed to the line verbatim. This is how to insert key
sequences like C-q, for example.
tab-insert (M-TAB)
Insert a tab character.
self-insert (a, b, A, 1, !, ...)
Insert yourself.
bracketed-paste-begin ()
This function is intended to be bound to the "bracketed paste" escape sequence
sent by some terminals, and such a binding is assigned by default. It allows
Readline to insert the pasted text as a single unit without treating each char-
acter as if it had been read from the keyboard. The characters are inserted
as if each one was bound to self-insert instead of executing any editing
commands.
Bracketed paste sets the region (the characters between point and the mark)
to the inserted text. It uses the concept of an active mark : when the mark
is active, Readline redisplay uses the terminal’s standout mode to denote the
region.
transpose-chars (C-t)
Drag the character before the cursor forward over the character at the cursor,
moving the cursor forward as well. If the insertion point is at the end of the
line, then this transposes the last two characters of the line. Negative arguments
have no effect.
transpose-words (M-t)
Drag the word before point past the word after point, moving point past that
word as well. If the insertion point is at the end of the line, this transposes the
last two words on the line.
upcase-word (M-u)
Uppercase the current (or following) word. With a negative argument, upper-
case the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
downcase-word (M-l)
Lowercase the current (or following) word. With a negative argument, lowercase
the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
capitalize-word (M-c)
Capitalize the current (or following) word. With a negative argument, capitalize
the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
712 Debugging with gdb
overwrite-mode ()
Toggle overwrite mode. With an explicit positive numeric argument, switches
to overwrite mode. With an explicit non-positive numeric argument, switches to
insert mode. This command affects only emacs mode; vi mode does overwrite
differently. Each call to readline() starts in insert mode.
In overwrite mode, characters bound to self-insert replace the text at
point rather than pushing the text to the right. Characters bound to
backward-delete-char replace the character before point with a space.
By default, this command is unbound.
kill-region ()
Kill the text in the current region. By default, this command is unbound.
copy-region-as-kill ()
Copy the text in the region to the kill buffer, so it can be yanked right away.
By default, this command is unbound.
copy-backward-word ()
Copy the word before point to the kill buffer. The word boundaries are the
same as backward-word. By default, this command is unbound.
copy-forward-word ()
Copy the word following point to the kill buffer. The word boundaries are the
same as forward-word. By default, this command is unbound.
yank (C-y)
Yank the top of the kill ring into the buffer at point.
yank-pop (M-y)
Rotate the kill-ring, and yank the new top. You can only do this if the prior
command is yank or yank-pop.
menu-complete ()
Similar to complete, but replaces the word to be completed with a single match
from the list of possible completions. Repeated execution of menu-complete
steps through the list of possible completions, inserting each match in turn.
At the end of the list of completions, the bell is rung (subject to the setting
of bell-style) and the original text is restored. An argument of n moves n
positions forward in the list of matches; a negative argument may be used to
move backward through the list. This command is intended to be bound to
TAB, but is unbound by default.
menu-complete-backward ()
Identical to menu-complete, but moves backward through the list of possible
completions, as if menu-complete had been given a negative argument.
delete-char-or-list ()
Deletes the character under the cursor if not at the beginning or end of the
line (like delete-char). If at the end of the line, behaves identically to
possible-completions. This command is unbound by default.
dump-macros ()
Print all of the Readline key sequences bound to macros and the strings they
output. If a numeric argument is supplied, the output is formatted in such a
way that it can be made part of an inputrc file. This command is unbound by
default.
emacs-editing-mode (C-e)
When in vi command mode, this causes a switch to emacs editing mode.
vi-editing-mode (M-C-j)
When in emacs editing mode, this causes a switch to vi editing mode.
^string1^string2^
Quick Substitution. Repeat the last command, replacing string1 with string2.
Equivalent to !!:s^string1^string2^.
!# The entire command line typed so far.
34.1.3 Modifiers
After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence of one or more of the following
modifiers, each preceded by a ‘:’. These modify, or edit, the word or words selected from
the history event.
h Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving only the head.
719
Appendix A In Memoriam
The gdb project mourns the loss of the following long-time contributors:
Fred Fish Fred was a long-standing contributor to gdb (1991-2006), and to Free Software
in general. Outside of gdb, he was known in the Amiga world for his series of
Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
Michael Snyder
Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the gdb project, with contri-
butions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition to his day to day
participation, he was a large driving force behind adding Reverse Debugging to
gdb.
Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also enjoyable members
of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
723
1
In gdb-14.0.50.20230731-git/gdb/refcard.ps of the version 14.0.50.20230731-git release.
724 Debugging with gdb
If you have TEX and a dvi printer program installed, you can typeset and print this
manual. First switch to the gdb subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
gdb-14.0.50.20230731-git/gdb) and type:
make gdb.dvi
Then give gdb.dvi to your dvi printing program.
725
Python gdb can be scripted using Python language. See Section 23.3 [Python],
page 391. The latest version is available from https: / / www . python . org /
downloads / . Use the --with-python=dir to specify the non-standard
directory where Python is installed.
Guile gdb can also be scripted using GNU Guile. See Section 23.4 [Guile], page 499.
The latest version can be found on https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/
download / . If you have more than one version of Guile installed, use the
--with-guile=guile-version to specify the Guile version to include in the
build.
Expat If available, gdb uses the Expat library for parsing XML files. gdb uses XML
files for the following functionalities:
• Remote protocol memory maps (see Section E.16 [Memory Map Format],
page 818)
• Target descriptions (see Appendix G [Target Descriptions], page 835)
• Remote shared library lists (See Section E.14 [Library List Format],
page 817, or alternatively see Section E.15 [Library List Format for SVR4
Targets], page 818)
• MS-Windows shared libraries (see [Shared Libraries], page 289)
• Traceframe info (see Section E.18 [Traceframe Info Format], page 820)
• Branch trace (see Section E.19 [Branch Trace Format], page 820, see
Section E.20 [Branch Trace Configuration Format], page 821)
The latest version of Expat is available from http://expat.sourceforge.net.
Use the --with-libexpat-prefix to specify non-standard installation places
for Expat.
iconv gdb’s features related to character sets (see Section 10.21 [Character Sets],
page 183) require a functioning iconv implementation. If you are on a GNU
system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some other systems also
provide a working iconv. Use the option --with-iconv-bin to specify where
to find the iconv program.
On systems without iconv, you can install the GNU Libiconv library; its lat-
est version can be found on https://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/libiconv/ if
your system doesn’t provide it. Use the --with-libiconv-prefix option to
configure to specify non-standard installation place for it.
Alternatively, gdb’s top-level configure and Makefile will arrange to build
Libiconv if a directory named libiconv appears in the top-most source direc-
tory. If Libiconv is built this way, and if the operating system does not provide
a suitable iconv implementation, then the just-built library will automatically
be used by gdb. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU Libiconv,
unpack it inside the top-level directory of the gdb source tree, and then rename
the directory holding the Libiconv source code to ‘libiconv’.
lzma gdb can support debugging sections that are compressed with the LZMA li-
brary. See Section 18.4 [MiniDebugInfo], page 298. If this library is not included
with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package at http: / /
Appendix C: Installing gdb 727
1
If you have a more recent version of gdb than 14.0.50.20230731-git, look at the README file in the sources;
we may have improved the installation procedures since publishing this manual.
728 Debugging with gdb
./configure
make
Running ‘configure’ and then running make builds the included supporting libraries,
then gdb itself. The configured source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding
source directories.
configure is a Bourne-shell (/bin/sh) script; if your system does not recognize this
automatically when you run a different shell, you may need to run sh on it explicitly:
sh configure
You should run the configure script from the top directory in the source tree, the
gdb-version-number directory. If you run configure from one of the subdirectories, you
will configure only that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular, if
you run the first configure from the gdb subdirectory of the gdb-version-number direc-
tory, you will omit the configuration of bfd, readline, and other sibling directories of the
gdb subdirectory. This leads to build errors about missing include files such as bfd/bfd.h.
You can install gdb anywhere. The best way to do this is to pass the --prefix option
to configure, and then install it with make install.
programs that run on another machine—the target). You specify a cross-debugging target
by giving the ‘--target=target’ option to configure.
When you run make to build a program or library, you must run it in a configured
directory—whatever directory you were in when you called configure (or one of its subdi-
rectories).
The Makefile that configure generates in each source directory also runs recursively. If
you type make in a source directory such as gdb-14.0.50.20230731-git (or in a separate
configured directory configured with ‘--srcdir=dirname/gdb-14.0.50.20230731-git’),
you will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate directories, you can run
make on them in parallel (for example, if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they
will not interfere with each other.
[--target=target]
You may introduce options with a single ‘-’ rather than ‘--’ if you prefer; but you may
abbreviate option names if you use ‘--’.
--help Display a quick summary of how to invoke configure.
--prefix=dir
Configure the source to install programs and files under directory dir.
--exec-prefix=dir
Configure the source to install programs under directory dir.
--srcdir=dirname
Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the gdb
source directories. Among other things, you can use this to build (or maintain)
several configurations simultaneously, in separate directories. configure writes
configuration-specific files in the current directory, but arranges for them to use
the source in the directory dirname. configure creates directories under the
working directory in parallel to the source directories below dirname.
--target=target
Configure gdb for cross-debugging programs running on the specified target.
Without this option, gdb is configured to debug programs that run on the same
machine (host) as gdb itself.
There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets. Also see
the --enable-targets option, below.
There are many other options that are specific to gdb. This lists just the most common
ones; there are some very specialized options not described here.
--enable-targets=[target]...
--enable-targets=all
Configure gdb for cross-debugging programs running on the specified list of
targets. The special value ‘all’ configures gdb for debugging programs running
on any target it supports.
--with-gdb-datadir=path
Set the gdb-specific data directory. gdb will look here for certain supporting
files or scripts. This defaults to the gdb subdirectory of ‘datadir’ (which can
be set using --datadir).
--with-relocated-sources=dir
Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory names
recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for any directory
under dir. dir should be a subdirectory of gdb’s configured prefix, the one
mentioned in the --prefix or --exec-prefix options to configure. This
option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place after it is
built.
--enable-64-bit-bfd
Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
Appendix C: Installing gdb 731
--disable-gdbmi
Build gdb without the GDB/MI machine interface (see Chapter 27 [GDB/MI],
page 569).
--enable-tui
Build gdb with the text-mode full-screen user interface (TUI). Requires a curses
library (ncurses and cursesX are also supported).
--with-curses
Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode terminal
operations.
--with-debuginfod
Build gdb with libdebuginfod, the debuginfod client library. Used to
automatically fetch ELF, DWARF and source files from debuginfod servers
using build IDs associated with any missing files. Enabled by default if
libdebuginfod is installed and found at configure time. For more information
regarding debuginfod see Appendix K [Debuginfod], page 863.
--with-libunwind-ia64
Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64 target plat-
forms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for details.
--with-system-readline
Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the library supplied
as part of gdb. Readline 7 or newer is required; this is enforced by the build
system.
--with-system-zlib
Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library supplied as
part of gdb.
--with-expat
Build gdb with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by default if libexpat
is installed and found at configure time.) This library is used to read XML files
supplied with gdb. If it is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol
memory maps, target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on
XML files, will not be available in gdb. If your host does not have libexpat
installed, you can get the latest version from http://expat.sourceforge.
net.
--with-libiconv-prefix[=dir]
Build gdb with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding conversion library. This
is not done by default, as on GNU systems the iconv that is built in to the
C library is sufficient. If your host does not have a working iconv, you can
get the latest version of GNU iconv from https://www.gnu.org/software/
libiconv/.
gdb’s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as part of the overall
build. See Section C.1 [Requirements], page 725.
--with-lzma
Build gdb with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default if liblzma is in-
stalled and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by gdb’s "mini debuginfo"
732 Debugging with gdb
feature, which is only useful on platforms using the ELF object file format. If
your host does not have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
https://tukaani.org/xz/.
--with-python[=python]
Build gdb with Python scripting support. (Done by default if libpython is
present and found at configure time.) Python makes gdb scripting much more
powerful than the restricted CLI scripting language. If your host does not have
Python installed, you can find it on http://www.python.org/download/. The
oldest version of Python supported by GDB is 3.0.1. The optional argument
python is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either the
name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which Python is
installed.
--with-guile[=guile]
Build gdb with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default if libguile is
present and found at configure time.) If your host does not have Guile installed,
you can find it at https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/. The optional
argument guile can be a version number, which will cause configure to try to
use that version of Guile; or the file name of a pkg-config executable, which
will be queried to find the information needed to compile and link against Guile.
--without-included-regex
Don’t use the regex library included with gdb (as part of the libiberty library).
This is the default on hosts with version 2 of the GNU C library.
--with-sysroot=dir
Use dir as the default system root directory for libraries whose file names begin
with /lib’ or /usr/lib’. (The value of dir can be modified at run time by
using the set sysroot command.) If dir is under the gdb configured prefix
(set with --prefix or --exec-prefix options, the default system root will
be automatically adjusted if and when gdb is moved to a different location.
--with-system-gdbinit=file
Configure gdb to automatically load a system-wide init file. file should be an
absolute file name. If file is in a directory under the configured prefix, and gdb
is moved to another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
init file will be adjusted accordingly.
--with-system-gdbinit-dir=directory
Configure gdb to automatically load init files from a system-wide directory.
directory should be an absolute directory name. If directory is in a directory
under the configured prefix, and gdb is moved to another location after being
built, the location of the system-wide init directory will be adjusted accordingly.
--enable-build-warnings
When building the gdb sources, ask the compiler to warn about any code which
looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many different warning flags, depending
on the exact version of the compiler you are using.
Appendix C: Installing gdb 733
--enable-werror
Treat compiler warnings as errors. It adds the -Werror flag to the compiler,
which will fail the compilation if the compiler outputs any warning messages.
--enable-ubsan
Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by default,
but passing --enable-ubsan=yes or --enable-ubsan=auto to configure will
enable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C++ undefined behavior.
It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at gdb’s performance, you should
disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
This command lists all the architectures for which a disassembler is currently
registered, and the name of the disassembler. If a disassembler is registered for
all architectures, then this is listed last against the ‘GLOBAL’ architecture.
If one of the disassemblers would be selected for the architecture of the current
inferior, then this disassembler will be marked.
The following example shows a situation in which two disassemblers are regis-
tered, initially the ‘i386’ disassembler matches the current architecture, then
the architecture is changed, now the ‘GLOBAL’ disassembler matches.
(gdb) show architecture
The target architecture is set to "auto" (currently "i386").
(gdb) maint info python-disassemblers
Architecture Disassember Name
i386 Disassembler_1 (Matches current architecture)
GLOBAL Disassembler_2
(gdb) set architecture arm
The target architecture is set to "arm".
(gdb) maint info python-disassemblers
quit
Architecture Disassember Name
i386 Disassembler_1
GLOBAL Disassembler_2 (Matches current architecture)
set displaced-stepping
show displaced-stepping
Control whether or not gdb will do displaced stepping if the target supports it.
Displaced stepping is a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing
them from the inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that
was originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-
stepping.
set displaced-stepping on
If the target architecture supports it, gdb will use displaced step-
ping to step over breakpoints.
set displaced-stepping off
gdb will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints, even
if such is supported by the target architecture.
set displaced-stepping auto
This is the default mode. gdb will use displaced stepping only
if non-stop mode is active (see Section 5.5.2 [Non-Stop Mode],
page 94) and the target architecture supports displaced stepping.
maint check-psymtabs
Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs. Use
this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
maint check-symtabs
Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
maint expand-symtabs [regexp]
Expand symbol tables. If regexp is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
names matching regexp.
738 Debugging with gdb
These commands let you override the default behaviour for each particular
action, described in the table below.
‘quit’ You can specify that gdb should always (yes) or never (no) quit.
The default is to ask the user what to do.
‘corefile’
You can specify that gdb should always (yes) or never (no) create
a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note that
there is no corefile option for demangler-warning: demangler
warnings always create a core file and this cannot be disabled.
maint set internal-error backtrace [on|off]
maint show internal-error backtrace
maint set internal-warning backtrace [on|off]
maint show internal-warning backtrace
When gdb reports an internal problem (error or warning) it is possible to have
a backtrace of gdb printed to the standard error stream. This is ‘on’ by default
for internal-error and ‘off’ by default for internal-warning.
maint packet text
If gdb is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol, then this command sends
the string text to the inferior, and displays the response packet. gdb supplies
the initial ‘$’ character, the terminating ‘#’ character, and the checksum.
Any non-printable characters in the reply are printed as escaped hex, e.g.
‘\x00’, ‘\x01’, etc.
maint print architecture [file]
Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument file names
the file where the output goes.
maint print c-tdesc [-single-feature] [file]
Print the target description (see Appendix G [Target Descriptions], page 835)
as a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current target,
but if the optional argument file is provided, that file is used to produce the
description. The file should be an XML document, of the form described in
Section G.2 [Target Description Format], page 835. The created source file is
built into gdb when gdb is built again. This command is used by developers
after they add or modify XML target descriptions.
When the optional flag ‘-single-feature’ is provided then the target descrip-
tion being processed (either the default, or from file) must only contain a single
feature. The source file produced is different in this case.
maint print xml-tdesc [file]
Print the target description (see Appendix G [Target Descriptions], page 835) as
an XML file. By default print the target description for the current target, but
if the optional argument file is provided, then that file is read in by GDB and
then used to produce the description. The file should be an XML document,
of the form described in Section G.2 [Target Description Format], page 835.
740 Debugging with gdb
script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile, and the full
path if known. See Section 23.5.2 [dotdebug gdb scripts section], page 552.
The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of gdb, such as in the
test suite.
set watchdog nsec
Set the maximum number of seconds gdb will wait for the target operation to
finish. If this time expires, gdb reports and error and the command is aborted.
show watchdog
Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
749
E.1 Overview
There may be occasions when you need to know something about the protocol—for example,
if there is only one serial port to your target machine, you might want your program to do
something special if it recognizes a packet meant for gdb.
In the examples below, ‘->’ and ‘<-’ are used to indicate transmitted and received data,
respectively.
All gdb commands and responses (other than acknowledgments and notifications, see
Section E.9 [Notification Packets], page 801) are sent as a packet. A packet is introduced
with the character ‘$’, the actual packet-data, and the terminating character ‘#’ followed
by a two-digit checksum:
$packet-data#checksum
The two-digit checksum is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all characters between the
leading ‘$’ and the trailing ‘#’ (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
Implementors should note that prior to gdb 5.0 the protocol specification also included
an optional two-digit sequence-id:
$sequence-id:packet-data#checksum
That sequence-id was appended to the acknowledgment. gdb has never output sequence-
ids. Stubs that handle packets added since gdb 5.0 must not accept sequence-id.
When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first response expected
is an acknowledgment: either ‘+’ (to indicate the package was received correctly) or ‘-’ (to
request retransmission):
-> $packet-data#checksum
<- +
The binary data representation uses 7d (ascii ‘}’) as an escape character. Any escaped
byte is transmitted as the escape character followed by the original character XORed with
0x20. For example, the byte 0x7d would be transmitted as the two bytes 0x7d 0x5d. The
bytes 0x23 (ascii ‘#’), 0x24 (ascii ‘$’), and 0x7d (ascii ‘}’) must always be escaped.
Responses sent by the stub must also escape 0x2a (ascii ‘*’), so that it is not interpreted
as the start of a run-length encoded sequence (described next).
Response data can be run-length encoded to save space. Run-length encoding replaces
runs of identical characters with one instance of the repeated character, followed by a ‘*’
and a repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid binary characters in
data: a value of n is sent as n+29. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this produces
a printable ascii character, e.g. a space (ascii code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is
because run-length encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example, ‘0* ’
is a run-length encoding of “0000”: the space character after ‘*’ means repeat the leading
0 32 - 29 = 3 more times.
The printable characters ‘#’ and ‘$’ or with a numeric value greater than 126 must not
be used. Runs of six repeats (‘#’) or seven repeats (‘$’) can be expanded using a repeat
count of only five (‘"’). For example, ‘00000000’ can be encoded as ‘0*"00’.
The error response returned for some packets includes a two character error number.
That number is not well defined.
For any command not supported by the stub, an empty response (‘$#00’) should be
returned. That way it is possible to extend the protocol. A newer gdb can tell if a packet
is supported based on that response.
At a minimum, a stub is required to support the ‘?’ command to tell gdb the reason
for halting, ‘g’ and ‘G’ commands for register access, and the ‘m’ and ‘M’ commands for
memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets can implement run control
with the ‘c’ (continue) command, and if the target architecture supports hardware-assisted
single-stepping, the ‘s’ (step) command. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
support the ‘vCont’ command. All other commands are optional.
E.2 Packets
The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined commands and their cor-
responding response data. See Section E.13 [File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension], page 805,
for details about the File I/O extension of the remote protocol.
Each packet’s description has a template showing the packet’s overall syntax, followed
by an explanation of the packet’s meaning. We include spaces in some of the templates for
clarity; these are not part of the packet’s syntax. No gdb packet uses spaces to separate its
components. For example, a template like ‘foo bar baz’ describes a packet beginning with
the three ASCII bytes ‘foo’, followed by a bar, followed directly by a baz. gdb does not
transmit a space character between the ‘foo’ and the bar, or between the bar and the baz.
Several packets and replies include a thread-id field to identify a thread. Normally
these are positive numbers with a target-specific interpretation, formatted as big-endian
hex strings. A thread-id can also be a literal ‘-1’ to indicate all threads, or ‘0’ to pick any
thread.
In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in which the thread-id
syntax is extended to optionally include both process and thread ID fields, as ‘ppid.tid’.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 751
The pid (process) and tid (thread) components each have the format described above: a
positive number with target-specific interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string,
literal ‘-1’ to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or ‘0’ to indicate an arbitrary
process or thread. Specifying just a process, as ‘ppid’, is equivalent to ‘ppid.-1’. It is an
error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as ‘p-1.tid’. Note that the ‘p’
prefix is not used for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
ID, rather than a thread-id.
The multiprocess thread-id syntax extensions are only used if both gdb and the stub
report support for the ‘multiprocess’ feature using ‘qSupported’. See [multiprocess ex-
tensions], page 781, for more information.
Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case letter, other than
those described here, are reserved for future use.
Here are the packet descriptions.
‘!’ Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made persistent.
The ‘R’ packet is used to restart the program being debugged.
Reply:
‘OK’ The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
‘?’ This is sent when connection is first established to query the reason the target
halted. The reply is the same as for step and continue. This packet has a special
interpretation when the target is in non-stop mode; see Section E.10 [Remote
Non-Stop], page 803.
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘A arglen,argnum,arg,...’
Initialized argv[] array passed into program. arglen specifies the number of
bytes in the hex encoded byte stream arg. See gdbserver for more details.
Reply:
‘OK’ The arguments were set.
‘E NN’ An error occurred.
‘b baud’ (Don’t use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.) Change the serial line
speed to baud.
JTC: When does the transport layer state change? When it’s received, or after
the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or
the acknowledgment packet is dropped.
Stan: If people really wanted to add something like this, and get it working
for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-
band message to a specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between"
packets, so that from remote protocol’s point of view, nothing actually happened.
‘B addr,mode’
Set (mode is ‘S’) or clear (mode is ‘C’) a breakpoint at addr.
Don’t use this packet. Use the ‘Z’ and ‘z’ packets instead (see [insert breakpoint
or watchpoint packet], page 759).
752 Debugging with gdb
‘bc’ Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter. See
Chapter 6 [Reverse Execution], page 99, for more information.
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘bs’ Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter. See
Chapter 6 [Reverse Execution], page 99, for more information.
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘c [addr]’ Continue at addr, which is the address to resume. If addr is omitted, resume
at current address.
This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. See [vCont packet],
page 756.
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘C sig[;addr]’
Continue with signal sig (hex signal number). If ‘;addr’ is omitted, resume at
same address.
This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. See [vCont packet],
page 756.
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘d’ Toggle debug flag.
Don’t use this packet; instead, define a general set packet (see Section E.4
[General Query Packets], page 765).
‘D’
‘D;pid’ The first form of the packet is used to detach gdb from the remote system. It
is sent to the remote target before gdb disconnects via the detach command.
The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess protocol
extensions are enabled (see [multiprocess extensions], page 781), to detach only
a specific process. The pid is specified as a big-endian hex string.
Reply:
‘OK’ for success
‘E NN’ for an error
‘F RC,EE,CF;XX’
A reply from gdb to an ‘F’ packet sent by the target. This is part of the File-
I/O protocol extension. See Section E.13 [File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension],
page 805, for the specification.
‘g’ Read general registers.
Reply:
‘XX...’ Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The
bytes with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 753
size of each register and their position within the ‘g’ packet are
determined by the target description (see Appendix G [Target De-
scriptions], page 835); in the absence of a target description, this is
done using code internal to gdb; typically this is some customary
register layout for the architecture in question.
When reading registers, the stub may also return a string of lit-
eral ‘x’’s in place of the register data digits, to indicate that the
corresponding register’s value is unavailable. For example, when
reading registers from a trace frame (see Section 13.2 [Using the
Collected Data], page 211), this means that the register has not
been collected in the trace frame. When reading registers from a
live program, this indicates that the stub has no means to access the
register contents, even though the corresponding register is known
to exist. Note that if a register truly does not exist on the target,
then it is better to not include it in the target description in the
first place.
For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of 4 bytes each,
the following reply indicates to gdb that registers 0 and 2 are un-
available, while registers 1 and 3 are available, and both have zero
value:
-> g
<- xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000
‘vAttach;pid’
Attach to a new process with the specified process ID pid. The process ID is a
hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all threads in the
attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be attached without
being stopped if that is supported by the target.
This packet is only available in extended mode (see [extended mode], page 751).
Reply:
‘E nn’ for an error
‘Any stop packet’
for success in all-stop mode (see Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets],
page 761)
‘OK’ for success in non-stop mode (see Section E.10 [Remote Non-Stop],
page 803)
‘vCont[;action[:thread-id]]...’
Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching thread-id is ap-
plied. Threads that don’t match any action remain in their current state.
Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in [thread-id syntax],
page 750. If multiprocess extensions (see [multiprocess extensions], page 781)
are supported, actions can be specified to match all threads in a process by us-
ing the ‘ppid.-1’ form of the thread-id. An action with no thread-id matches
all threads. Specifying no actions is an error.
Currently supported actions are:
‘c’ Continue.
‘C sig’ Continue with signal sig. The signal sig should be two hex digits.
‘s’ Step.
‘S sig’ Step with signal sig. The signal sig should be two hex digits.
‘t’ Stop.
‘r start,end’
Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
addresses between start (inclusive) and end (exclusive). The remote
stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out of the
range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting a
breakpoint. See [range stepping], page 86.
If the range is empty (start == end), then the action becomes
equivalent to the ‘s’ action. In other words, single-step once, and
report the stop (even if the stepped instruction jumps to start).
(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 757
The optional argument addr normally associated with the ‘c’, ‘C’, ‘s’, and ‘S’
packets is not supported in ‘vCont’.
The ‘t’ action is only relevant in non-stop mode (see Section E.10 [Remote Non-
Stop], page 803) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise. A stop reply should
be generated for any affected thread not already stopped. When a thread is
stopped by means of a ‘t’ action, the corresponding stop reply should indicate
that the thread has stopped with signal ‘0’, regardless of whether the target
uses some other signal as an implementation detail.
The server must ignore ‘c’, ‘C’, ‘s’, ‘S’, and ‘r’ actions for threads that are
already running. Conversely, the server must ignore ‘t’ actions for threads that
are already stopped.
Note: In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until gdb acknowl-
edges an asynchronous stop notification for it with the ‘vStopped’ packet (see
Section E.10 [Remote Non-Stop], page 803).
The stub must support ‘vCont’ if it reports support for multiprocess extensions
(see [multiprocess extensions], page 781).
Reply: See Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761, for the reply specifica-
tions.
‘vCont?’ Request a list of actions supported by the ‘vCont’ packet.
Reply:
‘vCont[;action...]’
The ‘vCont’ packet is supported. Each action is a supported com-
mand in the ‘vCont’ packet.
‘’ The ‘vCont’ packet is not supported.
‘vCtrlC’ Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote terminal.
This is the equivalent to reacting to the ^C (‘\003’, the control-C character)
character in all-stop mode while the target is running, except this works in
non-stop mode. See [interrupting remote targets], page 801, for more info on
the all-stop variant.
Reply:
‘E nn’ for an error
‘OK’ for success
‘vFile:operation:parameter...’
Perform a file operation on the target system. For details, see Section E.7 [Host
I/O Packets], page 799.
‘vFlashErase:addr,length’
Direct the stub to erase length bytes of flash starting at addr. The region may
enclose any number of flash blocks, but its start and end must fall on block
boundaries, as indicated by the flash block size appearing in the memory map
(see Section E.16 [Memory Map Format], page 818). gdb groups flash memory
programming operations together, and sends a ‘vFlashDone’ request after each
758 Debugging with gdb
group; the stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the ‘vFlashDone’ packet
is received.
Reply:
‘OK’ for success
‘E NN’ for an error
‘vFlashWrite:addr:XX...’
Direct the stub to write data to flash address addr. The data is passed in
binary form using the same encoding as for the ‘X’ packet (see [Binary Data],
page 749). The memory ranges specified by ‘vFlashWrite’ packets preceding a
‘vFlashDone’ packet must not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing
addresses (although ‘vFlashErase’ packets for higher addresses may already
have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between ‘vFlashWrite’
packets). If a packet writes to an address that was neither erased by a preceding
‘vFlashErase’ packet nor by some other target-specific method, the results are
unpredictable.
Reply:
‘OK’ for success
‘E.memtype’
for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
‘E NN’ for an error
‘vFlashDone’
Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished. The stub
is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of ‘vFlashErase’ and
‘vFlashWrite’ packets until a ‘vFlashDone’ packet is received. The contents of
the affected regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the ‘vFlashDone’
request is completed.
‘vKill;pid’
Kill the process with the specified process ID pid, which is a hexadecimal in-
teger identifying the process. This packet is used in preference to ‘k’ when
multiprocess protocol extensions are supported; see [multiprocess extensions],
page 781.
Reply:
‘E nn’ for an error
‘OK’ for success
‘vMustReplyEmpty’
The correct reply to an unknown ‘v’ packet is to return the empty string,
however, some older versions of gdbserver would incorrectly return ‘OK’ for
unknown ‘v’ packets.
The ‘vMustReplyEmpty’ is used as a feature test to check how gdbserver han-
dles unknown packets, it is important that this packet be handled in the same
way as other unknown ‘v’ packets. If this packet is handled differently to other
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 759
unknown ‘v’ packets then it is possible that gdb may run into problems in other
areas, specifically around use of ‘vFile:setfs:’.
‘vRun;filename[;argument]...’
Run the program filename, passing it each argument on its command line. The
file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If filename is an empty string, the
stub may use a default program (e.g. the last program run). The program is
created in the stopped state.
This packet is only available in extended mode (see [extended mode], page 751).
Reply:
‘E nn’ for an error
‘Any stop packet’
for success (see Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets], page 761)
‘vStopped’
See Section E.9 [Notification Packets], page 801.
‘X addr,length:XX...’
Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary. Memory is
specified by its address addr and number of addressable memory units length
(see [addressable memory unit], page 150); ‘XX...’ is binary data (see [Binary
Data], page 749).
Reply:
‘OK’ for success
‘E NN’ for an error
‘z type,addr,kind’
‘Z type,addr,kind’
Insert (‘Z’) or remove (‘z’) a type breakpoint or watchpoint starting at address
address of kind kind.
Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet type is documented separately.
Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string for an un-
recognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet type. A remote target shall support
either both or neither of a given ‘Ztype...’ and ‘ztype...’ packet pair. To
avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be imple-
mented in an idempotent way.
‘z0,addr,kind’
‘Z0,addr,kind[;cond_list...][;cmds:persist,cmd_list...]’
Insert (‘Z0’) or remove (‘z0’) a software breakpoint at address addr of type
kind.
A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at addr with
a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The kind is target-specific and typi-
cally indicates the size of the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g.,
the arm and mips can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some architec-
tures have additional meanings for kind (see Section E.5 [Architecture-Specific
Protocol Details], page 791); if no architecture-specific value is being used, it
760 Debugging with gdb
Reply:
‘OK’ success
‘’ not supported
‘E NN’ for an error
‘z3,addr,kind’
‘Z3,addr,kind’
Insert (‘Z3’) or remove (‘z3’) a read watchpoint at addr. The number of bytes
to watch is specified by kind.
Reply:
‘OK’ success
‘’ not supported
‘E NN’ for an error
‘z4,addr,kind’
‘Z4,addr,kind’
Insert (‘Z4’) or remove (‘z4’) an access watchpoint at addr. The number of
bytes to watch is specified by kind.
Reply:
‘OK’ success
‘’ not supported
‘E NN’ for an error
reducing round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported this
way. Each ‘n:r’ pair is interpreted as follows:
• If n is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the corresponding
r gives that register’s value. The data r is a series of bytes in target byte
order, with each byte given by a two-digit hex number.
• If n is ‘thread’, then r is the thread ID of the stopped thread, as specified
in [thread-id syntax], page 750.
• If n is ‘core’, then r is the hexadecimal number of the core on which the
stop event was detected.
• If n is a recognized stop reason, it describes a more specific event that
stopped the target. The currently defined stop reasons are listed below.
The aa should be ‘05’, the trap signal. At most one stop reason should be
present.
• Otherwise, gdb should ignore this ‘n:r’ pair and go on to the next; this
allows us to extend the protocol in the future.
The currently defined stop reasons are:
‘watch’
‘rwatch’
‘awatch’ The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and r is the data address,
in hex.
‘syscall_entry’
‘syscall_return’
The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and r is the syscall
number, in hex.
‘library’ The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed. gdb
should use ‘qXfer:libraries:read’ to fetch a new list of loaded
libraries. The r part is ignored.
‘replaylog’
The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of r
will be either ‘begin’ or ‘end’. See Chapter 6 [Reverse Execution],
page 99, for more information.
‘swbreak’ The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was exe-
cuted, irrespective of whether it was gdb that planted the break-
point or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The r part
must be left empty.
On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when
a breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at
the breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
address.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 763
‘create’ The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new
thread is stopped until gdb sets it running with a resumption
packet (see [vCont packet], page 756). This packet should not
be sent by default; gdb requests it with the [QThreadEvents],
page 774, packet. See also the ‘w’ (see [thread exit event], page 764)
remote reply below. The r part is ignored.
‘W AA’
‘W AA ; process:pid’
The process exited, and AA is the exit status. This is only applicable to certain
targets.
The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited pro-
cess, can be used only when gdb has reported support for multiprocess protocol
extensions; see [multiprocess extensions], page 781. Both AA and pid are for-
matted as big-endian hex strings.
‘X AA’
‘X AA ; process:pid’
The process terminated with signal AA.
The second form of the response, including the process ID of the terminated
process, can be used only when gdb has reported support for multiprocess
protocol extensions; see [multiprocess extensions], page 781. Both AA and pid
are formatted as big-endian hex strings.
‘w AA ; tid’
The thread exited, and AA is the exit status. This response should not be sent
by default; gdb requests it with the [QThreadEvents], page 774, packet. See
also [thread create event], page 764, above. AA is formatted as a big-endian
hex string.
‘N’ There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even though
the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For example, say the
target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread 2. The client leaves thread
1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which subsequently exits. At this point, even
though the process is still alive, and thus no ‘W’ stop reply is sent, no thread is
actually executing either. The ‘N’ stop reply thus informs the client that it can
stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be sent by default; older
gdb versions did not support it. gdb requests it, by supplying an appropriate
‘qSupported’ feature (see [qSupported], page 775). The remote stub must also
supply the appropriate ‘qSupported’ feature indicating support.
‘O XX...’ ‘XX...’ is hex encoding of ascii data, to be written as the program’s console
output. This can happen at any time while the program is running and the
debugger should continue to wait for ‘W’, ‘T’, etc. This reply is not permitted
in non-stop mode.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 765
‘F call-id,parameter...’
call-id is the identifier which says which host system call should be called. This
is just the name of the function. Translation into the correct system call is only
applicable as it’s defined in gdb. See Section E.13 [File-I/O Remote Protocol
Extension], page 805, for a list of implemented system calls.
‘parameter...’ is a list of parameters as defined for this very system call.
The target replies with this packet when it expects gdb to call a host system
call on behalf of the target. gdb replies with an appropriate ‘F’ packet and
keeps up waiting for the next reply packet from the target. The latest ‘C’, ‘c’,
‘S’ or ‘s’ action is expected to be continued. See Section E.13 [File-I/O Remote
Protocol Extension], page 805, for more details.
‘QStartupWithShell:value’
On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a shell program.
This is the default behavior on both gdb and gdbserver (see [set startup-with-
shell], page 36). This packet is used to inform gdbserver whether it should
start the inferior using a shell or not.
If value is ‘0’, gdbserver will not use a shell to start the inferior. If value is ‘1’,
gdbserver will use a shell to start the inferior. All other values are considered
an error.
This packet is only available in extended mode (see [extended mode], page 751).
Reply:
‘OK’ The request succeeded.
‘E nn’ An error occurred. The error number nn is given as hex digits.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, by
supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see [qSupported], page 775).
This should only be done on targets that actually support starting the inferior
using a shell.
Use of this packet is controlled by the set startup-with-shell command; see
[set startup-with-shell], page 36.
‘QEnvironmentHexEncoded:hex-value’
On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that will be
passed to the inferior during the startup process. This packet is used to inform
gdbserver of an environment variable that has been defined by the user on
gdb (see [set environment], page 39).
The packet is composed by hex-value, an hex encoded representation of the
name=value format representing an environment variable. The name of the
environment variable is represented by name, and the value to be assigned to
the environment variable is represented by value. If the variable has no value
(i.e., the value is null), then value will not be present.
This packet is only available in extended mode (see [extended mode], page 751).
Reply:
‘OK’ The request succeeded.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, by
supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see [qSupported], page 775).
This should only be done on targets that actually support passing environment
variables to the starting inferior.
This packet is related to the set environment command; see [set environment],
page 39.
‘QEnvironmentUnset:hex-value’
On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables before start-
ing the inferior in the remote target. This packet is used to inform gdbserver
of an environment variable that has been unset by the user on gdb (see [unset
environment], page 39).
768 Debugging with gdb
threads. The first query of the sequence will be the ‘qfThreadInfo’ query;
subsequent queries in the sequence will be the ‘qsThreadInfo’ query.
NOTE: This packet replaces the ‘qL’ query (see below).
Reply:
‘m thread-id’
A single thread ID
‘m thread-id,thread-id...’
a comma-separated list of thread IDs
‘l’ (lower case letter ‘L’) denotes end of list.
In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or more thread
IDs, separated by commas. gdb will respond to each reply with a request for
more thread ids (using the ‘qs’ form of the query), until the target responds
with ‘l’ (lower-case ell, for last). Refer to [thread-id syntax], page 750, for the
format of the thread-id fields.
Note: gdb will send the qfThreadInfo query during the initial connection with
the remote target, and the very first thread ID mentioned in the reply will be
stopped by gdb in a subsequent message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that
the first thread ID in the qfThreadInfo reply is suitable for being stopped by
gdb.
‘qGetTLSAddr:thread-id,offset,lm’
Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified by thread-id,
offset, and lm.
thread-id is the thread ID associated with the thread for which to fetch the
TLS address. See [thread-id syntax], page 750.
offset is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the thread local
variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug information associated with
the variable.)
lm is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the load mod-
ule associated with the thread local storage. For example, a gnu/Linux system
will pass the link map address of the shared object associated with the thread
local storage under consideration. Other operating environments may choose to
represent the load module differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter
will vary.
Reply:
‘XX...’ Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the
thread local storage requested.
‘E nn’ An error occurred. The error number nn is given as hex digits.
‘’ An empty reply indicates that ‘qGetTLSAddr’ is not supported by
the stub.
‘qGetTIBAddr:thread-id’
Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
770 Debugging with gdb
‘qSearch:memory:address;length;search-pattern’
Search length bytes at address for search-pattern. Both address and length are
encoded in hex; search-pattern is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
Reply:
‘0’ The pattern was not found.
‘1,address’
The pattern was found at address.
‘E NN’ A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching
memory.
‘’ An empty reply indicates that ‘qSearch:memory’ is not recognized.
‘QStartNoAckMode’
Request that the remote stub disable the normal ‘+’/‘-’ protocol acknowledg-
ments (see Section E.11 [Packet Acknowledgment], page 804).
Reply:
‘OK’ The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode. gdb acknowl-
edges this response, but neither the stub nor gdb shall send or
expect further ‘+’/‘-’ acknowledgments in the current connection.
‘’ An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support
no-acknowledgment mode.
‘qSupported [:gdbfeature [;gdbfeature]... ]’
Tell the remote stub about features supported by gdb, and query the stub for
features it supports. This packet allows gdb and the remote stub to take advan-
tage of each others’ features. ‘qSupported’ also consolidates multiple feature
probes at startup, to improve gdb performance—a single larger packet per-
forms better than multiple smaller probe packets on high-latency links. Some
features may enable behavior which must not be on by default, e.g. because
it would confuse older clients or stubs. Other features may describe packets
which could be automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
reported before gdb will use them. This “default unsupported” behavior is
not appropriate for all packets, but it helps to keep the initial connection time
under control with new versions of gdb which support increasing numbers of
packets.
Reply:
‘stubfeature [;stubfeature]...’
The stub supports or does not support each returned stubfeature,
depending on the form of each stubfeature (see below for the pos-
sible forms).
‘’ An empty reply indicates that ‘qSupported’ is not recognized, or
that no features needed to be reported to gdb.
The allowed forms for each feature (either a gdbfeature in the ‘qSupported’
packet, or a stubfeature in the response) are:
776 Debugging with gdb
‘name=value’
The remote protocol feature name is supported, and associated
with the specified value. The format of value depends on the fea-
ture, but it must not include a semicolon.
‘name+’ The remote protocol feature name is supported, and does not need
an associated value.
‘name-’ The remote protocol feature name is not supported.
‘name?’ The remote protocol feature name may be supported, and gdb
should auto-detect support in some other way when it is needed.
This form will not be used for gdbfeature notifications, but may be
used for stubfeature responses.
Whenever the stub receives a ‘qSupported’ request, the supplied set of gdb
features should override any previous request. This allows gdb to put the stub
in a known state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with a
different version of gdb.
The following values of gdbfeature (for the packet sent by gdb) are defined:
‘multiprocess’
This feature indicates whether gdb supports multiprocess exten-
sions to the remote protocol. gdb does not use such extensions
unless the stub also reports that it supports them by including
‘multiprocess+’ in its ‘qSupported’ reply. See [multiprocess ex-
tensions], page 781, for details.
‘xmlRegisters’
This feature indicates that gdb supports the XML target descrip-
tion. If the stub sees ‘xmlRegisters=’ with target specific strings
separated by a comma, it will report register description.
‘qRelocInsn’
This feature indicates whether gdb supports the ‘qRelocInsn’
packet (see Section E.6 [Relocate instruction reply packet],
page 792).
‘swbreak’ This feature indicates whether gdb supports the swbreak stop rea-
son in stop replies. See [swbreak stop reason], page 762, for details.
‘hwbreak’ This feature indicates whether gdb supports the hwbreak stop rea-
son in stop replies. See [swbreak stop reason], page 762, for details.
‘fork-events’
This feature indicates whether gdb supports fork event extensions
to the remote protocol. gdb does not use such extensions
unless the stub also reports that it supports them by including
‘fork-events+’ in its ‘qSupported’ reply.
‘vfork-events’
This feature indicates whether gdb supports vfork event exten-
sions to the remote protocol. gdb does not use such extensions
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 777
‘augmented-libraries-svr4-read’
No ‘-’ No
‘multiprocess’ No ‘-’ No
‘ConditionalBreakpoints’ No ‘-’ No
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 779
‘ConditionalTracepoints’ No ‘-’ No
‘ReverseContinue’ No ‘-’ No
‘ReverseStep’ No ‘-’ No
‘TracepointSource’ No ‘-’ No
‘QAgent’ No ‘-’ No
‘QAllow’ No ‘-’ No
‘QDisableRandomization’ No ‘-’ No
‘EnableDisableTracepoints’ No ‘-’ No
‘QTBuffer:size’ No ‘-’ No
‘tracenz’ No ‘-’ No
‘BreakpointCommands’ No ‘-’ No
‘swbreak’ No ‘-’ No
‘hwbreak’ No ‘-’ No
‘fork-events’ No ‘-’ No
‘vfork-events’ No ‘-’ No
‘exec-events’ No ‘-’ No
‘QThreadEvents’ No ‘-’ No
‘no-resumed’ No ‘-’ No
‘memory-tagging’ No ‘-’ No
‘PacketSize=bytes’
The remote stub can accept packets up to at least bytes in length.
gdb will send packets up to this size for bulk transfers, and will
never send larger packets. This is a limit on the data characters in
the packet, including the frame and checksum. There is no trailing
NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub stores packets in a
NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra byte in its buffer
780 Debugging with gdb
for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported, gdb guesses
based on the size of the ‘g’ packet response.
‘qXfer:auxv:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:auxv:read’ packet (see
[qXfer auxiliary vector read], page 785).
‘qXfer:btrace:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:btrace:read’ packet (see
[qXfer btrace read], page 786).
‘qXfer:btrace-conf:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:btrace-conf:read’
packet (see [qXfer btrace-conf read], page 786).
‘qXfer:exec-file:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:exec-file:read’ packet
(see [qXfer executable filename read], page 786).
‘qXfer:features:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:features:read’ packet
(see [qXfer target description read], page 786).
‘qXfer:libraries:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:libraries:read’ packet
(see [qXfer library list read], page 787).
‘qXfer:libraries-svr4:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:libraries-svr4:read’
packet (see [qXfer svr4 library list read], page 787).
‘augmented-libraries-svr4-read’
The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
‘qXfer:libraries-svr4:read’ packet (see [qXfer svr4 library list
read], page 787).
‘qXfer:memory-map:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:memory-map:read’ packet
(see [qXfer memory map read], page 788).
‘qXfer:sdata:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:sdata:read’ packet (see
[qXfer sdata read], page 788).
‘qXfer:siginfo:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:siginfo:read’ packet
(see [qXfer siginfo read], page 788).
‘qXfer:siginfo:write’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:siginfo:write’ packet
(see [qXfer siginfo write], page 789).
‘qXfer:threads:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:threads:read’ packet
(see [qXfer threads read], page 788).
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 781
‘qXfer:traceframe-info:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:traceframe-info:read’
packet (see [qXfer traceframe info read], page 788).
‘qXfer:uib:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:uib:read’ packet (see
[qXfer unwind info block], page 789).
‘qXfer:fdpic:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:fdpic:read’ packet (see
[qXfer fdpic loadmap read], page 789).
‘QNonStop’
The remote stub understands the ‘QNonStop’ packet (see
[QNonStop], page 772).
‘QCatchSyscalls’
The remote stub understands the ‘QCatchSyscalls’ packet (see
[QCatchSyscalls], page 772).
‘QPassSignals’
The remote stub understands the ‘QPassSignals’ packet (see
[QPassSignals], page 773).
‘QStartNoAckMode’
The remote stub understands the ‘QStartNoAckMode’ packet and
prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. See Section E.11
[Packet Acknowledgment], page 804.
‘multiprocess’
The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the
remote protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the
syntax of thread IDs in both packets and replies (see [thread-id
syntax], page 750), and add process IDs to the ‘D’ packet and ‘W’ and
‘X’ replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for
the syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not
use multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless gdb has also
indicated it supports them in its ‘qSupported’ request.
‘qXfer:osdata:read’
The remote stub understands the ‘qXfer:osdata:read’ packet
((see [qXfer osdata read], page 789).
‘ConditionalBreakpoints’
The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional ex-
pressions defined for breakpoints. The target will only report break-
point triggers when such conditions are true (see Section 5.1.6
[Break Conditions], page 75).
782 Debugging with gdb
‘ConditionalTracepoints’
The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions
defined for tracepoints (see Section 13.1.4 [Tracepoint Conditions],
page 203).
‘ReverseContinue’
The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue
packet (see [bc], page 751).
‘ReverseStep’
The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
(see [bs], page 752).
‘TracepointSource’
The remote stub understands the ‘QTDPsrc’ packet that supplies
the source form of tracepoint definitions.
‘QAgent’ The remote stub understands the ‘QAgent’ packet.
‘QAllow’ The remote stub understands the ‘QAllow’ packet.
‘QDisableRandomization’
The remote stub understands the ‘QDisableRandomization’
packet.
‘StaticTracepoint’
The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
‘InstallInTrace’
The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
‘EnableDisableTracepoints’
The remote stub supports the ‘QTEnable’ (see [QTEnable],
page 795) and ‘QTDisable’ (see [QTDisable], page 795) packets
that allow tracepoints to be enabled and disabled while a trace
experiment is running.
‘QTBuffer:size’
The remote stub supports the ‘QTBuffer:size’ (see [QTBuffer-
size], page 798) packet that allows to change the size of the trace
buffer.
‘tracenz’ The remote stub supports the ‘tracenz’ bytecode for collecting
strings. See Section F.2 [Bytecode Descriptions], page 825, for de-
tails about the bytecode.
‘BreakpointCommands’
The remote stub supports running a breakpoint’s command list
itself, rather than reporting the hit to gdb.
‘Qbtrace:off’
The remote stub understands the ‘Qbtrace:off’ packet.
‘Qbtrace:bts’
The remote stub understands the ‘Qbtrace:bts’ packet.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 783
‘Qbtrace:pt’
The remote stub understands the ‘Qbtrace:pt’ packet.
‘Qbtrace-conf:bts:size’
The remote stub understands the ‘Qbtrace-conf:bts:size’
packet.
‘Qbtrace-conf:pt:size’
The remote stub understands the ‘Qbtrace-conf:pt:size’ packet.
‘swbreak’ The remote stub reports the ‘swbreak’ stop reason for memory
breakpoints.
‘hwbreak’ The remote stub reports the ‘hwbreak’ stop reason for hardware
breakpoints.
‘fork-events’
The remote stub reports the ‘fork’ stop reason for fork events.
‘vfork-events’
The remote stub reports the ‘vfork’ stop reason for vfork events
and vforkdone events.
‘exec-events’
The remote stub reports the ‘exec’ stop reason for exec events.
‘vContSupported’
The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
‘vCont?’ packet.
‘QThreadEvents’
The remote stub understands the ‘QThreadEvents’ packet.
‘no-resumed’
The remote stub reports the ‘N’ stop reply.
‘memory-tagging’
The remote stub supports and implements the required memory
tagging functionality and understands the ‘qMemTags’ (see
[qMemTags], page 770) and ‘QMemTags’ (see [QMemTags],
page 771) packets.
For AArch64 GNU/Linux systems, this feature also requires access
to the /proc/pid/smaps file so memory mapping page flags can be
inspected. This is done via the ‘vFile’ requests.
‘qSymbol::’
Notify the target that gdb is prepared to serve symbol lookup requests. Accept
requests from the target for the values of symbols.
Reply:
‘OK’ The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
‘qSymbol:sym_name’
The target requests the value of symbol sym name (hex
encoded). gdb may provide the value by using the
‘qSymbol:sym_value:sym_name’ message, described below.
784 Debugging with gdb
‘qSymbol:sym_value:sym_name’
Set the value of sym name to sym value.
sym name (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the target has
previously requested.
sym value (hex) is the value for symbol sym name. If gdb cannot supply a
value for sym name, then this field will be empty.
Reply:
‘OK’ The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
‘qSymbol:sym_name’
The target requests the value of a new symbol sym name (hex
encoded). gdb will continue to supply the values of symbols (if
available), until the target ceases to request them.
‘qTBuffer’
‘QTBuffer’
‘QTDisconnected’
‘QTDP’
‘QTDPsrc’
‘QTDV’
‘qTfP’
‘qTfV’
‘QTFrame’
‘qTMinFTPILen’
See Section E.6 [Tracepoint Packets], page 792.
‘qThreadExtraInfo,thread-id’
Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread attributes for
the thread thread-id; see [thread-id syntax], page 750, for the forms of thread-
id. This string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
for gdb to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed in gdb’s
info threads display. Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are
‘Runnable’, or ‘Blocked on Mutex’.
Reply:
(Note that the qThreadExtraInfo packet’s name is separated from the com-
mand by a ‘,’, not a ‘:’, contrary to the naming conventions above. Please
don’t use this packet as a model for new packets.)
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 785
‘QTNotes’
‘qTP’
‘QTSave’
‘qTsP’
‘qTsV’
‘QTStart’
‘QTStop’
‘QTEnable’
‘QTDisable’
‘QTinit’
‘QTro’
‘qTStatus’
‘qTV’
‘qTfSTM’
‘qTsSTM’
‘qTSTMat’ See Section E.6 [Tracepoint Packets], page 792.
‘qXfer:object:read:annex:offset,length’
Read uninterpreted bytes from the target’s special data area identified by the
keyword object. Request length bytes starting at offset bytes into the data.
The content and encoding of annex is specific to object; it can supply additional
details about what data to access.
Reply:
‘m data’ Data data (see [Binary Data], page 749) has been read from the
target. There may be more data at a higher address (although it
is permitted to return ‘m’ even for the last valid block of data, as
long as at least one byte of data was read). It is possible for data
to have fewer bytes than the length in the request.
‘l data’ Data data (see [Binary Data], page 749) has been read from the
target. There is no more data to be read. It is possible for data to
have fewer bytes than the length in the request.
‘l’ The offset in the request is at the end of the data. There is no more
data to be read.
‘E00’ The request was malformed, or annex was invalid.
‘E nn’ The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading
the data. The nn part is a hex-encoded errno value.
‘’ An empty reply indicates the object string was not recognized by
the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
‘qXfer:object:read:...’ requests use the same reply formats, listed above.
‘qXfer:auxv:read::offset,length’
Access the target’s auxiliary vector. See Section 10.17 [OS Infor-
mation], page 177. Note annex must be empty.
786 Debugging with gdb
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:btrace:read:annex:offset,length’
Return a description of the current branch trace. See Section E.19
[Branch Trace Format], page 820. The annex part of the generic
‘qXfer’ packet may have one of the following values:
all Returns all available branch trace.
new Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace
changed since the last read request.
delta Returns the new branch trace since the last read re-
quest. Adds a new block to the end of the trace that
begins at zero and ends at the source location of the
first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is used
to stitch traces together.
If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicat-
ing the overflow.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:btrace-conf:read::offset,length’
Return a description of the current branch trace configuration. See
Section E.20 [Branch Trace Configuration Format], page 821.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:exec-file:read:annex:offset,length’
Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadec-
imal number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should
return the filename corresponding to the currently executing pro-
cess.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:features:read:annex:offset,length’
Access the target description. See Appendix G [Target Descrip-
tions], page 835. The annex specifies which XML document to ac-
cess. The main description is always loaded from the ‘target.xml’
annex.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 787
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:libraries:read:annex:offset,length’
Access the target’s list of loaded libraries. See Section E.14 [Library
List Format], page 817. The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’
packet must be empty (see [qXfer read], page 785).
Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program’s memory
do not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms
where the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:annex:offset,length’
Access the target’s list of loaded libraries when the target is an
SVR4 platform. See Section E.15 [Library List Format for SVR4
Targets], page 818. The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet
must be empty unless the remote stub indicated it supports
the augmented form of this packet by supplying an appropriate
‘qSupported’ response (see [qXfer read], page 785, [qSupported],
page 775).
This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
gdb uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list oth-
erwise.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of
this packet then the annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet may
contain a semicolon-separated list of ‘name=value’ arguments. The
currently supported arguments are:
start=address
A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the
‘struct link_map’ to start reading the library list
from. If unset or zero then the first ‘struct link_map’
in the library list will be chosen as the starting point.
prev=address
A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the
‘struct link_map’ immediately preceding the ‘struct
link_map’ specified by the ‘start’ argument. If un-
set or zero then the remote stub will expect that no
‘struct link_map’ exists prior to the starting point.
788 Debugging with gdb
lmid=lmid
A hexadecimal number specifying a namespace identi-
fier. This is currently only used together with ‘start’
to provide the namespace identifier back to gdb in the
response. gdb will only provide values that were previ-
ously reported to it. If unset, the response will include
‘lmid="0x0"’.
Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be
silently ignored.
‘qXfer:memory-map:read::offset,length’
Access the target’s memory-map. See Section E.16 [Memory Map
Format], page 818. The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet
must be empty (see [qXfer read], page 785).
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:sdata:read::offset,length’
Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker in-
formation. The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet must be
empty (see [qXfer read], page 785). See Section 13.1.6 [Tracepoint
Action Lists], page 204.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:siginfo:read::offset,length’
Read contents of the extra signal information on the target system.
The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet must be empty (see
[qXfer read], page 785).
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:threads:read::offset,length’
Access the list of threads on target. See Section E.17 [Thread List
Format], page 819. The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet
must be empty (see [qXfer read], page 785).
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:traceframe-info:read::offset,length’
Return a description of the current traceframe’s contents. See
Section E.18 [Traceframe Info Format], page 820. The annex part
of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet must be empty (see [qXfer read],
page 785).
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 789
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:uib:read:pc:offset,length’
Return the unwind information block for pc. This packet is used
on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
This packet is not probed by default.
‘qXfer:fdpic:read:annex:offset,length’
Read contents of loadmaps on the target system. The annex, either
‘exec’ or ‘interp’, specifies which loadmap, executable loadmap or
interpreter loadmap to read.
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
‘qXfer:osdata:read::offset,length’
Access the target’s operating system information. See Appendix H
[Operating System Information], page 855.
‘qXfer:object:write:annex:offset:data...’
Write uninterpreted bytes into the target’s special data area identified by the
keyword object, starting at offset bytes into the data. The binary-encoded data
(see [Binary Data], page 749) to be written is given by data. . . . The content
and encoding of annex is specific to object; it can supply additional details
about what data to access.
Reply:
‘nn’ nn (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written. This may be
fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
‘E00’ The request was malformed, or annex was invalid.
‘E nn’ The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing
the data. The nn part is a hex-encoded errno value.
‘’ An empty reply indicates the object string was not recognized by
the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
‘qXfer:object:write:...’ requests use the same reply formats, listed above.
‘qXfer:siginfo:write::offset:data...’
Write data to the extra signal information on the target system.
The annex part of the generic ‘qXfer’ packet must be empty (see
[qXfer write], page 789).
This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must re-
quest it, by supplying an appropriate ‘qSupported’ response (see
[qSupported], page 775).
790 Debugging with gdb
‘qXfer:object:operation:...’
Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does not
recognize the object keyword, or its support for object does not recognize the
operation keyword, the stub must respond with an empty packet.
‘qAttached:pid’
Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an existing pro-
cess or created a new process. When the multiprocess protocol extensions are
supported (see [multiprocess extensions], page 781), pid is an integer in hex-
adecimal format identifying the target process. Otherwise, gdb will omit the
pid field and the query packet will be simplified as ‘qAttached’.
This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process should be
detached or killed when a gdb session is ended with the quit command.
Reply:
‘1’ The remote server attached to an existing process.
‘0’ The remote server created a new process.
‘E NN’ A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘Qbtrace:bts’
Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
Reply:
‘OK’ Branch tracing has been enabled.
‘E.errtext’
A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘Qbtrace:pt’
Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
Reply:
‘OK’ Branch tracing has been enabled.
‘E.errtext’
A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘Qbtrace:off’
Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
Reply:
‘OK’ Branch tracing has been disabled.
‘E.errtext’
A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=value’
Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the btrace recording
method in bts format.
Reply:
‘OK’ The ring buffer size has been set.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 791
‘E.errtext’
A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=value’
Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the btrace recording
method in pt format.
Reply:
‘OK’ The ring buffer size has been set.
‘E.errtext’
A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
‘M basereg,offset,len’
Collect len bytes of memory starting at the address in register num-
ber basereg, plus offset. If basereg is ‘-1’, then the range has a fixed
address: offset is the address of the lowest byte to collect. The
basereg, offset, and len parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
values (the ‘-1’ value for basereg is a special case).
‘X len,expr’
Evaluate expr, whose length is len, and collect memory as it directs.
The agent expression expr is as described in Appendix F [Agent
Expressions], page 823. Each byte of the expression is encoded as
a two-digit hex number in the packet; len is the number of bytes in
the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
packet).
Any number of actions may be packed together in a single ‘QTDP’ packet, as long
as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet length (400 bytes, for many
stubs). There may be only one ‘R’ action per tracepoint, and it must precede
any ‘M’ or ‘X’ actions. Any registers referred to by ‘M’ and ‘X’ actions must be
collected by a preceding ‘R’ action. (The “while-stepping” actions are treated
as if they were attached to a separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are
concerned.)
Replies:
‘OK’ The packet was understood and carried out.
‘qRelocInsn’
See Section E.6 [Relocate instruction reply packet], page 792.
‘’ The packet was not recognized.
‘QTDPsrc:n:addr:type:start:slen:bytes’
Specify a source string of tracepoint n at address addr. This is useful to get
accurate reproduction of the tracepoints originally downloaded at the beginning
of the trace run. The type is the name of the tracepoint part, such as ‘cond’
for the tracepoint’s conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
bytes is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
start is the offset of the bytes within the overall source string, while slen is the
total length of the source string. This is intended for handling source strings
that are longer than will fit in a single packet.
The available string types are ‘at’ for the location, ‘cond’ for the conditional,
and ‘cmd’ for an action command. gdb sends a separate packet for each com-
mand in the action list, in the same order in which the commands are stored
in the list.
The target does not need to do anything with source strings except report them
back as part of the replies to the ‘qTfP’/‘qTsP’ query packets.
Although this packet is optional, and gdb will only send it if the target replies
with ‘TracepointSource’ See Section E.4 [General Query Packets], page 765, it
makes both disconnected tracing and trace files much easier to use. Otherwise
794 Debugging with gdb
the user must be careful that the tracepoints in effect while looking at trace
frames are identical to the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small
discrepancy could cause ‘tdump’ not to work, or a particular trace frame not be
found.
‘QTDV:n:value:builtin:name’
Create a new trace state variable, number n, with an initial value of value,
which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both n and value are encoded as hexadecimal
values. gdb has the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero;
the target should simply create the trace state variables as they are mentioned
in expressions. The value builtin should be 1 (one) if the trace state variable is
builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin. gdb only sets builtin to 1 if a previous
‘qTfV’ or ‘qTsV’ packet had it set. The contents of name is the hex-encoded
name (without the leading ‘$’) of the trace state variable.
‘QTFrame:n’
Select the n’th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the register and mem-
ory contents recorded there to answer subsequent request packets from gdb.
A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the requested
frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated without separators,
describing the frame we selected. Each part has one of the following forms:
‘F f’ The selected frame is number n in the trace frame buffer; f is a
hexadecimal number. If f is ‘-1’, then there was no frame matching
the criteria in the request packet.
‘T t’ The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number t; t is
a hexadecimal number.
‘QTFrame:pc:addr’
Like ‘QTFrame:n’, but select the first tracepoint frame after the currently se-
lected frame whose PC is addr; addr is a hexadecimal number.
‘QTFrame:tdp:t’
Like ‘QTFrame:n’, but select the first tracepoint frame after the currently se-
lected frame that is a hit of tracepoint t; t is a hexadecimal number.
‘QTFrame:range:start:end’
Like ‘QTFrame:n’, but select the first tracepoint frame after the currently se-
lected frame whose PC is between start (inclusive) and end (inclusive); start
and end are hexadecimal numbers.
‘QTFrame:outside:start:end’
Like ‘QTFrame:range:start:end’, but select the first frame outside the given
range of addresses (exclusive).
‘qTMinFTPILen’
This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast trace-
point (see Section 13.1 [Set Tracepoints], page 199) may be placed. For instance,
on the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but it de-
pends on the target system being able to create trampolines in the first 64K of
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 795
memory, which might or might not be possible for that system. So the reply to
this packet will be 4 if it is able to arrange for that.
Replies:
‘0’ The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
‘length’ The minimum instruction length is length, where length is a hex-
adecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply of 1 means that a
fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
‘E’ An error has occurred.
‘’ An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
stub.
‘QTStart’ Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint hits
in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the ‘qRelocInsn’ reply (see
Section E.6 [Relocate instruction reply packet], page 792).
‘QTStop’ End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
‘QTEnable:n:addr’
Enable tracepoint n at address addr in a started tracepoint experiment. If the
tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection of data from it will resume.
‘QTDisable:n:addr’
Disable tracepoint n at address addr in a started tracepoint experiment. No
more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless ‘QTEnable:n:addr’ is
subsequently issued.
‘QTinit’ Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
‘QTro:start1,end1:start2,end2:...’
Establish the given ranges of memory as “transparent”. The stub will answer
requests for these ranges from memory’s current contents, if they were not
collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
gdb uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those containing pro-
gram code. Since these areas never change, they should still have the same
contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so there’s no reason for the stub
to refuse to provide their contents.
‘QTDisconnected:value’
Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when gdb disconnects from
the target. A value of 1 directs the target to continue the tracing run, while 0
tells the target to stop tracing if gdb is no longer in the picture.
‘qTStatus’
Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
The reply has the form:
‘Trunning[;field]...’
running is a single digit 1 if the trace is presently running, or 0 if
not. It is followed by semicolon-separated optional fields that an
agent may use to report additional status.
796 Debugging with gdb
If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several explanations as
one of the optional fields:
‘tnotrun:0’
No trace has been run yet.
‘tstop[:text]:0’
The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The
optional text field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
‘tfull:0’ The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
‘tdisconnected:0’
The trace stopped because gdb disconnected from the target.
‘tpasscount:tpnum’
The trace stopped because tracepoint tpnum exceeded its pass
count.
‘terror:text:tpnum’
The trace stopped because tracepoint tpnum had an error. The
string text is available to describe the nature of the error (for in-
stance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it is hex en-
coded.
‘tunknown:0’
The trace stopped for some other reason.
Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information. Although
not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring the progress of a
trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these numbers are reported, they must
reflect the state of the just-stopped trace.
‘tframes:n’
The number of trace frames in the buffer.
‘tcreated:n’
The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
‘tsize:n’ The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
‘tfree:n’ The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
‘circular:n’
The value of the circular trace buffer flag. 1 means that the trace
buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if necessary
to make room, 0 means that the trace buffer is linear and may fill
up.
‘disconn:n’
The value of the disconnected tracing flag. 1 means that tracing
will continue after gdb disconnects, 0 means that the trace run will
stop.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 797
‘qTP:tp:addr’
Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number tp at address addr.
Replies:
‘Vhits:usage’
The tracepoint has been hit hits times so far during the trace
run, and accounts for usage in the trace buffer. Note that
while-stepping steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
steps’ space consumption is added into the usage number.
‘qTV:var’ Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number var.
Replies:
‘Vvalue’ The value of the variable is value. This will be the current value
of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a saved
value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the user
is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in different
reply values, such as when requesting values while the program is
running.
‘U’ The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for exam-
ple, if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested
variable was not collected.
‘qTfP’
‘qTsP’ These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by the target.
gdb sends qTfP to get the first piece of data, and multiple qTsP to get additional
pieces. Replies to these packets generally take the form of the QTDP packets that
define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
‘qTfV’
‘qTsV’ These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the target.
gdb sends qTfV to get the first vari of data, and multiple qTsV to get additional
variables. Replies to these packets follow the syntax of the QTDV packets that
define trace state variables.
‘qTfSTM’
‘qTsSTM’ These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist in the
target program. gdb sends qTfSTM to get the first piece of data, and multiple
qTsSTM to get additional pieces. Replies to these packets take the following
form:
Reply:
‘m address:id:extra’
A single marker
‘m address:id:extra,address:id:extra...’
a comma-separated list of markers
‘l’ (lower case letter ‘L’) denotes end of list.
‘E nn’ An error occurred. The error number nn is given as hex digits.
798 Debugging with gdb
‘qRelocInsn:from;to’
This requests gdb to copy instruction at address from to address to, possibly
adjusted so that executing the instruction at to has the same effect as executing
it at from. gdb writes the adjusted instruction to target memory starting at
to.
Replies:
‘qRelocInsn:adjusted_size’
Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The adjusted size is the length in
bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
‘E NN’ A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while relo-
cating the instruction.
‘vFile:operation: parameter...’
operation is the name of the particular request; the target should compare
the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking for a supported
operation. The format of parameter depends on the operation. Numbers are
always passed in hexadecimal. Negative numbers have an explicit minus sign
(i.e. two’s complement is not used). Strings (e.g. filenames) are encoded as a
series of hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a buffer
of escaped binary data (see [Binary Data], page 749).
If pid is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process pid. If pid is zero,
select the filesystem as seen by the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1
if an error occurs. If vFile:setfs: indicates success, the selected filesystem
remains selected until the next successful vFile:setfs: operation.
E.8 Interrupts
In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running, gdb may attempt to
interrupt it by sending a ‘Ctrl-C’, BREAK or a BREAK followed by g, control of which is
specified via gdb’s ‘interrupt-sequence’.
The precise meaning of BREAK is defined by the transport mechanism and may, in fact,
be undefined. gdb does not currently define a BREAK mechanism for any of the network
interfaces except for TCP, in which case gdb sends the telnet BREAK sequence.
‘Ctrl-C’, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all transport mechanisms.
It is represented by sending the single byte 0x03 without any of the usual packet overhead
described in the Overview section (see Section E.1 [Overview], page 749). When a 0x03 byte
is transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data and does not represent
an interrupt. E.g., an ‘X’ packet (see [X packet], page 759), used for binary downloads, may
include an unescaped 0x03 as part of its packet.
BREAK followed by g is also known as Magic SysRq g. When Linux kernel receives this
sequence from serial port, it stops execution and connects to gdb.
In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous (see [vCont packet],
page 756), gdb is always free to send a remote command to the remote stub, even when the
target is running. For that reason, gdb instead sends a regular packet (see [vCtrlC packet],
page 757) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte 0x03.
Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the precise meaning
associated with receipt of the interrupt is implementation defined. If the target supports
debugging of multiple threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all currently-
executing threads and processes. If the stub is successful at interrupting the running pro-
gram, it should send one of the stop reply packets (see Section E.3 [Stop Reply Packets],
page 761) to gdb as a result of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a
stop reply for each stopped thread in non-stop mode. Interrupts received while the program
is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when it is resumed next time.
Every notification’s data begins with a name, which contains no colon characters, fol-
lowed by a colon character.
Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and notifications they do not un-
derstand. Recipients should restart timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification,
whether or not they understand it.
Senders should only send the notifications described here when this protocol description
specifies that they are permitted. In the future, we may extend the protocol to permit
existing notifications in new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
recipients.
(Older versions of gdb ignore bytes received until they see the ‘$’ byte that begins an
ordinary packet, so new stubs may transmit notifications without fear of confusing older
clients. There are no notifications defined for gdb to send at the moment, but we assume
that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
Each notification is comprised of three parts:
‘name:event’
The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the exchange (currently,
only the stub does that), with event carrying the specific information about the
notification, and name specifying the name of the notification.
‘ack’ The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually gdb, to acknowledge the ex-
change and request the event.
The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to gdb that some-
thing interesting happened in the remote stub.
The remote stub may send notification name:event at any time, but gdb acknowledges
the notification when appropriate. The notification event is pending before gdb acknowl-
edges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if additional events occur before
gdb has acknowledged the previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
synchronous transmission in response to ack packets from gdb. Because the notification
mechanism is unreliable, the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes gdb
may not have received it.
Specifically, notifications may appear when gdb is not otherwise reading input from
the stub, or when gdb is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a ‘+’/‘-’
acknowledgment to a packet it has sent. Notification packets are distinct from any other
communication from the stub so there is no ambiguity.
After receiving a notification, gdb shall acknowledge it by sending a ack packet as a
regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen
immediately, as gdb is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which
the stub should process normally.
Upon receiving a ack packet, if the stub has other queued events to report to gdb, it
shall respond by sending a normal event. gdb shall then send another ack packet to solicit
further responses; again, it is permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the
stub should process normally.
If the stub receives a ack packet and there are no additional event to report, the stub
shall return an ‘OK’ response. At this point, gdb has finished processing a notification and
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 803
the stub has completed sending any queued events. gdb won’t accept any new notifications
until the final ‘OK’ is received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send a
new notification, gdb shall accept the notification, and the process shall be repeated.
The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the following example:
<- %Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;
...
-> vStopped
<- T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;
-> vStopped
<- T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;
-> vStopped
<- OK
The following notifications are defined:
Stop vStopped reply. The reply has the Report an asynchronous stop
form of a stop reply, as de- event in non-stop mode.
scribed in Section E.3 [Stop Re-
ply Packets], page 761. Refer
to Section E.10 [Remote Non-
Stop], page 803, for information
on how these notifications are
acknowledged by gdb.
reply to the ‘?’ packet, and subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to ‘vStopped’
packets using the mechanism described above. The target must not send asynchronous stop
reply notifications until the sequence is complete. If all threads are running when the target
receives the ‘?’ packet, or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond ‘OK’.
If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the ‘swbreak’ stop reason if
software breakpoints are supported, and the ‘hwbreak’ stop reason if hardware breakpoints
are supported (see [swbreak stop reason], page 762). This is because given the asynchronous
nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint and the time the
event is finally processed by gdb, the breakpoint may have already been removed from the
target. Due to this, gdb needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was caused by a
delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as opposed to a random trap signal,
which should be reported to the user. Note the ‘swbreak’ feature implies that the target is
responsible for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if necessary, such as
on the x86 architecture.
E.12 Examples
Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart does not get any
direct output:
-> R00
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 805
<- +
target restarts
-> ?
<- +
<- T001:1234123412341234
-> +
Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
-> G1445...
<- +
-> s
<- +
time passes
<- T001:1234123412341234
-> +
-> g
<- +
<- 1455...
-> +
• The user presses RET. This is treated as end of input with a trailing newline.
• The user types Ctrl-d. This is treated as end of input. No trailing character (neither
newline nor ‘Ctrl-D’) is appended to the input.
If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to the read call, the
trailing characters are buffered in gdb until either another read(0, ...) is requested by
the target, or debugging is stopped at the user’s request.
Request: ‘Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode’
flags is the bitwise OR of the following values:
O_CREAT If the file does not exist it will be created. The host rules apply as
far as file ownership and time stamps are concerned.
O_EXCL When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is an error and
open() fails.
O_TRUNC If the file already exists and the open mode allows writing (O_RDWR
or O_WRONLY is given) it will be truncated to zero length.
O_APPEND The file is opened in append mode.
O_RDONLY The file is opened for reading only.
O_WRONLY The file is opened for writing only.
O_RDWR The file is opened for reading and writing.
Other bits are silently ignored.
mode is the bitwise OR of the following values:
S_IRUSR User has read permission.
S_IWUSR User has write permission.
S_IRGRP Group has read permission.
S_IWGRP Group has write permission.
S_IROTH Others have read permission.
S_IWOTH Others have write permission.
Other bits are silently ignored.
Return value:
open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error occurred.
Errors:
EEXIST pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 809
close
Synopsis:
int close(int fd);
Request: ‘Fclose,fd’
Return value:
close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
Errors:
EBADF fd isn’t a valid open file descriptor.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
read
Synopsis:
int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
Request: ‘Fread,fd,bufptr,count’
Return value:
On success, the number of bytes read is returned. Zero indicates end of file. If
count is zero, read returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
Errors:
EBADF fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for reading.
EFAULT bufptr is an invalid pointer value.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
810 Debugging with gdb
write
Synopsis:
int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
Request: ‘Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count’
Return value:
On success, the number of bytes written are returned. Zero indicates nothing
was written. On error, -1 is returned.
Errors:
EBADF fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for writing.
EFAULT bufptr is an invalid pointer value.
EFBIG An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the host-specific
maximum file size allowed.
ENOSPC No space on device to write the data.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
lseek
Synopsis:
long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
Request: ‘Flseek,fd,offset,flag’
flag is one of:
SEEK_SET The offset is set to offset bytes.
SEEK_CUR The offset is set to its current location plus offset bytes.
SEEK_END The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset bytes.
Return value:
On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from the beginning of the file
is returned. Otherwise, a value of -1 is returned.
Errors:
EBADF fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
ESPIPE fd is associated with the gdb console.
EINVAL flag is not a proper value.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
rename
Synopsis:
int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
Request: ‘Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len’
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 811
Return value:
On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
Errors:
EISDIR newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a directory.
EEXIST newpath is a non-empty directory.
EBUSY oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some process.
EINVAL An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory of itself.
ENOTDIR A component used as a directory in oldpath or new path is not a
directory. Or oldpath is a directory and newpath exists but is not
a directory.
EFAULT oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
EACCES No access to the file or the path of the file.
ENAMETOOLONG
oldpath or newpath was too long.
ENOENT A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
EROFS The file is on a read-only filesystem.
ENOSPC The device containing the file has no room for the new directory
entry.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
unlink
Synopsis:
int unlink(const char *pathname);
Request: ‘Funlink,pathnameptr/len’
Return value:
On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
Errors:
EACCES No access to the file or the path of the file.
EPERM The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
EBUSY The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it’s being used by
another process.
EFAULT pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
ENAMETOOLONG
pathname was too long.
ENOENT A directory component in pathname does not exist.
ENOTDIR A component of the path is not a directory.
EROFS The file is on a read-only filesystem.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
812 Debugging with gdb
stat/fstat
Synopsis:
int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
Request: ‘Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr’
‘Ffstat,fd,bufptr’
Return value:
On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
Errors:
EBADF fd is not a valid open file.
ENOENT A directory component in pathname does not exist or the path is
an empty string.
ENOTDIR A component of the path is not a directory.
EFAULT pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
EACCES No access to the file or the path of the file.
ENAMETOOLONG
pathname was too long.
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
gettimeofday
Synopsis:
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
Request: ‘Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr’
Return value:
On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
Errors:
EINVAL tz is a non-NULL pointer.
EFAULT tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
isatty
Synopsis:
int isatty(int fd);
Request: ‘Fisatty,fd’
Return value:
Returns 1 if fd refers to the gdb console, 0 otherwise.
Errors:
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
Note that the isatty call is treated as a special case: it returns 1 to the target if the
file descriptor is attached to the gdb console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system
calls would require implementing ioctl and would be more complex than needed.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 813
system
Synopsis:
int system(const char *command);
Request: ‘Fsystem,commandptr/len’
Return value:
If len is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is available. A zero
return value indicates a shell is not available. For non-zero len, the value re-
turned is -1 on error and the return status of the command otherwise. Only
the exit status of the command is returned, which is extracted from the host’s
system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval). In case /bin/sh could
not be executed, 127 is returned.
Errors:
EINTR The call was interrupted by the user.
gdb takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the system
call. The return value of system on the host is simplified before it’s returned to the target.
Any termination signal information from the child process is discarded, and the return value
consists entirely of the exit status of the called command.
Due to security concerns, the system call is by default refused by gdb. The user has to
allow this call explicitly with the set remote system-call-allowed 1 command.
set remote system-call-allowed
Control whether to allow the system calls in the File I/O protocol for the
remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
show remote system-call-allowed
Show whether the system calls are allowed in the File I/O protocol.
Pointer Values
Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception is made for pointers to
buffers for which the length isn’t transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings.
Strings are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.
1aaf/12
814 Debugging with gdb
which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf. The length is defined as the
full string length in bytes, including the trailing null byte. For example, the string "hello
world" at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
123456/d
Memory Transfer
Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for example, a struct
stat) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format with all scalar multibyte datatypes
being big endian. Translation to this representation needs to be done both by the target
before the F packet is sent, and by gdb before it transfers memory to the target. Transferred
pointers to structured data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
struct stat
The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and gdb is defined as follows:
struct stat {
unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
};
The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the appropriate section (see
[Integral Datatypes], page 813, for details) so this structure is of size 64 bytes.
The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or range of values.
st_dev A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
st_ino No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
st_mode Valid mode bits are described in Section E.13.9 [Constants], page 815. Any
other bits have currently no meaning for the target.
st_uid
st_gid
st_rdev No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
st_atime
st_mtime
st_ctime These values have a host and file system dependent accuracy. Especially on
Windows hosts, the file system may not support exact timing values.
The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is responsible for coercing
it to the target representation before continuing.
Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol representations
of struct stat members, these members could eventually get truncated on the target.
Appendix E: gdb Remote Serial Protocol 815
struct timeval
The buffer of type struct timeval used by the File-I/O protocol is defined as follows:
struct timeval {
time_t tv_sec; /* second */
long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
};
The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the appropriate section (see
[Integral Datatypes], page 813, for details) so this structure is of size 8 bytes.
E.13.9 Constants
The following values are used for the constants inside of the protocol. gdb and target are
responsible for translating these values before and after the call as needed.
Open Flags
All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
O_RDONLY 0x0
O_WRONLY 0x1
O_RDWR 0x2
O_APPEND 0x8
O_CREAT 0x200
O_TRUNC 0x400
O_EXCL 0x800
mode t Values
All values are given in octal representation.
S_IFREG 0100000
S_IFDIR 040000
S_IRUSR 0400
S_IWUSR 0200
S_IXUSR 0100
S_IRGRP 040
S_IWGRP 020
S_IXGRP 010
S_IROTH 04
S_IWOTH 02
S_IXOTH 01
Errno Values
All values are given in decimal representation.
EPERM 1
ENOENT 2
EINTR 4
EBADF 9
EACCES 13
EFAULT 14
EBUSY 16
EEXIST 17
ENODEV 19
ENOTDIR 20
EISDIR 21
EINVAL 22
ENFILE 23
816 Debugging with gdb
EMFILE 24
EFBIG 27
ENOSPC 28
ESPIPE 29
EROFS 30
ENAMETOOLONG 91
EUNKNOWN 9999
EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns any error value not
in the list of supported error numbers.
Lseek Flags
SEEK_SET 0
SEEK_CUR 1
SEEK_END 2
Limits
All values are given in decimal representation.
INT_MIN -2147483648
INT_MAX 2147483647
UINT_MAX 4294967295
LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three allocated sections (.text,
.data, .bss), looks like this:
<library-list>
<library name="sharedlib.o">
<section address="0x10000000"/>
<section address="0x20000000"/>
<section address="0x30000000"/>
</library>
</library-list>
In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a single library
element, and you must supply at least one segment or section for each library.
818 Debugging with gdb
gdb must be linked with the Expat library to support XML memory maps. See [Expat],
page 726.
The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
<?xml version="1.0"?>
<!DOCTYPE memory-map
PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
"http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
<memory-map>
region...
</memory-map>
Each region can be either:
• A region of RAM starting at addr and extending for length bytes from there:
<memory type="ram" start="addr" length="length"/>
• A region of read-only memory:
<memory type="rom" start="addr" length="length"/>
• A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks blocksize bytes in length:
<memory type="flash" start="addr" length="length">
<property name="blocksize">blocksize</property>
</memory>
Regions must not overlap. gdb assumes that areas of memory not covered by the memory
map are RAM, and uses the ordinary ‘M’ and ‘X’ packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
<!-- ................................................... -->
<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
<!-- .................................... .............. -->
<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
<!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
and its type, or device. -->
<!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
start CDATA #REQUIRED
length CDATA #REQUIRED>
<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
<!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
Each ‘thread’ element must have the ‘id’ attribute that identifies the thread (see [thread-
id syntax], page 750). The ‘core’ attribute, if present, specifies which processor core the
thread was last executing on. The ‘name’ attribute, if present, specifies the human-readable
name of the thread. The content of the of ‘thread’ element is interpreted as human-readable
auxiliary information. The ‘handle’ attribute, if present, is a hex encoded representation
of the thread handle.
The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
<!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
<!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
gdb must be linked with the Expat library to support XML traceframe info discovery.
See [Expat], page 726.
The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
<?xml version="1.0"?>
<!DOCTYPE btrace
PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
"http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
<btrace>
block...
</btrace>
• A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at begin and ending at end:
<block begin="begin" end="end"/>
The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
<!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
<!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
<!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
<!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
823
};
where LONGEST and DOUBLEST are typedef names for the largest integer and floating point
types on the machine.
By the time the bytecode interpreter reaches the end of the expression, the value of
the expression should be the only value left on the stack. For tracing applications, trace
bytecodes in the expression will have recorded the necessary data, and the value on the
stack may be discarded. For other applications, like conditional breakpoints, the value may
be useful.
Separate from the stack, the interpreter has two registers:
pc The address of the next bytecode to execute.
start The address of the start of the bytecode expression, necessary for interpreting
the goto and if_goto instructions.
Neither of these registers is directly visible to the bytecode language itself, but they are
useful for defining the meanings of the bytecode operations.
There are no instructions to perform side effects on the running program, or call the pro-
gram’s functions; we assume that these expressions are only used for unobtrusive debugging,
not for patching the running code.
Most bytecode instructions do not distinguish between the various sizes of values, and
operate on full-width values; the upper bits of the values are simply ignored, since they do
not usually make a difference to the value computed. The exceptions to this rule are:
memory reference instructions (refn)
There are distinct instructions to fetch different word sizes from memory. Once
on the stack, however, the values are treated as full-size integers. They may
need to be sign-extended; the ext instruction exists for this purpose.
the sign-extension instruction (ext n)
These clearly need to know which portion of their operand is to be extended to
occupy the full length of the word.
If the interpreter is unable to evaluate an expression completely for some reason (a mem-
ory location is inaccessible, or a divisor is zero, for example), we say that interpretation
“terminates with an error”. This means that the problem is reported back to the inter-
preter’s caller in some helpful way. In general, code using agent expressions should assume
that they may attempt to divide by zero, fetch arbitrary memory locations, and misbehave
in other ways.
Even complicated C expressions compile to a few bytecode instructions; for example, the
expression x + y * z would typically produce code like the following, assuming that x and
y live in registers, and z is a global variable holding a 32-bit int:
reg 1
reg 2
const32 address of z
ref32
ext 32
mul
add
Appendix F: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism 825
end
In detail, these mean:
reg 1 Push the value of register 1 (presumably holding x) onto the stack.
reg 2 Push the value of register 2 (holding y).
const32 address of z
Push the address of z onto the stack.
ref32 Fetch a 32-bit word from the address at the top of the stack; replace the address
on the stack with the value. Thus, we replace the address of z with z’s value.
ext 32 Sign-extend the value on the top of the stack from 32 bits to full length. This
is necessary because z is a signed integer.
mul Pop the top two numbers on the stack, multiply them, and push their product.
Now the top of the stack contains the value of the expression y * z.
add Pop the top two numbers, add them, and push the sum. Now the top of the
stack contains the value of x + y * z.
end Stop executing; the value left on the stack top is the value to be recorded.
We do not fully describe the floating point operations here; although this design can be
extended in a clean way to handle floating point values, they are not of immediate interest
to the customer, so we avoid describing them, to save time.
float (0x01): ⇒
Prefix for floating-point bytecodes. Not implemented yet.
add (0x02): a b ⇒ a+b
Pop two integers from the stack, and push their sum, as an integer.
sub (0x03): a b ⇒ a-b
Pop two integers from the stack, subtract the top value from the next-to-top
value, and push the difference.
mul (0x04): a b ⇒ a*b
Pop two integers from the stack, multiply them, and push the product on the
stack. Note that, when one multiplies two n-bit numbers yielding another n-bit
number, it is irrelevant whether the numbers are signed or not; the results are
the same.
div_signed (0x05): a b ⇒ a/b
Pop two signed integers from the stack; divide the next-to-top value by the top
value, and push the quotient. If the divisor is zero, terminate with an error.
div_unsigned (0x06): a b ⇒ a/b
Pop two unsigned integers from the stack; divide the next-to-top value by the
top value, and push the quotient. If the divisor is zero, terminate with an error.
rem_signed (0x07): a b ⇒ a modulo b
Pop two signed integers from the stack; divide the next-to-top value by the top
value, and push the remainder. If the divisor is zero, terminate with an error.
rem_unsigned (0x08): a b ⇒ a modulo b
Pop two unsigned integers from the stack; divide the next-to-top value by the
top value, and push the remainder. If the divisor is zero, terminate with an
error.
lsh (0x09): a b ⇒ a<<b
Pop two integers from the stack; let a be the next-to-top value, and b be the
top value. Shift a left by b bits, and push the result.
rsh_signed (0x0a): a b ⇒ (signed)a>>b
Pop two integers from the stack; let a be the next-to-top value, and b be the
top value. Shift a right by b bits, inserting copies of the top bit at the high
end, and push the result.
rsh_unsigned (0x0b): a b ⇒ a>>b
Pop two integers from the stack; let a be the next-to-top value, and b be the
top value. Shift a right by b bits, inserting zero bits at the high end, and push
the result.
log_not (0x0e): a ⇒ !a
Pop an integer from the stack; if it is zero, push the value one; otherwise, push
the value zero.
Appendix F: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism 827
• Later, when the user selects a given trace event and inspects the objects and expression
values recorded, GDB talks to the agent to retrieve recorded data as necessary to meet
the user’s requests. If the user asks to see an object whose contents have not been
recorded, GDB reports an error.
F.5 Rationale
Some of the design decisions apparent above are arguable.
What about stack overflow/underflow?
GDB should be able to query the target to discover its stack size. Given that
information, GDB can determine at translation time whether a given expression
will overflow the stack. But this spec isn’t about what kinds of error-checking
GDB ought to do.
Why are you doing everything in LONGEST?
Speed isn’t important, but agent code size is; using LONGEST brings in a bunch
of support code to do things like division, etc. So this is a serious concern.
First, note that you don’t need different bytecodes for different operand sizes.
You can generate code without knowing how big the stack elements actually
are on the target. If the target only supports 32-bit ints, and you don’t send
any 64-bit bytecodes, everything just works. The observation here is that the
MIPS and the Alpha have only fixed-size registers, and you can still get C’s
semantics even though most instructions only operate on full-sized words. You
just need to make sure everything is properly sign-extended at the right times.
So there is no need for 32- and 64-bit variants of the bytecodes. Just implement
everything using the largest size you support.
GDB should certainly check to see what sizes the target supports, so the user
can get an error earlier, rather than later. But this information is not necessary
for correctness.
832 Debugging with gdb
help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for their targets, we also describe the
grammar here.
Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target and (for some
architectures) provide information about custom register sets. They can also identify the
OS ABI of the remote target. gdb can use this information to autoconfigure for your target,
or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
Here is a simple target description:
<target version="1.0">
<architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
</target>
This minimal description only says that the target uses the x86-64 architecture.
A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking optional elements
and . . . marking repeatable elements. The elements are explained further below.
<?xml version="1.0"?>
<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
<target version="1.0">
[architecture]
[osabi]
[compatible]
[feature...]
</target>
The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line breaks, under the usual
common-sense rules. The XML version declaration and document type declaration can
generally be omitted (gdb does not require them), but specifying them may be useful
for XML validation tools. The ‘version’ attribute for ‘<target>’ may also be omitted,
but we recommend including it; if future versions of gdb use an incompatible revision of
gdb-target.dtd, they will detect and report the version mismatch.
G.2.1 Inclusion
It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into several different annexes,
either for organizational purposes, or to share files between different possible target descrip-
tions. You can divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of the target
description with an inclusion directive of the form:
<xi:include href="document"/>
When gdb encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve the named XML document,
and replace the inclusion directive with the contents of that document. If the current
description was read using ‘qXfer’, then so will be the included document; document will
be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the current description was read from a file, gdb
will look for document as a file in the same directory where it found the original description.
G.2.2 Architecture
An ‘<architecture>’ element has this form:
<architecture>arch</architecture>
arch is one of the architectures from the set accepted by set architecture (see
Chapter 19 [Specifying a Debugging Target], page 303).
Appendix G: Target Descriptions 837
G.2.3 OS ABI
This optional field was introduced in gdb version 7.0. Previous versions of gdb ignore it.
An ‘<osabi>’ element has this form:
<osabi>abi-name</osabi>
abi-name is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by set osabi (see
Section 22.7 [Configuring the Current ABI], page 365).
G.2.5 Features
Each ‘<feature>’ describes some logical portion of the target system. Features are currently
used to describe available CPU registers and the types of their contents. A ‘<feature>’
element has this form:
<feature name="name">
[type...]
reg...
</feature>
Each feature’s name should be unique within the description. The name of a feature does
not matter unless gdb has some special knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does,
the feature should have its standard name. See Section G.5 [Standard Target Features],
page 841.
G.2.6 Types
Any register’s value is a collection of bits which gdb must interpret. The default interpreta-
tion is a two’s complement integer, but other types can be requested by name in the register
description. Some predefined types are provided by gdb (see Section G.3 [Predefined Target
Types], page 839), and the description can define additional composite and enum types.
Each type element must have an ‘id’ attribute, which gives a unique (within the con-
taining ‘<feature>’) name to the type. Types must be defined before they are used.
Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays of scalar elements.
These types are written as ‘<vector>’ elements, specifying the array element type, type,
and the number of elements, count:
<vector id="id" type="type" count="count"/>
838 Debugging with gdb
If a register’s value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it with a union type con-
taining the useful representations. The ‘<union>’ element contains one or more ‘<field>’
elements, each of which has a name and a type:
<union id="id">
<field name="name" type="type"/>
...
</union>
If a register’s value is composed from several separate values, define it with either a
structure type or a flags type. A flags type may only contain bitfields. A structure type
may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields. If the value contains only bitfields,
its total size in bytes must be specified.
Non-bitfield values have a name and type.
<struct id="id">
<field name="name" type="type"/>
...
</struct>
Both name and type values are required. No implicit padding is added.
Bitfield values have a name, start, end and type.
<struct id="id" size="size">
<field name="name" start="start" end="end" type="type"/>
...
</struct>
<flags id="id" size="size">
<field name="name" start="start" end="end" type="type"/>
...
</flags>
The name value is required. Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, ‘""’, in
which case the field is “filler” and its value is not printed. Not all bits need to be specified,
so “filler” fields are optional.
The start and end values are required, and type is optional. The field’s start must be
less than or equal to its end, and zero represents the least significant bit.
The default value of type is bool for single bit fields, and an unsigned integer otherwise.
Which to choose? Structures or flags?
Registers defined with ‘flags’ have these advantages over defining them with ‘struct’:
• Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
• They are printed in a more readable fashion.
Registers defined with ‘struct’ have one advantage over defining them with ‘flags’:
• One can fetch individual fields like in ‘C’.
(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
$1 = 42
G.2.7 Registers
Each register is represented as an element with this form:
<reg name="name"
bitsize="size"
[regnum="num"]
[save-restore="save-restore"]
Appendix G: Target Descriptions 839
[type="type"]
[group="group"]/>
name The register’s name; it must be unique within the target description.
regnum The register’s number. If omitted, a register’s number is one greater than that
of the previous register (either in the current feature or in a preceding feature);
the first register in the target description defaults to zero. This register number
is used to read or write the register; e.g. it is used in the remote p and P
packets, and registers appear in the g and G packets in order of increasing
register number.
save-restore
Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function calls; this must
be either yes or no. The default is yes, which is appropriate for most registers
except for some system control registers; this is not related to the target’s ABI.
type The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type defined in the
current feature, or one of the special types int and float. int is an integer
type of the correct size for bitsize, and float is a floating point type (in the
architecture’s normal floating point format) of the correct size for bitsize. The
default is int.
group The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the standard
register groups general, float, vector or an arbitrary string. Group names
should be limited to alphanumeric characters. If a group name is made up of
multiple words the words may be separated by hyphens; e.g. special-group
or ultra-special-group. If no group is specified, gdb will not display the
register in info registers.
int8
int16
int24
int32
int64
int128 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
840 Debugging with gdb
uint8
uint16
uint24
uint32
uint64
uint128 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
code_ptr
data_ptr Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and any dedicated
return address register may be marked as code pointers; printing a code pointer
converts it into a symbolic address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address
registers may be marked as data pointers.
ieee_half
Half precision IEEE floating point.
ieee_single
Single precision IEEE floating point.
ieee_double
Double precision IEEE floating point.
bfloat16 The 16-bit brain floating point format used e.g. by x86 and ARM.
arm_fpa_ext
The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
i387_ext The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
i386_eflags
32bit eflags register used by x86.
i386_mxcsr
32bit mxcsr register used by x86.
Given that description, a value of 3 for the ‘flags’ register would be printed as:
(gdb) info register flags
flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
− ‘fpsr’, the floating-point status register. It is 32 bits in size and has a custom flags
type.
− ‘fpcr’, the floating-point control register. It is 32 bits in size and has a custom flags
type.
The semantics of the individual flags and fields in ‘fpsr’ and ‘fpcr’ can change as new
architectural features are added.
The types for the vector registers, ‘fpsr’ and ‘fpcr’ registers can be found in the aarch64-
fpu.xml file.
Extra registers are allowed in this feature, but they will not affect gdb.
Only ‘tpidr’:
− ‘tpidr’, the software thread id register. It is 64 bits in size and has a type of ‘data_ptr’.
Both ‘tpidr’ and ‘tpidr2’.
− ‘tpidr’, the software thread id register. It is 64 bits in size and has a type of ‘data_ptr’.
− ‘tpidr2’, the second software thread id register. It is 64 bits in size and has a type of
‘data_ptr’. It may be used in the future alongside the Scalable Matrix Extension for
a lazy restore scheme.
If gdb sees this feature, it will attempt to find one of the variations of the register set.
If ‘tpidr2’ is available, gdb may act on it to display additional data in the future.
There is no XML for this feature as the presence of ‘tpidr2’ is determined dynamically
at runtime.
Extra registers are allowed in this feature, but they will not affect gdb.
Extension core registers ‘r32’ through ‘r59’ are optional and their existence depends
on the configuration. When debugging GNU/Linux applications, i.e. user space debugging,
these core registers are not available.
The ‘org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux’ feature is required for all ARC targets. Here is the list of
registers pertinent to this feature:
− mandatory: ‘pc’ and ‘status32’.
− optional: ‘lp_start’, ‘lp_end’, and ‘bta’.
Extra registers are allowed in this feature, but they will not affect gdb.
Upon seeing this feature, gdb will acknowledge that it is dealing with an M-profile target.
This means gdb will use hooks and configurations that are meaningful to M-profiles.
Extra registers are allowed in this feature, but they will not affect gdb.
846 Debugging with gdb
Note: The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers are overlapped
with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-
precision registers, if not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit single-precision registers
explicitly is deprecated, and the support to it could be totally removed some day.
the csr feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no other floating
point hardware.
The ‘org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector’ feature is optional. If present, it should contain reg-
isters ‘v0’ through ‘v31’, all of which must be the same size.
G.5.14 RX Features
The ‘org.gnu.gdb.rx.core’ feature is required for RX targets. It should contain the
registers ‘r0’ through ‘r15’, ‘usp’, ‘isp’, ‘psw’, ‘pc’, ‘intb’, ‘bpsw’, ‘bpc’, ‘fintv’, ‘fpsw’,
and ‘acc’.
V number value
Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value value of trace
state variable numbered number.
Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types of blocks.
859
Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of offset_type values. The first value is
the offset of the symbol’s name in the constant pool. The second value is the offset of
the CU vector in the constant pool.
If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This is ok because while
0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a valid index for both a string and a CU
vector.
The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an iterative hash function to
the symbol’s name. Starting with an initial value of r = 0, each (unsigned) character
‘c’ in the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the index
version:
Version 4 The formula is r = r * 67 + c - 113.
Versions 5 to 7
The formula is r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113.
The terminating ‘\0’ is not incorporated into the hash.
The step size used in the hash table is computed via ((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1,
where ‘hash’ is the hash value, and ‘size’ is the size of the hash table. The step size
is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash collision.
The names of C++ symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We don’t currently
have a simple description of the canonicalization algorithm; if you intend to create new
index sections, you must read the code.
6. The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized so that alignment
is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by strings.
A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of offset_type values. The first value
is the number of CU indices in the vector. Each subsequent value is the index and
symbol attributes of a CU in the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to
indicate which CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used. See below for the
format of each CU index+attributes entry.
A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
Attributes were added to CU index values in .gdb_index version 7. If a symbol has
multiple uses within a CU then there is one CU index+attributes value for each use.
The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows (bit 0 = LSB):
Bits 0-23 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
Bits 24-27 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
Bits 28-30 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
0 This value is reserved and should not be used. By reserving zero
the full offset_type value is backwards compatible with previous
versions of the index.
1 The symbol is a type.
2 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
3 The symbol is a function.
861
gdb man
gdb [OPTIONS] [prog|prog procID|prog core]
The purpose of a debugger such as gdb is to allow you to see what is going on “inside”
another program while it executes – or what another program was doing at the moment it
crashed.
gdb can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of these) to help you
catch bugs in the act:
• Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
• Make your program stop on specified conditions.
• Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
• Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the effects of
one bug and go on to learn about another.
You can use gdb to debug programs written in C, C++, Fortran and Modula-2.
gdb is invoked with the shell command gdb. Once started, it reads commands from the
terminal until you tell it to exit with the gdb command quit or exit. You can get online
help from gdb itself by using the command help.
You can run gdb with no arguments or options; but the most usual way to start gdb is
with one argument or two, specifying an executable program as the argument:
gdb program
You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
gdb program core
You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option -p, if you
want to debug a running process:
gdb program 1234
gdb -p 1234
would attach gdb to process 1234. With option -p you can omit the program filename.
Here are some of the most frequently needed gdb commands:
break [file:][function|line]
Set a breakpoint at function or line (in file).
run [arglist]
Start your program (with arglist, if specified).
bt Backtrace: display the program stack.
print expr
Display the value of an expression.
c Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
next Execute next program line (after stopping); step over any function calls in the
line.
866 Debugging with gdb
edit [file:]function
look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
list [file:]function
type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
step Execute next program line (after stopping); step into any function calls in the
line.
help [name]
Show information about gdb command name, or general information about
using gdb.
quit
exit Exit from gdb.
Any arguments other than options specify an executable file and core file (or process
ID); that is, the first argument encountered with no associated option flag is equivalent to
a --se option, and the second, if any, is equivalent to a -c option if it’s the name of a file.
Many options have both long and abbreviated forms; both are shown here. The long forms
are also recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is present to be
unambiguous.
The abbreviated forms are shown here with ‘-’ and long forms are shown with ‘--’
to reflect how they are shown in --help. However, gdb recognizes all of the following
conventions for most options:
--option=value
--option value
-option=value
-option value
--o=value
--o value
-o=value
-o value
All the options and command line arguments you give are processed in sequential order.
The order makes a difference when the -x option is used.
--help
-h List all options, with brief explanations.
--symbols=file
-s file Read symbol table from file.
--write Enable writing into executable and core files.
--exec=file
-e file Use file as the executable file to execute when appropriate, and for examining
pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
--se=file
Read symbol table from file and use it as the executable file.
Appendix L: Manual pages 867
--core=file
-c file Use file as a core dump to examine.
--command=file
-x file Execute gdb commands from file.
--eval-command=command
-ex command
Execute given gdb command.
--init-eval-command=command
-iex Execute gdb command before loading the inferior.
--directory=directory
-d directory
Add directory to the path to search for source files.
--nh Do not execute commands from ~/.config/gdb/gdbinit, ~/.gdbinit,
~/.config/gdb/gdbearlyinit, or ~/.gdbearlyinit
--nx
-n Do not execute commands from any .gdbinit or .gdbearlyinit initialization
files.
--quiet
--silent
-q “Quiet”. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These mes-
sages are also suppressed in batch mode.
--batch Run in batch mode. Exit with status 0 after processing all the command files
specified with -x (and .gdbinit, if not inhibited). Exit with nonzero status if
an error occurs in executing the gdb commands in the command files.
Batch mode may be useful for running gdb as a filter, for example to download
and run a program on another computer; in order to make this more useful, the
message
Program exited normally.
(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under gdb control
terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
--batch-silent
Run in batch mode, just like --batch, but totally silent. All gdb output is
suppressed (stderr is unaffected). This is much quieter than --silent and
would be useless for an interactive session.
This is particularly useful when using targets that give ‘Loading section’ mes-
sages, for example.
Note that targets that give their output via gdb, as opposed to writing directly
to stdout, will also be made silent.
--args prog [arglist]
Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following this option
are passed as arguments to the inferior. As an example, take the following
command:
gdb ./a.out -q
868 Debugging with gdb
It would start gdb with -q, not printing the introductory message. On the
other hand, using:
gdb --args ./a.out -q
starts gdb with the introductory message, and passes the option to the inferior.
--pid=pid
Attach gdb to an already running program, with the PID pid.
--tui Open the terminal user interface.
--readnow
Read all symbols from the given symfile on the first access.
--readnever
Do not read symbol files.
--return-child-result
gdb’s exit code will be the same as the child’s exit code.
--configuration
Print details about GDB configuration and then exit.
--version
Print version information and then exit.
--cd=directory
Run gdb using directory as its working directory, instead of the current direc-
tory.
--data-directory=directory
-D Run gdb using directory as its data directory. The data directory is where gdb
searches for its auxiliary files.
--fullname
-f Emacs sets this option when it runs gdb as a subprocess. It tells gdb to output
the full file name and line number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time
a stack frame is displayed (which includes each time the program stops). This
recognizable format looks like two ‘\032’ characters, followed by the file name,
line number and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
Emacs-to-gdb interface program uses the two ‘\032’ characters as a signal to
display the source code for the frame.
-b baudrate
Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial interface used by
gdb for remote debugging.
-l timeout
Set timeout, in seconds, for remote debugging.
--tty=device
Run using device for your program’s standard input and output.
Appendix L: Manual pages 869
gdbserver man
gdbserver comm prog [args . . . ]
This tells gdbserver to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and to communicate
with gdb via /dev/com1. gdbserver now waits patiently for the host gdb to communicate
with it.
To use a TCP connection, you could say:
target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are going to
communicate with the host gdb via TCP. The host:2345 argument means that we are
expecting to see a TCP connection from host to local TCP port 2345. (Currently, the host
part is ignored.) You can choose any number you want for the port number as long as it
does not conflict with any existing TCP ports on the target system. This same port number
must be used in the host gdbs target remote command, which will be described shortly.
Note that if you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, gdbserver will
print an error message and exit.
gdbserver can also attach to running programs. This is accomplished via the --attach
argument. The syntax is:
target> gdbserver --attach comm pid
pid is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn’t necessary to point gdbserver
at a binary for the running process.
To start gdbserver without supplying an initial command to run or process ID to
attach, use the --multi command line option. In such case you should connect using
target extended-remote to start the program you want to debug.
target> gdbserver --multi comm
870 Debugging with gdb
--debug Instruct gdbserver to display extra status information about the debugging
process. This option is intended for gdbserver development and for bug reports
to the developers.
--remote-debug
Instruct gdbserver to display remote protocol debug output. This option is
intended for gdbserver development and for bug reports to the developers.
--debug-file=filename
Instruct gdbserver to send any debug output to the given filename. This option
is intended for gdbserver development and for bug reports to the developers.
--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]
Instruct gdbserver to include extra information in each line of debugging out-
put. See [Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver], page 314.
--wrapper
Specify a wrapper to launch programs for debugging. The option should be
followed by the name of the wrapper, then any command-line arguments to
pass to the wrapper, then -- indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
--once By default, gdbserver keeps the listening TCP port open, so that additional
connections are possible. However, if you start gdbserver with the --once
option, it will stop listening for any further connection attempts after connecting
to the first gdb session.
gcore
gcore [-a] [-o prefix] pid1 [pid2...pidN ]
Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs pid1, pid2, etc.
A core file produced by gcore is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process
crashes (and when ulimit -c was used to set up an appropriate core dump limit). However,
unlike after a crash, after gcore finishes its job the program remains running without any
change.
-a Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on the
Operating System. On gnu/Linux, it will disable use-coredump-filter (see
[set use-coredump-filter], page 182) and enable dump-excluded-mappings (see
[set dump-excluded-mappings], page 183).
-o prefix The optional argument prefix specifies the prefix to be used when composing
the file names of the core dumps. The file name is composed as prefix.pid,
872 Debugging with gdb
where pid is the process ID of the running program being analyzed by gcore.
If not specified, prefix defaults to gcore.
gdbinit
~/.config/gdb/gdbinit
~/.gdbinit
./.gdbinit
These files contain gdb commands to automatically execute during gdb startup. The
lines of contents are canned sequences of commands, described in Section 23.1 [Sequences],
page 381.
Please read more in Section 2.1.3 [Startup], page 16.
(not enabled with --with-system-gdbinit during compilation)
System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified gdb option
-nx or -n. See more in
(not enabled with --with-system-gdbinit-dir during compilation)
System-wide initialization directory. All files in this directory are executed on
startup unless user specified gdb option -nx or -n, as long as they have a
recognized file extension. See more in Section C.6 [System-wide configuration],
page 733.
~/.config/gdb/gdbinit or ~/.gdbinit
User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified gdb options -nx, -n
or -nh.
.gdbinit Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with gdb
security command set auto-load local-gdbinit. See more in Section 22.8.1
[Init File in the Current Directory], page 368.
gdb-add-index
gdb-add-index filename
When gdb finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the file in order to construct an
internal symbol table. This lets most gdb operations work quickly–at the cost of a delay
early on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so gdb provides a way to
build an index, which speeds up startup.
To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command readelf -S
filename: the index is stored in a section named .gdb_index. The index file can only
be produced on systems which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e.,
sections named .debug_*).
gdb-add-index uses gdb and objdump found in the PATH environment variable. If you
want to use different versions of these programs, you can specify them through the GDB and
OBJDUMP environment variables.
Appendix L: Manual pages 873
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other kinds of
works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away your
freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a program—to make
sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the
GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to any other work
released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies
of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs,
and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or asking
you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you distribute
copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you
must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You must make sure
that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so
they know their rights.
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: (1) assert copy-
right on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal permission to copy,
distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers’ and authors’ protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no
warranty for this free software. For both users’ and authors’ sake, the GPL requires that
modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed
erroneously to authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of the
software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally incom-
patible with the aim of protecting users’ freedom to change the software. The systematic
pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use, which is pre-
cisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this version of the GPL
to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise substantially in other
domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions of the
GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
876 Debugging with gdb
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not
allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose computers, but
in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program
could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that patents cannot
be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
The “System Libraries” of an executable work include anything, other than the work as
a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major Component, but
which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the
work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
implementation is available to the public in source code form. A “Major Component”,
in this context, means a major essential component (kernel, window system, and so
on) of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a
compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The “Corresponding Source” for a work in object code form means all the source code
needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to
modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not
include the work’s System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available
free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are
not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source includes interface definition
files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries
and dynamically linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms
and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate auto-
matically from other parts of the Corresponding Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the
Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License ex-
plicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The output
from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair use
or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without
conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered
works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively
for you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you
comply with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not
control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do
so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit
them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship
with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions
stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users’ Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under
any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty
adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention
of such measures.
878 Debugging with gdb
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention of
technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising rights
under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any intention
to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the
work’s users, your or third parties’ legal rights to forbid circumvention of technological
measures.
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you receive it, in any
medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an
appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all
notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License
along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may offer
support or warranty protection for a fee.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from
the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that
you also meet all of these conditions:
a. The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a
relevant date.
b. The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this Li-
cense and any conditions added under section 7. This requirement modifies the
requirement in section 4 to “keep intact all notices”.
c. You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who
comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any
applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license
the work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have
separately received it.
d. If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate Legal
Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display
Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which
are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined
with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution
medium, is called an “aggregate” if the compilation and its resulting copyright are
not used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation’s users beyond what the
individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause
this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate.
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and
5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under
the terms of this License, in one of these ways:
Appendix M: GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE 879
a. Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a phys-
ical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a
durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange.
b. Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physi-
cal distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three
years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that
product model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of
the Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this
License, on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange,
for a price no more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this con-
veying of source, or (2) access to copy the Corresponding Source from a network
server at no charge.
c. Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to
provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally
and noncommercially, and only if you received the object code with such an offer,
in accord with subsection 6b.
d. Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for
a charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same
way through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients
to copy the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to
copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on
a different server (operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent
copying facilities, provided you maintain clear directions next to the object code
saying where to find the Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts
the Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is available for
as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
e. Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform other
peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being offered
to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the Cor-
responding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the object
code work.
A “User Product” is either (1) a “consumer product”, which means any tangible per-
sonal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes, or
(2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In determining whether
a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage.
For a particular product received by a particular user, “normally used” refers to a
typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the par-
ticular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is
expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether
the product has substantial commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such
uses represent the only significant mode of use of the product.
“Installation Information” for a User Product means any methods, procedures, autho-
rization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified versions of a
covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its Corresponding Source.
880 Debugging with gdb
The information must suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified
object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because modification has
been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for
use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which
the right of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in
perpetuity or for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized),
the Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the
Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any
third party retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for
example, the work has been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement
to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been
modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been
modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself
materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord with
this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an implementa-
tion available to the public in source code form), and must require no special password
or key for unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
“Additional permissions” are terms that supplement the terms of this License by mak-
ing exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are
applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this
License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permis-
sions apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those
permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard
to the additional permissions.
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any
additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions
may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the
work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered
work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered
work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement
the terms of this License with terms:
a. Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections 15
and 16 of this License; or
b. Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions
in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing
it; or
c. Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that mod-
ified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the
original version; or
Appendix M: GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE 881
d. Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the
material; or
e. Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names, trade-
marks, or service marks; or
f. Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who
conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions
of liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions
directly impose on those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered “further restrictions” within
the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, con-
tains a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a
further restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further
restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this License, you may add to a
covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that
the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the
relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a
notice indicating where to find the applicable terms.
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a sep-
arately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either
way.
8. Termination.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided un-
der this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and will
automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses
granted under the third paragraph of section 11).
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular
copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder
explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days
after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if
the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the
first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the
notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties
who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have
been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new
licenses for the same material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the
Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence of
using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance.
882 Debugging with gdb
However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or modify
any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not accept this License.
Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you indicate your acceptance
of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license
from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this
License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this
License.
An “entity transaction” is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or
substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging organizations.
If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work
the party’s predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus
a right to possession of the Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in
interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or
affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or
other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate
litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent
claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program
or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A “contributor” is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the
Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called
the contributor’s “contributor version”.
A contributor’s “essential patent claims” are all patent claims owned or controlled by
the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed
by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor
version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of
further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition, “con-
trol” includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the
requirements of this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license
under the contributor’s essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import
and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a “patent license” is any express agreement or com-
mitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express permission
to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To “grant” such
a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to
enforce a patent against the party.
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the Corre-
sponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge and under
the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or other readily
accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
Appendix M: GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE 883
available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent license for this
particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the requirements of this
License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients. “Knowingly relying”
means you have actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
covered work in a country, or your recipient’s use of the covered work in a country,
would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that you have reason
to believe are valid.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey,
or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license
to some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate,
modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant
is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it.
A patent license is “discriminatory” if it does not include within the scope of its cover-
age, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the
rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered
work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the business of
distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party based on the
extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third party grants,
to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work conveyed by you (or
copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in connection with specific
products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless you entered into that
arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license or
other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under applicable
patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others’ Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions
of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously
your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a
consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that
obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License would
be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or
combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero
General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work.
The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, section 13,
concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
884 Debugging with gdb
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the GNU
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit
to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that
a certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License “or any later version”
applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that
numbered version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Program does not specify a version number of the GNU General Public License,
you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU
General Public License can be used, that proxy’s public statement of acceptance of a
version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no
additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your
choosing to follow a later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PER-
MITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN
WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE
THE PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EX-
PRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE
OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFEC-
TIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR
CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, IN-
CIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR
INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUS-
TAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM
TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAM-
AGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given
local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that
most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with
the Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the
Program in return for a fee.
Appendix M: GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE 885
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program. If not, see http://www.gnu.org/licenses/.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short notice like this when it
starts in an interactive mode:
program Copyright (C) year name of author
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
under certain conditions; type ‘show c’ for details.
The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts of
the General Public License. Of course, your program’s commands might be different; for a
GUI interface, you would use an “about box”.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, if any, to
sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. For more information on this,
and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see http://www.gnu.org/licenses/.
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more
useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you want
to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this License. But first, please
read http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html.
887
under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is
not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant
Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none.
The “Cover Texts” are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover
Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under
this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may
be at most 25 words.
A “Transparent” copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented
in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for
revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images com-
posed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing
editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to
a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise
Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to
thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image
format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is
not “Transparent” is called “Opaque”.
Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ascii without
markup, Texinfo input format, LaTEX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly
available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed
for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF
and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited
only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML,
PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only.
The “Title Page” means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following
pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the
title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, “Title Page”
means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work’s title, preceding the
beginning of the body of the text.
The “publisher” means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document
to the public.
A section “Entitled XYZ” means a named subunit of the Document whose title either
is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in
another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such
as “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, “Endorsements”, or “History”.) To “Preserve
the Title” of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
section “Entitled XYZ” according to this definition.
The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that
this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to
be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties:
any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no
effect on the meaning of this License.
2. VERBATIM COPYING
Appendix N: GNU Free Documentation License 889
You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or
noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license
notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and
that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies
you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies.
If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions
in section 3.
You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly
display copies.
3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of
the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document’s license notice requires
Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all
these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher
of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title
equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the
Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other
respects.
If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put
the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the
rest onto adjacent pages.
If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100,
you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque
copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which
the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network
protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If
you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin
distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will
remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time
you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
edition to the public.
It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well
before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you
with an updated version of the Document.
4. MODIFICATIONS
You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions
of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely
this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing
distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of
it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the
Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any,
890 Debugging with gdb
be listed in the History section of the Document). You may use the same title as
a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for
authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five
of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer
than five), unless they release you from this requirement.
C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the
publisher.
D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other
copyright notices.
F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public
permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form
shown in the Addendum below.
G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover
Texts given in the Document’s license notice.
H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
I. Preserve the section Entitled “History”, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item
stating at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version
as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled “History” in the Docu-
ment, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document
as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as
stated in the previous sentence.
J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to
a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in
the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the
“History” section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published
at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the
version it refers to gives permission.
K. For any section Entitled “Acknowledgements” or “Dedications”, Preserve the Title
of the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the
contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and
in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the
section titles.
M. Delete any section Entitled “Endorsements”. Such a section may not be included
in the Modified Version.
N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled “Endorsements” or to conflict in
title with any Invariant Section.
O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify
as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at
your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their
Appendix N: GNU Free Documentation License 891
titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version’s license notice. These
titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
You may add a section Entitled “Endorsements”, provided it contains nothing but
endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties—for example, statements of
peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative
definition of a standard.
You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up
to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified
Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be
added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement
made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but
you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that
added the old one.
The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission
to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified
Version.
5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License,
under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you
include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents,
unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license
notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical
Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant
Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section
unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or
publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment
to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined
work.
In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled “History” in the vari-
ous original documents, forming one section Entitled “History”; likewise combine any
sections Entitled “Acknowledgements”, and any sections Entitled “Dedications”. You
must delete all sections Entitled “Endorsements.”
6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released
under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various
documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you
follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all
other respects.
You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individu-
ally under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted
document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of
that document.
892 Debugging with gdb
Concept Index
! --return-child-result . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
‘!’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751 --se . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--selftest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
--silent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
# --statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
--symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
# in Modula-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
--tty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
--tui . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
$ --version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
--windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
$ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
‘--with-gdb-datadir’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
$$ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
‘--with-relocated-sources’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
$_ and info breakpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
‘--with-sysroot’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
$_ and info line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
--wrapper, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
$_, $__, and value history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
--write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
-b . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
& -c . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
-d . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
&, background execution of commands . . . . . . . . . . 95 -D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
-e . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
– -eiex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
-eix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--annotate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 -ex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--args. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
-f . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
--attach, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
-iex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--batch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
-info-gdb-mi-command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 664
--batch-silent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
-ix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--baud. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
-l . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
--cd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
-n . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
-nw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
--configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
-p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--core. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
-q . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--data-directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
--debug, gdbserver option. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 -r . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--debug-file, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 -readnever, option for symbol-file command . . 286
--debug-format, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . 314 -s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 -t . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
--early-init-command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 -w . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
--early-init-eval-command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 -x . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--eval-command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--exec. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
--fullname . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 .
--init-command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 ., Modula-2 scope operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
--init-eval-command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 .build-id directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
--interpreter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 .debug subdirectories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
--multi, gdbserver option. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 .debug_gdb_scripts section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
--nh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 ‘.gdb_index’ section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
--nowindows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 .gdb index section format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 859
--nx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 .gdbinit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
--once, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 ‘.gnu_debugdata’ section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
--pid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 .gnu_debuglink sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
--quiet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 .note.gnu.build-id sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
--readnever, command-line option . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 .o files, reading symbols from . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
--readnow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
--remote-debug, gdbserver option . . . . . . . . . . . 314
896 Debugging with gdb
B C
‘b’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751 ‘c’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
‘B’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751 C and C++ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
background execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 571 C and C++ checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
backtrace beyond main function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 C and C++ constants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
backtrace limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 C and C++ defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
base name differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 C and C++ operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
baud rate for remote targets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 ‘C’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
‘bc’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751 C++ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
bcache statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742 C++ compilers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
bits in remote address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 C++ demangling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
blocks in guile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532 C++ exception handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
blocks in python . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467 C++ overload debugging info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
bookmark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 C++ scope resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
boundary violations, Intel MPX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 C++ symbol decoding style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
branch trace configuration format . . . . . . . . . . . . . 821 C++ symbol display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
branch trace format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 820 caching data of targets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
branch trace store . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 caching of bfd objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
break in overloaded functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 caching of opened files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
break on a system call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 call dummy stack unwinding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
break on fork/exec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 call dummy stack unwinding on
BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 unhandled exception. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
breakpoint address adjusted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 call overloaded functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
breakpoint at static probe point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 call stack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
breakpoint commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 call stack traces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
breakpoint commands for gdb/mi . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587 call-clobbered registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
breakpoint commands, in remote protocol . . . . . 782 caller-saved registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
breakpoint conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 calling functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
breakpoint kinds, ARM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 791 calling functions in the program, disabling. . . . . 278
breakpoint kinds, MIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 792 calling make . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
breakpoint lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 case sensitivity in symbol names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
breakpoint numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 case-insensitive symbol names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
breakpoint on events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 casts, in expressions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
breakpoint on memory address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 casts, to view memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
breakpoint on variable modification . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 catch Ada exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
breakpoint ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 catch Ada exceptions when handled . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
breakpoint subroutine, remote. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 catch syscalls from inferior, remote request . . . . 772
898 Debugging with gdb
exec events, remote reply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763 fork, debugging programs which call . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
executable file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 format options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
executable file target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 formatted output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
executable file, for remote target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 Fortran . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
execute commands from a file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 fortran array slicing debugging info . . . . . . . . . . . 375
execute forward or backward in time . . . . . . . . . . 100 Fortran Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
execute remote command, remote request . . . . . 774 Fortran Intrinsics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
execution, foreground, background Fortran modules, information about . . . . . . . . . . . 268
and asynchronous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 571 Fortran operators and expressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
exit status of shell commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Fortran Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
exiting gdb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Fortran-specific support in gdb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
expand macro once . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 frame debugging info. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
expanding preprocessor macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 frame decorator api . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
explicit locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 frame filters api . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
explore type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 frame information, printing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
explore value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 frame level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
exploring hierarchical data structures . . . . . . . . . 139 frame number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
expression debugging info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 frame pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
expression parser, debugging info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 frame pointer register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
expressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 frame, definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
expressions in Ada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 frameless execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
expressions in C or C++ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 frames in guile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
expressions in C++ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 frames in python . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
expressions in Modula-2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 free memory information (MS-DOS). . . . . . . . . . . 332
extend gdb for remote targets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312 FreeBSD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
extending GDB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 FreeBSD LWP debug messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
extra signal information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 FreeBSD native target debug messages . . . . . . . . 374
fstat, file-i/o system call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
Fujitsu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
F full symbol tables, listing gdb’s internal . . . . . . . 269
‘F’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752 function call arguments, optimized out . . . . . . . . 112
F reply packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 807 function entry/exit, wrong
F request packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 806 values of variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
fast tracepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 functions and variables by Fortran module . . . . 268
fast tracepoints, setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 functions without line info, and stepping . . . . . . . 84
fatal signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 689
fatal signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
features of the remote protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 775 G
fetch memory tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 770 ‘g’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
file name canonicalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 g++, gnu C++ compiler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
file transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312 ‘G’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 753
file transfer, remote protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 799 garbled pointers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
file-i/o examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816 gcc and C++ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
file-i/o overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 805 gdb bugs, reporting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 689
file-i/o reply packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 807 gdb internal error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 738
file-i/o request packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 806 gdb module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
File-I/O remote protocol extension . . . . . . . . . . . . 805 gdb objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
filename-display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 gdb reference card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
find trace snapshot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 gdb startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
flinching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372 gdb version number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
float promotion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 gdb.ini . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
floating point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 gdb.printing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
floating point registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 gdb.prompt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 498
floating point, MIPS remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343 gdb.types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
focus of debugging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 gdb.Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
foo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 gdb/mi development . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
foreground execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 571 gdb/mi, async records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
fork events, remote reply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763 gdb/mi, breakpoint commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
Concept Index 901
M
K ‘m’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754
‘k’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754 m680x0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
kernel crash dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 m68k-stub.c . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
kernel memory image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 ‘M’ packet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754
kill ring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694 Mach-O symbols processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
killing text. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694 machine instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
macro definition, showing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
macro expansion, showing the results
of preprocessor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
macros, example of debugging with. . . . . . . . . . . . 196
macros, from debug info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Concept Index 903
! $trace_file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 $trace_frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
$trace_func . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
$trace_line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
# $tracepoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
# (a comment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
–
$ -ada-task-info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 606
$_, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 -add-inferior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 670
$__, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 -break-after . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
$_ada_exception, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . 70 -break-commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
$_any_caller_is, convenience function . . . . . . . 174 -break-condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
$_any_caller_matches, -break-delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 -break-disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
$_as_string, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 -break-enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
$_caller_is, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 -break-info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
$_caller_matches, convenience function . . . . . . 174 -break-insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 591
$_cimag, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 -break-list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
$_creal, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 -break-passcount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
$_exception, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 -break-watch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
$_exitcode, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 -catch-assert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
$_exitsignal, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . 168 -catch-catch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
$_gdb_maint_setting, convenience function . . . 172 -catch-exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599
$_gdb_maint_setting_str, -catch-handlers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599
convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 -catch-load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
$_gdb_major, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 -catch-rethrow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
$_gdb_minor, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 -catch-throw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
$_gdb_setting, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . 171 -catch-unload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
$_gdb_setting_str, convenience function . . . . . 171 -complete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 673
$_gthread, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 -data-disassemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
$_hit_bpnum, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 -data-evaluate-expression. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634
$_hit_locno, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 -data-list-changed-registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
$_inferior, convenience variable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 -data-list-register-names. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
$_inferior_thread_count, -data-list-register-values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 -data-read-memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
$_isvoid, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 -data-read-memory-bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
$_memeq, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 -data-write-memory-bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
$_probe_arg, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 -dprintf-insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
$_regex, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 -enable-frame-filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
$_sdata, collect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 -enable-pretty-printing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
$_sdata, inspect, convenience variable. . . . . . . . . 169 -enable-timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 672
$_shell, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 -environment-cd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
$_shell_exitcode, convenience variable. . . . . . . 170 -environment-directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
$_shell_exitsignal, convenience variable . . . . 170 -environment-path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
$_siginfo, convenience variable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 -environment-pwd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604
$_streq, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 -exec-arguments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
$_strlen, convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 -exec-continue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
$_thread, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 -exec-finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
$_tlb, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 -exec-interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609
$bpnum, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 -exec-jump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609
$cdir, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 -exec-next . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 610
$cwd, convenience variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 -exec-next-instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 610
$tpnum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 -exec-return . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611
912 Debugging with gdb
A B
abort (C-g) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714 b (break) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
accept-line (Newline or Return) . . . . . . . . . . . . 709 backtrace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 backward-char (C-b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 708
ada-task-info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 665 backward-delete-char (Rubout) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711
add-auto-load-safe-path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 backward-kill-line (C-x Rubout) . . . . . . . . . . . 712
add-auto-load-scripts-directory . . . . . . . . . . . 552 backward-kill-word (M-DEL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 712
add-inferior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 backward-word (M-b) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 708
add-symbol-file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 beginning-of-history (M-<) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
add-symbol-file-from-memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 beginning-of-line (C-a) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 708
adi assign . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352 bell-style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 697
adi examine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 bfd caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
advance locspec. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 bind-tty-special-chars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 697
alias. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 blink-matching-paren . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 697
append . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 block-end . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
append-pretty-printer! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550 block-function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
apropos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 block-global-block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-bool-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 block-global? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-char-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 block-start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-charset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 block-static-block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
block-static? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
arch-disassemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
block-superblock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-double-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
block-symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
arch-float-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
block-symbols-progress? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
arch-int-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
block-valid? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-int16-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
Block.end . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-int32-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Block.function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-int64-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Block.global_block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-int8-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
Block.is_global . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-long-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 Block.is_static . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-longdouble-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 Block.is_valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-longlong-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 Block.start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 Block.static_block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-schar-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 Block.superblock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
arch-short-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 block? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
arch-uchar-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-uint-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 BP_BREAKPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-uint16-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 BP_CATCHPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-uint32-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 BP_HARDWARE_BREAKPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
arch-uint64-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-uint8-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 BP_READ_WATCHPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-ulong-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 BP_WATCHPOINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476, 539
arch-ulonglong-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 bracketed-paste-begin () . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711
arch-ushort-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544 break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
arch-void-type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 break ... task taskno (Ada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
arch-wide-charset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 break ... thread thread-id . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
arch?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 break, and Objective-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Architecture.disassemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481 break-range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Architecture.integer_type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 breakpoint annotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 678
Architecture.name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481 breakpoint-commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
Architecture.register_groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 breakpoint-condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
Architecture.registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 breakpoint-enabled? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
attach. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 breakpoint-expression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
attach& . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 breakpoint-hit-count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
awatch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 breakpoint-ignore-count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
breakpoint-location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
breakpoint-notifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 665
breakpoint-number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
914 Debugging with gdb
H InferiorThread.is_exited . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
h (help) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 InferiorThread.is_running. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
handle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 InferiorThread.is_stopped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
handle_exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 InferiorThread.is_valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
hbreak. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 InferiorThread.name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 InferiorThread.num . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
help function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 InferiorThread.ptid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
help target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 InferiorThread.switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
help user-defined . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
history-append! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501 info address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
history-preserve-point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699 info all-registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
history-ref . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501 info args . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
history-search-backward () . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709 info auto-load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
history-search-forward () . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709 info auto-load gdb-scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
history-size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699 info auto-load guile-scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
history-substring-search-backward () . . . . . 710 info auto-load libthread-db . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
history-substring-search-forward () . . . . . . 710 info auto-load local-gdbinit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 info auto-load python-scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
hookpost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 info auxv . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
horizontal-scroll-mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699 info breakpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
host-config . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 info checkpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
info classes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
info common . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
I info connections [ id... ] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
i (info) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 info copying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
i (SingleKey TUI key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 info dcache . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
if . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 info display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
ignore. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 info dll . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
inferior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 info dos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
inferior infno . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 info exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Inferior.architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info extensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Inferior.arguments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info f (info frame) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Inferior.clear_env . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Inferior.connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437 info float . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Inferior.connection_num . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Inferior.is_valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info frame, show the source language . . . . . . . . . 225
Inferior.main_name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info frame-filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Inferior.num . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437 info functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Inferior.pid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Inferior.progspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info inferiors [ id... ] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Inferior.read_memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info io_registers, AVR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Inferior.search_memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Inferior.set_env . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info line, and Objective-C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Inferior.thread_from_handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info locals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Inferior.thread_from_thread_handle . . . . . . . 439 info macro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Inferior.threads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Inferior.unset_env . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info main . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Inferior.was_attached . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 info mem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Inferior.write_memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439 info meminfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
InferiorCallPostEvent.address . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 info module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
InferiorCallPostEvent.ptid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 info modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
InferiorCallPreEvent.address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 info os . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
InferiorCallPreEvent.ptid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 info os cpus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
InferiorDeletedEvent.inferior . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 info os files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
InferiorThread.details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 info os modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
InferiorThread.global_num. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444 info os msg . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
InferiorThread.handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 info os processes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
InferiorThread.inferior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 info os procgroups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
920 Debugging with gdb
Q RecordGap.error_code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
q (quit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 RecordGap.error_string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
q (SingleKey TUI key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 RecordGap.number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
query annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676 RecordInstruction.is_speculative . . . . . . . . . 447
queue-signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 RecordInstruction.number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
quit [expression] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 RecordInstruction.sal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
quit annotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677 redraw-current-line () . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
quoted-insert (C-q or C-v) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 refresh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
register-breakpoint! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
register-command! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522
R register-parameter! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526
r (run) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 register_disassembler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
r (SingleKey TUI key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 register_xmethod_matcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
rbreak. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
RegisterChangedEvent.frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
rc (reverse-continue) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
RegisterChangedEvent.regnum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
re-read-init-file (C-x C-r) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
readnow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 RegisterDescriptor.name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
rec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 RegisterDescriptorIterator.find . . . . . . . . . . . 482
rec btrace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 RegisterGroup.name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
rec btrace bts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 remote delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
rec btrace pt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 remote get . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
rec bts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 remote put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
rec del . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 RemoteTargetConnection.send_packet . . . . . . . 484
rec full . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 remove-inferiors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
rec function-call-history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 remove-symbol-file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
rec instruction-history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 restart checkpoint-id . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
rec pt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
rec s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
RET (repeat last command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
recognize on type_recognizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 return . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
record btrace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 reverse-continue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
record btrace bts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 reverse-finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
record btrace pt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 reverse-next . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
record bts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 reverse-nexti . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
record delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 reverse-search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
record full . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 reverse-search-history (C-r) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
record function-call-history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 reverse-step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
record goto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 reverse-stepi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
record instruction-history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 revert-all-at-newline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 701
record pt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 revert-line (M-r) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715
record restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Right. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
record save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
rn (reverse-next) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
record stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Record.begin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 rni (reverse-nexti) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Record.end . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 rs (step) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Record.format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 rsi (reverse-stepi). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Record.function_call_history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Record.goto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 run& . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Record.instruction_history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 rwatch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Record.method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
Record.replay_position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
RecordFunctionSegment.instructions . . . . . . . 447
RecordFunctionSegment.level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
RecordFunctionSegment.next . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
RecordFunctionSegment.number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
RecordFunctionSegment.prev . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
RecordFunctionSegment.symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
RecordFunctionSegment.up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
Command, Variable, and Function Index 925
T tvariable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
taas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 type-array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
tab-insert (M-TAB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 type-code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
tabset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565 type-const . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 type-field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
target ctf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 type-fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
target record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 type-has-field-deep? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
target record-btrace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 type-has-field? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
target record-full . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 type-name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
target sim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 type-num-fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
target tfile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 type-pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
target-config . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 type-print-name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
TargetConnection.description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484 type-range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
TargetConnection.details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484 type-reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
TargetConnection.is_valid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483 type-sizeof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
TargetConnection.num . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483 type-strip-typedefs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
TargetConnection.type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484 type-tag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
task (Ada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 type-target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
tbreak. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 type-unqualified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
tcatch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 type-vector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
tdump. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 type-volatile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
teval (tracepoints) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Type.alignof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
tfaas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Type.array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
tfile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Type.code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
tfind. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Type.const . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
thbreak . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Type.dynamic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
this, inside C++ member functions . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Type.fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
thread apply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Type.is_scalar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
thread find . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Type.is_signed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
thread name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Type.name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
thread thread-id . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Type.objfile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
thread-info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 665 Type.optimized_out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
ThreadEvent.inferior_thread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Type.pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
ThreadExitedEvent.inferior_thread . . . . . . . . 443 Type.range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
throw-user-error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522 Type.reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
tilde-expand (M-~) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715 Type.sizeof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
trace. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Type.strip_typedefs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
transpose-chars (C-t). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 Type.tag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
transpose-words (M-t). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 Type.target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
tsave. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Type.template_argument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
tstart [ notes ] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Type.unqualified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
tstatus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Type.vector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
tstop [ notes ] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Type.volatile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
tty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 type?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
tui disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562 TYPE_CODE_ARRAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411, 514
tui enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562 TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
tui layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563 TYPE_CODE_BOOL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
tui new-layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562 TYPE_CODE_CHAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
tui refresh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564 TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
tui reg . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564 TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413, 516
tui window height. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564 TYPE_CODE_ENUM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411, 514
tui window width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564 TYPE_CODE_ERROR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
TuiWindow.erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_FIXED_POINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413, 516
TuiWindow.height . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_FLAGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411, 515
TuiWindow.is_valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_FLT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
TuiWindow.title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_FUNC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
TuiWindow.width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_INT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412, 515
TuiWindow.write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . 413, 516
Command, Variable, and Function Index 931